Mazda 2015 Cx 5 Owners Manual 20131120 1..532 ++

Mazda-Cx-5-Owners-Manual-746903 mazda-cx-5-owners-manual-746903

2015-10-23

: Mazda Mazda-2015-Mazda-Cx-5-Owners-Manual-817880 mazda-2015-mazda-cx-5-owners-manual-817880 mazda pdf

Open the PDF directly: View PDF PDF.
Page Count: 532 [warning: Documents this large are best viewed by clicking the View PDF Link!]

Black plate (1,1)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page1
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (2,1)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page2
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (3,1)
Thank you for choosing a Mazda. We at Mazda design and build vehicles with complete
customer satisfaction in mind.
To help ensure enjoyable and trouble-free operation of your Mazda, read this manual
carefully and follow its recommendations.
An Authorized Mazda Dealer knows your vehicle best. So when maintenance or service is
necessary, that's the place to go.
Our nationwide network of Mazda professionals is dedicated to providing you with the best
possible service.
We assure you that all of us at Mazda have an ongoing interest in your motoring pleasure
and in your full satisfaction with your Mazda product.
Mazda Motor Corporation
HIROSHIMA, JAPAN
Important Notes About This Manual
Keep this manual in the glove box as a handy reference for the safe and enjoyable use of your Mazda. Should you
resell the vehicle, leave this manual with it for the next owner.
All specifications and descriptions are accurate at the time of printing. Because improvement is a constant goal at
Mazda, we reserve the right to make changes in specifications at any time without notice and without obligation.
Air Conditioning and the Environment
Your Mazda's genuine air conditioner is filled with HFC134a (R134a), a refrigerant that has been found not to
damage the earth's ozone layer. If the air conditioner does not operate properly, consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Perchlorate
Certain components of this vehicle such as [air bag modules, seat belt pretensioners, lithium batteries, ···] may contain Perchlorate Material- - Special handling
may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal. See
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
Please be aware that this manual applies to all models, equipment and options. As a result, you may find
some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle.
©2014 Mazda Motor Corporation
Printed in Japan Jan. 2014 (Print1)
A Word to Mazda Owners
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page3
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (4,1)
We want to help you get the most driving
pleasure from your vehicle. Your owner's
manual, when read from cover to cover,
can do that in many ways.
Illustrations complement the words of the
manual to best explain how to enjoy your
Mazda. By reading your manual, you can
find out about the features, important
safety information, and driving under
various road conditions.
The symbol below in this manual means
Do not do thisor Do not let this
happen.
Index: A good place to start is the Index,
an alphabetical listing of all information
in your manual.
You'll find several WARNINGs,
CAUTIONs, and NOTEs in the manual.
WARNING
A WARNING indicates a situation in
which serious injury or death could
result if the warning is ignored.
CAUTION
A CAUTION indicates a situation in
which bodily injury or damage to
your vehicle, or both, could result if
the caution is ignored.
NOTE
A NOTE provides information and sometimes
suggests how to make better use of your
vehicle.
The symbol below, located on some parts
of the vehicle, indicates that this manual
contains information related to the part.
Please refer to the manual for a detailed
explanation.
How to Use This Manual
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page4
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (5,1)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page5
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Table of Contents
Pictorial Index
Interior, exterior views and part identification of your Mazda. 1
Essential Safety Equipment
Important information about safety equipment, including seats, seat belt
system, child-restraint systems and SRS air bags.
2
Before Driving
Use of various features, including keys, doors, mirrors and windows. 3
When Driving
Information concerning safe driving and stopping. 4
Interior Features
Use of various features for ride comfort, including air-conditioning and audio
system.
5
Maintenance and Care
How to keep your Mazda in top condition. 6
If Trouble Arises
Helpful information on what to do if a problem arises with the vehicle. 7
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment. 8
Specifications
Technical information about your Mazda. 9
Index 10
Black plate (6,1)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page6
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (7,1)
1Pictorial Index
Interior, exterior views and part identification of your Mazda.
Interior Overview .......................................................................... 1-2
Interior Equipment (View A) .................................................... 1-2
Interior Equipment (View B) .................................................... 1-3
Interior Equipment (View C) .................................................... 1-4
Exterior Overview ......................................................................... 1-5
1-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page7
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (8,1)
Interior Equipment (View A)
Door-lock knob .................................................................................................. page 3-17
TCS OFF switch ................................................................................................ page 4-84
Tire pressure monitoring system set switch ....................................................... page 4-95
Turn and lane-change signal .............................................................................. page 4-60
Lighting control ................................................................................................. page 4-55
Instrument cluster .............................................................................................. page 4-10
Dashboard illumination knob ............................................................................ page 4-13
Wiper and washer lever ..................................................................................... page 4-61
Push button start .................................................................................................. page 4-2
AFS OFF switch ................................................................................................ page 4-59
BSM OFF switch ............................................................................................. page 4-100
Outside mirror switch ........................................................................................ page 3-27
Door-lock switch ............................................................................................... page 3-14
Power window lock switch ................................................................................ page 3-32
Power window switches .................................................................................... page 3-30
1-2
Pictorial Index
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle
Interior Overview
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page8
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (9,1)
Interior Equipment (View B)
Audio control switches ...................................................................................... page 5-56
SRS air bags ...................................................................................................... page 2-40
Cruise control switches ...................................................................................... page 4-89
Navigation system (if equipped) .......................................... Refer to the separate manual
Audio system ..................................................................................................... page 5-13
Hazard warning flasher switch .......................................................................... page 4-67
Climate control system ........................................................................................ page 5-2
Glove compartment ......................................................................................... page 5-118
Rear window defogger switch ........................................................................... page 4-66
Accessory socket ............................................................................................. page 5-114
Manual transaxle shift lever ............................................................................... page 4-44
Automatic transaxle selector lever ..................................................................... page 4-46
Parking brake ..................................................................................................... page 4-72
Seat warmer switches .......................................................................................... page 2-7
Lock release lever .............................................................................................. page 3-26
Hood release handle .......................................................................................... page 6-18
Pictorial Index
Interior Overview
1-3The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page9
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (10,1)
Interior Equipment (View C)
Seat belts ............................................................................................................ page 2-14
SRS curtain air bag ............................................................................................ page 2-40
Remote fuel-filler lid release ............................................................................. page 3-24
Bottle holder .................................................................................................... page 5-117
Vanity mirror .................................................................................................... page 5-110
Moonroof switch ............................................................................................... page 3-33
Overhead lights ................................................................................................ page 5-111
Rearview mirror ................................................................................................. page 3-28
Sunvisor ........................................................................................................... page 5-110
Cup holders ...................................................................................................... page 5-116
Front seat ............................................................................................................. page 2-5
Center console ................................................................................................. page 5-119
Rear seat .............................................................................................................. page 2-8
1-4
Pictorial Index
The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle
Interior Overview
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page10
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (11,1)
Hood .................................................................................................................. page 6-18
Windshield wiper blades .................................................................................... page 6-27
Moonroof ........................................................................................................... page 3-33
Doors and keys .................................................................................................. page 3-11
Fuel-filler lid ...................................................................................................... page 3-24
Wheels and Tires ............................................................................................... page 6-35
Exterior lights .................................................................................................... page 6-40
Rear window wiper blade .................................................................................. page 6-28
Liftgate .............................................................................................................. page 3-18
Antenna ............................................................................................................. page 5-13
Child safety locks .............................................................................................. page 3-18
Outside mirror .................................................................................................... page 3-27
Pictorial Index
Exterior Overview
1-5The equipment and installation position varies by vehicle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page11
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (12,1)
1-6
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page12
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (13,1)
2Essential Safety Equipment
Important information about safety equipment, including seats, seat belt
system, child-restraint systems and SRS air bags.
Seats ............................................................................................... 2-2
Seat Precaution .......................................................................... 2-2
Front Seat .................................................................................. 2-5
Rear Seat ................................................................................... 2-8
Head Restraints ....................................................................... 2-12
Seat Belt Systems ........................................................................ 2-14
Seat Belt Precautions .............................................................. 2-14
Seat Belt .................................................................................. 2-17
Seat Belt Warning Systems ..................................................... 2-18
Front Seat Belt Pretensioner and Load Limiting Systems ....... 2-18
Center-Rear Position Seat Belt ................................................ 2-20
Seat Belt Extender ................................................................... 2-21
Child Restraint ............................................................................ 2-23
Child Restraint Precautions ..................................................... 2-23
Child-Restraint System Installation ........................................ 2-28
Installing Child-Restraint Systems .......................................... 2-29
SRS Air Bags ............................................................................... 2-40
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions ................ 2-40
Supplemental Restraint System Components ......................... 2-47
How the SRS Air Bags Work .................................................. 2-49
SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria .......................................... 2-53
Limitations to SRS Air Bag .................................................... 2-54
Front Passenger Occupant Classification System
í
................ 2-56
Constant Monitoring ............................................................... 2-62
2-1
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page13
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (14,1)
Seat Precaution
WARNING
Make sure the adjustable components of a seat are locked in place:
Adjustable seats and seatbacks that are not securely locked are dangerous. In a
sudden stop or collision, the seat or seatback could move, causing injury. Make sure
the adjustable components of the seat are locked in place by attempting to slide the
seat forward and backward and rocking the seatback.
Never allow children to adjust a seat:
Allowing children to adjust a seat is dangerous as it could result in serious injury if a
child's hands or feet become caught in the seat.
Do not drive with the seatback unlocked:
All of the seatbacks play an important role in your protection in a vehicle. Leaving
the seatback unlocked is dangerous as it can allow passengers to be ejected or
thrown around and baggage to strike occupants in a sudden stop or collision,
resulting in severe injury. After adjusting the seatback at any time, even when there
are no other passengers, rock the seatback to make sure it is locked in place.
Adjust the driver's seat only when the vehicle is stopped:
Adjusting the driver's seat while the vehicle is moving is dangerous. The driver could
lose control of the vehicle and have an accident.
Do not modify or replace the front seats:
Modifying or replacing the front seats such as replacing the upholstery or loosening
any bolts is dangerous. The front seats contain air bag components essential to the
supplemental restraint system. Such modifications could damage the supplemental
restraint system and result in serious injury. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer if
there is any need to remove or reinstall the front seats.
Do not drive with damaged front seats:
Driving with damaged front seats is dangerous. A collision, even one not strong
enough to inflate the air bags, could damage the front seats which contain essential
air bag components. If there was a subsequent collision, an air bag may not deploy
which could lead to injuries. Always have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect the
front seats, front seat belt pretensioners and air bags after a collision.
Do not drive with either front seats reclined:
Sitting in a reclined position while the vehicle is moving is dangerous because you do
not get the full protection from seat belts. During sudden braking or a collision, you
can slide under the lap belt and suffer serious internal injuries. For maximum
protection, sit well back and upright.
2-2
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page14
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (15,1)
Do not place an object such as a cushion between the seatback and your back:
Putting an object such as a cushion between the seatback and your back is
dangerous because you will be unable to maintain a safe driving posture and the
seat belt cannot function at its full capacity in a collision, which could result in a
serious accident, injury or death.
Do not place objects under the seat:
The object could get stuck and cause the seat to not be fixed securely, and result in
an accident.
Do not stack cargo higher than the seatbacks:
Stacking luggage or other cargo higher than the seatbacks is dangerous. During
sudden braking or a collision, objects can fly around and become projectiles that
may hit and injure passengers.
Make sure luggage and cargo is secured before driving:
Not securing cargo while driving is dangerous as it could move or be crushed during
sudden braking or a collision and cause injury.
Never allow a passenger to sit or stand on the folded seatback while the vehicle is
moving:
Driving with a passenger on the folded seatback is dangerous. Allowing a child to sit
up on the folded seatback while the vehicle is moving is particularly dangerous. In a
sudden stop or even a minor collision, a child not in a proper seat or child-restraint
system and seat belt could be thrown forward, back or even out of the vehicle
resulting in serious injuries or death. The child in the baggage area could be thrown
into other occupants and cause serious injury.
CAUTION
ØWhen operating a seat, be careful not to put your hands or fingers near the
moving parts of the seat or on the side trim to prevent injury.
ØWhen moving the seats, make sure there is no cargo in the surrounding area. If
the cargo gets caught it could damage the cargo.
Ø(Manual Seat)
When returning a rear-reclined seatback to its upright position, make sure you
hold onto the seatback with your other hand while operating the lever. If the
seatback is not supported, it will flip forward suddenly and could cause injury.
Ø(Power Seat)
The seat-bottom power adjustment is operated by motors. Avoid extended
operation because excessive use can damage the motors.
ØTo prevent the battery from running down, avoid using the power adjustment
when the engine is stopped. The adjuster uses a large amount of electrical
power.
ØDo not use the switch to make more than one adjustment at a time.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page15
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (16,1)
NOTE
When returning a rear seat to its original position, also replace the seat belt to its normal position.
Verify that the seat belt pulls out and retracts.
2-4
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page16
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (17,1)
Front Seat
qSeat Operation
Power operation
Seat Slide
(Manual Seat)
To move a seat forward or backward, raise the lever and slide the seat to the desired
position and release the lever.
Make sure the lever returns to its original position and the seat is locked in place by
attempting to push it forward and backward.
(Power Seat)
To slide the seat, move the slide lifter switch on the outside of the seat to the front or back
and hold it. Release the switch at the desired position.
Height Adjustment (Driver's Seat)
(Manual Seat)
To adjust the seat height, move the lever up or down.
(Power Seat)
To adjust the seat height, move the switch up or down.
Front Height Adjustment of Seat Bottom (Driver's Power Seat)
í
To adjust the front height of the seat bottom, raise or lower the front of the slide lifter
switch.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-5
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page17
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (18,1)
Seat Recline
(Manual Seat)
To change the seatback angle, lean forward slightly while raising the lever. Then lean back
to the desired position and release the lever.
Make sure the lever returns to its original position and the seatback is locked in place by
attempting to push it forward and backward.
(Power Seat)
To change the seatback angle, press the front or rear side of the reclining switch. Release
the switch at the desired position.
Lumbar Support Adjustment (Driver's Seat)
í
(Manual Operation)
To increase the seat firmness, push the lever forward. Pull the lever backward to decrease
firmness.
(Power Operation)
To increase the seat firmness, press and hold the front part of the switch to the desired
position, then release it.
Press the rear part of the switch to decrease firmness.
2-6
Essential Safety Equipment
í
Some models.
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page18
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (19,1)
qSeat Warmer
í
The front seats are electrically heated. The
ignition must be switched ON.
Press the seat warmer switch to illuminate
the indicator light while the ignition is
switched ON. The mode changes as
follow each time the seat warmer switch is
pressed.
Fully Automatic Type Climate Control
OFF
High
Mid
Low
Manual Type Climate Control
OFF
High
Mid
Low
WARNING
Be careful when using the seat warmer:
The heat from the seat warmer may
be too hot for some people, as
indicated below, and could cause a
low-temperature burn.
ØInfants, small babies, elderly
people, and physically challenged
people
ØPeople with delicate skin
ØPeople who are excessively
fatigued
ØPeople who are intoxicated
ØPeople who have taken sleep-
inducing medicine such as
sleeping pills or cold medicine
Do not use the seat warmer with
anything having high moisture-
retention ability such as a blanket or
cushion on the seat:
The seat may be heated excessively
and cause a low-temperature burn.
Do not use the seat warmer even when
taking a short nap in the vehicle:
The seat may be heated excessively
and cause a low-temperature burn.
Do not place heavy objects with sharp
projections on the seat, or insert
needles or pins into it:
This could cause the seat to become
excessively heated and result in injury
from a minor burn.
CAUTION
Do not use organic solvents to clean
the seat. It may damage the seat
surface and the heater.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-7
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page19
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:47 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (20,1)
NOTE
lIf the ignition is switched off while the seat
warmer is operating (High, Mid or Low)
and then switched ON again, the seat
warmer will automatically operate at the
temperature set before switching off the
ignition.
lUse the seat warmer when the engine is
running. Leaving the seat warmer on for
long periods with the engine not running
could cause the battery power to be
depleted.
lThe temperature of the seat warmer cannot
be adjusted beyond High, Mid and Low
because the seat warmer is controlled by a
thermostat.
Rear Seat
qSplit Folding
The seatbacks can be folded down to
provide more space in the luggage
compartment.
2-8
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page20
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (21,1)
WARNING
Tightly secure cargo in the luggage
compartment when it is transported
with the seatbacks folded down:
Driving without tightly securing
cargo and luggage is dangerous as it
could move and become an
obstruction to driving during
emergency braking or a collision
resulting in an unexpected accident.
Always remove the child-restraint
system from the rear seat before
operating the remote handle levers for
the rear seat:
Operating the remote handle levers
while a rear-facing child-restraint
system is in the rear seat is
dangerous. It could cause injury to a
child seated in the child-restraint
system when the seatback suddenly
flips forward.
Make sure there is nobody in the rear
seat area before operating (pulling) the
remote handle levers (Vehicles with
remote handle):
Not checking the rear seat area for
persons before folding the seatbacks
with the strap/remote handle levers
is dangerous. The rear seat area is
difficult to see from the rear of the
vehicle. Operating (pulling) the
remote handle levers without
checking could cause injury to a
person when a seatback suddenly
flips forward.
CAUTION
ØWhen operating the rear seatback
knob, make sure you support the
seatback with your hand. If the
seatback is not supported with
your hand, it will flip forward
suddenly and could cause injury to
the finger that pushes the rear
seatback knob down.
Ø(Vehicles with remote handle)
Before folding the seatbacks down
with the remote handle levers,
make sure there is no cup in a rear
cup holder. Folding the seatbacks
with the remote handle levers
while a cup is in the cup holder
could soil or damage the seat
bottom and seatback.
Ø(Vehicles with remote handle)
Be careful of the following when
using the remote handle levers:
ØOn a downward slope, the
seatback could flip forward
faster than on a flat surface.
ØOn an upward slope, the
seatback may not fold down.
When the seatbacks cannot be
folded down with levers, pull
the rear seatback forward from
inside the vehicle.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page21
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (22,1)
Folding both seatbacks down
CAUTION
Check the position of a front seat
before folding a rear seatback.
Depending on the position of a front
seat, it may not be possible to fold a
rear seatback all the way down
because it may hit the seatback of
the front seat which could scratch or
damage the front seat or its pocket.
Lower or remove the head restraint
on the rear outboard seat if
necessary.
Using remote handle
í
After checking that the rear seats are clear,
open the liftgate and lower the seatback
you want to fold down using the remote
handle.
When folding the left side, operate the
outer part of the remote handle.
CAUTION
(Folding the left seatback)
Be careful when operating the remote
handle with the center seat folded
down. If a person sitting in the right
rear seat places a hand on the center
seat, it could be pinched by a
seatback or seat component causing
injury.
Using push knob
Push the rear seatback knob down.
Folding only center seat
í
Using remote handle
1. If the center head restraint is in the
position for use, store it.
2-10
Essential Safety Equipment
í
Some models.
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page22
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (23,1)
2. After checking that the center seat is
clear, open the liftgate and pull the
inside remote handle levers on the left
side of the liftgate compartment.
Using strap
1. If the center head restraint is in the
position for use, store it.
2. Pull the strap on the back of the
seatback to fold the seatback forward.
To return the seatbacks to the upright
position
1. Lift the seatbacks upright.
2. Pull on the top of the seatbacks from
inside the vehicle to make sure they are
locked.
WARNING
Always make sure the seat belts are
fully pulled out from under the
seatbacks:
A seat belt caught under a seatback
after the seatback is returned to its
upright position is dangerous. In a
collision or sudden stop, the seat belt
cannot provide adequate protection.
When returning the seatback to the
upright position, make sure there is no
red indication:
A rear seatback not fully returned
and locked in the upright position is
dangerous. Sudden stops or
maneuvering could cause a seatback
to flip forward suddenly resulting in
injury. If the red indicator is visible on
the back of the rear seatback knob,
the seatback is not locked in the
upright position.
Locked position
Unlocked position
Red indicator
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page23
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (24,1)
qArmrest
í
The rear armrest in the center of the rear
seatback can be used (no occupant in the
center seat) or placed upright.
WARNING
Never put your hands and fingers
around the moving parts of the seat
and armrest:
Putting your hands and fingers
around the moving parts of the seat
and armrest is dangerous as they
could get injured.
Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head
restraints on all outboard seats and the
rear center seat. The head restraints are
intended to help protect you and the
passengers from neck injury.
WARNING
Always drive with the head restraints
installed when seats are being used
and make sure they are properly
adjusted.:
Driving with the head restraints
adjusted too low or removed is
dangerous. With no support behind
your head, your neck could be
seriously injured in a collision.
Height adjustment
To raise a head restraint, pull it up to the
desired position.
To lower the head restraint, press the stop-
catch release, then push the head restraint
down.
Adjust the head restraint so that the center
is even with the top of the passenger's
ears.
2-12
Essential Safety Equipment
í
Some models.
Seats
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page24
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (25,1)
Front outboard seat
Rear outboard seat
Rear center seat
Removal/Installation
To remove the head restraint, pull it up
while pressing the stop-catch.
To install the head restraint, insert the legs
into the holes while pressing the stop-
catch.
WARNING
Always drive with the head restraints
installed when seats are being used
and make sure they are properly
installed:
Driving with the head restraints not
installed is dangerous. With no
support behind your head, your neck
could be seriously injured in a
collision.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seats
2-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page25
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (26,1)
Seat Belt Precautions
Seat belts help to decrease the possibility of severe injury during accidents and sudden
stops. Mazda recommends that the driver and all passengers always wear seat belts.
All of the seat belt retractors are designed to keep the lap/shoulder belts out of the way
when not in use.
The driver's seat belt has no provisions for child-restraint systems and has only an
emergency locking mode. The driver may wear it comfortably, and it will lock during a
collision.
However, in some models (with automatic locking mode) the front passenger's seat and all
rear lap/shoulder belt retractors operate in two modes: emergency locking mode, and for
child-restraint systems, automatic locking mode. While we recommend you put all children
in the rear seats, if you must use the front passenger seat for a child, slide the front
passenger seat as far back as possible and make sure any child-restraint system is secured
properly.
WARNING
Always wear your seat belt and make sure all occupants are properly restrained:
Not wearing a seat belt is extremely dangerous. During a collision, occupants not
wearing seat belts could hit someone or things inside the vehicle or even be thrown
out of the vehicle. They could be seriously injured or even killed. In the same
collision, occupants wearing seat belts would be much safer.
Do not wear twisted seat belts:
Twisted seat belts are dangerous. In a collision, the full width of the belt is not
available to absorb the impact. This puts more force on the bones beneath the belt,
which could cause serious injury or death. So, if your seat belt is twisted, you must
straighten the seat belt to remove any twists and to allow the full width of the belt to
be used.
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant
properly restrained.
Do not operate a vehicle with a damaged seat belt:
Using a damaged seat belt is dangerous. An accident could damage the belt
webbing of the seat belt in use. A damaged seat belt cannot provide adequate
protection in a collision. Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect all seat belt
systems in use during an accident before they are used again.
2-14
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page26
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (27,1)
Have your seat belts changed immediately if the pretensioner or load limiter has
been expended:
Always have an Authorized Mazda Dealer immediately inspect the front seat belt
pretensioners and air bags after any collision. Like the air bags, the front seat belt
pretensioners and load limiters will only function once and must be replaced after
any collision that caused them to deploy. A seat belt with an expended pretensioner
or load limiter is still better than wearing no seat belt at all; however, if the front
seat belt pretensioners and load limiters are not replaced, the risk of injury in a
collision will increase.
Positioning the Shoulder Portion of the Seat Belt:
Improper positioning of the shoulder portion of the seat belt is dangerous. Always
make sure the shoulder portion of the seat belt is positioned across your shoulder
and near your neck, but never under your arm, on your neck, or on your upper arm.
Positioning the Lap Portion of the Seat Belt:
The lap portion of the seat belt worn too high is dangerous. In a collision, this would
concentrate the impact force directly on the abdominal area, causing serious injury.
Wear the lap portion of the belt snugly and as low as possible.
In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a
person wearing a seat belt.
CAUTION
Belt retraction may become difficult if the belts and rings are soiled, so try to keep
them clean. For more details about cleaning the seat belts, refer to Cleaning the
Lap/Shoulder Belt Webbing(page 6-63).
Ring
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
2-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page27
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (28,1)
qPregnant Women and Persons with Serious Medical Conditions
Pregnant women should always wear seat belts. Ask your doctor for specific
recommendations.
The lap belt should be worn SNUGLY AND AS LOW AS POSSIBLE OVER THE HIPS.
The shoulder belt should be worn across your shoulder properly, but never across the
stomach area.
Persons with serious medical conditions also should wear seat belts. Check with your
doctor for any special instructions regarding specific medical conditions.
qEmergency Locking Mode
When the seat belt is fastened, it will always be in the emergency locking mode.
In the emergency locking mode, the belt remains comfortable on the occupant and the
retractor will lock in position during a collision.
If the belt is locked and cannot be pulled out, retract the belt once, and then try pulling it
out slowly. If this fails, pull the belt strongly one time and loosen, then pull it out again
slowly.
(Seat Belt with Automatic Locking Mode)
When the seat belt is fastened, it will always be in the emergency locking mode until it is
switched to automatic locking mode by pulling it all the way out to its full length. If the
belt feels tight and hinders comfortable movement while the vehicle is stopped or in
motion, it may be in the automatic locking mode because the belt has been pulled too far
out. To return the belt to the more comfortable emergency locking mode, wait until the
vehicle has stopped in a safe, level area, retract the belt fully to convert it back to
emergency locking mode and then extend it around you again.
qAutomatic Locking Mode
Always use the automatic locking mode to keep the child-restraint system from shifting to
an unsafe position in the event of an accident. To enable seat belt automatic locking mode,
pull it all the way out and connect it as instructed on the child-restraint system. It will
retract down to the child-restraint system and stay locked on it. See the section on child
restraint (page 2-23).
2-16
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page28
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (29,1)
Seat Belt
qFastening the Seat Belt
Seat belt
buckle
Seat belt tongue
Position the lap belt as low as possible,
not on the abdominal area, then adjust the
shoulder belt so that it fits snugly against
your body.
Keep low on
hip bone
Too high
Take up slack
qUnfastening the Seat Belt
Depress the button on the seat belt buckle.
If the belt does not fully retract, pull it out
and check for kinks or twists. Then make
sure it remains untwisted as it retracts.
Button
NOTE
If a belt does not fully retract, inspect it for
kinks and twists. If it is still not retracting
properly, have it inspected at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
qFront Shoulder Belt Adjuster
To raise To lower
Make sure the adjuster is locked.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
2-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page29
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (30,1)
Seat Belt Warning Systems
If it detects that the driver's seat belt is
unfastened, the warning light or beep
alerts the driver.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
Front Seat Belt Pretensioner
and Load Limiting Systems
For optimum protection, the driver and
front passenger seat belts are equipped
with pretensioner and load limiting
systems. For both these systems to work
properly you must wear the seat belt
properly.
Pretensioners:
In moderate or severe frontal or near-
frontal accidents, the front air bag and
pretensioner systems deploy
simultaneously.
For deployment details, refer to the SRS
Air Bag Deployment Criteria (page 2-53).
The front seat belt retractors remove slack
quickly as the air bags are expanding.
Any time the air bags and seat belt
pretensioners have fired they must be
replaced.
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
Refer to Air Bag/Front Seat Belt
Pretensioner System Warning Beep on
page 7-33.
(With Front Passenger Occupant
Classification System)
In addition, the pretensioner system for
the front passenger, like the front and side
passenger air bag, is designed to only
deploy in accordance with the total seated
weight on the front passenger seat.
For details, refer to the front passenger
seat weight sensors (page 2-56).
2-18
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page30
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (31,1)
Load limiter:
The load limiting system releases belt
webbing in a controlled manner to reduce
belt force on the occupant's chest. While
the most severe load on a seat belt occurs
in frontal collisions, the load limiter has
an automatic mechanical function and can
activate in any accident mode with
sufficient occupant movement.
Even if the pretensioners have not fired,
the load limiting function must be
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
WARNING
Wear seat belts only as recommended
in this owner's manual:
Incorrect positioning of the driver and
front passenger seat belts is
dangerous. Without proper
positioning, the pretensioner and
load limiting systems cannot provide
adequate protection in an accident
and this could result in serious injury.
For more details about wearing seat
belts, refer to Fastening the seat
belts(page 2-17).
Have your seat belts changed
immediately if the pretensioner or load
limiter has been expended:
Always have an Authorized Mazda
Dealer immediately inspect the front
seat belt pretensioners and air bags
after any collision. Like the air bags,
the front seat belt pretensioners and
load limiters will only function once
and must be replaced after any
collision that caused them to deploy.
A seat belt with an expended
pretensioner or load limiter is still
better than wearing no seat belt at
all; however, if the front seat belt
pretensioners and load limiters are
not replaced, the risk of injury in a
collision will increase.
Do not modify the components or
wiring, or use electronic testing devices
on the pretensioner system:
Modifying the components or wiring
of the pretensioner system, including
the use of electronic testing devices is
dangerous. You could accidentally
activate it or make it inoperable
which would prevent it from
activating in an accident. The
occupants or repairers could be
seriously injured.
Properly dispose of the pretensioner
system:
Improper disposal of the pretensioner
system or a vehicle with non-
deactivated pretensioners is
dangerous. Unless all safety
procedures are followed, injury could
result. Have an Authorized Mazda
Dealer safely dispose of the
pretensioner system or scrap a
pretensioner system equipped vehicle.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
2-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page31
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (32,1)
NOTE
lThe pretensioner system will activate in a
moderate or greater frontal or near-frontal,
or a severe side collision. It will not
activate in most rollovers, rear impacts.
(With Front Passenger Occupant
Classification System)
The pretensioner system will activate in a
severe roll-over accident.
In addition, the pretensioner system for the
front passenger is designed to only deploy
in accordance with the total seated weight
on the front passenger seat.
lSome smoke (non-toxic gas) will be
released when the air bags and
pretensioners deploy. This does not indicate
a fire. This gas normally has no effect on
occupants, however, those with sensitive
skin may experience light skin irritation. If
residue from the deployment of the air bags
or the front pretensioner system gets on the
skin or in the eyes, wash it off as soon as
possible.
Center-Rear Position Seat
Belt
Before using the center-rear lap/shoulder
belt make sure tongue (A) and anchor
buckle (B) are fastened.
(A)
(B)
qFastening the Seat Belt
1. Grasp the seat belt tongue (C).
2. Slowly pull out the lap/shoulder belt.
3. Insert the seat belt tongue (C) into the
seat belt buckle (D) until you hear a
click sound.
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
2-20
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page32
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (33,1)
WARNING
Fastening the Center-Rear Seat Belt
with Only One Buckle:
Fastening the center-rear seat belt
with only one buckle is dangerous. If
only one pair of seat belt tongues
and buckles is fastened (either seat
belt tongue (C) and seat belt anchor
buckle (D) or seat belt tongue (A) and
seat belt buckle (B)), then the seat
belt cannot provide full protection. In
a sudden stop or collision, the user
could slide under the belt and suffer
serious injuries. Always make sure
that both pairs of seat belt tongues
and buckles are fastened properly.
Seat Belt Extender
If your seat belt is not long enough, even
when fully extended, a seat belt extender
may be available to you at no charge from
your Authorized Mazda Dealer.
This extender will be only for you and for
the particular vehicle and seat. Even if it
plugs into other seat belts, it may not hold
in the critical moment of a crash.
When ordering an extender, only order
one that provides the necessary additional
length to fasten the seat belt properly.
Please contact your Authorized Mazda
Dealer for more information.
WARNING
Do not use a seat belt extender unless
it is necessary:
Using a seat belt extender when not
necessary is dangerous. The seat belt
will be too long and not fit properly.
In an accident, the seat belt will not
provide adequate protection and you
could be seriously injured. Only use
the extender when it is required to
fasten the seat belt properly.
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
2-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page33
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (34,1)
Do not use an improper extender:
Using a seat belt extender that is for
another person or a different vehicle
or seat is dangerous. The seat belt
will not provide adequate protection
and the user could be seriously
injured in an accident. Only use the
extender provided for you and for the
particular vehicle and seat. NEVER
use the extender in a different vehicle
or seat. If you sell your Mazda, do
not leave your seat belt extender in
the vehicle. It could be used
accidentally by the new owner of the
vehicle. After removing the seat belt
extender, discard it. Never use the
seat belt extender in any other
vehicle you may own in the future.
Do not use an extender that is too
long:
Using an extender that is too long is
dangerous. The seat belt will not fit
properly. In an accident, the seat belt
will not provide adequate protection
and you could be seriously injured.
Do not use the extender or choose
one shorter in length if the distance
between the extender's buckle and
the center of the user's body is less
than 15 cm (6 in).
Do not leave a seat belt extender
connected to the buckle:
Leaving a seat belt extender
connected to the buckle without
using the seat belt is dangerous.
When the seat belt extender is
connected to the driver's seat belt
buckle (or front passenger) seat, the
SRS driver's (or front passenger's) air
bag system will determine that the
driver (or front passenger) is wearing
the seat belt even if the driver (or
front passenger) is not wearing it.
This condition could cause the
driver's (or front passenger's) air bag
to not activate correctly and result in
death or serious injury in the event of
collision. Always wear the seat belt
with the seat belt extender.
Do not use the seat belt extender when
installing a child-restraint system on
the front or rear passenger seat:
Using a seat belt extender to fasten a
child-restraint system on any seat is
dangerous. Always follow the child-
restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions and never
use a seat belt extender.
NOTE
When not in use, remove the seat belt extender
and store it in the vehicle. If the seat belt
extender is left connected, the seat belt
extender might get damaged as it will not
retract with the rest of the seat belt and can
easily fall out of the door when not in use and
be damaged. In addition, the seat belt warning
light will not illuminate and function properly.
2-22
Essential Safety Equipment
Seat Belt Systems
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page34
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (35,1)
Child Restraint Precautions
Mazda strongly urges the use of child-restraint systems for children small enough to use
them.
You are required by law to use a child-restraint system for children in the U.S. and Canada.
Check your local and state or provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety
of children riding in your vehicle.
Whatever child-restraint system you consider, please pick the appropriate one for the age
and size of the child, obey the law and follow the instructions that come with the individual
child-restraint system.
A child who has outgrown child-restraint systems should sit in the rear and use seat belts,
both lap and shoulder. If the shoulder belt crosses the neck or face, move the child closer to
the center of the vehicle in the outboard seats, and towards the buckle on the right if the
child is seated on the center seat.
Statistics confirm that the rear seat is the best place for all children up to 12 years of age,
and more so with a supplemental restraint system (air bags).
A rear-facing child-restraint system should NEVER be used on the front seat with the air
bag system activated. The front passenger's seat is also the least preferred seat for other
child-restraint systems.
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, the
front passenger seat weight sensors work as a part of the supplemental restraint system.
This system deactivates the front passenger front and side air bags and also the front
passenger seat belt pretensioner system when the front passenger air bag deactivation
indicator light illuminates.
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, the system shuts off the front
passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system, so make sure the front
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.
Even if the front passenger air bag is shut off, Mazda strongly recommends that children be
properly restrained and child-restraint systems of all kinds are properly secured on the rear
seats which are the best place for children.
For more details, refer to Front passenger seat weight sensors(page 2-56).
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page35
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (36,1)
WARNING
Use the correct size child-restraint system:
For effective protection in vehicle accidents and sudden stops, a child must be
properly restrained using a seat belt or child-restraint system depending on age and
size. If not, the child could be seriously injured or even killed in an accident.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions and always keep the child-restraint system
buckled down:
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make
sure any child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-
restraint system manufacturer's instructions. When not in use, remove it from the
vehicle or fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors
for LATCH child-restraint systems and the corresponding tether anchor.
Always secure a child in a proper child-restraint system:
Holding a child in your arms while the vehicle is moving is extremely dangerous. No
matter how strong the person may be, he or she cannot hold onto a child in a
sudden stop or collision and it could result in serious injury or death to the child or
other occupants. Even in a moderate accident, the child may be exposed to air bag
forces that could result in serious injury or death to the child, or the child may be
slammed into an adult, causing injury to both child and adult.
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that
could deploy:
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates. The
child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.
2-24
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page36
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (37,1)
(Except Mexico)
Vehicles with a front passenger air bag have a warning label attached as shown
below. The warning label reminds you not to put a rear-facing child-restraint system
on the front passenger seat at any time.
(Mexico)
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE
AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.
Vehicles with a front passenger air bag have a warning label attached as shown
below. The warning label reminds you not to put a rear-facing child-restraint system
on the front passenger seat at any time.
Do not install a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger seat unless
it is unavoidable:
In a collision, the force of a deploying air bag could cause serious injury or death to
the child. If installing a front-facing child-restraint system on the front passenger
seat is unavoidable, move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page37
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (38,1)
Seating a child in a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat is dangerous
under certain conditions (With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System):
Your vehicle is equipped with front passenger seat weight sensors. Even with the
front passenger seat weight sensors, if you must use the front passenger seat to seat
a child, using a child-restraint system on the front passenger seat under the
following conditions increases the danger of the front passenger air bag deploying
and could result in serious injury or death to the child.
ØThe front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when
seating a child in the child-restraint system.
ØLuggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint
system.
ØA rear passenger or luggage pushing or pulling down on the front passenger
seatback.
ØA rear passenger puts their feet on the front seat rails.
ØLuggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.
ØHeavy items are placed in the seatback map pocket.
ØThe seat is washed.
ØLiquids are spilled on the seat.
ØThe front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items
placed behind it.
ØThe front passenger seatback contacts the rear seat.
ØLuggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver
seat.
ØAny accessories, which might increase the total seated weight on the front
passenger seat, are attached to the front passenger seat.
The designated positions with seat belts on the rear seats are the safest places for
children. Always use seat belts and child restraints.
Do not allow a child or anyone to lean over or against the side window of a vehicle
with side and curtain air bags:
It is dangerous to allow anyone to lean over or against the side window, the area of
the front passenger seat, the front and rear window pillars and the roof edge along
both sides from which the side and curtain air bags deploy, even if a child-restraint
system is used. The impact of inflation from a side or curtain air bag could cause
serious injury or death to an out of position child. Furthermore, leaning over or
against the front door could block the side and curtain air bags and eliminate the
advantages of supplemental protection. With the front air bag and the additional
side air bag that comes out of the front seat, the rear seat is always a better location
for children. Take special care not to allow a child to lean over or against the side
window, even if the child is seated in a child-restraint system.
2-26
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page38
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (39,1)
Never use one seat belt on more than one person at a time:
Using one seat belt for more than one person at a time is dangerous. A seat belt
used in this way cannot spread the impact forces properly and the two passengers
could be crushed together and seriously injured or even killed. Never use one belt for
more than one person at a time and always operate the vehicle with each occupant
properly restrained.
Always remove the child-restraint system from the rear seat before operating the
remote handle levers for the rear seat:
Operating the remote handle levers while a rear-facing child-restraint system is in
the rear seat is dangerous. It could cause injury to a child seated in the child-
restraint system when the seatback suddenly flips forward.
CAUTION
A seat belt or child-restraint system can become very hot in a closed vehicle during
warm weather. To avoid burning yourself or a child, check them before you or your
child touches them.
NOTE
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed LATCH
child-restraint systems in the rear seats. When using these anchors to secure a child-restraint system,
refer to Using LATCH Lower Anchor (page 2-36).
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page39
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (40,1)
Child-Restraint System
Installation
qChild-Restraint System Types
In this owner's manual, explanation of
child-restraint systems is provided for the
following three types of popular child-
restraint systems: infant seat, child seat,
booster seat.
NOTE
lInstallation position is determined by the
type of child-restraint system. Always read
the manufacturer's instructions and this
owner's manual carefully.
lDue to variations in the design of child-
restraint systems, vehicle seats and seat
belts, all child-restraint systems may not fit
all seating positions. Before purchasing a
child-restraint system, it should be tested in
the specific vehicle seating position (or
positions) where it is intended to be used. If
a previously purchased child-restraint
system does not fit, you may need to
purchase a different one that will.
Infant seat
An infant seat provides restraint by
bracing the infant's head, neck and back
against the seating surface.
Child seat
A child seat restrains a child's body using
the harness.
Booster seat
A booster seat is a child restraint
accessory designed to improve the fit of
the seat belt system around the child's
body.
2-28
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page40
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (41,1)
Installing Child-Restraint
Systems
Accident statistics reveal that a child is
safer in the rear seat. The front passenger's
seat is clearly the worst choice for any
child under 12, and with rear-facing child-
restraint systems it is clearly unsafe due to
air bags.
NOTE
Even if your vehicle is equipped with front
passenger seat weight sensors (page 2-56),
which automatically deactivates the front
passenger air bag, a rear seat is the safest
place for a child of any age or size.
Some child-restraint systems now come
with tethers and therefore must be
installed on the seats that take tethers to
be effective. In your Mazda, tethered
child-restraint systems can only be
accommodated in the three positions on
the rear seat.
Some child-restraint systems also employ
specially designed LATCH attachments;
refer to Using LATCH Lower Anchor
(page 2-36).
WARNING
Tethered Child-Restraint Systems Work
Only on Tether-Equipped Rear Seats:
Installation of a tether equipped
child-restraint system in the front
passenger's seat defeats the safety
design of the system and will result in
an increased chance of serious injury
if the child-restraint system goes
forward without benefit of being
tethered.
Place tether equipped child-restraint
systems where there are tether
anchors.
qAnchor Bracket
Anchor brackets for securing child-
restraint systems are equipped in the
vehicle. Locate each anchor position
using the illustration.
To install a child-restraint system, always
follow the instruction manual
accompanying the child-restraint system.
Anchor bracket location
Use the indicated anchor bracket locations
when installing a child-restraint system
equipped with a tether.
For center
For left For right
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page41
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (42,1)
WARNING
Always attach the tether strap to the
correct tether anchor position:
Attaching the tether strap to the
incorrect tether anchor position is
dangerous. In a collision, the tether
strap could come off and loosen the
child-restraint system. If the child-
restraint system moves it could result
in death or injury to the child.
Always route the tether strap between
the head restraint and the seatback:
Routing the tether strap on top of the
head restraint is dangerous. In a
collision the tether strap could slide
off the head restraint and loosen the
child-restraint system. The child-
restraint system could move which
may result in death or injury to the
child.
Tether strap
Forward
Tether strap
Forward
2-30
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page42
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (43,1)
qUsing Automatic Locking Mode
Follow these instructions when using a
child-restraint system, unless you are
attaching a LATCH-equipped child-
restraint system to the rear LATCH lower
anchors. Refer to Using LATCH Lower
Anchor(page 2-36).
NOTE
Follow the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instructions carefully. If you
are not sure whether you have a LATCH
system or tether, check in the child-restraint
system manufacturer's instructions and follow
them accordingly. Depending on the type of
child-restraint system, it may use LATCH
system instead of seat belts or if the belt goes
across the child's chest, may recommend
against using automatic locking mode.
1. Make sure the seatback is securely
latched by pushing it back until it is
fully locked.
2. Raise the head restraint to the top
locked position.
Refer to Head Restraints on page 2-12.
3. Secure the child-restraint system with
the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.
See the manufacturer's instructions on
the child-restraint system for belt
routing instructions.
4. To get the retractor into the automatic
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt
portion of the seat belt until the entire
length of the belt is out of the retractor.
5. Push the child-restraint system firmly
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt
retracts as snugly as possible. A
clicking noise from the retractor will be
heard during retraction if the system is
in the automatic locking mode. If the
belt does not lock the seat down tight,
repeat this step.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page43
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (44,1)
NOTE
Inspect this function before each use of the
child-restraint system. You should not be able
to pull the shoulder belt out of the retractor
while the system is in the automatic locking
mode. When you remove the child-restraint
system, be sure the belt fully retracts to return
the system to emergency locking mode before
occupants use the seat belts.
6. If your child-restraint system requires
the use of a tether strap, refer to the
manufacturer's instructions to hook and
tighten the tether strap.
WARNING
Use the tether and tether anchor only
for a child-restraint system:
Using the tether or tether anchor to
secure anything but a child-restraint
system is dangerous. This could
weaken or damage the tether or
tether anchor and result in injury.
Always route the tether strap between
the head restraint and the seatback:
Routing the tether strap on top of the
head restraint is dangerous. In a
collision the tether strap could slide
off the head restraint and loosen the
child-restraint system. The child-
restraint system could move which
may result in death or injury to the
child.
Tether strap
Forward
Tether strap
Forward
Always attach the tether strap to the
correct tether anchor position:
Attaching the tether strap to the
incorrect tether anchor position is
dangerous. In a collision, the tether
strap could come off and loosen the
child-restraint system. If the child-
restraint system moves it could result
in death or injury to the child.
2-32
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page44
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (45,1)
qIf You Must Use the Front Seat
for Children
If you cannot put all children in the rear
seat, at least put the smallest children in
the rear and be sure the largest child up
front uses the shoulder belt over the
shoulder.
NEVER put a rear-facing child-restraint
system on the front passenger seat
whether your vehicle is equipped with a
seat weight sensor or not.
This seat is also not set up for tethered
child-restraint systems, put them in one of
the rear seat positions set up with tether
anchors.
Likewise the LATCH child-restraint
system cannot be secured in the front
passenger's seat and should be used in the
rear seat.
Do not allow anyone to sleep against the
side window since your vehicle has side
and curtain air bags, it could cause serious
injuries to an out of position occupant. As
children more often sleep in cars, it is
better to put them in the rear seat. If
installing the child-restraint system on the
front seat is unavoidable, follow these
instructions when using a front-facing
child-restraint system in the front
passenger's seat.
NOTE
lTo check if your front seats have side air
bags:
Mazda vehicles equipped with side air bag
will have a SRS AIRBAGtag on the
outboard shoulder of the front seats.
lTo check if your vehicle has curtain air
bags:
Mazda vehicles equipped with curtain air
bag will have an SRS AIRBAGmarking
on the window pillars along the roof edge.
WARNING
Always move the front passenger seat
as far back as possible if installing a
front-facing child-restraint system on it
is unavoidable:
As your vehicle has front air bags
and doubly so because your vehicle
has side air bags, a front-facing
child-restraint system should be put
on the front passenger seat only
when it is unavoidable.
Even if the front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light
illuminates, always move the seat as
far back as possible, because the
force of a deploying air bag could
cause serious injury or death to the
child.
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint
system in the front seat with an air bag
that could deploy:
Rear-facing child-restraint systems
on the front seat are particularly
dangerous.
Even in a moderate collision, the
child-restraint system can be hit by a
deploying air bag and moved
violently backward resulting in
serious injury or death to the child.
Even though you may feel assured
that the front passenger air bag will
not deploy based on the fact that the
front passenger air bag deactivation
indicator light illuminates, you
should not use a rear-facing child-
restraint system in the front seat.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page45
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (46,1)
Do not allow a child or anyone to lean
over or against the side window of a
vehicle with side and curtain air bags:
It is dangerous to allow anyone to
lean over or against the side window,
the area of the front passenger seat,
the front and rear window pillars and
the roof edge along both sides from
which the side and curtain air bags
deploy, even if a child-restraint
system is used. The impact of
inflation from a side or curtain air
bag could cause serious injury or
death to an out of position child.
Furthermore, leaning over or against
the front door could block the side
and curtain air bags and eliminate
the advantages of supplemental
protection. With the front air bag and
the additional side air bag that
comes out of the front seat, the rear
seat is always a better location for
children. Take special care not to
allow a child to lean over or against
the side window, even if the child is
seated in a child-restraint system.
Front Passenger's Seat Child-Restraint
System Installation (With automatic
locking mode seat belt)
1. Switch the ignition ON.
2. Slide the seat as far back as possible.
3. Place the child-restraint system on the
seat without putting your weight on the
seat and fasten the seat belt. See the
manufacturer's instructions on the
child-restraint system for belt routing
instructions.
4. To get the retractor into the automatic
locking mode, pull the shoulder belt
portion of the seat belt until the entire
length of the belt is out of the retractor.
5. Push the child-restraint system firmly
into the vehicle seat. Be sure the belt
retracts as snugly as possible. A
clicking noise from the retractor will be
heard during retraction if the system is
in automatic locking mode. If the belt
does not lock the seat down tight,
repeat the previous step and also this
one.
2-34
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page46
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (47,1)
NOTE
lInspect this function before each use of the
child-restraint system. You should not be
able to pull the shoulder belt out of the
retractor while the system is in the
automatic locking mode. When you remove
the child-restraint system, be sure the belt
fully retracts to return the system to
emergency locking mode before occupants
use the seat belts.
lFollow the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instructions carefully.
Depending on the type of child-restraint
system, it may not employ seat belts which
are in automatic locking mode.
6. Seat your child safely in the child-
restraint system and secure the child
according to the instructions from the
child-restraint system manufacturer.
7. (With Front Passenger Occupant
Classification System)
Make sure the front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light illuminates
after installing a child-restraint system
on the front passenger seat.
If the front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light does not
illuminate, remove the child-restraint
system, switch the ignition to OFF, and
then re-install the child-restraint
system. (page 2-56)
Climate control
Fully Automatic
Type
Manual Type
WARNING
Do not seat a child in a child-restraint
system on the front passenger seat if
the front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light does not
illuminate (With Front Passenger
Occupant Classification System):
While it is always better to install any
child-restraint system on the rear
seat, it is imperative that a child-
restraint system ONLY be used on the
front passenger seat if the
deactivation indicator light
illuminates when the child is seated
in the child-restraint system (page
2-56). Seating a child in a child-
restraint system installed on the front
passenger seat with the front
passenger air bag deactivation
indicator light not illuminated is
dangerous. If this indicator light does
not illuminate, this means that the
front passenger front and side air
bags, and seat belt pretensioner are
ready for deployment. If an accident
were to deploy an air bag, a child in
a child-restraint system sitting in the
front passenger seat could be
seriously injured or killed. If the
indicator light does not illuminate
after seating a child in a child-
restraint system on the front
passenger seat, seat a child in a
child-restraint system on the rear
seat and consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page47
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (48,1)
qUsing LATCH Lower Anchor
Your Mazda is equipped with LATCH lower anchors for attachment of specially designed
LATCH child-restraint systems in the rear seats. Both anchors must be used, otherwise the
seat will bounce around and put the child in danger. Most LATCH child-restraint systems
must also be used in conjunction with a tether to be effective. If they have a tether you
must use it to better assure your child's safety.
WARNING
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the use of the child-restraint system:
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Make
sure the child-restraint system is properly secured in place according to the child-
restraint system manufacturer's instructions.
Never attach two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor:
Attaching two child-restraint systems to the same LATCH lower anchor is dangerous.
In a collision, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child-restraint
system attachments, and it may break, causing serious injury or death. If you use the
seat position for another child-restraint system when an outboard LATCH position is
occupied, use the center seat belts instead, and the tether if tether-equipped.
Make sure the child-restraint system is properly secured:
An unsecured child-restraint system is dangerous. In a sudden stop or a collision it
could move causing serious injury or death to the child or other occupants. Follow
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions on belt routing to secure the
seat just as you would with a child in it so that nobody is tempted to put a child in
an improperly secured seat later on. When not in use, remove it from the vehicle or
fasten it with a seat belt, or latch it down to BOTH LATCH lower anchors for LATCH
child-restraint systems.
Make sure there are no seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH child-
restraint system:
Not following the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions when installing
the child-restraint system is dangerous. If seat belts or a foreign object prevent the
child-restraint system from being securely attached to the LATCH lower anchors and
the child-restraint system is installed improperly, the child-restraint system could
move in a sudden stop or collision causing serious injury or death to the child or
other occupants. When installing the child-restraint system, make sure there are no
seat belts or foreign objects near or around the LATCH lower anchors. Always follow
the child-restraint system manufacturer's instructions.
2-36
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page48
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (49,1)
Installation on rear outboard seats
1. First, adjust the front seat to allow
clearance between the child-restraint
system and the front seat (page 2-5).
2. Make sure the seatback is securely
latched by pushing it back until it is
fully locked.
3. Expand the area between the seat
bottom and the seatback slightly to
verify the locations of the LATCH
lower anchors.
NOTE
The markings above the LATCH lower anchors
indicate the locations of the LATCH lower
anchors for the attachment of a child-restraint
system.
4. Raise the head restraint to the top
locked position.
Refer to Head Restraints on page 2-12.
5. Secure the child-restraint system using
BOTH LATCH lower anchors,
following the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instruction. Pull on the
child-restraint to be sure both anchors
are engaged.
6. If your child-restraint system came
equipped with a tether, that means it is
very important to properly secure the
tether for child safety. Please carefully
follow the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instructions when
installing tethers.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-37
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page49
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (50,1)
WARNING
Use the tether and tether anchor only
for a child-restraint system:
Using the tether or tether anchor to
secure anything but a child-restraint
system is dangerous. This could
weaken or damage the tether or
tether anchor and result in injury.
Always route the tether strap between
the head restraint and the seatback:
Routing the tether strap on top of the
head restraint is dangerous. In a
collision the tether strap could slide
off the head restraint and loosen the
child-restraint system. The child-
restraint system could move which
may result in death or injury to the
child.
Tether strap
Forward
Always attach the tether strap to the
correct tether anchor position:
Attaching the tether strap to the
incorrect tether anchor position is
dangerous. In a collision, the tether
strap could come off and loosen the
child-restraint system. If the child-
restraint system moves it could result
in death or injury to the child.
Installation on rear center seat
The LATCH lower anchors at the center
of the rear seat are much further apart than
the sets of LATCH lower anchors for
child-restraint system installation at other
seating positions. Child-restraint systems
with rigid LATCH attachments cannot be
installed on the center seating position.
Some LATCH equipped child-restraint
systems can be placed in the center
position and will reach the nearest
LATCH lower anchors which are 420 mm
(16.5 in) apart. LATCH compatible child-
restraint systems (with attachments on belt
webbing) can be used at this seating
position only if the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instructions state that the
child-restraint system can be installed to
LATCH lower anchors that are 420 mm
(16.5 in) apart. Do not attach two child-
restraint systems to the same LATCH
lower anchor. If your child-restraint
system has a tether, it must also be used
for your child's optimum safety.
The procedure for installation on the rear
outboards seats is the same.
LATCH lower anchor location
2-38
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page50
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (51,1)
WARNING
Always route the tether strap between
the head restraint and the seatback:
Routing the tether strap on top of the
head restraint is dangerous. In a
collision the tether strap could slide
off the head restraint and loosen the
child-restraint system. The child-
restraint system could move which
may result in death or injury to the
child.
Tether strap
Forward
Always attach the tether strap to the
correct tether anchor position:
Attaching the tether strap to the
incorrect tether anchor position is
dangerous. In a collision, the tether
strap could come off and loosen the
child-restraint system. If the child-
restraint system moves it could result
in death or injury to the child.
Essential Safety Equipment
Child Restraint
2-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page51
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (52,1)
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions
The front and side supplemental restraint systems (SRS) include up to 6 air bags. Please
verify which kinds of air bags are equipped on your vehicle by locating the SRS
AIRBAGlocation indicators. These indicators are visible in the area where the air bags
are installed.
The air bags are installed in the following locations:
lThe steering wheel hub (driver air bag)
lThe front passenger dashboard (front passenger air bag)
lThe outboard sides of the front seatbacks (side air bags)
lThe front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge along both sides (curtain air bags)
Vehicles with the Front Passenger Occupant Classification System have a sensor which
detects an impending roll-over accident.
The air bag supplemental restraint systems are designed to provide supplemental protection
in certain situations so seat belts are always important in the following ways:
Without seat belt usage, the air bags cannot provide adequate protection during an accident.
Seat belt usage is necessary to:
lKeep the occupant from being thrown into an inflating air bag.
lReduce the possibility of injuries during an accident that is not designed for air bag
inflation, such as rear impact.
lReduce the possibility of injuries in frontal, near frontal or side collisions or roll-over
accidents that are not severe enough to activate the air bags.
lReduce the possibility of being thrown from your vehicle.
lReduce the possibility of injuries to lower body and legs during an accident because the
air bags provide no protection to these parts of the body.
lHold the driver in a position which allows better control of the vehicle.
2-40
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page52
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (53,1)
If your vehicle is also equipped with a front passenger occupant classification system,
refer to the Front Passenger Occupant Classification System (page 2-56) for details.
If your vehicle is equipped with a front passenger occupant classification system, the front
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates for a specified time after the
ignition is switched ON.
Climate control
Fully Automatic
Type
Manual Type
Small children must be protected by a child-restraint system as stipulated by law in every
state and province. In certain states and provinces, larger children must use a child-restraint
system (page 2-23).
Carefully consider which child-restraint system is necessary for your child and follow the
installation directions in this Owner's Manual as well as the child-restraint system
manufacturer's instructions.
WARNING
Seat belts must be worn in air bag equipped vehicles:
Depending only on the air bags for protection during an accident is dangerous.
Alone, air bags may not prevent serious injuries. The appropriate air bags can be
expected to inflate only in the first accident, such as frontal, near frontal or side
collisions or roll-over accident that are at least moderate. Vehicle occupants should
always wear seat belts.
Children should not ride in the front passenger seat:
Placing a child, 12 years or under, in the front seat is dangerous. The child could be
hit by a deploying air bag and be seriously injured or even killed. A sleeping child is
more likely to lean against the door and be hit by the side air bag in moderate
collision to the front-passenger side of the vehicle. Whenever possible, always secure
a child 12 years and under on the rear seats with an appropriate child-restraint
system for the child's age and size.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-41
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page53
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (54,1)
Never use a rear-facing child-restraint system in the front seat with an air bag that
could deploy:
Rear-facing child-restraint systems on the front seat are particularly dangerous even
though you may feel assured that a front passenger air bag will not deploy based on
the fact that the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates. The
child-restraint system can be hit by a deploying air bag and moved violently
backward resulting in serious injury or death to the child.
Do not sit too close to the driver and front passenger air bags:
Sitting too close to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing hands
or feet on them is extremely dangerous. The driver and front passenger air bags
inflate with great force and speed. Serious injuries could occur if someone is too
close. The driver should always hold onto only the rim of the steering wheel. The
front seat passenger should keep both feet on the floor. Front seat occupants should
adjust their seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.
Sit in the center of the seat and wear seat belts properly:
Sitting too close to the side air bag modules or placing hands on them, or sleeping
up against the door or hanging out the windows is extremely dangerous. The side
and curtain air bags inflate with great force and speed directly expanding along the
door on the side the car is hit. Serious injury could occur if someone is sitting too
close to the door or leaning against a window, or if rear seat occupants grab the
sides of the front seatbacks. Give the side and curtain air bags room to work by
sitting in the center of the seat while the vehicle is moving with seat belts worn
properly.
Do not attach objects on or around the area where driver and front passenger air
bags deploy:
Attaching an object to the driver and front passenger air bag modules or placing
something in front of them is dangerous. In an accident, an object could interfere
with air bag inflation and injure the occupants.
2-42
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page54
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (55,1)
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a side air bag deploys:
Attaching objects to the front seat in such a way as to cover the outboard side of the
seat in any way is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the side
air bag, which inflates from the outboard side of the front seats, impeding the added
protection of the side air bag system or redirecting the air bag in a way that is
dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open releasing the gas.
Do not hang net bags, map pouches or backpacks with side straps on the front
seats. Never use seat covers on the front seats. Always keep the side air bag modules
in your front seats free to deploy in the event of a side collision.
Do not attach objects on or around the area where a curtain air bag deploys:
Attaching objects to the areas where the curtain air bag activates such as on the
windshield glass, side door glass, front and rear window pillars and along the roof
edge and assist grips is dangerous. In an accident the object could interfere with the
curtain air bag, which inflates from the front and rear window pillars and along the
roof edge, impeding the added protection of the curtain air bag system or redirecting
the air bag in a way that is dangerous. Furthermore, the bag could be cut open
releasing the gas.
Do not place hangers or any other objects on the assist grips. When hanging clothes,
hang them on the coat hook directly. Always keep the curtain air bag modules free
to deploy in the event of a side collision or roll-over accident.
Do not touch the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags
have inflated:
Touching the components of the supplemental restraint system after the air bags
have inflated is dangerous. Immediately after inflation, they are very hot. You could
get burned.
Never install any front-end equipment to your vehicle:
Installation of front-end equipment, such as frontal protection bar (kangaroo bar,
bull bar, push bar, or other similar devices), snowplow, or winches, is dangerous. The
air bag crash sensor system could be affected. This could cause air bags to inflate
unexpectedly, or it could prevent the air bags from inflating during an accident.
Front occupants could be seriously injured.
Do not modify the suspension:
Modifying the vehicle suspension is dangerous. If the vehicle's height or the
suspension is modified, the vehicle will be unable to accurately detect a collision or
roll-over accident resulting in incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the
possibility of serious injuries.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-43
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page55
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (56,1)
To prevent false detection by the air bag sensor system, heed the following:
ØDo not use tires or wheels other than those specified for your Mazda:
Use of any tire or wheel other than those specified for your Mazda (page 9-8) is
dangerous. Use of such wheels will prevent the vehicle's accident detections
system from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in
incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.
ØDo not overload your vehicle:
Overloading your vehicle is dangerous as it could prevent the air bag crash sensor
system from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting in
incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious injuries.
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR) and the gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR)
for your vehicle are on the Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label on the driver's
door frame. Do not exceed these ratings.
ØDo not drive the vehicle off-road:
Driving your Mazda off-road is dangerous because the vehicle has not been
designed to do so. Driving the vehicle off-road could prevent the air bag crash
sensor system from accurately detecting a collision or roll-over accident resulting
in incorrect or unexpected air bag deployment and the possibility of serious
injuries.
Do not modify a front door or leave any damage unrepaired. Always have an
Authorized Mazda Dealer inspect a damaged front door:
Modifying a front door or leaving any damage unrepaired is dangerous. Each front
door has a side crash sensor as a component of the supplemental restraint system. If
holes are drilled in a front door, a door speaker is left removed, or a damaged door is
left unrepaired, the sensor could be adversely affected causing it to not detect the
pressure of an impact correctly during a side collision. If a sensor does not detect a
side impact correctly, the side and curtain air bags and the front seat belt
pretensioner may not operate normally which could result in serious injury to
occupants.
Do not modify the supplemental restraint system:
Modifying the components or wiring of the supplemental restraint system is
dangerous. You could accidentally activate it or make it inoperable. Do not make
any modifications to the supplemental restraint system. This includes installing trim,
badges, or anything else over the air bag modules. It also includes installing extra
electrical equipment on or near system components or wiring. An Authorized Mazda
Dealer can provide the special care needed in the removal and installation of front
seats. It is important to protect the air bag wiring and connections to assure that the
bags do not accidentally deploy and that the seats retain an undamaged air bag
connection.
2-44
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page56
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (57,1)
Do not place luggage or other objects under the front seats:
Placing luggage or other objects under the front seats is dangerous. The components
essential to the supplemental restraint system could be damaged, and in the event of
a side collision, the appropriate air bags may not deploy, which could result in death
or serious injury. To prevent damage to the components essential to the
supplemental restraint system, do not place luggage or other objects under the front
seats.
Do not operate a vehicle with damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system
components:
Expended or damaged air bag/seat belt pretensioner system components must be
replaced after any collision which caused them to deploy or damage them. Only a
trained Authorized Mazda Dealer can fully evaluate these systems to see that they
will work in any subsequent accident. Driving with an expended or damaged air bag
or pretensioner unit will not afford you the necessary protection in the event of any
subsequent accident which could result in serious injury or death.
Do not remove interior air bag parts:
Removing any components such as the front seats, front dashboard, the steering
wheel or parts on the front and rear window pillars and along the roof edge,
containing air bag parts or sensors is dangerous. These parts contain essential air
bag components. The air bag could accidentally activate and cause serious injuries.
Always have an Authorized Mazda Dealer remove these parts.
Properly dispose of the air bag system:
Improper disposal of an air bag or a vehicle with live air bags in it can be extremely
dangerous. Unless all safety procedures are followed, injury could result. Have an
Authorized Mazda Dealer safely dispose of the air bag system or scrap an air bag
equipped vehicle.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page57
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (58,1)
NOTE
lIf it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)
(page 8-2).
lWhen an air bag deploys, a loud inflation noise can be heard and some smoke will be released.
Neither is likely to cause injury, however, the texture of the air bags may cause light skin injuries
on body parts not covered with clothing through friction.
lShould you sell your Mazda, we urge you to tell the new owner of its air bag systems and that
familiarization with all instructions about them, from the Owner's Manual, is important.
lThis highly-visible label is displayed which warns against the use of rear-facing child-restraint
systems on the front passenger seat.
(Except Mexico)
(Mexico)
2-46
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page58
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (59,1)
Supplemental Restraint System Components
With front passenger occupant classification system
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-47
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page59
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (60,1)
Without front passenger occupant classification system
Driver/Front passenger inflators and air bags
Roll-over sensor
í
, crash sensors, and diagnostic module (SAS unit)
Front seat belt pretensioners (page 2-18)
Front air bag sensors
Side crash sensors
Air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light (page 4-22)
Side and curtain inflators and air bags
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light (page 2-56)
Front passenger seat weight sensors (page 2-56)
Front passenger seat weight sensor control module
Driver and front passenger seat belt buckle switches (page 2-61)
NOTE
- are equipped only on models with the front passenger occupant classification system.
2-48
Essential Safety Equipment
í
Some models.
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page60
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (61,1)
How the SRS Air Bags Work
Your Mazda is equipped with the following types of SRS air bags. SRS air bags are
designed to work together with the seat belts to help to reduce injuries during an accident.
The SRS air bags are designed to provide further protection for passengers in addition to
the seat belt functions. Be sure to wear seat belts properly.
qFront Seat Belt Pretensioners
The front seat belt pretensioners are designed to deploy in moderate or severe frontal, near
frontal collisions. In addition, during a side collision, the pretensioner operates on the side
in which the collision occurs.
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
The front seat belt pretensioners are also designed to deploy in a roll-over accident.
qDriver Air Bag
The driver's air bag is mounted in the steering wheel.
When air bag crash sensors detect a frontal impact of greater than moderate force, the
driver's air bag inflates quickly helping to reduce injury mainly to the driver's head or chest
caused by directly hitting the steering wheel.
For more details about air bag deployment, refer to SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria
(page 2-53).
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
The driver's dual-stage air bag controls air bag inflation in two energy stages. During an
impact of moderate severity the driver's air bag deploys with lesser energy, whereas during
more severe impacts, it deploys with more energy.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page61
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (62,1)
qFront Passenger Air Bag
The front passenger air bag is mounted in the front passenger dashboard.
The inflation mechanism for the front passenger air bag is the same as the driver's air bag,
as mentioned above.
For more details about air bag deployment, refer to SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria
(page 2-53).
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In addition, the front passenger air bag is designed to only deploy in accordance with the
total seated weight on the front passenger seat. For details, refer to the front passenger
occupant classification system (page 2-56).
qSide Air Bags
The side air bags are mounted in the outboard sides of the front seatbacks.
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the
system inflates the side air bag only on the side in which the vehicle was hit. The side air
bag inflates quickly to reduce injury to the driver or front passenger's chest caused by
directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window.
For more details about air bag deployment, refer to SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria
(page 2-53).
2-50
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page62
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (63,1)
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In addition, the front passenger side air bag is designed to only deploy in accordance with
the total seated weight on the front passenger seat. For details, refer to the front passenger
occupant classification system (page 2-56).
qCurtain Air Bags
The curtain air bags are mounted in the front and rear window pillars, and the roof edge
along both sides.
When the air bag crash sensors detect a side impact of greater than moderate force, the
curtain air bag inflates quickly and helps to reduce injury mainly to the rear outboard
passenger's head caused by directly hitting interior parts such as a door or window.
For more details about air bag deployment, refer to SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria
(page 2-53).
In a side impact:
Greater than moderate impact to one side of the vehicle will cause the curtain air bag on
that side only to inflate.
Only one side curtain air bag will deploy on the
side of the vehicle that receives the force of an
impact.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-51
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page63
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (64,1)
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In a roll-over:
In response to a vehicle roll-over, both curtain air bags inflate.
Both curtain air bags will deploy after
the roll-over accident is detected.
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In an angled collision:
During a collision, the driver and front passenger's air bags will deploy. Depending on the
nature of the impact, the curtain air bag may deploy.
qWarning Light/Beep
A system malfunction or operation conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page 4-22.
Refer to Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Beep on page 7-33.
2-52
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page64
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (65,1)
SRS Air Bag Deployment Criteria
This chart indicates the applicable SRS equipment that will deploy depending on the type
of collision.
(The illustrations are the representative cases of collisions.)
SRS
equipment
Types of collision
A severe frontal/near frontal
collision
A severe side
collision
A roll-over/near
roll-over
*3
A rear collision
Front seat
belt
pretensioner
X
*1
(both sides)
X
*1
(impact side only)
X
*1
(both sides)
No air bag and front
seat belt
pretensioner will be
activated in a rear
collision.
Driver air
bag X
Front
passenger air
bag
X
*1
Side air bag
X
*1
(impact side only)
Curtain air
bag X
*2
X (impact side only) X (both sides)
X: The SRS air bag equipment is designed to deploy in a collision.
*1 (With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
The front passenger front and side air bags and the seat belt pretensioner are designed
to deploy depending on the condition of the total seated weight on the front passenger
seat.
*2 (With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In an angled collision, the curtain air bag may deploy.
*3 (With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
In a roll-over accident, the seat belt pretensioners and the curtain air bags deploy.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-53
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page65
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (66,1)
Limitations to SRS Air Bag
In severe collisions such as those described previously in SRS Air Bag Deployment
Criteria, the applicable SRS air bag equipment will deploy. However, in some accidents,
the equipment may not deploy depending on the type of collision and its severity.
Limitations to front/near front collision detection:
The following illustrations are examples of front/near front collisions that may not be
detected as severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.
Impacts involving trees or poles Frontal offset impact to the vehicle
Rear-ending or running under a truck's tail gate
Limitations to side collision detection:
The following illustrations are examples of side collisions that may not be detected as
severe enough to deploy the SRS air bag equipment.
Side impacts involving trees or poles Side impacts with two-wheeled vehicles
2-54
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page66
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (67,1)
Roll-over (Without Driver and Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
Limitations to roll-over detection:
The following illustration is an example of an accident that may not be detected as a roll-
over accident. Therefore, the front seat belt pretensioners and curtain air bags may not
deploy.
Pitch end over end
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-55
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page67
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (68,1)
Front Passenger Occupant Classification System
í
First, please read Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Precautions(page 2-40)
carefully.
qFront Passenger Seat Weight Sensor
Your vehicle is equipped with a front passenger seat weight sensors as a part of the
supplemental restraint system. These sensors are located under both of the front passenger
seat rails. These sensors determine the total seated weight on the front passenger seat and
monitor the seat belt buckle for the front passenger seat. The SAS unit is designed to
prevent the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system from
deploying if the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.
To reduce the chance of injuries caused by deployment of the front passenger air bag, the
system deactivates the front passenger front and side air bags and also the seat belt
pretensioner system when the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light
illuminates. Refer to the following table for the front passenger air bag deactivation
indicator light illumination conditions.
This system shuts off the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner
system, so make sure the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates
according to the following table.
The air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light flashes and the front
passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates if the sensors have a possible
malfunction. If this happens, the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt
pretensioner system will not deploy.
2-56
Essential Safety Equipment
í
Some models.
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page68
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (69,1)
Front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light
This indicator light illuminates to remind you that the front passenger front and side air
bags and seat belt pretensioner will not deploy during a collision.
Fully Automatic Type climate controlManual Type climate control
If the front passenger weight sensors are normal, the indicator light illuminates when the
ignition is switched ON. The light turns off after a few seconds. Then, the indicator light
illuminates or is off under the following conditions:
Condition detected by the
front passenger occupant
classification system
Front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light
Front passenger front and
side air bags
Front passenger seat
belt pretensioner
system
Empty (Not occupied) On Deactivated Deactivated
Child or child-restraint
system
*1
On Deactivated Deactivated
Adult
*2
Off Ready Ready
*1 : If a larger child sits on the front passenger seat, the sensors might detect the child as being an adult depending
on the child's physique.
*2 : If a smaller adult sits on the front passenger seat, the sensors might detect the person as being a child
depending on the person's physique.
The curtain air bag is ready for inflating regardless of the chart above.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-57
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page69
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (70,1)
If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate when the
ignition is switched ON and does not illuminate as indicated in the above chart, do not
allow a child to sit in the front passenger seat and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as
soon as possible. The system may not work properly in an accident.
WARNING
Do not decrease the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:
When an adult or large child sits on the front passenger seat, decreasing the total
seated weight on the front passenger seat required for air bag deployment is
dangerous. The front passenger seat weight sensors will detect the reduced total
seated weight condition and the front passenger front and side air bags and seat
belt pretensioner system will not deploy during an accident. The front passenger will
not have the supplementary protection of the air bag, which could result in serious
injury. Decreasing the total seated weight on the front passenger seat could result in
an air bag not deploying under the following conditions, for example:
2-58
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page70
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (71,1)
ØA front passenger is seated as shown in the following figure:
ØA rear passenger pushes up on the front passenger seat with their feet.
ØLuggage or other items placed under the front passenger seat or between the
front passenger seat and driver seat that push up the front passenger seat
bottom.
ØAny accessories which might decrease the total seated weight on the front
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.
The front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner systems will
deactivate if the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-59
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page71
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (72,1)
Do not increase the total seated weight on the front passenger seat:
When an infant or small child sits on the front passenger seat, increasing the total
seated weight on the front passenger seat is dangerous. The front passenger seat
weight sensors will detect the increased total seated weight, which could result in the
unexpected deployment of the front passenger front and side air bags and seat belt
pretensioner system in an accident and may cause serious injury. Increasing the total
seated weight on the front passenger seat could result in the front passenger front
and side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system deployment in an accident under
the following conditions, for example:
ØLuggage or other items are placed on the seat with the child in the child-restraint
system.
ØA rear passenger or luggage push or pull down on the front passenger seatback.
ØA rear passenger steps on the front passenger seat rails with their feet.
ØLuggage or other items are placed on the seatback or hung on the head restraint.
ØHeavy items are placed in the seatback map pocket.
ØThe seat is washed.
ØLiquids are spilled on the seat.
ØThe front passenger seat is moved backward, pushing into luggage or other items
placed behind it.
ØThe front passenger seatback contacts the rear seat.
ØLuggage or other items are placed between the front passenger seat and driver
seat.
ØAny accessories which might increase the total seated weight on the front
passenger seat are attached to the front passenger seat.
CAUTION
ØTo assure proper deployment of the front air bag and to prevent damage to the
sensors in the front seat bottoms:
ØDo not place sharp objects on the front seat bottoms or leave heavy luggage on
them.
ØDo not spill any liquids on the front seats or under the front seats.
ØTo allow the sensors to function properly, always perform the following:
ØAdjust the front seats as far back as possible and always sit upright against the
seatbacks with seat belts worn properly.
ØIf you place your child on the front passenger seat, secure the child-restraint
system properly and slide the front passenger seat as far back as possible (page
2-31).
2-60
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page72
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (73,1)
NOTE
lThe system requires about 10 seconds to alternate between turning the front passenger front and
side air bags and seat belt pretensioner system on or off.
lThe front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate repeatedly if luggage or
other items are put on the front passenger seat, or if the temperature of the vehicle's interior
changes suddenly.
lThe front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light may illuminate for 10 seconds if the total
seated weight on the front passenger seat changes.
lThe air bag/front seat belt pretensioner system warning light might illuminate if the front
passenger seat receives a severe impact.
lIf the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light does not illuminate after installing a
child-restraint system on the front passenger seat, first, re-install your child-restraint system
according to the procedure in this owner's manual. Then, if the front passenger air bag
deactivation indicator light still does not illuminate, install the child-restraint system on the rear
seat and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
lIf the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light illuminates when an adult is seated in
the front passenger seat, have the passenger re-adjust their posture by sitting with their feet on the
floor, and then re-fastening the seat belt. If the front passenger air bag deactivation indicator light
still illuminates, move the passenger to the rear seat. If sitting in the rear seat is not possible, slide
the front passenger seat as far back as possible. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
qDriver and Front Passenger Buckle Switches
The buckle switches on the front seat belts detect whether or not the front seat belts are
securely fastened and further control the deployment of the air bags.
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
2-61
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page73
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (74,1)
Constant Monitoring
The following components of the air bag systems are monitored by a diagnostic system:
lCrash sensors, and diagnostic module (SAS unit)
lFront air bag sensors
lAir bag modules
lSide crash sensors
lAir bag/Front seat belt pretensioner system warning light
lFront seat belt pretensioners
lRelated wiring
(With Front Passenger Occupant Classification System)
lFront passenger air bag deactivation indicator light
lFront passenger seat weight sensors
lFront passenger seat weight sensor control module
lFront passenger seat belt buckle switches
The diagnostic module continuously monitors the system's readiness. This begins when the
ignition is switched ON and continues while the vehicle is being driven.
2-62
Essential Safety Equipment
SRS Air Bags
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page74
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (75,1)
3Before Driving
Use of various features, including keys, doors, mirrors and windows.
Keys .......................................................... 3-2
Keys .................................................... 3-2
Keyless Entry System ......................... 3-3
Advanced Keyless Entry System ............ 3-8
Advanced Keyless Entry System
í
..... 3-8
Operational Range .............................. 3-9
Doors and Locks .................................... 3-10
Door Locks ....................................... 3-10
Liftgate .............................................. 3-18
Fuel and Emission ................................. 3-21
Fuel and Engine Exhaust
Precautions ........................................ 3-21
Fuel-Filler Lid and Cap ..................... 3-24
Steering Wheel ....................................... 3-26
Steering Wheel .................................. 3-26
Mirrors ................................................... 3-27
Mirrors .............................................. 3-27
Windows ................................................. 3-30
Power Windows ................................ 3-30
Moonroof
í
....................................... 3-33
Security System ..................................... 3-35
Modification and Add-On
Equipment ......................................... 3-35
Immobilizer System .......................... 3-35
Theft-Deterrent System
í
.................. 3-37
Driving Tips ........................................... 3-39
Break-In Period ................................. 3-39
Money-Saving Suggestions .............. 3-39
Hazardous Driving ............................ 3-40
Floor Mat .......................................... 3-40
Rocking the Vehicle .......................... 3-41
Winter Driving .................................. 3-41
Driving In Flooded Area ................... 3-43
Overloading ...................................... 3-43
Driving on Uneven Road .................. 3-44
Towing .................................................... 3-45
Trailer Towing (U.S.A. and
Canada) ............................................. 3-45
Recreational Towing ......................... 3-53
3-1
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page75
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (76,1)
Keys
WARNING
Do not leave the key in your vehicle
with children and keep them in a place
where your children will not find or
play with them:
Leaving children in a vehicle with the
key is dangerous. This could result in
someone being badly injured or even
killed. Children may find these keys
to be an interesting toy to play with
and could cause the power windows
or other controls to operate, or even
make the vehicle move.
CAUTION
ØBecause the key (transmitter) uses
low-intensity radio waves, it may
not function correctly under the
following conditions:
ØThe key is carried with
communication devices such as
cellular phones.
ØThe key contacts or is covered
by a metal object.
ØThe key is near electronic
devices such as personal
computers.
ØNon-Mazda genuine electronic
equipment is installed in the
vehicle.
ØThere is equipment which
discharges radio waves near the
vehicle.
ØThe key (transmitter) may
consume battery power excessively
if it receives high-intensity radio
waves. Do not place the key near
electronic devices such as
televisions or personal computers.
ØTo avoid damage to the key
(transmitter), DO NOT:
ØDrop the key.
ØGet the key wet.
ØDisassemble the key.
ØExpose the key to high
temperatures on places such as
the dashboard or hood, under
direct sunlight.
ØExpose the key to any kind of
magnetic field.
ØPlace heavy objects on the key.
ØPut the key in an ultrasonic
cleaner.
ØPut any magnetized objects
close to the key.
3-2
Before Driving
Keys
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page76
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (77,1)
A code number is stamped on the plate
attached to the key set; detach this plate
and store it in a safe place (not in the
vehicle) for use if you need to make a
replacement key (auxiliary key).
Also write down the code number and
keep it in a separate safe and convenient
place, but not in the vehicle.
If your key (auxiliary key) is lost, consult
your Authorized Mazda Dealer and have
your code number ready.
NOTE
The driver must carry the key to ensure the
system functions properly.
Operation indicator light Auxiliary key
Key code number plate
Transmitter
Pull out the auxiliary key from the key
(transmitter).
Keyless Entry System
This system uses the key buttons to
remotely lock and unlock the doors and
the liftgate.
The system can start the engine without
having to take the key out of your purse
or pocket.
It can also help you signal for attention.
Operating the theft-deterrent system is
also possible on theft-deterrent system-
equipped vehicles.
Press the buttons slowly and carefully.
System malfunctions or warnings are
indicated by the following warning lights
or beeps.
For vehicles with the type A instrument
cluster, check the displayed message for
more information and, if necessary, have
the vehicle inspected at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer, according to the indication.
lKEY Warning Light (Red)
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
lIgnition Not Switched Off (STOP)
Warning Beep
Refer to Ignition Not Switched Off
(STOP) Warning Beep on page 7-33.
lKey Removed from Vehicle Warning
Beep
Refer to Key Removed from Vehicle
Warning Beep on page 7-34.
If you have a problem with the key,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
If your key is lost or stolen, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible for a replacement and to make
the lost or stolen key inoperative.
Before Driving
Keys
3-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page77
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (78,1)
CAUTION
Radio equipment like this is governed
by laws.
Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void
the user's authority to operate the
equipment.
NOTE
lThe keyless entry system operation may
vary due to local conditions.
lThe keyless entry system is fully operational
(door/liftgate lock/unlock) when the push
button start is switched off. The system does
not operate if the push button start is
switched to any position other than off.
lIf the key does not operate when pressing a
button or the operational range becomes
too small, the battery may be dead. To
install a new battery, refer to Replace
Electrical Battery(page 6-33).
lAdditional keys can be obtained at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer. Up to 6 keys can
be used with the keyless functions per
vehicle. Bring all keys to an Authorized
Mazda Dealer when additional keys are
required.
qTransmitter
NOTE
l(With theft-deterrent system)
The hazard warning lights flash when the
theft-deterrent system is armed or turned
off.
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System on page
3-37.
l(With the advanced keyless function)
A beep sound can be heard for confirmation
when the doors and liftgate are locked/
unlocked using the key. If you prefer, the
beep sound can be turned off.
The volume of the beep sound can also be
changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
Use the following procedure to change the
setting.
1. Switch the ignition off and close all of the
doors and the liftgate.
2. Open the driver's door.
3. Within 30 seconds of opening the driver's
door, press and hold the LOCK button on
the key for 5 seconds or longer.
All of the doors and the liftgate lock and the
beep sound activates at the currently set
volume. (If the beep sound is currently set
to not activate, it will not activate.) The
setting changes each time the LOCK button
on the key is pressed and the beep sound
activates at the set volume. (If the beep
sound has been set to not activate, it will
not activate.)
4. The setting change is completed by doing
any one of the following:
lSwitch the ignition to ACC or ON.
lClose the driver's door.
lOpen the liftgate.
lThe key is not operated for 10 seconds.
lPress any button except the LOCK
button on the key.
lA request switch is pressed.
3-4
Before Driving
Keys
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page78
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (79,1)
The operation indicator light flashes when
the buttons are pressed.
Lock button
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press
the lock button and the hazard warning
lights will flash once.
(With the advanced keyless function)
A beep sound will be heard once.
To confirm that all doors and the liftgate
have been locked, press the lock button
again within 5 seconds. If they are closed
and locked, the horn will sound.
NOTE
lThe doors and the liftgate can be locked by
pressing the lock button while any other
door or the liftgate is open. The hazard
warning lights will not flash.
When the lock button is pressed while any
door is open and then the door is closed, all
the doors and the liftgate are locked.
lConfirm that all doors and the liftgate are
locked visually or audibly by use of the
double click.
lMake sure all doors and the liftgate are
locked after pressing the button.
l(With theft-deterrent system)
When the doors are locked by pressing the
lock button on the key while the theft-
deterrent system is armed, the hazard
warning lights will flash once to indicate
that the system is armed.
Unlock button
To unlock the driver's door, press the
unlock button and the hazard warning
lights will flash twice.
(With the advanced keyless function)
A beep sound will be heard twice.
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press
the unlock button again within 3 seconds
and two more beep sounds will be heard.
NOTE
lThe system can be set to unlock all doors by
performing a single operation.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
Use the following procedure to change the
setting.
1. Switch the ignition off and close all of the
doors and the liftgate.
2. Open the driver's door.
3. Within 30 seconds of opening the driver's
door, press and hold the UNLOCK button
on the key for 5 seconds or longer. The
sound of the doors locking/unlocking can
be heard.
After this, the system switches the setting
each time the UNLOCK button is pressed
(the sound of the doors locking/unlocking
can be heard).
Before Driving
Keys
3-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page79
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (80,1)
4. The setting change is completed by doing
any one of the following:
lSwitch the ignition to ACC or ON.
lClose the driver's door.
lOpen the liftgate.
lThe key is not operated for 10 seconds.
lPress any button except the UNLOCK
button on the key.
lA request switch is pressed.
l(Auto re-lock function)
After unlocking with the key, all doors and
the liftgate will automatically lock if any of
the following operations are not performed
within about 60 seconds. If your vehicle has
a theft-deterrent system, the hazard
warning lights will flash for confirmation.
The time required for the doors to lock
automatically can be changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
lA door or the liftgate is opened.
lThe push button start is switched to any
position other than off.
l(With theft-deterrent system)
When the doors are unlocked by pressing
the unlock button on the key while the theft-
deterrent system is turned off, the hazard
warning lights will flash twice to indicate
that the system is turned off.
Panic button
If you witness from a distance someone
attempting to break into or damage your
vehicle, press and hold the panic button to
activate the vehicle's alarm.
NOTE
The panic button will work whether any door
or the liftgate is open or closed.
(Turning on the alarm)
Pressing the panic button for 1 second or
more will trigger the alarm for about 2
minutes and 30 seconds, and the
following will occur:
lThe horn sounds intermittently.
lThe hazard warning lights flash.
(Turning off the alarm)
The alarm stops by pressing any button on
the key.
qOperational Range
The system operates only when the driver
is in the vehicle or within operational
range while the key is being carried.
Starting the Engine
NOTE
lStarting the engine may be possible even if
the key is outside of the vehicle and
extremely close to a door and window,
however, always start the engine from the
driver's seat.
If the vehicle is started and the key is not in
the vehicle, the vehicle will not restart after
it is shut off and the push button start is
switched to off.
lThe luggage compartment is out of the
assured operational range, however, if the
key (transmitter) is operable the engine will
start.
3-6
Before Driving
Keys
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page80
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (81,1)
With the advanced keyless function
Interior antenna
Operational range
Without the advanced keyless function
Interior antenna
Operational range
NOTE
The engine may not start if the key is placed in
the following areas:
lAround the dashboard
lIn the storage compartments such as the
glove compartment
qKey Suspend Function
If a key is left in the vehicle, the functions
of the key left in the vehicle are
temporarily suspended to prevent theft of
the vehicle.
The following are inoperable:
lStarting the engine using the push
button start.
l(With the advanced keyless function)
Operating the request switches.
To restore these functions, perform any
one of the following:
lPress a button on the key which has
had its functions temporarily
suspended.
l(Manual transaxle)
When carrying another key, depress the
clutch pedal until the KEY indicator
light (green) illuminates.
(Automatic transaxle)
When carrying another key, depress the
brake pedal until the KEY indicator
light (green) illuminates.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
Before Driving
Keys
3-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page81
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (82,1)
Advanced Keyless Entry
System
í
WARNING
Radio waves from the key may affect
medical devices such as pacemakers:
Before using the key near people who
use medical devices, ask the medical
device manufacturer or your
physician if radio waves from the key
will affect the device.
The advanced keyless function allows you
to lock/unlock the doors and liftgate, or
open the liftgate while carrying the key
without using the key.
System malfunctions or warnings are
indicated by the following warning beeps.
lRequest switch Inoperable Warning
Beep
Refer to Request Switch Inoperable
Warning Beep (With the advanced
keyless function) on page 7-34.
lKey Left-in-luggage Compartment
Warning Beep
Refer to Key Left-in-luggage
Compartment Warning Beep (With the
advanced keyless function) on page
7-34.
lKey Left-in-vehicle Warning Beep
Refer to Key Left-in-vehicle Warning
Beep (With the advanced keyless
function) on page 7-34.
NOTE
The advanced keyless entry system functions
can be deactivated to prevent any possible
adverse effect on a user wearing a pacemaker
or other medical device. If the system is
deactivated, you will be unable to start the
engine by carrying the key. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer for details. If the
advanced keyless entry system has been
deactivated, you can start the engine by
following the procedure indicated when the key
battery goes dead.
Refer to Engine Start Function When Key
Battery is Dead on page 4-6.
3-8
Before Driving
í
Some models.
Advanced Keyless Entry System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page82
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (83,1)
Operational Range
The system operates only when the driver
is in the vehicle or within operational
range while the key is being carried.
NOTE
When the battery power is low, or in places
where there are high-intensity radio waves or
noise, the operational range may become
narrower or the system may not operate.
qLocking, Unlocking the Doors
and the Liftgate
Exterior antenna
Locking
only
Operational range
80cm (31in)
80cm (31in)
NOTE
The system may not operate if you are too
close to the windows, door handles, or liftgate.
qOpening the Liftgate
Exterior antenna
Operational range
80cm (31in)
Before Driving
Advanced Keyless Entry System
3-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page83
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (84,1)
Door Locks
WARNING
Always take all children and pets with
you or leave a responsible person with
them:
Leaving a child or a pet unattended
in a parked vehicle is dangerous. In
hot weather, temperatures inside a
vehicle can become high enough to
cause brain damage or even death.
Do not leave the key in your vehicle
with children and keep them in a place
where your children will not find or
play with them:
Leaving children in a vehicle with the
key is dangerous. This could result in
someone being badly injured or even
killed.
Keep all doors locked when driving:
Unlocked doors in a moving vehicle
are dangerous. Passengers can fall
out if a door is accidentally opened
and can more easily be thrown out in
an accident.
Always close all the windows and
moonroof, lock the doors and take the
key with you when leaving your vehicle
unattended:
Leaving your vehicle unlocked is
dangerous as children could lock
themselves in a hot vehicle, which
could result in death. Also, a vehicle
left unlocked becomes an easy target
for thieves and intruders.
After closing the doors, always verify
that they are securely closed:
Doors not securely closed are
dangerous, if the vehicle is driven
with a door not securely closed, the
door could open unexpectedly
resulting in an accident.
Always confirm the safety around the
vehicle before opening a door:
Suddenly opening a door is
dangerous. A passing vehicle or a
pedestrian could be hit and cause an
accident.
3-10
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page84
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (85,1)
NOTE
lWhen the ignition is switched to ACC or
ON, the vehicle lock-out prevention feature
prevents you from locking yourself out of
the vehicle.
All doors and the liftgate will automatically
unlock if they are locked using the power
door locks with any door or the liftgate
open.
The vehicle lock-out prevention feature
does not operate while the ignition is
switched off.
When any door is opened from the outside
while the key is inside the vehicle, the
closed doors are locked. All the doors are
automatically unlocked by closing the open
door.
(With the advanced keyless function)
The beep sound is heard for about 10
seconds to notify the driver that the key has
been left in the vehicle.
(Without the advanced keyless function)
The horn sound is heard twice to notify the
driver that the key has been left in the
vehicle.
l(Door unlock (control) system with
collision detection)
This system automatically unlocks the
doors in the event the vehicle is involved in
an accident to allow passengers to get out
of the vehicle immediately and prevent
being trapped inside. While the ignition is
switched ON and in the event the vehicle
receives an impact strong enough to inflate
the air bags, all the doors are automatically
unlocked after about 6 seconds have
elapsed from the time of the accident.
The doors may not unlock depending on
how an impact is applied, the force of the
impact, and other conditions of the
accident.
If door-related systems or the battery is
malfunctioning, the doors will not unlock.
qLocking, Unlocking with Key
All doors and the liftgate lock
automatically when the driver's door is
locked with the key.
All doors and the liftgate unlock when the
driver's door is unlocked and the key is
held in the unlock position for one second
or longer.
Turn the key toward the front to lock,
toward the back to unlock.
Lock Unlock
NOTE
Holding the key in the unlocked position in the
driver's door lock for about a second unlocks
all doors and the liftgate. To unlock only the
driver's door, insert the key into the driver's
door lock and turn the key briefly to the unlock
position and then immediately return it to the
center position.
qLocking, Unlocking with Request
Switch (With the advanced
keyless function)
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/
unlocked by pressing the request switch
on the front doors while the key is being
carried.
The request switch on the liftgate can only
be used to lock all doors and the liftgate.
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
3-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page85
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (86,1)
Front doors
Request switch
Liftgate (Lock only)
Request switch
To lock
To lock the doors and the liftgate, press
the request switch and the hazard warning
lights will flash once.
A beep sound will be heard once.
To unlock
Driver's door request switch
To unlock the driver's door, press the
request switch. A beep sound will be
heard twice and the hazard warning lights
will flash twice.
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press
the request switch again within 3 seconds
and two more beep sounds will be heard.
Front passenger door request switch
To unlock all doors and the liftgate, press
the request switch. A beep sound will be
heard twice and the hazard warning lights
will flash twice.
NOTE
lThe system can be set to unlock all doors by
performing a single operation.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
Use the following procedure to change the
setting.
1. Switch the ignition off and close all of the
doors and the liftgate.
2. Open the driver's door.
3. Within 30 seconds of opening the driver's
door, press and hold the UNLOCK button
on the key for 5 seconds or longer. The
sound of the doors locking/unlocking can
be heard.
After this, the system switches the setting
each time the UNLOCK button is pressed
(the sound of the doors locking/unlocking
can be heard).
4. The setting change is completed by doing
any one of the following:
lSwitch the ignition to ACC or ON.
lClose the driver's door.
lOpen the liftgate.
lThe key is not operated for 10 seconds.
lPress any button except the UNLOCK
button on the key.
lA request switch is pressed.
lConfirm that all doors and the liftgate are
securely locked.
For the liftgate, move it without pressing
the electric liftgate opener to verify that the
liftgate has not been left ajar.
lAll doors and the liftgate cannot be locked
when any door or the liftgate is open.
lIt may require a few seconds for the doors
to unlock after the request switch is
pressed.
3-12
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page86
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (87,1)
lA beep sound is heard for confirmation
when the doors and the liftgate are locked/
unlocked using the request switch. If you
prefer, the beep sound can be turned off.
The volume of the beep sound can also be
changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
Use the following procedure to change the
setting.
1. Switch the ignition off and close all of the
doors and the liftgate.
2. Open the driver's door.
3. Within 30 seconds of opening the driver's
door, press and hold the LOCK button on
the key for 5 seconds or longer.
All of the doors and the liftgate lock and the
beep sound activates at the currently set
volume. (If the beep sound is currently set
to not activate, it will not activate.) The
setting changes each time the LOCK button
on the key is pressed and the beep sound
activates at the set volume. (If the beep
sound has been set to not activate, it will
not activate.)
4. The setting change is completed by doing
any one of the following:
lSwitch the ignition to ACC or ON.
lClose the driver's door.
lOpen the liftgate.
lThe key is not operated for 10 seconds.
lPress any button except the LOCK
button on the key.
lA request switch is pressed.
l(With theft-deterrent system)
The hazard warning lights flash when the
theft-deterrent system is armed or turned
off.
Refer to Theft-Deterrent System on page
3-37.
lThe setting can be changed so that the
doors and the liftgate are locked
automatically without pressing the request
switch.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
(Auto-lock function)
A beep sound is heard when all doors and
the liftgate are closed while the advanced
key is being carried. All doors and the
liftgate are locked automatically after about
three seconds when the advanced key is out
of the operational range. Also, the hazard
warning lights flash once. (Even if the
driver is in the operational range, all doors
and the liftgate are locked automatically
after about 30 seconds.) If you are out of
the operational range before the doors and
the liftgate are completely closed or
another key is left in the vehicle, the auto-
lock function will not work. Always make
sure that all doors and the liftgate are
closed and locked before leaving the
vehicle. The auto-lock function does not
close the power windows.
l(Auto re-lock function)
After unlocking with the request switch, all
doors and the liftgate will automatically
lock if any of the following operations are
not performed within about 60 seconds. If
your vehicle has a theft-deterrent system,
the hazard warning lights will flash for
confirmation.
The time required for the doors to lock
automatically can be changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
lA door or the liftgate is opened.
lThe ignition is switched to any position
other than off.
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
3-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page87
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (88,1)
q
Locking, Unlocking with Transmitter
All doors and the liftgate can be locked/
unlocked by operating the keyless entry
system transmitter, refer to Keyless Entry
System (page 3-3).
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-
Lock Switch
All doors and the liftgate lock
automatically when lock side is pressed.
They all unlock when unlock side is
pressed.
Driver's door
Unlock
Lock
Front passenger's door
Unlock
Lock
To lock all the doors/liftgate from an open
front door, press the lock side of the door
lock switch and then close the door.
NOTE
When locking the doors this way, be careful
not to leave the key inside the vehicle.
qAuto Lock/Unlock Function
WARNING
Do not pull the inner handle on a front
door:
Pulling an inner handle on a front
door while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. Passengers can fall out of
the vehicle if a front door accidentally
opens, which could result in death or
serious injury.
lWhen the vehicle speed exceeds 20
km/h (12 mph), all doors and the
liftgate lock automatically.
lWhen the ignition is switched off, all
doors and the liftgate unlock
automatically.
These functions can also be disabled so
that they do not operate.
Auto lock/unlock function setting
change using door-lock switch
The doors and the liftgate can set to lock
or unlock automatically by selecting any
one of the functions from the following
table and using the driver's door-lock
switch on the interior door panel to
perform the setting change as indicated in
the procedure which follows.
Settings can be changed using the
following operation.
3-14
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page88
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (89,1)
NOTE
lFunction number 3 is the factory setting for
your vehicle.
lThere are only a total of five auto lock/
unlock settings available for automatic
transaxle vehicles, and three for manual
transaxle vehicles. Be sure to press the
unlock side of the driver's door-lock switch
the correct number of times according to
the selected function number. If the switch
is mistakenly pressed six times on an
automatic transaxle vehicle or four times
on a manual transaxle, the procedure will
be invalidated. If this occurs, start the
procedure from the beginning.
Function
number Function
*1
1The auto door-lock function is
disabled.
2
All the doors and the liftgate lock
automatically when the vehicle speed
is about 20 km/h (12 mph) or more.
3
All the doors and the liftgate lock
automatically when the vehicle speed
is about 20 km/h (12 mph) or more.
All the doors and the liftgate unlock
when the ignition is switched from ON
to Off.
4
(Automatic transaxle vehicles only)
When the ignition is switched ON and
the shift lever is shifted from park (P)
to any other gear position, all the
doors and the liftgate lock
automatically.
5
(Automatic transaxle vehicles only)
When the ignition is switched ON and
the shift lever is shifted from park (P)
to any other gear position, all the
doors and the liftgate lock
automatically.
When the shift lever is shifted to park
(P) while the ignition is switched ON,
all the doors and the liftgate unlock
automatically.
*1 Other settings for the auto door lock function are
available at an Authorized Mazda Dealer. For
details consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Refer to Personalization Features on page 9-10.
1. Safely park the vehicle. All doors must
remain closed.
2. Switch the ignition ON.
3. Press and hold the lock side of the
driver's door-lock switch within 20
seconds of switching the ignition ON,
and make sure a beep sound is heard
about eight seconds afterwards.
4. Referring to the auto lock/unlock
function setting table and determine the
function number for the desired setting.
Press the unlock side of the driver's
door-lock switch the same number of
times as the selected function number
(Ex. If you select function 2, press the
unlock side of the switch only 2 times).
5. Three seconds after the function setting
has been changed, a beep sound will
beep in the amount of the selected
function number. (Ex. Function
number 3 = 3 beep sounds)
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
3-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page89
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (90,1)
(Manual transaxle vehicles)
Press 2 times
Press 3 times
Current Function Number
Function Number 1
Function Number 2
Function Number 3
Press 4 times
Press unlock side of
lock switch once
Cancel setting
Cancel setting
Function set (The
number of beeps
heard is the same as
the selected function
number)
Press lock side of
lock switch
Wait for 3 second
(Automatic transaxle vehicles)
Press unlock side of
lock switch once
Press 2 times
Press 3 times
Current Function Number
Function Number 1
Function Number 2
Press 4 times
Function Number 3
Press 5 times
Function Number 4
Press 6 times
Function Number 5
Cancel setting
Cancel setting
Function set (The
number of beeps
heard is the same as
the selected function
number)
Press lock side of
lock switch
Wait for 3 second
NOTE
lThe doors cannot be locked or unlocked
while the setting function is being
performed.
lThe procedure can be cancelled by pressing
the lock side of the driver's door-lock
switch.
3-16
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page90
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (91,1)
qLocking, Unlocking with Door-
Lock Knob
To lock any door from the inside, press
the door-lock knob.
To unlock, pull it outward.
This does not operate the other door
locks.
Lock
Unlock
To lock the front passenger door with the
door-lock knob from the outside, press the
door-lock knob to the lock position and
close the door (holding the door handle
pulled is not required).
This does not operate the other door
locks.
Door-lock knob
NOTE
When locking the door this way:
lBe careful not to leave the key inside the
vehicle.
lThe driver's door lock knob cannot be used
while the driver's door is open.
lThe red indication can be seen when the
door-lock knob is unlocked.
Red indication
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
3-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page91
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (92,1)
qRear Door Child Safety Locks
These locks are intended to help prevent
children from accidentally opening the
rear doors. Use them both whenever a
child rides in the vehicle.
If you slide the child safety lock to the
lock position before closing that door, the
door cannot be opened from the inside.
The door can be opened only by pulling
the outside handle.
Lock
Unlock
Liftgate
WARNING
Never allow a person to ride in the
luggage compartment:
Allowing a person to ride in the
luggage compartment is dangerous.
The person in the luggage
compartment could be seriously
injured or killed during sudden
braking or a collision.
Do not drive with the liftgate open:
Exhaust gas in the cabin of a vehicle
is dangerous. An open liftgate in a
moving vehicle will cause exhaust
gas to be drawn into the cabin. This
gas contains CO (carbon monoxide),
which is colorless, odorless, and
highly poisonous, and it can cause
loss of consciousness and death.
Moreover, an open liftgate could
cause occupants to fall out in an
accident.
Do not stack or leave loaded luggage
unsecured in the luggage
compartment:
Otherwise, the luggage may move or
collapse, resulting in injury or an
accident. In addition, do not load
luggage higher than the seatbacks. It
may affect the side or rear field of
view.
3-18
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page92
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (93,1)
CAUTION
ØWhen loading or unloading
luggage in the luggage
compartment, turn off the engine.
Otherwise, you could get burned
by the heat of the exhaust gas.
ØBe careful not to apply excessive
force to the damper stay on the
liftgate such as by putting your
hand on the stay. Otherwise, the
damper stay may bend and affect
the liftgate operation.
Damper stay
qOpening and Closing the Liftgate
Opening the liftgate with Electric
liftgate opener
Unlock the doors and liftgate, press the
electric liftgate opener on the liftgate, and
then raise the liftgate when the latch
releases.
Electric liftgate
opener
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
3-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page93
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (94,1)
NOTE
(With the advanced keyless function)
lA locked liftgate can also be opened while
the key is being carried.
lWhen opening the liftgate with the doors
and the liftgate locked, it may require a few
seconds for the liftgate latch to release after
the electric liftgate opener is pressed.
lThe liftgate can be closed when the doors
are locked with the key left in the vehicle.
However, to prevent leaving the key in the
vehicle, the liftgate can be opened by
pressing the electric liftgate opener.
lWhen the liftgate latch is released by
pressing the electric liftgate opener, the
liftgate raises slightly to allow it to be
opened. If the liftgate is not operated for a
certain period of time after the electric
liftgate opener has been pressed, the
liftgate cannot be raised any more from its
slightly raised position. Press the electric
liftgate opener again to fully open the
liftgate. To close the liftgate from its slightly
raised position, open it first by pressing the
electric liftgate opener, and waiting for 1
second or longer then close it.
If the liftgate is not fully closed, the driver
is notified by a warning indicated in the
instrument cluster.
lThe sound of the latch may be heard for a
few seconds after the electric liftgate
opener has been pressed, however, this does
not indicate a malfunction.
Closing the liftgate
To close, lower the liftgate slowly using
the liftgate grip recess, and then push the
liftgate closed using both hands.
Do not slam it. Pull up on the liftgate to
make sure it is secure.
Liftgate grip
recess
3-20
Before Driving
Doors and Locks
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page94
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (95,1)
Fuel and Engine Exhaust Precautions
qFuel Requirements
Vehicles with catalytic converters or oxygen sensors must use ONLY UNLEADED FUEL,
which will reduce exhaust emissions and keep spark plug fouling to a minimum.
Your Mazda will perform best with fuel listed in the table.
Fuel Octane Rating
*
(Anti-knock index)
Regular unleaded fuel 87 [ (R M)/2 method] or above (91 RON or above)
* U.S. federal law requires that octane ratings be posted on gasoline station pumps.
Fuel with a rating lower than 87 octane (91 RON) could cause the emission control system
to lose effectiveness. It could also cause engine knocking and serious engine damage.
CAUTION
ØUSE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.
Leaded fuel is harmful to the catalytic converter and oxygen sensors and will lead
to deterioration of the emission control system and or failures.
ØYour vehicle can only use oxygenated fuels containing no more than 10 % ethanol
by volume. Damage to your vehicle may occur when ethanol exceeds this
recommendation, or if the gasoline contains any methanol. Stop using gasohol of
any kind if your vehicle engine is performing poorly.
ØNever add fuel system additives. Otherwise, the emission control system could be
damaged. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer for details.
Gasoline blended with oxygenates such as alcohol or ether compounds are generally
referred to as oxygenated fuels. The common gasoline blend that can be used with your
vehicle is ethanol blended at no more than 10 %. Gasoline containing alcohol, such as
ethanol or methanol, may be marketed under the name Gasohol.
Vehicle damage and drivability problems resulting from the use of the following may not
be covered by the Mazda warranty.
lGasohol containing more than 10 % ethanol.
lGasoline or gasohol containing methanol.
lLeaded fuel or leaded gasohol.
Before Driving
Fuel and Emission
3-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page95
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (96,1)
qEmission Control System
Your vehicle is equipped with an emission control system (the catalytic converter is part of
this system) that enables your vehicle to comply with existing exhaust emissions
requirements.
WARNING
Never park over or near anything flammable:
Parking over or near anything flammable, such as dry grass, is dangerous. Even with
the engine turned off, the exhaust system remains very hot after normal use and
could ignite anything flammable. A resulting fire could cause serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Ignoring the following precautions could cause lead to accumulate on the catalyst
inside the converter or cause the converter to get very hot. Either condition will
damage the converter and cause poor performance.
ØUSE ONLY UNLEADED FUEL.
ØDo not drive your Mazda with any sign of engine malfunction.
ØDo not coast with the ignition switched off.
ØDo not descend steep grades in gear with the ignition switched off.
ØDo not operate the engine at high idle for more than 2 minutes.
ØDo not tamper with the emission control system. All inspections and adjustments
must be made by a qualified technician.
ØDo not push-start or pull-start your vehicle.
NOTE
lUnder U.S. federal law, any modification to the original-equipment emission control system before
the first sale and registration of a vehicle is subject to penalties. In some states, such modification
made on a used vehicle is also subject to penalties.
lWhile the engine is off, the sound of a valve opening and closing can be heard at the rear of the
right side of the vehicle, however this does not indicate an abnormality. Your vehicle has a self-
checking device and it operates while the engine is off.
3-22
Before Driving
Fuel and Emission
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page96
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (97,1)
qEngine Exhaust (Carbon monoxide)
WARNING
Do not drive your vehicle if you smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle:
Engine exhaust gas is dangerous. This gas contains carbon monoxide (CO), which is
colorless, odorless, and poisonous. When inhaled, it can cause loss of consciousness
and death. If you smell exhaust gas inside your vehicle, keep all windows fully open
and contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer immediately.
Do not run the engine when inside an enclosed area:
Running the engine inside an enclosed area, such as a garage, is dangerous. Exhaust
gas, which contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could easily enter the cabin. Loss
of consciousness or even death could occur.
Open the windows or adjust the heating or cooling system to draw fresh air when
idling the engine:
Exhaust gas is dangerous. When your vehicle is stopped with the windows closed
and the engine running for a long time even in an open area, exhaust gas, which
contains poisonous carbon monoxide, could enter the cabin. Loss of consciousness or
even death could occur.
Clear snow from underneath and around your vehicle, particularly the tail pipe,
before starting the engine:
Running the engine when a vehicle is stopped in deep snow is dangerous. The
exhaust pipe could be blocked by the snow, allowing exhaust gas to enter the cabin.
Because exhaust gas contains poisonous carbon monoxide, it could cause loss of
consciousness or even death to occupants in the cabin.
Before Driving
Fuel and Emission
3-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page97
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (98,1)
Fuel-Filler Lid and Cap
WARNING
When removing the fuel-filler cap,
loosen the cap slightly and wait for any
hissing to stop. Then remove it:
Fuel spray is dangerous. Fuel can
burn skin and eyes and cause illness
if ingested. Fuel spray is released
when there is pressure in the fuel
tank and the fuel-filler cap is
removed too quickly.
Before refueling, stop the engine, and
always keep sparks and flames away
from the filler neck:
Fuel vapor is dangerous. It could be
ignited by sparks or flames causing
serious burns and injuries.
Additionally, use of the incorrect fuel-
filler cap or not using a fuel-filler cap
may result in fuel leak, which could
result in serious burns or death in an
accident.
Do not continue refueling after the fuel
pump nozzle shuts off automatically:
Continuing to add fuel after the fuel
pump nozzle has shut off
automatically is dangerous because
overfilling the fuel tank may cause
fuel overflow or leakage. Fuel
overflow and leakage could damage
the vehicle and if the fuel ignites it
could cause a fire and explosion
resulting in serious injury or death.
CAUTION
(U.S.A. and Canada)
Always use only a genuine Mazda
fuel-filler cap or an approved
equivalent, available at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer. The wrong
cap can result in a serious
malfunction of the fuel and emission
control systems. It may also cause
the check engine light in the
instrument cluster to illuminate.
qFuel-Filler Lid
To open, pull the remote fuel-filler lid
release.
Remote fuel-filler
lid release
qFuel-Filler Cap
To remove the fuel-filler cap, turn it
counterclockwise.
Attach the removed cap to the inner side
of the fuel lid.
3-24
Before Driving
Fuel and Emission
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page98
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (99,1)
To close the fuel-filler cap, turn it
clockwise until a click is heard.
Open
Close
CAUTION
(U.S.A. and Canada)
If the check fuel cap warning light
illuminates, the fuel-filler cap may
not be properly installed. If the
warning light illuminates, park your
vehicle safely off the right-of-way,
remove the fuel-filler cap and
reinstall it correctly. After the cap has
been correctly installed, the fuel cap
warning light may continue to
illuminate until a number of driving
cycles have been completed. A drive
cycle consists of starting the engine
(after four or more hours with the
engine off) and driving the vehicle on
city and highway roads.
Continuing to drive with the check
fuel cap warning light illuminated
could cause the check engine light to
illuminate as well.
Before Driving
Fuel and Emission
3-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page99
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (100,1)
Steering Wheel
WARNING
Never adjust the steering wheel while
the vehicle is moving:
Adjusting the steering wheel while
the vehicle is moving is dangerous.
Moving it can very easily cause the
driver to abruptly turn to the left or
right. This can lead to loss of control
or an accident.
qSteering Wheel Adjustment
To change the angle or length of the
steering wheel:
1. Stop the vehicle, and then pull down
the lock release lever under the steering
column.
Lock release lever
2. Tilt the steering wheel and/or adjust the
steering column length to the desired
positions, and then push the lever up to
lock the column.
3. Attempt to push the steering wheel up
and down to make sure it's locked
before driving.
3-26
Before Driving
Steering Wheel
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page100
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (101,1)
Mirrors
Before driving, adjust the inside and
outside mirrors.
qOutside Mirrors
WARNING
Be sure to look over your shoulder
before changing lanes:
Changing lanes without taking into
account the actual distance of the
vehicle in the convex mirror is
dangerous. You could have a serious
accident. What you see in the convex
mirror is closer than it appears.
Mirror type
Flat type (driver's side)
Flat surface mirror.
Convex type (front passenger side)
The mirror has single curvature on its
surface.
Power mirror adjustment
The ignition must be switched to ACC or
ON position.
To adjust:
1. Rotate the mirror switch to the left ( )
or right ( ) to choose the left or right
side mirror.
2. Press the mirror switch in the
appropriate direction.
Mirror switch
Center position
After adjusting the mirror, lock the control
by rotating the switch in the center
position.
Folding mirror
WARNING
Always return the outside mirrors to
the driving position before you start
driving:
Driving with the outside mirrors
folded in is dangerous. Your rear view
will be restricted, and you could have
an accident.
Fold the outside mirror rearward until it is
flush with the vehicle.
Before Driving
Mirrors
3-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page101
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (102,1)
qRearview Mirror
WARNING
Do not stack cargo or objects higher
than the seatbacks:
Cargo stacked higher than the
seatbacks is dangerous. It can block
your view in the rearview mirror,
which might cause you to hit another
car when changing lanes.
Rearview mirror adjustment
Before driving, adjust the rearview mirror
to center on the scene through the rear
window.
NOTE
For the manual day/night mirror, perform the
adjustment with the day/night lever in the day
position.
Reducing glare from headlights
Manual day/night mirror
Push the day/night lever forward for day
driving. Pull it back to reduce glare of
headlights from cars at the rear.
Night
Day
Day/Night lever
Auto-dimming mirror
The auto-dimming mirror automatically
reduces glare of headlights from cars at
the rear when the ignition is switched ON.
(With Homelink wireless control
system)
Press the OFF button ( ) to cancel the
automatic dimming function. The
indicator light will turn off.
To reactivate the automatic dimming
function, press the ON button ( ). The
indicator light will illuminate.
Indicator light
OFF button
ON button
3-28
Before Driving
Mirrors
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page102
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (103,1)
(Without Homelink wireless control
system)
Press the ON/OFF button to cancel the
automatic dimming function. The
indicator light will turn off.
To reactivate the automatic dimming
function, press the ON/OFF button .
The indicator light will illuminate.
ON/OFF buttonIndicator light
NOTE
lDo not use glass cleaner or suspend objects
on or around the light sensor. Otherwise,
light sensor sensitivity will be affected and
may not operate normally.
(With Homelink wireless control system)
Light sensor
(Without Homelink wireless control system)
Light sensor
l(With Homelink wireless control system)
For information regarding the 3 buttons
(, , ) on the auto-dimming
mirror.
Refer to HomeLink Wireless Control System
on page 4-68.
lThe auto-dimmer function is canceled when
the ignition is switched ON and the shift
lever is in reverse (R).
Before Driving
Mirrors
3-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page103
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (104,1)
Power Windows
The ignition must be switched ON for the
power windows to operate.
WARNING
Make sure the opening is clear before
closing a window:
Closing power windows are
dangerous. A person's hands, head,
or even neck could be caught by the
window and result in serious injury
or even death. This warning applies
especially to children.
Never allow children to play with
power window switches:
Power window switches that are not
locked with the power window lock
switch would allow children to
operate power windows
unintentionally which could result in
serious injury if a child's hands, head
or neck becomes caught by the
window.
CAUTION
To prevent burning out the fuse and
damaging the power window system,
do not open or close more than three
windows at once.
qOperating the Driver's Side
Power Window
Normal opening/closing
To open the window to the desired
position, lightly hold down the switch.
To close the window to the desired
position, lightly pull up the switch.
Driver's window
Open
Close
Master control switches
Auto-opening/closing
To fully open the window automatically,
press the switch completely down, then
release. The window will fully open
automatically.
To fully close the window automatically,
pull the switch completely up, then
release. The window will fully close
automatically.
To stop the window partway, pull or press
the switch in the opposite direction and
then release it.
3-30
Before Driving
Windows
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page104
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (105,1)
Power window system initialization
procedure
If the battery was disconnected during
vehicle maintenance, or for other reasons
(such as a switch continues to be operated
after the window is fully open/closed), the
window will not fully open and close
automatically.
The power window auto function will
only resume on the power window that
has been reset.
1 Switch the ignition ON.
2 Make sure that the power window lock
switch located on the driver's door is
not depressed.
3 Press the switch and fully open the
window.
4 Pull up the switch to fully close the
window and continue holding the
switch for about 2 seconds after the
window fully closed.
Jam-safe window
If a person's hands, head or an object
blocks the window during the auto-
closing operation, the window will stop
and open halfway.
WARNING
Make sure nothing blocks the window
just before it reaches the fully closed
position or while holding up the power
window switch:
Blocking the power window just
before it reaches the fully closed
position or while holding up the
power window switch is dangerous.
In this case, the jam-safe function
cannot prevent the window from
closing all the way. If fingers are
caught, serious injuries could occur.
NOTE
lDepending on driving conditions, a closing
power window could stop and start opening
when the window feels a shock that is
similar to something blocking it.
In the event the jam-safe function activates
and the power window cannot be closed
automatically, pull and hold the switch and
the window will close.
lThe jam-safe window function does not
operate until the system has been reset.
Engine-off power window operation
The power window can be operated for
about 40 seconds after the ignition is
switched from ON to off with all doors
closed. If any door is opened, the power
window will stop operating.
NOTE
For engine-off operation of the power window,
the switch must be held up firmly throughout
window closure because the auto-closing
function will be inoperable.
Before Driving
Windows
3-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page105
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (106,1)
qOperating the Passenger Power
Windows
The power windows may be operated
when the power window lock switch on
the driver's door is in the unlocked
position.
The passenger windows may be opened or
closed using the master control switches
on the driver's door.
Left rear window
Right rear window
Front
passenger's
window
Driver's window
Master control switches
To open the window to the desired
position, hold down the switch.
To close the window to the desired
position, pull up the switch.
Close
Open
qPower Window Lock Switch
This feature prevents all power windows
from operating, except the driver's power
window. Keep this switch in the locked
position while children are in the vehicle.
Locked position (button depressed):
Only the driver's power window can be
operated.
Unlocked position (button not
depressed):
All power windows on each door can be
operated.
Locked position
Unlocked position
3-32
Before Driving
Windows
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page106
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (107,1)
Moonroof
í
The moonroof can be opened or closed
electrically only when the ignition is
switched ON.
Tilt/Slide switch
WARNING
Do not let passengers stand up or
extend part of the body through the
open moonroof while the vehicle is
moving:
Extending the head, arms, or other
parts of the body through the
moonroof is dangerous. The head or
arms could hit something while the
vehicle is moving. This could cause
serious injury or death.
Make sure the opening is clear before
closing the moonroof:
A closing moonroof is dangerous. The
hands, head, or even neck of a
person, especially a child, could be
caught in it as it closes, causing
serious injury or even death.
NOTE
Before washing your Mazda, make sure the
moonroof is completely closed so that water
does not get inside the cabin area. After
washing your Mazda or after it rains, wipe the
water off the moonroof before operating it to
avoid water penetration which could cause
rust and water damage to your headliner.
qTilt Operation
The rear of the moonroof can be tilted
open to provide more ventilation.
To fully tilt automatically, momentarily
press the tilt/slide switch.
To stop tilting partway, press the tilt/slide
switch.
To close to the desired position, press the
tilt/slide switch in the forward direction.
Close (Tilt down)
Tilt up
qSlide Operation
To fully open automatically, momentarily
press the tilt/slide switch in the backward
direction.
To stop sliding partway, press the tilt/slide
switch.
Before Driving
Windows
3-33
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page107
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (108,1)
To close to the desired position, press the
tilt/slide switch in the forward direction.
Close
Open
q
Power Moonroof Re-set Procedure
If the battery is disconnected, the
moonroof will not operate. The moonroof
will not operate correctly until it is re-set.
Carry out the following procedure to re-
set the moonroof and resume operation:
1. Switch the ignition ON.
2. Press the tilt switch, to partially tilt
open the rear of the moonroof.
3. Repeat Step 2. The rear of the
moonroof tilts open to the fully open
position, then closes a little.
NOTE
If the re-set procedure is performed while the
moonroof is in the slide position (partially
open) it will close before the rear tilt opens.
qSunshade
The sunshade can be opened and closed
by hand.
The sunshade opens automatically when
the moonroof is opened, but must be
closed by hand.
Sunshade
CAUTION
ØThe sunshade does not tilt. To
avoid damaging the sunshade, do
not push up on it.
ØDo not close the sunshade while
the moonroof is opening. Trying to
force the sunshade closed could
damage it.
3-34
Before Driving
Windows
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page108
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (109,1)
Modification and Add-On
Equipment
Mazda cannot guarantee the immobilizer
and the theft-deterrent systems' operation
if the system have been modified or if any
add-on equipment has been installed.
CAUTION
To avoid damage to your vehicle, do
not modify the system or install any
add-on equipment to the immobilizer
and the theft-deterrent systems or
the vehicle.
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system allows the engine
to start only with a key the system
recognizes.
If someone attempts to start the engine
with an unrecognized key, the engine will
not start, thereby helping to prevent the
theft of your vehicle.
If you have a problem with the
immobilizer system or the key, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
CAUTION
ØRadio equipment like this is
governed by laws.
Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could
void the user's authority to
operate the equipment.
ØTo avoid damage to the key, do
not:
ØDrop the key.
ØGet the key wet.
ØExpose the key to any kind of
magnetic field.
ØExpose the key to high
temperatures on places such as
the dashboard or hood, under
direct sunlight.
ØIf the engine does not start with
the correct key, and the security
indicator light keeps illuminating
or flashing, the system may have
a malfunction. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Before Driving
Security System
3-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page109
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (110,1)
NOTE
lThe keys carry a unique electronic code.
For this reason, and to assure your safety,
obtaining a replacement key requires some
waiting time. They are only available
through an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lAlways keep a spare key in case one is lost.
If a key is lost, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
lIf you lose a key, an Authorized Mazda
Dealer will reset the electronic codes of
your remaining keys and immobilizer
system. Bring all the remaining keys to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer to reset.
Starting the vehicle with a key that has not
been reset is not possible.
qOperation
NOTE
lThe engine may not start and security
indicator light may illuminate or flash if the
key is placed in an area where it is difficult
for the system to detect the signal, such as
on the dashboard or in the glove
compartment. Move the key to a location
within the signal range, switch the ignition
off, and then restart the engine.
lSignals from a TV or radio station, or from
a transceiver or mobile telephone could
interfere with your immobilizer system. If
you are using the proper key and the engine
fails to start, check the security indicator
light.
Arming
The system is armed when the push
button start is pressed from ON to off.
The security indicator light in the
instrument cluster flashes every 2 seconds
until the system is disarmed.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
Disarming
The system is disarmed when the ignition
is switched ON with the correct
programmed key. The security indicator
light illuminates for about 3 seconds and
then turns off. If the engine does not start
with the correct key, and the security
indicator light remains illuminated or
flashing, try the following:
Make sure the key is within the
operational range for signal transmission.
Switch the ignition off, and then restart
the engine. If the engine does not start
after 3 or more tries, contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lIf the security indicator light flashes
continuously while you are driving, do not
shut off the engine. Go to an Authorized
Mazda Dealer and have it checked. If the
engine is shut off while the indicator light is
flashing, you will not be able to restart it.
lBecause the electronic codes are reset when
the immobilizer system is repaired, the keys
are needed. Make sure to bring all the keys
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer so that they
can be programmed.
3-36
Before Driving
Security System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page110
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (111,1)
Theft-Deterrent System
í
If the theft deterrent system detects an
inappropriate entry into the vehicle, which
could result in the vehicle or its contents
being stolen, the alarm alerts the
surrounding area of an abnormality by
sounding the horn and flashing the hazard
warning lights.
The system will not function unless it's
properly armed. So when you leave the
vehicle, follow the arming procedure
correctly.
qOperation
System triggering conditions
The horn sounds intermittently and the
hazard warning lights flash for about 30
seconds when the system is triggered by
any one of the following:
lUnlocking a door with the key
í
, door
lock switch, or an inside door-lock
knob.
lForcing open a door, the hood or the
liftgate.
lOpening the hood by operating the
hood release handle.
lSwitching the ignition ON without
using the push button start.
If the system is triggered again, the lights
and horn will activate until the driver's
door or the liftgate is unlocked with the
auxiliary key
í
or with the transmitter.
(With advanced key)
The lights and horn can also be
deactivated by pressing the request switch
on a door.
NOTE
If the battery goes dead while the theft-
deterrent system is armed, the horn will
activate and the hazard warning lights will
flash when the battery is charged or replaced.
qHow to Arm the System
1. Close the windows and the moonroof
í
securely.
2. Press the push button start off.
3. Make sure the hood, the doors, and the
liftgate are closed.
4. Press the lock button on the transmitter
or lock the driver's door from the
outside with the auxiliary key.
The hazard warning lights will flash
once.
The following method will also arm the
theft-deterrent system:
Press the door-lock switch while
any door is open and then close all of
the doors.
(With the advanced keyless function)
Press a request switch.
The security indicator light in the
instrument panel flashes twice per
second for 20 seconds.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
5. After 20 seconds, the system is fully
armed.
Before Driving
Security System
3-37
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page111
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (112,1)
NOTE
lThe theft deterrent system can also be
armed by activating the auto relock
function with all the doors, the liftgate and
the hood closed.
Refer to Transmitter on page 3-4.
lThe system will disarm if one of the
following operations takes place within 20
seconds after pressing the lock button:
lUnlocking a door.
lAny door or the liftgate is opened.
lThe hood is opened.
lThe ignition is switched on.
l(With the advanced keyless function)
Press the electric liftgate opener while
the key is being carried.
To rearm the system, do the arming
procedure again.
lWhen the doors are locked by pressing the
lock button on the transmitter or using the
auxiliary key while the theft-deterrent
system is armed, the hazard warning lights
will flash once to indicate that the system is
armed.
qTo Turn Off an Armed System
An armed system can be turned off using
any one of the following methods:
lUnlock the driver's door with the
auxiliary key.
í
lPress the unlock button on the
transmitter.
lSwitch the ignition ON.
l(With the advanced keyless function)
Press a request switch on the doors.
The hazard warning lights will flash
twice.
NOTE
When the doors are unlocked by pressing the
unlock button on the transmitter or using the
auxiliary key
í
while the theft-deterrent system
is turned off, the hazard warning lights will
flash twice to indicate that the system is turned
off.
qTo Stop the Alarm
A triggered alarm can be turned off using
any one of the following methods:
lUnlock the driver's door with the
auxiliary key.
í
lPress the unlock button on the
transmitter.
lThe engine is started with the push
button start.
l(With the advanced keyless function)
lPress a request switch on the doors.
lPress the electric liftgate opener
while the key is being carried.
The hazard warning lights will flash
twice.
qTheft-Deterrent Labels
A label indicating that your vehicle is
equipped with a Theft-Deterrent System is
in the glove compartment.
Mazda recommends that you affix it to the
lower rear corner of a front door window.
3-38
Before Driving
í
Some models.
Security System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page112
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (113,1)
Break-In Period
No special break-in is necessary, but a few
precautions in the first 1,000 km (600
miles) may add to the performance,
economy, and life of your Mazda.
lDo not race the engine.
lDo not maintain one constant speed,
either slow or fast, for a long period of
time.
lDo not drive constantly at full-throttle
or high engine rpm for extended
periods of time.
lAvoid unnecessary hard stops.
lAvoid full-throttle starts.
lDo not tow a trailer.
Money-Saving Suggestions
How you operate your Mazda determines
how far it will travel on a tank of fuel. Use
these suggestions to help save money on
fuel and repairs.
lAvoid long warm-ups. Once the engine
runs smoothly, begin driving.
lAvoid fast starts.
lFollow the maintenance schedule (page
6-4) and have an Authorized Mazda
Dealer perform inspections and
servicing.
lUse the air conditioner only when
necessary.
lSlow down on rough roads.
lKeep the tires properly inflated.
lDo not carry unnecessary weight.
lDo not rest your foot on the brake
pedal while driving.
lKeep the wheels in correct alignment.
lKeep windows closed at high speeds.
lSlow down when driving in crosswinds
and headwinds.
WARNING
Never stop the engine when going
down a hill:
Stopping the engine when going
down a hill is dangerous. This causes
the loss of power steering and power
brake control, and may cause
damage to the drivetrain. Any loss of
steering or braking control could
cause an accident.
Before Driving
Driving Tips
3-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page113
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (114,1)
Hazardous Driving
WARNING
Be extremely careful if it is necessary to
downshift on slippery surfaces:
Downshifting into lower gear while
driving on slippery surfaces is
dangerous. The sudden change in tire
speed could cause the tires to skid.
This could lead to loss of vehicle
control and an accident.
When driving on ice or in water, snow,
mud, sand, or similar hazards:
lBe cautious and allow extra distance
for braking.
lAvoid sudden braking and sudden
maneuvering.
lDo not pump the brakes. Continue to
press down on the brake pedal.
Refer to Antilock Brake System (ABS)
on page 4-82.
lIf you get stuck, select a lower gear and
accelerate slowly. Do not spin the front
wheels.
lFor more traction in starting on
slippery surfaces such as ice or packed
snow, use sand, rock salt, chains,
carpeting, or other nonslip material
under the front wheels.
NOTE
Use snow chains only on the front wheels.
Floor Mat
WARNING
Make sure the floor mats are hooked
on the retention pins to prevent them
from bunching up under the foot
pedals:
Using a floor mat that is not secured
is dangerous as it will interfere with
the accelerator and brake pedal
operation, which could result in an
accident.
Do not install two floor mats, one on
top of the other, on the driver's side:
Installing two floor mats, one on top
of the other, on the driver's side is
dangerous as the retention pins can
only keep one floor mat from sliding
forward.
In using a heavy duty floor mat for
winter use always remove the
original floor mat.
Loose floor mat(s) will interfere with
the foot pedal and could result in an
accident.
When setting a floor mat, position the
floor mat so that its grommets are inserted
over the pointed end of the retention
posts.
3-40
Before Driving
Driving Tips
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page114
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (115,1)
Rocking the Vehicle
WARNING
Do not spin the wheels at more than 56
km/h (35 mph), and do not allow
anyone to stand behind a wheel when
pushing the vehicle:
When the vehicle is stuck, spinning
the wheels at high speed is
dangerous. The spinning tire could
overheat and explode. This could
cause serious injuries.
CAUTION
Too much rocking may cause engine
overheating, transaxle failure, and
tire damage.
If you must rock the vehicle to free it from
snow, sand or mud, depress the
accelerator slightly and slowly move the
shift lever from 1 (D) to R.
Winter Driving
Carry emergency gear, including tire
chains, window scraper, flares, a small
shovel, jumper cables, and a small bag of
sand or salt.
Ask an Authorized Mazda Dealer to
perform the following precautions:
lHave the proper ratio of antifreeze in
the radiator.
Refer to Engine Coolant on page 6-23.
lInspect the battery and its cables. Cold
reduces battery capacity.
lUse an engine oil appropriate for the
lowest ambient temperatures that the
vehicle will be driven in (page 6-21).
lInspect the ignition system for damage
and loose connections.
lUse washer fluid made with
antifreezebut do not use engine
coolant antifreeze for washer fluid
(page 6-25).
lDo not use the parking brake in
freezing weather as it may freeze.
Instead, shift to P with an automatic
transaxle and to 1 or R with a manual
transaxle. Block the rear wheels.
lSnow left on the windshield is
dangerous as it could obstruct vision.
Remove snow before driving.
lDo not apply excessive force to a
window scraper when removing ice or
frozen snow on the mirror glass and
windshield.
lNever use warm or hot water for
removing snow or ice from windows
and mirrors as it could result in the
glass cracking.
Before Driving
Driving Tips
3-41
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page115
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (116,1)
lBraking performance can be adversely
affected if snow or ice adheres to the
brake components. If this situation
occurs, drive the vehicle slowly,
releasing the accelerator pedal and
lightly applying the brakes several
times until the brake performance
returns to normal.
qSnow Tires
Use snow tires on all four wheels
Do not go faster than 120 km/h (75 mph)
while driving with snow tires. Inflate
snow tires 30 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm
2
, 4.3 psi)
more than recommended on the tire
pressure label (driver's door frame), but
never more than the maximum cold-tire
pressure shown on the tires.
Your vehicle is originally equipped with
all season radials designed to be used all
year around. In some extreme climates
you may find it necessary to replace them
with snow tires during the winter months
to further improve traction on snow and
ice covered roads.
WARNING
Use only the same size and type tires
(snow, radial, or non-radial) on all four
wheels:
Using tires different in size or type is
dangerous. Your vehicle's handling
could be greatly affected and result
in an accident.
CAUTION
Check local regulations before using
studded tires.
qTire Chains
Check local regulations before using tire
chains.
CAUTION
ØChains may affect handling.
ØDo not go faster than 50 km/h (30
mph) or the chain manufacturer's
recommended limit, whichever is
lower.
ØDrive carefully and avoid bumps,
holes, and sharp turns.
ØAvoid locked-wheel braking.
ØDo not use chains on a temporary
spare tire; it may result in damage
to the vehicle and to the tire.
ØDo not use chains on roads that
are free of snow or ice. The tires
and chains could be damaged.
ØChains may scratch or chip
aluminum wheels.
NOTE
The tire pressure monitoring system may not
function correctly when using tire chains.
Install the chains on the front tires only.
Do not use chains on the rear tires.
Please consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Installing the chains
1. Secure the chains on the front tires as
tightly as possible.
Always follow the chain
manufacturer's instructions.
2. Retighten the chains after driving 1/2
1 km (1/41/2 mile).
3-42
Before Driving
Driving Tips
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page116
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (117,1)
Driving In Flooded Area
WARNING
Dry off brakes that have become wet
by driving slowly, releasing the
accelerator pedal and lightly applying
the brakes several times until the brake
performance returns to normal:
Driving with wet brakes is
dangerous. Increased stopping
distance or the vehicle pulling to one
side when braking could result in a
serious accident. Light braking will
indicate whether the brakes have
been affected.
CAUTION
Do not drive the vehicle on flooded
roads as it could cause short
circuiting of electrical/electronic
parts, or engine damage or stalling
from water absorption. If the vehicle
has been immersed in water, consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Overloading
WARNING
Be careful not to overload your vehicle:
The gross axle weight rating (GAWR)
and the gross vehicle weight rating
(GVWR) of your vehicle are on the
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard Label
on the driver's door frame. Exceeding
these ratings can cause an accident
or vehicle damage. You can estimate
the weight of your load by weighing
the items (or people) before putting
them in the vehicle.
Before Driving
Driving Tips
3-43
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page117
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (118,1)
Driving on Uneven Road
Your vehicle's suspension and underbody can be damaged if driven on rough/uneven roads
or over speed bumps at excessive speeds. Use care and reduce speed when traveling on
rough/uneven roads or over speed bumps.
Use care not to damage the vehicle's underbody, bumpers or muffler(s) when driving under
the following conditions:
lAscending or descending a slope with a sharp transition angle
lAscending or descending a driveway or trailer ramp with a sharp transition angle
Your vehicle is equipped with low profile tires allowing class-leading performance and
handling. As a result, the sidewall of the tires are very thin and the tires and wheels can be
damaged if driven through potholes or on rough/uneven roads at excessive speeds. Use
care and reduce speed when traveling on rough/uneven roads or through potholes.
3-44
Before Driving
Driving Tips
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page118
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (119,1)
Trailer Towing (U.S.A. and Canada)
Your Mazda was designed and built primarily to carry passengers and cargo.
If you tow a trailer, follow these instructions because driver and passenger safety depends
on proper equipment and safe driving habits. Towing a trailer will affect handling, braking,
durability, performance, and fuel economy.
Never overload vehicle or trailer. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer if you need further
details.
CAUTION
Do not tow a trailer during the first 1,000 km (600 miles) of your new Mazda. If you
do, you may damage the engine, transaxle, differential, wheel bearings, and other
power train components.
qWeight Limits
TTW and GCWR
The total trailer weight (TTW), gross combination weight rating (GCWR), gross axle
weight rating (GAWR), trailer load, and trailer tongue load must be within the
prescribed limits.
lThe total trailer weight (TTW) is the sum of the weights of the trailer load (trailer
weight plus cargo), trailer hitch, 2 passengers, and vehicle load (baggage, food,
camp gear, etc.). Never allow the total trailer weight (TTW) to exceed specifications
in the Trailer Towing-Load Table.
lThe maximum GCWR is the combination weight of the trailer and load plus the
towing vehicle (including trailer hitch, vehicle passengers, and load). It must not
exceed specifications in the load table.
GAWR and GVWR
Do not exceed front and rear GAWR (gross axle weight rating) and GVWR (gross vehicle
weight rating). If you do, vehicle handling, braking, and performance will be affected.
These values are also on the Motor Vehicle Safety Certification Label posted on the driver's
door frame.
High-altitude operation
In a high-altitude operating environment, a gasoline engine loses power at a rate of 3 % to
4 % per 304 m (1,000 ft) of elevation. In these conditions, a reduction in gross vehicle
weight and gross combination weight is recommended.
Before Driving
Towing
3-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page119
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (120,1)
TRAILER TOWING-LOAD TABLE
Because vehicle weights vary, adjustments must be made to meet the requirements in this
table.
Item
Model
SKYACTIV-G 2.0 SKYACTIV-G 2.5
2WD AWD 2WD AWD
Manual
transaxle Automatic transaxle Automatic transaxle
MAX.
FRONTAL
AREA
2.97 m
2
(32 ft
2
)
MAX. TTW 907 kg (2,000 lb)
MAX. GCWR 2,577 kg
(5,637 lb)
2,640 kg
(5,820 lb)
2,708 kg
(5,970 lb)
2,677 kg
(5,901 lb)
2,747 kg
(6,056 lb)
MAX. GAWR
Front 972 kg
(2,143 lb)
1,009 kg
(2,224 lb)
1,026 kg
(2,262 lb)
1,035 kg
(2,282 lb)
1,056 kg
(2,328 lb)
Rear 971 kg
(2,141 lb)
969 kg
(2,136 lb)
1,020 kg
(2,249 lb)
968 kg
(2,134 lb)
1,018 kg
(2,244 lb)
MAX. GVWR 1,940 kg
(4,277 lb)
1,975 kg
(4,354 lb)
2,043 kg
(4,504 lb)
2,000 kg
(4,409 lb)
2,071 kg
(4,566 lb)
TRAILER-
TONGUE
LOAD
Tongue load
Tongue load/Trailer load × 100 = 10 % to 15 %
Trailer load
DISTRIBU-
TION OF
TRAILER
LOAD
Front 60 %
Rear 40 %
3-46
Before Driving
Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page120
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (121,1)
WARNING
Always keep tow loads within specified limits as indicated in the Trailer Towing-Load
Table:
Attempting to tow loads greater than those specified is dangerous as it may cause
serious handling and performance problems that could result in personal injury or
vehicle damage, or both.
Load your trailer with the weight about 60 % toward the front and 40 % toward the
rear:
Loading the trailer with more weight in the rear than in the front is dangerous.
Doing so could cause you to lose control. The trailer tongue load must be 10 %15
% of the total trailer load (sum of the weights of the trailer and cargo).
Always have the total trailer weight and tongue load determined prior to departure:
Attempting to tow loads without determining the total trailer weight and tongue
load is dangerous. Trailer sway from crosswinds, rough roads or other causes could
result in loss of control and a serious accident.
CAUTION
The total trailer weight and tongue load can be determined by weighing the trailer
on platform scales at a highway weight station or a trucking company.
qTrailer Hitch
Use only a hitch ball recommended by the trailer manufacturer that conforms to the gross
trailer weight requirement.
When not towing a trailer, remove the trailer hitch (if detachable) to reduce the possibility
of damage as a result of the vehicle being rear-ended.
Before Driving
Towing
3-47
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page121
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (122,1)
WARNING
Always make sure the trailer hitch is securely attached before departure:
An unsecured trailer hitch is dangerous as it causes greater trailer sway from
crosswinds, rough roads or other causes, resulting in loss of control and a serious
accident.
Examine all trailer-hitch mounting bolts regularly and tighten any that are loose. If
the hitch is removed, seal any open mounting holes to prevent exhaust, dust, water,
dirt and other foreign elements from filtering in, possibly endangering personal
safety and damaging your vehicle.
Do not install a hitch that stiffens the bumper as it will reduce the bumper's
performance.
Make sure there are no exhaust gas leaks into the passenger compartment if any
mounting bolts are connected to the body:
Modifying your vehicle exhaust system is dangerous. Exhaust gas entering the
vehicle could cause loss of consciousness or even death.
When mounting the trailer hitch, make no modifications to the vehicle exhaust
system.
CAUTION
ØMake all hitch adjustments with actual loads. Do not load and unload vehicle
while adjusting hitch. This action will change the vehicle height.
ØDo not use an axle-mounted hitch. This may damage the axle and related parts.
qTires
When towing a trailer, make sure all tires are inflated to the recommended cold-tire
pressure, as indicated on the tire pressure chart on the driver's door frame. Trailer tire size,
load rating, and inflation pressures should conform to tire manufacturer specifications.
WARNING
Never use the temporary spare tire when towing:
Using the temporary spare tire on your vehicle when towing a trailer is dangerous as
it could result in tire failure, loss of control, and injury to vehicle occupants.
3-48
Before Driving
Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page122
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (123,1)
qSafety Chains
Safety chains must be used as a precautionary measure should the trailer become
unintentionally unhitched. They should cross under the trailer tongue and attach to the
hitch. Leave enough slack to allow full turns. Consult literature published by your trailer or
hitch manufacturer for more details.
WARNING
Make sure the safety chain is securely attached to both the trailer and the vehicle
prior to departure:
Towing a trailer without using a safety chain securely attached to both the trailer
and the vehicle is dangerous. If damage occurs to the coupling unit or hitch ball, the
trailer could wander into another lane and cause a collision.
qTrailer Lights
Trailer lights must comply with all federal, state, and local regulations. Equip your trailer
as required before towing it day or night.
CAUTION
Do not connect a trailer lighting system directly to the lighting system of your
Mazda. This may damage your vehicle's electrical system and lighting systems. Have
a recreational vehicle dealer or trailer rental agency connect the system, and inspect
the brake lights and turn signals yourself before each trip.
qTrailer Brakes
If the total trailer weight exceeds 450 kg (1,000 lb), trailer brakes are required. If your
trailer has brakes, make sure they comply with all federal, state, and local regulations.
WARNING
Do not connect a hydraulic trailer-brake system to your vehicle's brake system:
Connecting a hydraulic trailer-brake system directly to the vehicle brake system is
dangerous and will result in inadequate braking and possible injury.
qTrailer Towing Tips
lVerify that your Mazda maintains a near-normal attitude when a loaded or unloaded
trailer is connected. Do not drive if it has an abnormal front-up or front-down position.
Inspect for incorrect tongue load, worn suspension parts, and trailer overloading.
lMake sure the trailer is properly loaded and the cargo is secure to prevent it from
shifting.
lMake sure the mirrors conform to all government regulations. If they do not, install
required rear view mirrors appropriate for towing purposes.
Before Driving
Towing
3-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page123
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (124,1)
The three main causes of vehicle-trailer accidents are driver error, excessive speed, and
improper trailer loading.
Before driving
lHave your cooling and braking system checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lBefore starting out, inspect the operation of all vehicle and trailer lights and all vehicle-
to-trailer connections. Stop and re-inspect all lights and connections after driving a short
distance.
Driving
lYour Mazda will handle differently with a trailer in tow, so practice turning, backing,
and stopping in a traffic-free area.
lTake time to get accustomed to the extra weight and length.
lAllow more room between your vehicle and the one in front because braking distance
increases with a trailer. For each 16 km/h (10 mph) of speed, allow at least one vehicle
and trailer length between your Mazda and the vehicle ahead.
lAvoid jerky starts or sudden acceleration.
lAvoid sudden braking. It may cause loss of control and result in jackknifing, especially
so on wet or slippery roads.
lShift the shift lever to the D position when towing a trailer in hilly terrain or when
heavily loaded.
The D position will allow operating the vehicle without frequent shifting.
Lane changes and turning
Avoid quick lane changes, sudden turns, and tight turns. Slow down before turning to
avoid the need of sudden braking.
A turning trailer will make a tighter arc than the tow vehicle. Compensate with turns that
are larger than normal.
Passing
Plan well ahead to pass other vehicles, and provide plenty of room before changing lanes.
Crosswinds from passing vehicles, especially larger ones, and the effects of rough roads
will affect handling.
If swaying occurs, firmly grip the steering wheel and reduce speed immediately, but
gradually.
Steer straight ahead. If no extreme correction of steering or braking is made, the
combination of less speed and firm steering will result in stability.
Backing up
Backing a vehicle with a trailer requires practice and patience. Back slowly, and have a
helper outside at the rear of the trailer to reduce the risk of an accident.
To turn the trailer, place your hand at the bottom of the steering wheel and turn it in the
direction you want the trailer to go. Make only slight movements to prevent sharp or
prolonged turning.
3-50
Before Driving
Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page124
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (125,1)
Ascending a hill
Shift into a lower gear to reduce the possibility of overloading or overheating the engine, or
both.
Descending a hill
Shift into a lower gear and use engine compression as a braking effect.
WARNING
Always use lower gears to reduce speed:
Holding the brake pedal down too long or too frequently is dangerous as it could
cause the brakes to overheat and lose power, resulting in loss of control and a
serious accident. Use lower gears to help reduce speed. Pull off the road and allow
brakes to cool down whenever braking performance feels reduced.
Overheated engine
The extra weight of the trailer may strain the engine on hot days and on long or steep
upgrades.
If the temperature gauge indicates overheating, turn off the air conditioner, drive safely to
the side of the road, park off the right-of-way and wait for engine to cool. Refer to
Overheating (page 7-18).
Parking
Always make sure the tires of the trailer and the tow vehicle are blocked while parked.
Apply the parking brake firmly and put the transaxle in P.
Avoid parking on an incline, but if you must, follow these instructions:
1. Depress and hold down the brake pedal.
2. Have a helper put wheel blocks against the downhill side of all vehicle and trailer tires.
3. Then release the brake pedal slowly until the blocks bear the load.
lIf the grade is downhill, turn the steering wheel so that the front of the front tires face
the curb.
lIf it is uphill, face the rear of the front tires against the curb.
4. Firmly apply the parking brake.
5. Shift the transaxle into P, and stop the engine.
To restart after parking on an incline:
1. With the transaxle in P, start the engine. (Be sure to depress and hold the brake pedal.)
2. Shift into gear.
Before Driving
Towing
3-51
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page125
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (126,1)
3. Release the parking brake (also the foot brake) and pull away from the wheel blocks.
Stop; apply the parking brake and shift into P.
4. Have a helper retrieve the wheel blocks.
Fuel consumption
Trailer towing causes higher fuel consumption.
Maintenance
If you tow a trailer frequently, have your vehicle serviced as shown in Scheduled
Maintenance (page 6-4).
3-52
Before Driving
Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page126
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (127,1)
Recreational Towing
An example of recreational towingis
towing your vehicle behind a motorhome.
The transaxle is not designed for towing
this vehicle on all 4 wheels.
When doing recreational towing refer to
Towing Description(page 7-20) and
Tiedown Hooks(page 7-21) and
carefully follow the instructions.
Before Driving
Towing
3-53
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page127
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (128,1)
3-54
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page128
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (129,1)
4When Driving
Information concerning safe driving and stopping.
Start/Stop Engine .................................... 4-2
Ignition Switch .................................... 4-2
Starting the Engine .............................. 4-3
Turning the Engine Off ....................... 4-8
Instrument Cluster and Display ........... 4-10
Meters and Gauges ............................ 4-10
Warning/Indicator Lights .................. 4-22
Transaxle ................................................ 4-44
Manual Transaxle Operation ............. 4-44
Automatic Transaxle Controls .......... 4-46
Switches and Controls ........................... 4-55
Lighting Control ............................... 4-55
Fog Lights
í
...................................... 4-60
Turn and Lane-Change Signals ......... 4-60
Windshield Wipers and Washer ........ 4-61
Rear Window Wiper and Washer ...... 4-65
Rear Window Defogger .................... 4-66
Horn .................................................. 4-67
Hazard Warning Flasher .................... 4-67
HomeLink Wireless Control
System
í
............................................ 4-68
Brake ...................................................... 4-71
Brake System .................................... 4-71
Hill Launch Assist (HLA) ................. 4-74
Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS)
í
........................................... 4-76
ABS/TCS/DSC ....................................... 4-82
Antilock Brake System (ABS) .......... 4-82
Traction Control System (TCS) ........ 4-83
Dynamic Stability Control (DSC) ..... 4-84
AWD ....................................................... 4-86
All-Wheel Drive (AWD) Operation... 4-86
Power Steering ....................................... 4-88
Power Steering .................................. 4-88
Cruise Control ....................................... 4-89
Cruise Control ................................... 4-89
Tire Pressure Monitoring System ........ 4-93
Tire Pressure Monitoring System ...... 4-93
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM)
System .................................................... 4-97
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM)
System
í
............................................ 4-97
Rear View Monitor .............................. 4-101
Rear View Monitor
í
...................... 4-101
4-1
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page129
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (130,1)
Ignition Switch
qPush Button Start Positions
The system operates only when the driver
is in the vehicle or within operational
range while the key is being carried.
Each time the push button start is pressed,
the ignition switches in the order of off,
ACC, and ON. Pressing the push button
start again from ON switches the ignition
off.
Indicator light
NOTE
lThe engine starts by pressing the push
button start while depressing the clutch
pedal (manual transaxle) or the brake
pedal (automatic transaxle). To switch the
ignition position, press the push button start
without depressing the pedal.
lDo not leave the ignition switched ON
while the engine is not running. Doing so
could result in the battery going dead. If the
ignition is left in ACC (For automatic
transaxle, the shift lever is in the P position,
and the ignition is in ACC), the ignition
switches off automatically after about 25
minutes.
Off
The power supply to electrical devices
turns off and the push button start
indicator light (amber) also turns off.
WARNING
Before leaving the driver's seat, always
switch the ignition off, set the parking
brake, and make sure the shift lever is
in P (automatic transaxle) or in 1st gear
or R (manual transaxle):
Leaving the driver's seat without
switching the ignition off, setting the
parking brake, and shifting the shift
lever to P (automatic transaxle) or to
1st gear or R (manual transaxle) is
dangerous. Unexpected vehicle
movement could occur which could
result in an accident.
In addition, if your intention is to
leave the vehicle for even a short
period, it is important to switch the
ignition off, as leaving it in another
position will disable some of the
vehicle's security systems and run the
battery down.
ACC (Accessory)
Some electrical accessories will operate
and the indicator light (amber)
illuminates.
NOTE
The keyless entry system does not function
while the push button start has been pressed to
ACC, and the doors will not lock/unlock even
if they have been locked manually.
4-2
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page130
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (131,1)
ON
This is the normal running position after
the engine is started. The indicator light
(amber) turns off. (The indicator light
(amber) illuminates when the ignition is
switched ON and the engine is not
running.)
Some indicator lights/warning lights
should be inspected before the engine is
started (page 4-22).
NOTE
When the push button start is pressed to ON,
the sound of the fuel pump motor operating
near the fuel tank can be heard. This does not
indicate an abnormality.
Starting the Engine
WARNING
Radio waves from the key may affect
medical devices such as pacemakers:
Before using the key near people who
use medical devices, ask the medical
device manufacturer or your
physician if radio waves from the key
will affect the device.
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
4-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page131
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (132,1)
NOTE
lThe key must be carried because the key
carries an immobilizer chip that must
communicate with the engine controls at
short range.
lThe engine can be started when the push
button start is pressed from off, ACC, or
ON.
lThe push button start system functions
(function which can start the engine by only
carrying the key) can be deactivated to
prevent any possible adverse effect on a
user wearing a pacemaker or other medical
device. If the system is deactivated, you will
be unable to start the engine by carrying
the key. Consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer for details. If the push button start
system functions have been deactivated, you
can start the engine by following the
procedure indicated when the key battery
goes dead.
Refer to Engine Start Function When Key
Battery is Dead on page 4-6.
lAfter starting a cold engine, the engine
speed increases and a whining sound from
the engine compartment can be heard.
This is for improved exhaust gas
purification and does not indicate defect of
the parts.
lEngine-starting is controlled by the spark
ignition system.
This system meets all Canadian
Interference-Causing Equipment Standard
requirements regulating the impulse
electrical field strength of radio noise.
1. Make sure you are carrying the key.
2. Occupants should fasten their seat
belts.
3. Make sure the parking brake is on.
4. Continue to press the brake pedal
firmly until the engine has completely
started.
5. (Manual transaxle)
Continue to press the clutch pedal
firmly until the engine has completely
started.
(Automatic transaxle)
Put the vehicle in park (P). If you must
restart the engine while the vehicle is
moving, shift into neutral (N).
NOTE
(Manual transaxle)
The starter will not operate if the clutch pedal
is not depressed sufficiently.
(Automatic transaxle)
The starter will not operate if the shift lever is
not in P or N and the brake pedal is not
depressed sufficiently.
6. Verify that the KEY indicator light
(green) (if equipped) in the instrument
cluster and the push button start
indicator light (green) illuminate. Refer
to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22. If the push button start indicator
light (green) flashes, make sure that the
key is being carried (for vehicles with a
type A meter (page 4-22), messages are
displayed in the instrument cluster). If
the push button start indicator light
(green) flashes with the key being
carried, touch the key to the push
button start and start the engine (for
vehicles with a type A meter (page
4-22), messages are displayed in the
instrument cluster). Refer to Engine
Start Function When Key Battery is
Dead on page 4-6.
4-4
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page132
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (133,1)
CAUTION
If the KEY warning light (red)
illuminates, or the push button start
indicator light (amber) flashes, this
could indicate a problem with the
engine starting system and the
inability to start the engine or switch
the ignition to ACC or ON (for
vehicles with a type A meter (page
4-22), messages are displayed in the
instrument cluster). Have your
vehicle inspected at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
NOTE
lUnder the following conditions, the KEY
warning light (red) flashes after the push
button start is pressed to inform the driver
that the push button start will not switch to
ACC even if it is pressed from off (for
vehicles with a type A meter (page 4-22),
messages are displayed in the instrument
cluster).
lThe key battery is dead.
lThe key is out of operational range.
lThe key is placed in areas where it is
difficult for the system to detect the
signal (page 3-6).
lA key from another manufacturer similar
to the key is in the operational range.
l(Forced engine starting method)
If the KEY warning light (red) illuminates,
or the push button start indicator light
(amber) flashes, this could indicate that the
engine may not start using the usual
starting method (for vehicles with a type A
meter, messages are displayed in the
instrument cluster). Have your vehicle
inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer
as soon as possible. If this occurs, the
engine can be force-started. Press and hold
the push button start until the engine starts.
Other procedures necessary for starting the
engine such as having the key in the cabin,
and depressing the clutch pedal (manual
transaxle) or the brake pedal (automatic
transaxle) are required.
lWhen the engine is force-started, the KEY
warning light (red) (if equipped) remains
illuminated and the push button start
indicator light (amber) remains flashing.
l(Automatic transaxle)
When the shift lever is in the neutral (N)
position, the KEY indicator light (green) (if
equipped) and the push button start
indicator light (green) do not illuminate.
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
4-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page133
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (134,1)
7. Press the push button start after both
the KEY indicator light (green) (if
equipped) in the instrument cluster and
the push button start indicator light
(green) illuminate.
NOTE
lAfter starting the engine, the push button
start indicator light (amber) turn off and
the ignition is in the ON position.
lAfter pressing the push button start and
before the engine starts, the operation
sound of the fuel pump motor from near the
fuel tank can be heard, however, this does
not indicate a malfunction.
8. After starting the engine, let it idle for
about ten seconds.
NOTE
lWhether the engine is cold or warm, it
should be started without the use of the
accelerator.
lIf the engine does not start the first time,
refer to Starting a Flooded Engine under
Emergency Starting. If the engine still does
not start, have your vehicle inspected by an
Authorized Mazda Dealer (page 7-17).
qEngine Start Function When Key
Battery is Dead
CAUTION
When starting the engine by holding
the transmitter over the push button
start due to a dead key battery or a
malfunctioning key, be careful not to
allow the following.
Otherwise the signal from the key
will not be received correctly and the
engine may not start.
ØMetal parts of other keys or metal
objects touch the key.
ØSpare keys or keys for other
vehicles equipped with an
immobilizer system touch or come
near the key.
ØDevices for electronic purchases, or
security passage which touch or
come near the key.
If the engine cannot be started due to a
dead key battery, the engine can be started
using the following procedure:
1. Depress the brake pedal (automatic
transaxle) or fully depress the clutch
pedal (manual transaxle).
4-6
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page134
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (135,1)
2. Verify that the push button start
indicator light (green) flashes.
NOTE
The push button start indicator light (green)
will flash even if the push button start is
pressed before depressing the brake pedal
(automatic transaxle) or the clutch pedal
(manual transaxle). If the clutch pedal is
depressed (manual transaxle) or the brake
pedal is depressed (automatic transaxle) under
this condition, the engine can be started by
resuming the procedure following this.
3. Touch the push button start using the
backside of the key (as shown) while
the push button start indicator light
(green) flashes.
Key
Indicator light
Push button start
4. After the push button start indicator
light (green) changes to full
illumination, press the push button start
with your finger.
NOTE
lThe engine cannot be started unless the
clutch pedal is fully depressed (manual
transaxle) or the brake pedal is fully
depressed (automatic transaxle).
lIf there is a malfunction with the push
button start function, the push button start
indicator light (amber) flashes. In this case,
the engine may start, however, have the
vehicle checked at an Authorized Mazda
Dealer as soon as possible.
lIf the push button start indicator light
(green) does not illuminate, perform the
operation from the beginning again. If it
does not illuminate, have the vehicle
checked at an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lIf you just want to change the ignition
position (with a dead key battery), after the
push button start indicator light (green)
changes to illumination, release the brake
pedal (automatic transaxle) or the clutch
pedal (manual transaxle), and press the
push button start. The ignition switches in
the order of ACC, ON, and OFF each time
it is pressed. Once the ignition switches off,
the ignition position can no longer be
switched. Therefore, if the engine starts,
perform the operation from the beginning
again.
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
4-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page135
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (136,1)
qEmergency Operation for
Starting the Engine
If the KEY warning light (red)
illuminates, or the push button start
indicator light (amber) flashes, this could
indicate that the engine may not start
using the usual starting method (for
vehicles with a type A meter, messages
are displayed in the instrument cluster).
Have your vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible. If this occurs, the engine can be
force-started. Press and hold the push
button start until the engine starts. Other
procedures necessary for starting the
engine such as having the key in the
cabin, and depressing the clutch pedal
(manual transaxle) or the brake pedal
(automatic transaxle) are required.
Turning the Engine Off
WARNING
Do not stop the engine while the
vehicle is moving:
Stopping the engine while the vehicle
is moving for any reason other than
in an emergency is dangerous.
Stopping the engine while the vehicle
is moving will result in reduced
braking ability due to the loss of
power braking, which could cause an
accident and serious injury.
1. Stop the vehicle completely.
2. (Manual transaxle)
Shift into neutral.
(Automatic transaxle)
Shift the shift lever to the P position.
3. Press the push button start to turn off
the engine. The ignition position is off.
CAUTION
When leaving the vehicle, make sure
the push button start is pressed to
off.
4-8
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page136
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (137,1)
NOTE
lThe cooling fan in the engine compartment
could turn on for a few minutes after the
ignition is switched from ON to OFF,
whether or not the A/C is on or off, to cool
the engine compartment quickly.
lIf the system detects that the remaining
battery power of the key is low when the
ignition is switched from ON to ACC or
OFF, the following is indicated.
Replace with a new battery before the key
becomes unusable.
Refer to Replace Electrical Battery on page
6-33.
(Vehicle equipped with Type A
*1
instrument cluster)
A message is indicated in the display of the
instrument cluster.
*1 Refer to Type A on page 4-22.
(Vehicle equipped with Type B
*2
instrument cluster)
The KEY indicator light (green) flashes for
approximately 30 seconds.
*2 Refer to Type B on page 4-26.
l(Automatic transaxle)
If the engine is turned off while the shift
lever is in a position other than P, the
ignition switches to ACC.
qEmergency Engine Stop
Continuously pressing the push button
start while the engine is running or the
vehicle being driven, or quickly pressing
it any number of times will turn the
engine off immediately. The ignition
position will be ACC.
When Driving
Start/Stop Engine
4-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page137
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (138,1)
Meters and Gauges
Type A
Type B
Speedometer ....................................................................................................... page 4-11
Odometer, Trip Meter and Trip Meter Selector .................................................. page 4-11
Tachometer ........................................................................................................ page 4-12
Fuel Gauge ........................................................................................................ page 4-13
Dashboard Illumination ..................................................................................... page 4-13
Outside Temperature Display ............................................................................. page 4-14
Cruise Control Set Vehicle Speed Display (Type A instrument cluster) ............ page 4-15
Maintenance Monitor (Type A instrument cluster) ............................................ page 4-15
Trip Computer and INFO Switch ...................................................................... page 4-18
4-10
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page138
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (139,1)
qSpeedometer
The speedometer indicates the speed of
the vehicle.
qOdometer, Trip Meter and Trip
Meter Selector
The display mode can be changed
between trip meter A and trip meter B by
pressing the selector while one of them is
displayed. The selected mode will be
displayed.
Type A
Press the selector
Press the selector
Trip meter A
Odometer
Trip meter B
Odometer
Type B
Press the selector
Press the selector
Trip meter A
Odometer
Trip meter B
Odometer
NOTE
When the ignition is switched to ACC or OFF,
the odometer or trip meters cannot be
displayed, however, pressing the selector can
inadvertently switch the trip meters or reset
them during an approximate ten-minute period
in the following cases:
lAfter the ignition is switched to OFF from
ON.
lAfter the driver's door is opened.
Odometer
The odometer records the total distance
the vehicle has been driven.
Trip meter
The trip meter can record the total
distance of two trips. One is recorded in
trip meter A, and the other is recorded in
trip meter B.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page139
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (140,1)
For instance, trip meter A can record the
distance from the point of origin, and trip
meter B can record the distance from
where the fuel tank is filled.
When trip meter A is selected, pressing
the selector again within one second will
change to trip meter B mode.
When trip meter A is selected, TRIP A
will be displayed. When trip meter B is
selected, TRIP B will be displayed.
The trip meter records the total distance
the vehicle is driven until the meter is
again reset. Return it to 0.0by holding
the selector depressed for 1 second or
more. Use this meter to measure trip
distances and to compute fuel
consumption.
NOTE
lOnly the trip meters record tenths of
kilometers (miles).
lThe trip record will be erased when:
lThe power supply is interrupted (blown
fuse or the battery is disconnected).
lThe vehicle is driven over 9999.9 km
(mile).
qTachometer
The tachometer shows engine speed in
thousands of revolutions per minute
(rpm).
CAUTION
Do not run the engine with the
tachometer needle in the RED ZONE.
This may cause severe engine
damage.
*1 The range varies depending on the type
of gauge.
*1 Striped zone
*1 Red zone
NOTE
When the tachometer needle enters the
STRIPED ZONE, this indicates to the driver
that the gears should be shifted before entering
the RED ZONE.
4-12
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page140
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (141,1)
qFuel Gauge
The fuel gauge shows approximately how
much fuel is remaining in the tank when
the ignition is switched ON. We
recommend keeping the tank over 1/4 full.
Type A
Full
1/4 Full
Type B
Full
1/4 Full
If the low fuel warning light illuminates or
the fuel level is very low, refuel as soon as
possible.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
NOTE
lAfter refueling, it may require some time for
the indicator to stabilize. In addition, the
indicator may deviate while driving on a
slope or curve since the fuel moves in the
tank.
lThe display indicating a quarter or less
remaining fuel has more segments to show
the remaining fuel level in greater detail.
lThe direction of the arrow ( ) indicates
that the fuel-filler lid is on the left side of
the vehicle.
qDashboard Illumination
Rotate the knob to adjust the brightness of
the instrument cluster and other
illuminations in the dashboard.
NOTE
lThe brightness of dashboard illuminations
can be adjusted when the headlights and
Parking lights are turned on.
lWhen the dashboard illumination
brightness cannot be adjusted any more, a
beep sound will be heard.
Dim
Bright
Canceling the illumination dimmer
When the headlight switch is in the
or position, the illumination of the
instrument cluster dims.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page141
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (142,1)
When driving on snowy or foggy roads,
or in other situations when the instrument
cluster's visibility is reduced due to glare
from surrounding brightness, cancel the
illumination dimmer and increase the
illumination intensity.
To cancel the illumination dimmer, rotate
the knob clockwise fully. You will hear a
beep sound and the illumination dimmer
will be canceled.
NOTE
lThis symbol ( ) indicates the knob to
adjust the brightness of the dashboard
illumination.
lIf the dashboard illumination knob is kept
at the illumination dimmer cancel position,
the instrument cluster will not dim when the
headlight switch is turned to the or
position again. Rotate the dashboard
illumination knob counterclockwise to
activate the illumination dimmer.
qOutside Temperature Display
When the ignition is switched ON, the
outside temperature is displayed.
Type A
Type B
NOTE
Under the following conditions, the outside
temperature display may differ from the actual
outside temperature depending on the
surroundings and vehicle conditions:
lSignificantly cold or hot temperatures.
lSudden changes in outside temperature.
lThe vehicle is parked.
lThe vehicle is driven at low speeds.
(Type B instrument cluster)
The outside temperature unit can be
switched between Celsius and Fahrenheit
using the following procedure.
1. Press the INFO button with the ignition
switched off and continue pressing the
INFO button for 5 seconds or longer
while switching the ignition ON. The
outside temperature display flashes.
2. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to change the outside
temperature unit.
3. Press and hold the INFO button for 3
seconds or longer while the outside
temperature display is flashing. The
outside temperature display
illuminates.
4-14
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page142
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (143,1)
q
Cruise Control Set Vehicle Speed
Display (Type A instrument cluster)
The vehicle speed preset using the cruise
control is displayed.
qMaintenance Monitor (Type A
instrument cluster)
The following maintenance period
notifications can be displayed by turning
the Maintenance Monitor on.
lScheduled Maintenance
lTire Rotation
lTire Pressure Check
The maintenance monitor displays the
information when the ignition is switched
ON.
NOTE
This function is inoperable while the vehicle is
being driven.
Initial setting method
1. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Settings, and
then press the INFO button.
2. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Maintenance,
and then press the INFO button.
3. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to select the item you
want to turn on from the following, and
then press the INFO button.
lScheduled
lTire Rotation
lTire Pressure
NOTE
If a Scheduled Maintenance item has been set,
both the time and distance can be set. For
items other than Scheduled Maintenance,
either distance or time can be set.
4. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Set Time or Set
Distance, and then press the INFO
button. The screen for setting the
distance or time to the next
maintenance period is displayed.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page143
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (144,1)
5. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to change the set distance
or time, and press the INFO button. If
no changes are necessary, press the
INFO button.
NOTE
lThe initial setting values are displayed
corresponding to the maintenance schedule
(except some countries). For each regional
maintenance schedule, Refer to Scheduled
Maintenance on page 6-4.
lis displayed on the set items.
Message display
When the remaining time or the distance
approaches 0, a message is displayed each
time the ignition is switched ON.
NOTE
lIf any of the INFO switches (up , down
, or INFO button) is pressed while a
message is displayed, it will no longer be
displayed the next time the ignition is
switched ON.
lAfter the vehicle is serviced and the
remaining time/distance is reset, the
message for the next maintenance period
will be displayed when the remaining
distance or time to the next maintenance
period approaches 0 (displays when engine
is started).
lIf there are multiple messages, they are
displayed according to their order.
lIf OFF is set for Messages, messages are
not displayed.
4-16
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page144
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (145,1)
Message display
Item Start of message display Displayed message
Scheduled
Maintenance
When remaining distance is less than
500 km (250 mile), or remaining days are
less than 15 (whichever comes first)
Scheduled Maintenance Due
Tire Rotation When remaining distance is less than
500 km (250 mile)
Tire Rotation Due
Tire Pressure Check When remaining days are less than 15 Tire Pressure Increase Pressure
Reset method
If resetting is performed after a
maintenance has been completed, a
notification of the next maintenance
period will be displayed when the period
approaches.
1. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Settings, and
then press the INFO button.
2. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Maintenance,
and then press the INFO button.
3. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to select the item you
want to reset from the following, and
then press the INFO button.
lScheduled
lTire Rotation
lTire Pressure
NOTE
lThe current remaining distance and time is
displayed.
lEven if the remaining distance or time have
surpassed 0, the display does not display a
minus (_) and leaves the value at 0.
4. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Set Time or Set
Distance, and then press the INFO
button. The remaining time and
distance values return to the values
previously set. If no changes are
necessary, press the INFO button.
NOTE
lIf the settings are changed from the initial
values, the values which you set are
displayed, not the initial values.
lEven if the battery is disconnected, the
remaining distance and time information is
not erased.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page145
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (146,1)
Method for turning the system off
The maintenance monitor can be turned
off even after it has been turned on. If you
want to turn it off, the remaining distance
and time calculation to the next
maintenance period is stopped, and a
message does not display to indicate an
approaching maintenance period.
1. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Settings, and
then press the INFO button.
2. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Maintenance,
and then press the INFO button.
3. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to select the item you
want to turn off from the following,
and then press the INFO button.
lScheduled
lTire Rotation
lTire Pressure
4. Select OFF and press the INFO button.
qTrip Computer and INFO Switch
The following information can be selected
by pressing the up or down part of
the INFO switch with the ignition
switched ON.
lApproximate distance you can travel
on the available fuel
lAverage fuel economy
lCurrent fuel economy
lAverage vehicle speed
lSettings (Type A instrument cluster)
lWarning (Type A instrument cluster)
If you have any problems with your trip
computer, consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Distance-to-empty mode
This mode displays the approximate
distance you can travel on the remaining
fuel based on the fuel economy.
4-18
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page146
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (147,1)
The distance-to-empty will be calculated
and displayed every second.
Type A
Type B
NOTE
lEven though the distance-to-empty display
may indicate a sufficient amount of
remaining driving distance before refueling
is required, refuel as soon as possible if the
fuel level is very low or the low fuel
warning light illuminates.
lThe display will not change unless you add
more than approximately 10 L (2.6 US gal,
2.2 Imp gal) of fuel.
lThe distance-to-empty is the approximate
remaining distance the vehicle can be
driven until all the graduation marks in the
fuel gauge indicating the remaining fuel
supply disappear.
Average fuel economy mode
This mode displays the average fuel
economy by calculating the total fuel
consumption and the total traveled
distance since purchasing the vehicle, re-
connecting the battery after disconnection,
or resetting the data. The average fuel
economy is calculated and displayed
every minute.
Type A
Type B
To clear the data being displayed, press
the INFO button for more than 1.5
seconds.
After pressing the INFO button, - - - L/
100 km (- - - mpg) will be displayed for
about 1 minute before the fuel economy is
recalculated and displayed.
Current fuel economy mode
This mode displays the current fuel
economy by calculating the amount of
fuel consumption and the distance
traveled.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page147
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (148,1)
Current fuel economy will be calculated
and displayed every 2 seconds.
Type A
Type B
When you've slowed to about 5 km/h (3
mph), - - - L/100 km (- - - mpg) will be
displayed.
Average vehicle speed mode
This mode displays the average vehicle
speed by calculating the distance and the
time traveled since connecting the battery
or resetting the data.
Average vehicle speed will be calculated
and displayed every 10 seconds.
Type A
Type B
To clear the data being displayed, press
the INFO button for more than 1.5
seconds. After pressing the INFO button,
- - - km/h (- - - mph) will be displayed for
about 1 minute before the vehicle speed is
recalculated and displayed.
Settings (Type A instrument cluster)
The following settings can be changed
(Setting changes cannot be made while
driving because the settings are not
displayed.):
lReset Averages
lSmart City Brake Support (SCBS)
lBlind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
lMaintenance
lOptional Screen
lVolumes
lUnits
lLanguage
4-20
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page148
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (149,1)
lRestore Default
To change settings
1. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch and select Settings, and
then press the INFO button.
2. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to select the item you
want to change, and then press the
INFO button.
3. Press the up or down part of the
INFO switch to select the desired
setting, and then press the INFO
button.
Warning (Display Indication) (Type A
instrument cluster)
A message is displayed to notify the user
of the system operation status and
malfunctions or abnormalities.
Check the indicated message.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page149
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (150,1)
Warning/Indicator Lights
qType A
Warning/Indicator lights will appear in any of the highlighted areas
(Display example)
Displays as follows:
Master
warning
light
Indication in display and master warning light in instrument cluster are illuminated
at same time
This indicates a malfunction with the vehicle system. Check the message indicated in the
display and consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer. For details, refer to the explanations for
the warning/indicator lights, in the warning/indicator lights section, which match the
symbol in the upper part of the display. If a message is not indicated in the display, operate
the INFO switch to display the Warningscreen.
Multi-information display
A message such as the system operation status, a malfunction, or an abnormality is
indicated.
l(When a symbol and message are indicated in the display)
For details on the symbols indicated in the upper part of the screen, check the indication
and method for taking action list.
4-22
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page150
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (151,1)
l(When only a message is indicated in the display)
Follow the instructions indicated in the display.
If any of the content in the following illustrations is indicated, there may be a problem with
the vehicle. The method for taking action differs depending on the indication.
Check the following illustrations below.
Action: Park the vehicle immediately, view the symbol indicated in the upper part of
the screen and then refer to the Indication and method for taking action list
containing the symbol to see what action should be taken.
Indication on display
Action: Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have your vehicle inspected. View the
symbol indicated in the upper part of the screen and refer to the Indication and
method for taking action listcontaining the symbol to see what action should be
taken.
Indication on display
Action: Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have your vehicle inspected.
Indication on display
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page151
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (152,1)
Indication and method for taking action list
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
Master Warning Light 4-28
Brake System Warning Light 4-28
ABS Warning Light 4-29
Charging System Warning Indication 4-30
Engine Oil Warning Indication 4-30
Check Engine Light 4-31
High Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light (Red) 4-31
AWD Warning Indication 4-32
BSM OFF Indicator Light 4-43
Automatic Transaxle Warning Indication 4-32
Power Steering Malfunction Indication 4-33
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light 4-33
Low Fuel Warning Light 4-34
Check Fuel Cap Warning Indication 4-34
Seat Belt Warning Light 4-34
4-24
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page152
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (153,1)
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
Door-Ajar Warning Indication 4-35
Liftgate-Ajar Warning Indication 4-36
Low Washer Fluid Level Warning Indication 4-36
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light 4-36
KEY Warning Indication 4-38
Wrench Indication 4-40
TCS/DSC Indicator Light 4-40
TCS OFF Indicator Light 4-40
AFS OFF Indicator Light 4-40
Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) OFF Indicator Light 4-41
Low Engine Coolant Temperature Indicator Light (Blue) 4-41
Shift Position Indication 4-41
Headlight High-Beam Indicator Light 4-42
Turn Signal/Hazard Warning Indicator Lights 4-42
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page153
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (154,1)
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
Security Indicator Light 4-42
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green) 4-42
Lights-On Indicator Light 4-43
qType B
Warning/Indicator lights will appear in any of the highlighted areas
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
Master Warning Light 4-28
Brake System Warning Light 4-28
ABS Warning Light 4-29
Charging System Warning Light 4-30
Engine Oil Warning Light 4-30
Check Engine Light 4-31
High Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light (Red) 4-31
4-26
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page154
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (155,1)
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
AWD Warning Light 4-32
BSM OFF Indicator Light 4-43
Automatic Transaxle Warning Light 4-32
Power Steering Malfunction Indicator Light 4-33
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt Pretensioner System Warning Light 4-33
Low Fuel Warning Light 4-34
Check Fuel Cap Warning Light 4-34
Seat Belt Warning Light 4-34
Door-Ajar Warning Light 4-35
Low Washer Fluid Level Warning Light 4-36
Tire Pressure Monitoring System Warning Light 4-36
KEY Warning Light 4-38
TCS/DSC Indicator Light 4-40
TCS OFF Indicator Light 4-40
AFS OFF Indicator Light 4-40
Low Engine Coolant Temperature Indicator Light (Blue) 4-41
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page155
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (156,1)
Signal Warning/Indicator Lights Page
Shift Position Indication 4-41
Headlight High-Beam Indicator Light 4-42
Turn Signal/Hazard Warning Indicator Lights 4-42
Security Indicator Light 4-42
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green) 4-42
Lights-On Indicator Light 4-43
qMaster Warning Light
This warning light stays on for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
Type A
Displays when notification of the system
malfunctions is required.
Check the message indicated in the
display and consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Type B
The light illuminates continuously if any
one of the following occurs. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lThere is a malfunction in the battery
management system.
lThere is a malfunction in the brake
switch.
qBrake System Warning Light
This warning has the following functions:
Parking brake warning/Warning light
inspection
The light illuminates when the parking
brake is applied with the ignition switched
to START or ON. It turns off when the
parking brake is fully released.
4-28
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page156
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (157,1)
Low brake fluid level warning
If the brake warning light remains
illuminated even though the parking brake
is released, the brake fluid may be low or
there could be a problem with the brake
system. Park the vehicle in a safe place
immediately and contact an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
WARNING
Do not drive with the brake system
warning light illuminated. Contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the
brakes inspected as soon as possible:
Driving with the brake system
warning light illuminated is
dangerous. It indicates that your
brakes may not work at all or that
they could completely fail at any
time. If this light remains
illuminated, after checking that the
parking brake is fully released, have
the brakes inspected immediately.
CAUTION
In addition, the effectiveness of the
braking may diminish so you may
need to depress the brake pedal more
strongly than normal to stop the
vehicle.
qABS Warning Light
The warning light stays on for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
If the ABS warning light stays on while
you're driving, the ABS control unit has
detected a system malfunction. If this
occurs, your brakes will function normally
as if the vehicle had no ABS.
Should this happen, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
NOTE
When the engine is jump-started to charge the
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS
warning light may illuminate. If this occurs, it
is the result of the weak battery and does not
indicate an ABS malfunction.
Recharge the battery.
qElectronic Brake Force
Distribution System Warning
If the electronic brake force distribution
control unit determines that some
components are operating incorrectly, the
control unit may illuminate the brake
system warning light and the ABS
warning light simultaneously. The
problem is likely to be the electronic
brake force distribution system.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page157
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (158,1)
WARNING
Do not drive with both the ABS warning
light and brake warning light
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have
the brakes inspected as soon as
possible:
Driving when the brake system
warning light and ABS warning light
are illuminated simultaneously is
dangerous.
When both lights are illuminated, the
rear wheels could lock more quickly
in an emergency stop than under
normal circumstances.
qCharging System Warning
Indication/Warning Light
Type B
This warning light illuminates when the
ignition is switched ON and turns off
when the engine is started.
Type A/Type B
If the warning light/indication illuminates
while driving, it indicates a malfunction
of the alternator or of the charging system.
Drive to the side of the road and park off
the right-of-way. Consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
CAUTION
Do not continue driving when the
charging system warning light is
illuminated because the engine could
stop unexpectedly.
qEngine Oil Warning Indication/
Warning Light
Type B
This warning light illuminates when the
ignition is switched ON and turns off
when the engine is started.
Type A/Type B
This warning light/warning indication
indicates low engine oil pressure.
CAUTION
Do not run the engine if the oil
pressure is low. Otherwise, it could
result in extensive engine damage.
If the light illuminates or the warning
indication is displayed while driving:
1. Drive to the side of the road and park
off the right-of-way on level ground.
2. Turn off the engine and wait 5 minutes
for the oil to drain back into the oil
pan.
3. Inspect the engine oil level (page 6-22).
If it's low, add the appropriate amount
of engine oil while being careful not to
overfill.
4-30
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page158
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (159,1)
CAUTION
Do not run the engine if the oil level
is low. Otherwise, it could result in
extensive engine damage.
4. Start the engine and check the warning
light/warning indication.
If the light/indication remains illuminated
even though the oil level is normal or after
adding oil, stop the engine immediately
and have your vehicle towed to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qCheck Engine Light
This indicator light illuminates when the
ignition is switched ON and turns off
when the engine is started.
If this light illuminates while driving, the
vehicle may have a problem. It is
important to note the driving conditions
when the light illuminated and consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
The check engine light may illuminate in
the following cases:
lThe fuel tank level being very low or
approaching empty.
lThe engine's electrical system has a
problem.
lThe emission control system has a
problem.
l(U.S.A. and Canada)
The fuel-filler cap is missing or not
tightened securely.
If the check engine light remains on, do
not drive at high speeds and consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
q
High Engine Coolant Temperature
Warning Light (Red)
When the ignition is switched ON, the
light illuminates momentarily and then
turns off.
The light flashes when the engine coolant
temperature is extremely high, and
illuminates when the engine coolant
temperature increases further.
Handling Procedure
Flashing light
Drive slowly to reduce engine load until
you can find a safe place to stop the
vehicle and wait for the engine to cool
down.
Illuminated light
This indicates the possibility of
overheating. Park the vehicle in a safe
place immediately and stop the engine.
Refer to Overheating (page 7-18).
CAUTION
Do not drive the vehicle with the high
engine coolant temperature warning
light illuminated. Otherwise, it could
result in damage to the engine.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page159
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (160,1)
qAWD Warning Indication/
Warning Light
í
Type A
The warning indication will display under
the following conditions;
lThere is an abnormality with the AWD
system.
lThere is too much difference in tire
radius between the front and rear
wheels.
lThe differential oil temperature is
abnormally high.
lThere is a continuous large difference
between front and rear wheel rotation,
such as when trying to pull away from
an icy surface or when trying to
remove the vehicle from mud, sand or
similar conditions.
When 4WD system inspection
requiredis indicated
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
When Stop vehicle at safe areais
indicated
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a
few moments, if the indication disappears,
you can resume driving. If the indication
does not disappear, contact an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
Type B
The warning light will illuminate or flash
under the following conditions:
lIlluminates when there is an
abnormality with the AWD system.
lIlluminates if there is too much
difference in tire radius between the
front and rear wheels.
lFlashes when the differential oil
temperature is abnormally high.
lFlashes when there is a continuous
large difference between front and rear
wheel rotation, such as when trying to
pull away from an icy surface or when
trying to remove the vehicle from mud,
sand or similar conditions.
When illuminated
If the AWD warning light illuminates,
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
When flashing
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a
few moments, if the warning light stops
flashing, you can resume driving. If the
light does not stop flashing, contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qAutomatic Transaxle Warning
Indication/Warning Light
Type B
This warning light stays on for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
Type A/Type B
The light/indication illuminates when the
transaxle has a problem.
4-32
When Driving
í
Some models.
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page160
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (161,1)
CAUTION
If the automatic transaxle warning
light/warning indication illuminates,
the transaxle has an electrical
problem. Continuing to drive your
Mazda in this condition could cause
damage to your transaxle. Consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon
as possible.
q
Power Steering Malfunction
Warning Indication/Indicator Light
Type B
This indicator light illuminates when the
ignition is switched ON, and turns off
when the engine is started.
Type A/Type B
The power steering malfunction indicator
light/warning indication illuminates or
flashes if there is a malfunction with the
power steering while the engine is
running.
If the indicator light/warning indication
illuminates or flashes, park the vehicle in
a safe place immediately and stop the
engine.
If the indicator light/warning indication
does not turn off even if the engine is
restarted afterwards, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lIf the indicator light/warning indication
illuminates or flashes, the power steering
will not operate normally. If this happens,
the steering wheel can still be operated,
however, the operation may feel heavy
compared to normal, and the steering
wheel could vibrate when turning.
lRepeatedly jerking the steering wheel left
and right while the vehicle is stopped or
moving extremely slowly will cause the
power steering system to go into protective
mode which will make the steering feel
heavy, but this does not indicate a problem.
If this occurs, park the vehicle safely and
wait several minutes for the system to
return to normal.
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt
Pretensioner System Warning Light
If the air bag/front seat belt pretensioner
system is working properly, the warning
light illuminates when the ignition is
switched ON or after the engine is
cranked. The warning light turns off after
a specified period of time.
A system malfunction is indicated if the
warning light constantly flashes,
constantly illuminates or does not
illuminate at all when the ignition is
switched ON. If any of these occur,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as
soon as possible. The system may not
operate in an accident.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page161
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (162,1)
WARNING
Never tamper with the air bag/
pretensioner systems and always have
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform
all servicing and repairs:
Self-servicing or tampering with the
systems is dangerous. An air bag/
pretensioner could accidentally
activate or become disabled causing
serious injury or death.
qLow Fuel Warning Light
This warning light signals that the fuel
tank will soon be empty.
Refuel as soon as possible.
qCheck Fuel Cap Warning
Indication/Indicator Light
í
Type B
This warning light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
Type A/Type B
If the check fuel cap warning light
illuminates/indication while driving, the
fuel-filler cap may not be installed
properly. Stop the engine and reinstall the
fuel-filler cap.
Refer to Fuel-Filler Cap on page 3-24.
qSeat Belt Warning Light
Driver's seat
Front passenger's seat
í
With warning light for front
passenger's seat
The seat belt warning light illuminates if
the driver or front passenger's seat is
occupied and the seat belt is not fastened
with the ignition switched ON.
4-34
When Driving
í
Some models.
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page162
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (163,1)
Without warning light for front
passenger's seat
The seat belt warning light illuminates if
the driver's seat is occupied and the seat
belt is not fastened with the ignition
switched ON.
Seat belt reminder
NOTE
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer to
deactivate or restore the belt reminder. Though
the belt reminder can be deactivated, doing so
will defeat the purpose of the system to warn
the driver and the front passenger in the event
that their seat belts are not fastened. For the
safety of the driver and front passenger, Mazda
recommends not deactivating the belt
reminder.
Front seat
If the vehicle is driven with the driver or
front passenger's seat belt unfastened, the
seat belt warning light illuminates and a
warning beep sounds.
NOTE
Some models do not have the seat belt
reminder function for the front passenger's
seat.
If the driver or front passenger's seat belt
is unfastened (only when the front
passenger seat is occupied) and the
vehicle is driven at a speed faster than
about 20 km/h (12 mph), the warning
light will flash and a beep sound will be
heard. After a short time, the warning
light stops flashing, but remains
illuminated, and the beep sound stops.
Until a seat belt is fastened or a given
period of time has elapsed, the beep sound
will not stop even if the vehicle speed
falls below 20 km/h (12 mph).
NOTE
lThe warning light flashes and a beep sound
will be heard for about 6 seconds if the
driver's seat belt is not fastened when the
ignition is switched ON.
lIf a driver or front passenger's seat belt is
unfastened after the beep sound turns off
(warning light remains illuminated), and
the vehicle speed exceeds 20 km/h (12
mph), the warning light flashes and beep
sound activates again.
lPlacing heavy items on the front passenger
seat may cause the front passenger seat belt
warning function to operate depending on
the weight of the item.
lTo allow the front passenger seat weight
sensor to function properly, do not place
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the
front passenger seat. The sensor may not
function properly because the additional
seat cushion could cause sensor
interference.
lWhen a small child sits on the front
passenger seat, it is possible that the
warning light will not operate.
qDoor-Ajar Warning Indication/
Warning Light
Type A
Type B
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page163
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (164,1)
Type A
This warning indication illuminates when
any door is not securely closed.
Close the door securely before driving the
vehicle.
Type B
This warning light illuminates when any
door or the liftgate is not securely closed.
Close the door or the liftgate securely
before driving the vehicle.
qLiftgate-Ajar Warning Indication
(Type A instrument cluster)
í
This warning indication is illuminated
when the liftgate is not securely closed.
Close the liftgate securely before driving
the vehicle.
q
Low Washer Fluid Level Warning
Indication/Warning Light
í
This warning light indicates that little
washer fluid remains. Add fluid (page
6-25).
qTire Pressure Monitoring System
Warning Light
This warning light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
The warning light illuminates and a beep
is heard when tire pressure is too low in
one or more tires, and flashes when there
is a system malfunction.
4-36
When Driving
í
Some models.
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page164
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (165,1)
WARNING
If the tire pressure monitoring system
warning light illuminates or flashes, or
the tire pressure warning beep sound is
heard, decrease vehicle speed
immediately and avoid sudden
maneuvering and braking:
If the tire pressure monitoring system
warning light illuminates or flashes,
or the tire pressure warning beep
sound is heard, it is dangerous to
drive the vehicle at high speeds, or
perform sudden maneuvering or
braking. Vehicle drivability could
worsen and result in an accident.
To determine if you have a slow leak
or a flat, pull over to a safe position
where you can check the visual
condition of the tire and determine if
you have enough air to proceed to a
place where air may be added and
the system monitored again by an
Authorized Mazda Dealer or a tire
repair station.
Do not ignore the TPMS Warning Light:
Ignoring the TPMS warning light is
dangerous, even if you know why it is
illuminated. Have the problem taken
care of as soon as possible before it
develops into a more serious
situation that could lead to tire
failure and a dangerous accident.
Warning light illuminates/Warning
beep sounds
When the warning light illuminates, and
the warning beep sound is heard (about 3
seconds), tire pressure is too low in one or
more tires.
Adjust the tire pressure to the correct tire
pressure and initialize TPMS. Refer to the
specification charts (page 9-8).
NOTE
lPerform tire pressure adjustment when the
tires are cold. Tire pressure will vary
according to the tire temperature, therefore
let the vehicle stand for 1 hour or only drive
it 1.6 km (1 mile) or less before adjusting
the tire pressures. When pressure is
adjusted on hot tires to the cold inflation
pressure, the TPMS warning light/beep may
turn on after the tires cool and pressure
drops below specification.
Also, an illuminated TPMS warning light,
resulting from the tire air pressure dropping
due to cold ambient temperature will
remain illuminated even if the ambient
temperature rises. In this case, it will also
be necessary to adjust the tire air pressures.
If the TPMS warning light illuminates due
to a drop in tire air pressure, make sure to
check and adjust the tire air pressures.
lTires lose air naturally over time and the
TPMS cannot tell if the tires are getting too
soft over time or you have a flat. However,
when you find one low tire in a set of four-
that is an indication of trouble; you should
have someone drive the vehicle slowly
forward so you can inspect any low tire for
cuts and any metal objects sticking through
tread or sidewall. Put a few drops of water
in the valve stem to see if it bubbles
indicating a bad valve. Leaks need to be
addressed by more than simply reinflating
the tire as leaks are dangerous - take it to
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
If the warning light illuminates again even
after the tire pressures are adjusted and the
TPMS initialization is performed, there
may be a tire puncture. Replace the
punctured tire with the temporary spare
tire (page 7-7).
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-37
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page165
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (166,1)
Warning light flashes
If the tire pressure monitoring system has
a malfunction, the tire pressure warning
light flashes for about 1 minute when the
ignition is switched ON and then
continues illuminating. Have your vehicle
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer
as soon as possible.
qKEY Warning Light (Red)/KEY
Indicator Light (Green)
Type A
Keyless System Inspection Required
is displayed
This message is displayed if the advanced
keyless entry & push button start system
has a problem.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
CAUTION
If the above message is indicated, or
the push button start indicator light
(amber) flashes, the engine may not
start. If the engine cannot be started,
try starting it using the emergency
operation for starting the engine, and
have the vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
Refer to Emergency Operation for
Starting the Engine on page 4-8.
Set Power to OFFis displayed
This message is displayed when the
driver's door is opened without switching
the ignition off.
Key not foundis displayed
This message is displayed when any of
the following operations is performed
with the key out of the operational range
or placed in areas inside the cabin where it
is difficult for the key to be detected.
lThe push button start is pressed with
the ignition switched off
lThe ignition is switched on
lThe driver's door is opened or all doors
are closed without switching the
ignition off
Depress the Brake Pedal and Touch
the Key to the Start Button
(Automatic Transaxle vehicle)/Depress
the Clutch Pedal and Touch the Key to
the Start Button(Manual Transaxle
vehicle) is displayed
This message is displayed when any of
the following operations is performed
with the key out of the operational range
or placed in areas inside the cabin where it
is difficult for the key to be detected.
lThe push button start is pressed with
the ignition switched off
lBrake pedal (Automatic transaxle
vehicle)/Clutch pedal (Manual
transaxle vehicle) is depressed with the
ignition switched off
Key Battery is lowis displayed
This message is displayed when the
remaining battery power of the key is low
and the ignition is switched from on to
off.
4-38
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page166
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (167,1)
NOTE
Because the key utilizes low-intensity radio
waves, the Key Removed From Vehicle
Warning may activate if the key is carried
together with a metal object or it is placed in a
poor signal reception area.
Type B
This indicator has two colors.
KEY Warning Light (Red)
When illuminated
If any malfunction occurs in the keyless
entry system, it illuminates continuously.
CAUTION
If the key warning indicator light
illuminates or the push button start
indicator light (amber) flashes, the
engine may not start. If the engine
cannot be started, try starting it
using the emergency operation for
starting the engine, and have the
vehicle inspected at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
Refer to Emergency Operation for
Starting the Engine on page 4-8.
When flashing
lUnder the following conditions, the
KEY warning light (red) flashes to
notify the driver that the ignition
cannot be switched from off.
lThe key battery is dead.
lThe key is not within operational
range.
lThe key is placed in areas where it is
difficult for the system to detect the
signal (page 3-6).
lA key from another manufacturer
similar to the key is in the
operational range.
lUnder the following conditions, the
KEY warning light (red) will flash
continuously when the ignition has not
been switched off to notify the driver
that the key has been removed from the
vehicle. The KEY warning light (red)
will stop flashing when the key is back
inside the vehicle:
The ignition has not been switched off
and all the doors and the liftgate are
closed after removing the key from the
vehicle.
NOTE
Because the key utilizes low-intensity radio
waves, the Key Removed From Vehicle
Warning may activate if the key is carried
together with a metal object or it is placed in a
poor signal reception area.
KEY Indicator Light (Green)
When illuminated
When the brake pedal is depressed with
an automatic transaxle or the clutch pedal
is depressed with a manual transaxle, the
system confirms that the correct key is
inside the vehicle, the KEY indicator light
(green) illuminates, and the engine can be
started (page 4-3).
When flashing
When the ignition is switched from ON to
off, the KEY indicator light (green)
flashes for approximately 30 seconds
indicating that the remaining battery
power is low. Replace with a new battery
before the key becomes unusable.
Refer to Replace Electrical Battery on
page 6-33.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page167
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (168,1)
qWrench Indication
í
Perform maintenance in accordance with
the message.
qTCS/DSC Indicator Light
This indicator light stays on for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON. If the TCS or DSC is operating, the
indicator light flashes.
If the light stays on, the TCS, DSC or the
brake assist system may have a
malfunction and they may not operate
correctly. Take your vehicle to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lIn addition to the indicator light flashing, a
slight lugging sound will come from the
engine. This indicates that the TCS/DSC is
operating properly.
lOn slippery surfaces, such as fresh snow, it
will be impossible to achieve high rpm
when the TCS is on.
qTCS OFF Indicator Light
This indicator light stays on for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
It also illuminates when the TCS OFF
switch is pressed and TCS is switched off.
Refer to TCS OFF Switch on page 4-84.
If the light remains illuminated and the
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The DSC
may have a malfunction.
qAFS OFF Indicator Light
í
When illuminated
This indicator light illuminates briefly
when the ignition is switched ON, and
then turns off.
Pressing the AFS OFF switch cancels the
AFS function and illuminates the
indicator light.
When flashing
The indicator light flashes continuously if
the system is malfunctioning. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
4-40
When Driving
í
Some models.
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page168
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (169,1)
NOTE
lEven if the AFS is not operating due to
some malfunction, the normal headlight
function is still operable.
lIf there is a malfunction with the headlight
auto-leveling function, the indicator light
flashes.
qSmart City Brake Support
(SCBS) OFF Indicator Light
í
This indicator light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
When the Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS) system is turned off, the Smart
City Brake Support (SCBS) OFF indicator
light turns on.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
NOTE
When the TCS OFF switch is pressed to stop
the TCS operation, the Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS) system operation also stops
and the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS)
OFF indicator light turns on.
q
Low Engine Coolant Temperature
Indicator Light (Blue)
The light illuminates continuously when
the engine coolant temperature is low and
turns off after the engine is warm.
If the low engine coolant temperature
indicator light remains illuminated after
the engine has been sufficiently warmed
up, the temperature sensor could have a
malfunction. Consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
qShift Position Indication
This indicates the selected shift position.
Gear position indicator
In manual shift mode, the Mof the shift
position indicator illuminates and the
numeral for the selected gear displays.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-41
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page169
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (170,1)
qHeadlight High-Beam Indicator
Light
This light indicates one of two things:
lThe high-beam headlights are on.
lThe turn signal lever is in the flash-to-
pass position.
qTurn Signal/Hazard Warning
Indicator Lights
When operating the turn signal lights, the
left or right turn signal indicator light
flashes to indicate which turn signal light
is operating (page 4-60).
When operating the hazard warning
lights, both turn signal indicator lights
flash (page 4-67).
If an indicator light remains illuminated
(does not flash) or if it flashes abnormally,
one of the turn signal bulbs may be
burned out. Consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
qSecurity Indicator Light
This indicator light starts flashing every
two seconds when the ignition is switched
from ON to OFF and the immobilizer
system is armed.
The light stops flashing when the ignition
is switched ON with the correct key.
At this time, the immobilizer system is
disarmed and the light illuminates for
about three seconds and then turns off.
If the engine does not start with the
correct key, and the security indicator
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the
system may have a malfunction. Consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qCruise Main Indicator Light
(Amber)/Cruise Set Indicator
Light (Green)
The indicator light has two colors.
Cruise Main Indicator Light (Amber)
The indicator light illuminates amber
when the ON switch is pressed and the
cruise control system is activated.
4-42
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page170
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (171,1)
Cruise Set Indicator Light (Green)
The indicator light illuminates green when
a cruising speed has been set.
qBSM OFF Indicator Light
í
This indicator light illuminates for a few
seconds when the ignition is switched
ON.
The BSM OFF indicator light illuminates
when the BSM system is turned off by
pressing the BSM OFF switch.
The indicator light flashes if the BSM
system has a malfunction. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
If the vehicle is driven on a road with less
traffic and few vehicles that the radar sensors
can detect, the system may pause (The BSM
OFF indicator light in the instrument panel
flashes). However, it does not indicate a
malfunction.
qLights-On Indicator Light
This indicator light illuminates when the
exterior lights and dashboard illumination
are on.
The light continues to flash if the lighting
system has a malfunction. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
When Driving
Instrument Cluster and Display
4-43
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page171
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (172,1)
Manual Transaxle Operation
qManual Transaxle Shift Pattern
Neutral position
The shift pattern of the transaxle is
conventional, as shown.
Depress the clutch pedal all the way down
while shifting; then release it slowly.
Your vehicle is equipped with a device to
prevent shifting to R (reverse) by mistake.
Push the shift lever downward and shift to
R.
WARNING
Do not use sudden engine braking on
slippery road surfaces or at high
speeds:
Shifting down while driving on wet,
snowy, or frozen roads, or while
driving at high speeds causes sudden
engine braking, which is dangerous.
The sudden change in tire speed
could cause the tires to skid. This
could lead to loss of vehicle control
and an accident.
Be sure to leave the shift lever in 1 or R
position and set the parking brake
when leaving the vehicle unattended:
Otherwise the vehicle could move
and cause an accident.
CAUTION
ØKeep your foot off the clutch pedal
except when shifting gears. Also,
do not use the clutch to hold the
vehicle on an upgrade. Riding the
clutch will cause needless clutch
wear and damage.
ØDo not apply any excessive lateral
force to the shift lever when
changing from 5th to 4th gear.
This could lead to the accidental
selection of 2nd gear, which can
result in damage to the transaxle.
ØMake sure the vehicle comes to a
complete stop before shifting to R.
Shifting to R while the vehicle is
still moving may damage the
transaxle.
NOTE
If shifting to R is difficult, shift back into
neutral, release the clutch pedal, and try
again.
4-44
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page172
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (173,1)
qRecommendations for Shifting
Upshifting
For normal acceleration, we recommend
these shift points.
Gear Vehicle speed
1 to 2 24 km/h (15 mph)
2 to 3 42 km/h (26 mph)
3 to 4 60 km/h (37 mph)
4 to 5 75 km/h (46 mph)
5 to 6 79 km/h (49 mph)
For cruising
Gear Vehicle speed
1 to 2 13 km/h (8 mph)
2 to 3 29 km/h (18 mph)
3 to 4 49 km/h (30 mph)
4 to 5 63 km/h (39 mph)
5 to 6 70 km/h (43 mph)
Downshifting
When you must slow down in heavy
traffic or on a steep upgrade, downshift
before the engine starts to overwork. This
reduces the chance of stalling and gives
better acceleration when you need more
speed.
On a steep downgrade, downshifting
helps maintain safe speed and prolongs
brake life.
When Driving
Transaxle
4-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page173
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (174,1)
Automatic Transaxle Controls
Indicates the selector lever can be shifted freely into any position.
Indicates that you must hold in the lock-release button to shift.
Indicates that you must depress the brake pedal and hold in the lock-release
button to shift (The ignition must be switched ON).
Various Lockouts:
Lock-release button
NOTE
The Sport AT has an option that is not included in the traditional automatic transaxle giving the
driver the option of selecting each gear instead of leaving it to the transaxle to shift gears. Even if
you intend to use the automatic transaxle functions as a traditional automatic, you should also be
aware that you can inadvertently shift into manual shift mode and an inappropriate gear may be
retained as the vehicle speed increases. If you notice the engine speed going higher or hear the
engine racing, confirm you have not accidentally slipped into manual shift mode (page 4-49).
4-46
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page174
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (175,1)
qWarning Light
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
qTransaxle Ranges
lThe shift position indicator light in the
instrument cluster illuminates.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
lThe shift lever must be in P or N to
operate the starter.
P (Park)
P locks the transaxle and prevents the
front wheels from rotating.
WARNING
Always set the shift lever to P and set
the parking brake:
Only setting the shift lever to the P
position without using the parking
brake to hold the vehicle is
dangerous. If P fails to hold, the
vehicle could move and cause an
accident.
CAUTION
ØShifting into P, N or R while the
vehicle is moving can damage
your transaxle.
ØShifting into a driving gear or
reverse when the engine is running
faster than idle can damage the
transaxle.
R (Reverse)
In position R, the vehicle moves only
backward. You must be at a complete stop
before shifting to or from R, except under
rare circumstances as explained in
Rocking the Vehicle (page 3-41).
N (Neutral)
In N, the wheels and transaxle are not
locked. The vehicle will roll freely even
on the slightest incline unless the parking
brake or brakes are on.
WARNING
If the engine is running faster than idle,
do not shift from N or P into a driving
gear:
It's dangerous to shift from N or P
into a driving gear when the engine
is running faster than idle. If this is
done, the vehicle could move
suddenly, causing an accident or
serious injury.
Do not shift into N when driving the
vehicle:
Shifting into N while driving is
dangerous. Engine braking cannot be
applied when decelerating which
could lead to an accident or serious
injury.
CAUTION
Do not shift into N when driving the
vehicle. Doing so can cause transaxle
damage.
NOTE
Apply the parking brake or depress the brake
pedal before moving the shift lever from N to
prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.
When Driving
Transaxle
4-47
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page175
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (176,1)
D (Drive)
D is the normal driving position. From a
stop, the transaxle will automatically shift
through a 6-gear sequence.
M (Manual)
M is the manual shift mode position.
Gears can be shifted up or down by
operating the shift lever.
Refer to Manual Shift Mode on page
4-49.
qActive Adaptive Shift (AAS)
Active Adaptive Shift (AAS)
automatically controls the transaxle shift
points to best suit the road conditions and
driver input. This improves driving feel.
The transaxle may switch to AAS mode
when driving up and down slopes,
cornering, or depressing the accelerator
pedal quickly while the shift lever is in the
D position.
Depending on the driving conditions and
vehicle operations, the transaxle may not
shift gears, however, this does not indicate
a problem because the AAS mode will
maintain the optimum gear position.
qShift-Lock System
The shift-lock system prevents shifting
out of P unless the brake pedal is
depressed.
To shift from P:
1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.
2. Start the engine.
3. Press and hold the lock-release button.
4. Move the selector lever.
NOTE
lWhen the ignition is switched to ACC or the
ignition is switched off, the selector lever
cannot be shifted from P.
lThe ignition cannot be switched to OFF if
the selector lever is not in P.
qShift-Lock Override
If the selector lever will not move from P
using the proper shift procedure, continue
to hold down the pedal.
1. Remove the shift-lock override cover
using a cloth-wrapped flat head
screwdriver.
2. Insert a screwdriver and push it down.
Cover
3. Press and hold the lock-release button.
4. Move the selector lever.
5. Take the vehicle to an Authorized
Mazda Dealer to have the system
checked.
4-48
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page176
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (177,1)
qManual Shift Mode
This mode gives you the feel of driving a
manual transaxle vehicle by operating the
selector lever and allows you to control
engine rpm and torque to the drive wheels
much like a manual transaxle when more
control is desired.
To change to manual shift mode, shift the
lever from D to M.
NOTE
Changing to manual shift mode while driving
will not damage the transaxle.
To return to automatic shift mode, shift
the lever from M to D.
NOTE
lIf you change to manual shift mode when
the vehicle is stopped, the gear will shift to
M1.
lIf you change to manual shift mode without
depressing the accelerator pedal when
driving in D range, 5th gear/6th gear, the
gear will shift to M4/M5.
Indicators
Manual shift mode indicator
In manual shift mode, the Mof the shift
position indicator in the instrument panel
illuminates.
Gear position indicator
The numeral for the selected gear
illuminates.
Manual shift mode indicator
Gear position indicator
NOTE
lIf the gears cannot be shifted down when
driving at higher speeds, the gear position
indicator will flash twice to signal that the
gears cannot be shifted down (to protect the
transaxle).
lIf the automatic transaxle fluid (ATF)
temperature becomes too high, there is the
possibility that the transaxle will switch to
automatic shift mode, canceling manual
shift mode and turning off the gear position
indicator illumination. This is a normal
function to protect the AT. After the ATF
temperature has decreased, the gear
position indicator illumination turns back
on and driving in manual shift mode is
restored.
When Driving
Transaxle
4-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page177
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (178,1)
Shifting
Manually Shifting up
(M1 M2 M3 M4 M5 M6)
To shift up to a higher gear, move the
selector lever back ( ) once.
NOTE
lWhen driving slowly, the gears may not
shift up.
lIn manual shift mode, do not run the engine
with the tachometer needle in the RED
ZONE. When the engine rpm is high, a gear
may shift up automatically to protect the
engine.
lWhen depressing the accelerator fully, the
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,
depending on vehicle speed (Except M2
M1).
Manually Shifting down
(M6 M5 M4 M3 M2 M1)
To shift down to a lower gear, move the
selector lever forward ( ) once.
WARNING
Do not use engine braking on slippery
road surfaces or at high speeds:
Shifting down while driving on wet,
snowy, or frozen roads, or while
driving at high speeds causes sudden
engine braking, which is dangerous.
The sudden change in tire speed
could cause the tires to skid. This
could lead to loss of vehicle control
and an accident.
NOTE
lWhen driving at high speeds, the gear may
not shift down.
lDuring deceleration, the gear may
automatically shift down depending on
vehicle speed.
lWhen depressing the accelerator fully, the
transaxle will shift to a lower gear,
depending on vehicle speed (Except M2
M1).
4-50
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page178
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (179,1)
Second gear fixed mode
When the selector lever is moved back
() while the vehicle speed is about 10
km/h (6 mph) or less, the transaxle is set
in the second gear fixed mode. The gear is
fixed in second while in this mode for
easier acceleration from a stop and driving
on slippery roads such as snow-covered
roads.
If the selector lever is moved back ( )or
forward ( ) while in the second gear
fixed mode, the mode will be canceled.
When Driving
Transaxle
4-51
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page179
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (180,1)
Shift gear (shifting) speed limit
For each gear position while in the manual mode, the speed limit is set as follows: When
the selector lever is operated within the range of the speed limit, the gear is shifted.
Shift up
The gear does not shift up while the vehicle speed is lower than the speed limit.
Shift down
The gear does not shift down while the vehicle speed exceeds the speed limit.
If the vehicle speed exceeds the speed limit and the gear does not shift down, the gear
position indication flashes 2 times to notify the driver that the gear cannot be shifted.
Kickdown
When the accelerator pedal is depressed fully while driving, the gear shifts down.
NOTE
The gear also shifts down using kickdown while in the second gear fixed mode.
Auto-shift down
The gear shifts down automatically depending on the vehicle speed during deceleration.
NOTE
If the vehicle comes to a stop while in the second gear fixed mode, the gear remains in second.
4-52
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page180
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (181,1)
Recommendations for shifting (U.S.A. and Canada)
Upshifting
For normal acceleration and cruising, we recommend these shift points.
Gear Vehicle speed
*1
M1 to M2 24 km/h (15 mph)
M2 to M3 40 km/h (25 mph)
M3 to M4 65 km/h (40 mph)
M4 to M5 73 km/h (45 mph)
M5 to M6 81 km/h (50 mph)
*1
: Always observe local speed limit regulations.
Downshifting
When you must slow down in heavy traffic or on a steep upgrade, downshift before the
engine starts to overwork. This gives better acceleration when you need more speed.
On a steep downgrade, downshifting helps maintain safe speed and prolongs brake life.
qDriving Tips
WARNING
Do not allow the vehicle to move in
reverse on an up-slope while the
selector lever is in a forward gear
position, or move forward on a down-
slope while the selector lever is in the
reverse position:
Otherwise, the engine will stop,
causing the loss of the power brake
and power steering functions, and
make it difficult to control the vehicle
which could result in an accident.
Passing
For extra power when passing another
vehicle or climbing steep grades, depress
the accelerator fully. The transaxle will
shift to a lower gear, depending on vehicle
speed.
NOTE
The accelerator pedal feels heavy as it is being
depressed, but then lightens as it is fully
depressed. This change in pedal force aids the
engine control system in determining how
much the accelerator pedal has been
depressed for performing kickdown, and
functions to control whether or not kickdown
should be performed.
Climbing steep grades from a stop
To climb a steep grade from a stopped
position:
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Shift to D or M1, depending on the
load weight and grade steepness.
3. Release the brake pedal while
gradually accelerating.
When Driving
Transaxle
4-53
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page181
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (182,1)
Descending steep grades
When descending a steep grade, shift to
lower gears, depending on load weight
and grade steepness. Descend slowly,
using the brakes only occasionally to
prevent them from overheating.
4-54
When Driving
Transaxle
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page182
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (183,1)
Lighting Control
qHeadlights
lTurn the headlight switch to turn the headlights, other exterior lights and dashboard
illumination on or off.
lFor vehicles with the type A instrument cluster, check the vehicle condition or have the
vehicle inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer according to the indication.
lA system malfunction or operation conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page 4-22.
NOTE
lIf the light switch is left on, the lights will automatically switch off (if equipped) approximately 30
seconds after switching the ignition off.
The time setting can be changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page 9-10.
lTo prevent discharging the battery, do not leave the lights on while the engine is off unless safety
requires them.
Without auto-light control
Switch Position
Ignition Position ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Headlights Off Off Off Off On On
Daytime running lights On Off On Off Off Off
Taillights
Parking lights
License lights
Side-marker lights
Dashboard illumination
Off Off On On On On
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-55
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page183
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (184,1)
With auto-light control
Switch Position
Ignition Position ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF ON OFF
Headlights Off Off Auto
*
Off Off Off On On
Daytime running lights On Off Auto
*
Off On Off Off Off
Taillights
Parking lights
License lights
Side-marker lights
Dashboard illumination
Off Off Auto
*
OffOnOnOnOn
* The headlight and other light settings switch automatically depending on the surrounding brightness detected by
the sensor.
4-56
When Driving
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page184
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (185,1)
Auto-light control
When the headlight switch is in the position and the ignition is switched ON, the
light sensor senses the surrounding lightness or darkness and automatically turns the
headlights, other exterior lights and dashboard illumination on or off (see chart above).
CAUTION
ØDo not shade the light sensor by adhering a sticker or a label on the windshield.
Otherwise the light sensor will not operate correctly.
ØThe light sensor also works as a rain sensor for the auto-wiper control. Keep
hands and scrapers clear of the windshield when the wiper lever is in the
position and the ignition is switched ON as fingers could be pinched or the wipers
and wiper blades damaged when the wipers activate automatically. If you are
going to clean the windshield, be sure the wipers are turned off completely this
is particularly important when clearing ice and snow when it is particularly
tempting to leave the engine running.
NOTE
lThe headlights, other exterior lights and dashboard illumination may not turn off immediately
even if the surrounding area becomes well-lit because the light sensor determines that it is
nighttime if the surrounding area is continuously dark for several minutes such as inside long
tunnels, traffic jams inside tunnels, or in indoor parking lots.
In this case, the lights turn off if the light switch is turned to the position.
lWhen the headlight switch is in the position and the ignition is switched to ACC or the
ignition is switched off, the headlights, other exterior lights and dashboard illumination will turn
off.
lThe dashboard illumination can be adjusted by rotating the knob in the instrument cluster. Also,
the day/night mode can be changed by rotating the knob until a beep sound is heard. To adjust the
brightness of the dashboard illumination:
Refer to Dashboard Illumination on page 4-13.
lThe sensitivity of the AUTO lights may be changed by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Refer to Personalization Features on page 9-10.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-57
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page185
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (186,1)
Xenon fusion headlight bulbs
í
The low-beam bulbs of the headlights have xenon fusion bulbs that produce a bright white
beam over a wide area.
WARNING
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs yourself
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs yourself is dangerous. Because the xenon fusion
bulbs require high voltage, you could receive an electric shock if the bulbs are
handled incorrectly. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer when the replacement is
necessary.
NOTE
If the headlights flicker, or the brightness weakens, the bulb-life may be depleted and a replacement is
necessary. Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qHeadlight High-Low Beam
Press the lever forward to turn on the high
beams.
Pull the lever back to its original position
for the low beams.
The headlight high-beam indicator light in
the instrument cluster illuminates while
the high beams are turned on.
High beam
Low beam
qFlashing the Headlights
To flash the headlights, pull the lever fully
towards you (the headlight switch does
not need to be on). The headlight high-
beam indicator light in the instrument
cluster illuminates simultaneously. The
lever will return to the normal position
when released.
OFF
Flashing
4-58
When Driving
í
Some models.
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page186
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (187,1)
qHeadlight Leveling
í
The number of passengers and weight of
cargo in the luggage compartment change
the angle of the headlights.
The angle of the headlights will be
automatically adjusted when turning on
the headlights.
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
qAdaptive Front Lighting System
(AFS)
í
The adaptive front lighting system (AFS)
automatically adjusts the headlight beams
to the left or right in conjunction with the
operation of the steering wheel after the
headlights have been turned on and the
vehicle speed is about 2 km/h (2 mph) or
higher.
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
AFS OFF switch
Pressing the AFS OFF switch turns off the
AFS. The AFS OFF indicator light in the
instrument cluster illuminates.
Pressing the AFS OFF switch again turns
off the switch illumination and turns on
the AFS operation. The AFS OFF
indicator light turns off.
qDaytime Running Lights
Some countries require moving vehicles
to have their lights on (daytime running
lights) during the daytime.
Daytime running lights turn on
automatically when the ignition is
switched ON.
They turn off when the parking brake is
operated or the shift lever is shifted to the
P position (automatic transaxle vehicle).
NOTE
(Except Canada)
The daytime running lights can be deactivated.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-59
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page187
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (188,1)
Fog Lights
í
Use this switch to turn on the fog lights.
The fog lights will improve visibility at
night and during foggy conditions.
To turn the fog lights on, rotate the fog
light switch to the position.
The headlight switch must be in the
position before turning on the fog lights.
Fog light switch
To turn the fog lights off, rotate the fog
light switch to the position or turn
the headlight switch to the or
position.
NOTE
lThe fog lights will turn off when the
headlights are set at high beams.
l(With auto-light control)
If the fog light switch is in the position
and the headlight switch is in the
position, the fog lights will turn on when
the headlights, the exterior lights and
dashboard illumination turn on.
Turn and Lane-Change
Signals
NOTE
lIf an indicator light stays on without
flashing or if it flashes abnormally, one of
the turn signal bulbs may be burned out.
lA personalized function is available to
change the turn indicator sound volume.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
qTurn Signals
Move the signal lever down (for a left
turn) or up (for a right turn) to the stop
position. The signal will self-cancel after
the turn is completed.
If the indicator light continues to flash
after a turn, manually return the lever to
its original position.
Right turn
Left turn
Right lane change
Left lane change
OFF
Green indicators on the dashboard show
which signal is working.
4-60
When Driving
í
Some models.
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page188
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (189,1)
qLane-Change Signals
Move the lever halfway toward the
direction of the change until the
indicator flashesand hold it there. It
will return to the off position when
released.
qThree-Flash Turn Signal
To signal a lane change, operate the turn
signal lever up or down slightly and
release. After releasing the lever, the turn
signal indicator flashes three times.
NOTE
The three-flash turn signal function can be
switched to operable/inoperable using the
personalization function.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
Windshield Wipers and
Washer
The ignition must be switched ON.
WARNING
Use only windshield washer fluid or
plain water in the reservoir:
Using radiator antifreeze as washer
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the
windshield, it will dirty the
windshield, affect your visibility, and
could result in an accident.
Only use windshield washer fluid
mixed with anti-freeze protection in
freezing weather conditions:
Using windshield washer fluid
without anti-freeze protection in
freezing weather conditions is
dangerous as it could freeze on the
windshield and block your vision
which could cause an accident.
In addition, make sure the
windshield is sufficiently warmed
using the defroster before spraying
the washer fluid.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-61
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page189
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (190,1)
NOTE
Because heavy ice and snow can jam the wiper
blades, the wiper motor is protected from
motor breakdown, overheating and possible
fire by a circuit breaker. This mechanism will
automatically stop operation of the blades, but
only for about 5 minutes.
If this happens, turn off the wiper switch and
park off the right-of-way, and remove the snow
and ice.
After 5 minutes, turn on the switch and the
blades should operate normally. If they do not
resume functioning, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible. Drive to
the side of the road and park off the right-of-
way. Wait until the weather clears before trying
to drive with the wipers inoperative.
qWindshield Wipers
Turn the wipers on by pressing the lever
up or down.
With intermittent wiper
Switch
Position Wiper operation
MIST Single wipe cycle (mist)
INT Intermittent
LO Low speed
HI High speed
With auto-wiper control
Switch
Position Wiper operation
MIST Single wipe cycle (mist)
AUTO Auto control
LO Low speed
HI High speed
Variable-speed intermittent wipers
Set the lever to the intermittent position
and choose the interval timing by rotating
the ring.
INT ring Fast
Slow
4-62
When Driving
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page190
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (191,1)
Auto-wiper control
When the wiper lever is in the
position, the rain sensor senses the
amount of rainfall on the windshield and
turns the wipers on or off automatically
(offintermittentlow speedhigh
speed).
The sensitivity of the rain sensor can be
adjusted by turning the switch on the
wiper lever.
From the center position (normal), rotate
the switch downward for higher
sensitivity (faster response) or rotate it
upward for less sensitivity (slower
response).
Higher sensitivity
Less sensitivity
Switch
Center
position
CAUTION
ØDo not shade the rain sensor by
adhering a sticker or a label on
the windshield. Otherwise the rain
sensor will not operate correctly.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-63
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page191
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (192,1)
ØWhen the wiper lever is in the
AUTO position and the ignition is
switched ON, the wipers may
move automatically in the
following cases:
ØIf the windshield above the rain
sensor is touched or wiped with
a cloth.
ØIf the windshield is struck with
a hand or other object from
either outside or inside the
vehicle.
Keep hands and scrapers clear of
the windshield when the wiper
lever is in the AUTO position and
the ignition is switched ON as
fingers could be pinched or the
wipers and wiper blades damaged
when the wipers activate
automatically.
If you are going to clean the
windshield, be sure the wipers are
turned off completelythis is
particularly important when
clearing ice and snowwhen it is
most likely that the engine is left
running.
NOTE
lSwitching the auto-wiper lever from the
to the position while driving
activates the windshield wipers once, after
which they operate according to the rainfall
amount.
lThe auto-wiper control may not operate
when the rain sensor temperature is about
_10 °C (14 °F) or lower, or about 85 °C
(185 °F) or higher.
lIf the windshield is coated with water
repellent, the rain sensor may not be able to
sense the amount of rainfall correctly and
auto-wiper control may not operate
properly.
lIf dirt or foreign matter (Such as ice or
matter containing salt water) adheres to the
windshield above the rain sensor or if the
windshield is iced, it could cause the wipers
to move automatically. However, if the
wipers cannot remove this ice, dirt or
foreign matter, the auto-wiper control will
stop operation. In this case, set the wiper
lever to the low speed position or high
speed position for manual operation, or
remove the ice, dirt or foreign matter by
hand to restore the auto-wiper operation.
lIf the auto-wiper lever is left in the
position, the wipers could operate
automatically from the effect of strong light
sources, electromagnetic waves, or infrared
light because the rain sensor uses an
optical sensor. It is recommended that the
auto-wiper lever be switched to the
position other than when driving the vehicle
under rainy conditions.
lThe auto-wiper control functions can be
turned off.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
4-64
When Driving
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page192
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (193,1)
qWindshield Washer
Pull the lever toward you and hold it to
spray washer fluid.
Washer
OFF
NOTE
With the wiper lever in the or
intermittent position/ position, the
wipers will operate continuously until the lever
is released.
If the washer does not work, inspect the
fluid level (page 6-25). If it's normal,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Rear Window Wiper and
Washer
The ignition must be switched ON.
qRear Window Wiper
Turn the wiper on by turning the rear
wiper/washer switch.
Switch
Position Wiper operation
INT Intermittent
ON Normal
qRear Window Washer
To spray washer fluid, turn the rear wiper/
washer switch to the position. After
the switch is released, the washer will
stop.
If the washer does not work, inspect the
fluid level (page 6-25). If it's normal and
the washer still does not work, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-65
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page193
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (194,1)
Rear Window Defogger
The rear window defogger clears fog from
the rear window.
The ignition must be switched ON.
Press the switch to turn on the rear
window defogger. The rear window
defogger operates for about 15 minutes
and turns off automatically.
The indicator light illuminates during
operation.
To turn off the rear window defogger
before the 15 minutes has elapsed, press
the switch again.
Fully Automatic Type Climate Control
Indicator light
Manual Type Climate Control
Indicator light
CAUTION
Do not use sharp instruments or
window cleaners with abrasives to
clean the inside of the rear window
surface. They may damage the
defogger grid inside the window.
NOTE
This defogger is not designed for melting snow.
If there is an accumulation of snow on the rear
window, remove it before using the defogger.
qMirror Defogger
í
To turn on the mirror defoggers, switch
the ignition ON and press the rear window
defogger switch (page 4-66).
4-66
When Driving
í
Some models.
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page194
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (195,1)
Horn
To sound the horn, press the mark on
the steering wheel.
Hazard Warning Flasher
The hazard warning lights should always
be used when you stop on or near a
roadway in an emergency.
The hazard warning lights warn other
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard
and that they must take extreme caution
when near it.
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all
the turn signals will flash. The hazard
warning indicator lights in the instrument
cluster flash simultaneously.
NOTE
lThe turn signals do not work when the
hazard warning lights are on.
lCheck local regulations about the use of
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is
being towed to verify that it is not in
violation of the law.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-67
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page195
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (196,1)
HomeLink Wireless
Control System
í
NOTE
HomeLink and HomeLink house are registered
trademarks of Johnson Controls.
The HomeLink system replaces up to 3
hand-held transmitters with a single built-
in component in the auto-dimming mirror.
Pressing the HomeLink button on the
auto-dimming mirror activates garage
doors, gates and other devices
surrounding your home.
HomeLink button
Indicator light
WARNING
Do not use the HomeLink system with
any garage door opener that lacks the
safety stop and reverse feature:
Using the HomeLink system with any
garage door opener that lacks the
safety stop and reverse feature as
required by federal safety standards
is dangerous. (This includes garage
doors manufactured before April 1,
1982.)
Using these garage door openers can
increase the risk of serious injury or
death. For further information,
contact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515
or www.homelink.com or your
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Always check the areas surrounding
garage doors and gates for people or
obstructions before programming or
during operation of the HomeLink
system:
Programming or operating the
HomeLink system without verifying
the safety of areas surrounding
garage doors and gates is dangerous
and could result in an unexpected
accident and serious injury if
someone were to be hit.
NOTE
The programming will not be erased even if
the battery is disconnected.
qPre-programming the HomeLink
System
NOTE
It is recommended that a new battery be
placed in the hand-held transmitter of the
device being programmed to HomeLink for
quicker training and accurate transmission of
the radio-frequency signal.
4-68
When Driving
í
Some models.
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page196
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (197,1)
lVerify that there is a remote control
transmitter available for the device you
would like to program.
lDisconnect the power to the device.
q
Programming the HomeLink System
CAUTION
When programming a garage door
opener or a gate, disconnect the
power to these devices before
performing programming, as
continuous operation of the devices
could damage the motor.
The HomeLink system provides 3 buttons
which can be individually selected and
programmed using the transmitters for
current, on-market devices as follows:
1. Position the end of your hand-held
transmitter 2.57.5 cm (13 inches)
away from the HomeLink button you
wish to program while keeping the
indicator light in view.
2. Simultaneously press and hold both the
chosen HomeLink and hand-held
transmitter buttons. Do not release the
buttons until step 3 has been
completed.
NOTE
Some gate operators and garage door openers
may require you to replace this Programming
Step 2 with procedures noted in the Gate
Operator/Canadian Programmingsection.
3. After the HomeLink indicator light
changes from a slow to a rapidly
blinking light, release both the
HomeLink and hand-held transmitter
buttons.
NOTE
If the HomeLink indicator light does not
change to a rapidly blinking light, contact
HomeLink at www.homelink.com or call 1-
800-355-3515 for assistance.
4. Firmly press and hold the programmed
HomeLink button for five seconds, and
then release it. Perform this operation
two times to activate the door. If the
door does not activate, press and hold
the just-trained HomeLink button and
observe the indicator light.
If the indicator light stays on constantly,
programming is complete and your
device should activate when the
HomeLink button is pressed and released.
NOTE
To program the remaining two HomeLink
buttons, begin with Programmingstep 1.
If the indicator light blinks rapidly for
two seconds and then turns to a
constant light, continue with
Programmingsteps 57to complete
the programming of a rolling code
equipped device (most commonly a
garage door opener).
5. At the garage door opener receiver
(motor-head unit) in the garage, locate
the learnor smartbutton. This can
usually be found where the hanging
antenna wire is attached to the motor-
head unit.
6. Firmly press and release the learnor
smartbutton. (The name and color of
the button may vary by manufacturer.)
NOTE
Complete the programming within 30 seconds.
When Driving
Switches and Controls
4-69
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page197
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (198,1)
7. Return to the vehicle and firmly press,
hold for two seconds and release the
programmed HomeLink button. Repeat
the press/hold/releasesequence a
second time, and, depending on the
brand of the garage door opener (or
other rolling code equipped device),
repeat this sequence a third time to
complete the programming process.
HomeLink should now activate your
rolling code equipped device.
NOTE
To program the remaining two HomeLink
buttons, begin with Programmingstep 1.
For questions or comments, please contact
HomeLink at www.homelink.com or 1-
800-355-3515.
qGate operator/Canadian
Programming
Canadian radio-frequency laws require
transmitter signals to time-out(or quit)
after several seconds of transmission
which may not be long enough for
HomeLink to pick up the signal during
programming. Similar to this Canadian
law, some U.S. gate operators are
designed to time-outin the same
manner.
If you live in Canada or you are having
difficulties programming a gate operator
by using the Programmingprocedures
(regardless of where you live), replace
Programming HomeLinkstep 2 with
the following:
NOTE
If programming a garage door opener or gate
operator, it is advised to unplug the device
during the cyclingprocess to prevent
possible overheating.
Continue to press and hold the HomeLink
button while you press and release
every two seconds (cycle) your hand-
held transmitter until the frequency signal
has successfully been accepted by
HomeLink. (The indicator light will flash
slowly and then rapidly.)
Proceed with Programmingstep 3 to
complete.
qOperating the HomeLink System
Press the programmed HomeLink button
to operate a programmed device. The
code will continue being transmitted for a
maximum of 20 seconds.
qReprogramming the HomeLink
system
To program a device to HomeLink using a
HomeLink button previously trained,
follow these steps:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink
button. DO NOT release the button.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash
after 20 seconds. Without releasing the
HomeLink button, proceed with
Programming- step 1.
qErasing Programmed HomeLink
Buttons
To erase the existing programming from
all three operating channels, press and
hold the two outside buttons ( , )
on the auto-dimming mirror until the
HomeLink indicator light begins to flash
after approximately 10 seconds.
Verify that the programming has been
erased when you resell the vehicle.
4-70
When Driving
Switches and Controls
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page198
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (199,1)
Brake System
qFoot Brake
Your Mazda has power-assisted brakes
that adjust automatically through normal
use.
Should power-assist fail, you can stop by
applying greater force than normal to the
brake pedal. But the distance required to
stop will be greater than usual.
WARNING
Do not coast with the engine stalled or
turned off, find a safe place to stop:
Coasting with the engine stalled or
turned off is dangerous. Braking will
require more effort, and the brake's
power-assist could be depleted if you
pump the brake. This will cause
longer stopping distances or even an
accident.
Shift to a lower gear when going down
steep hills:
Driving with your foot continuously
on the brake pedal or steadily
applying the brakes for long
distances is dangerous. This causes
overheated brakes, resulting in
longer stopping distances or even
total brake failure. This could cause
loss of vehicle control and a serious
accident. Avoid continuous
application of the brakes.
Dry off brakes that have become wet
by driving slowly, releasing the
accelerator pedal and lightly applying
the brakes several times until the brake
performance returns to normal:
Driving with wet brakes is
dangerous. Increased stopping
distance or the vehicle pulling to one
side when braking could result in a
serious accident. Light braking will
indicate whether the brakes have
been affected.
When Driving
Brake
4-71
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page199
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (200,1)
CAUTION
ØDo not drive with your foot held
on the clutch pedal or brake pedal,
or hold the clutch pedal depressed
halfway unnecessarily. Doing so
could result in the following:
ØThe clutch and brake parts will
wear out more quickly.
ØThe brakes can overheat and
adversely affect brake
performance.
ØAlways depress the brake pedal
with the right foot. Applying the
brakes with the unaccustomed left
foot could slow your reaction time
to an emergency situation
resulting in insufficient braking
operation.
ØWear shoes appropriate for driving
in order to avoid your shoe
contacting the brake pedal when
depressing the accelerator pedal.
qParking Brake
CAUTION
Driving with the parking brake on
will cause excessive wear of the brake
parts.
NOTE
For parking in snow, refer to Winter Driving
(page 3-41) regarding parking brake use.
Setting the parking brake
Depress the brake pedal and then firmly
pull the parking brake lever fully upwards
with sufficient force to hold the vehicle in
a stationary position.
Releasing the parking brake
Depress the brake pedal and pull the
parking brake lever upwards, then press
the release button. While holding the
button, lower the parking brake lever all
the way down to the released position.
4-72
When Driving
Brake
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page200
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (201,1)
qDisplay Indication
For vehicles with the type A instrument
cluster, check the vehicle condition or
have the vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer according to
the indication.
qWarning Light
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
qBrake Pad Wear Indicator
When the disc brake pads become worn,
the built-in wear indicators contact the
disc plates. This causes a screeching noise
to warn that the pads should be replaced.
When you hear this noise, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
WARNING
Do not drive with worn disc pads:
Driving with worn disc pads is
dangerous. The brakes could fail and
cause a serious accident. As soon as
you hear a screeching noise consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qBrake Assist
During emergency braking situations
when it is necessary to depress the brake
pedal with greater force, the brake assist
system provides braking assistance, thus
enhancing braking performance.
When the brake pedal is depressed hard or
depressed more quickly, the brakes apply
more firmly.
NOTE
lWhen the brake pedal is depressed hard or
depressed more quickly, the pedal will feel
softer but the brakes will apply more firmly.
This is a normal effect of the brake assist
operation and does not indicate a
malfunction.
lWhen the brake pedal is depressed hard or
depressed more quickly, a motor/pump
operation noise may be heard. This is a
normal effect of the brake assist and does
not indicate a malfunction.
lThe brake assist equipment does not
supersede the functionality of the vehicle's
main braking system.
When Driving
Brake
4-73
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page201
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (202,1)
Hill Launch Assist (HLA)
Hill Launch Assist (HLA) is a function
which assists the driver in accelerating
from a stop while on a slope. When the
driver releases the brake pedal and
depresses the accelerator pedal while on a
slope, the function prevents the vehicle
from rolling.
The braking force is maintained
automatically after the brake pedal is
released on a steep grade.
For vehicles with a manual transaxle, Hill
Launch Assist (HLA) operates on a
downward slope when the shift lever is in
the reverse (R) position, and on an
upward slope when the shift lever is in a
position other than the reverse (R)
position.
For vehicles with an automatic transaxle,
Hill Launch Assist (HLA) operates on a
downward slope when the shift lever is in
the reverse (R) position, and on an
upward slope when the shift lever is in a
forward gear.
WARNING
Do not rely completely on Hill Launch
Assist (HLA):
Hill Launch Assist (HLA) is an
auxiliary device for accelerating from
a stop on a slope. The system only
operates for about two seconds and
therefore, relying only on the system,
when accelerating from a stop is
dangerous because the vehicle may
move (roll) unexpectedly and cause
an accident.
The vehicle could roll depending on
the vehicle's load or if it is towing
something. In addition, for vehicles
with a manual transaxle, the vehicle
could still roll depending on how the
clutch pedal or the accelerator pedal
is operated.
Always confirm the safety around the
vehicle before starting to drive the
vehicle.
4-74
When Driving
Brake
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page202
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (203,1)
NOTE
lHill Launch Assist (HLA) does not operate
on a gentle slope. In addition, the gradient
of the slope on which the system will
operate changes depending on the vehicle's
load.
lHill Launch Assist (HLA) does not operate
if the parking brake is applied, the vehicle
has not stopped completely, or the clutch
pedal is released.
lWhile Hill Launch Assist (HLA) is
operating, the brake pedal may feel stiff
and vibrate, however, this does not indicate
a malfunction.
lHill Launch Assist (HLA) does not operate
while the TCS/DSC indicator light is
illuminated.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
lHill Launch Assist (HLA) does not turn off
even if the TCS OFF switch is pressed to
turn off the TCS.
When Driving
Brake
4-75
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page203
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (204,1)
Smart City Brake Support (SCBS)
í
lThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system is designed to reduce damage in the
event of a collision by operating the brake control (SCBS brake) when the system's laser
sensor detects a vehicle ahead and determines that a collision with the vehicle ahead is
unavoidable. It may also be possible to avoid a collision if the relative speed between
your vehicle and the vehicle ahead is less than about 15 km/h (9.3 mph).
In addition, when the driver depresses the brake pedal while the system is in the
operation range at about 4 to 30 km/h (2 to 18 mph), the brakes are applied firmly and
quickly to assist. (Brake Assist (SCBS brake assist))
lFor vehicles with the type A instrument cluster, check the vehicle condition or have the
vehicle inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer according to the indication.
lA system malfunction or operation conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page 4-22.
Laser sensor
WARNING
Do not rely on the Smart City Brake Support System (SCBS) as a substitute for safe
driving:
The Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system cannot compensate for unsafe and
reckless driving, excessive speed, tailgating (following another vehicle too closely),
and driving on slippery roads such as wet, snowy, and icy roads (reduced tire friction
and road contact because of water on the road surface). You can still have an
accident.
4-76
When Driving
í
Some models.
Brake
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page204
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (205,1)
Do not rely completely on the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system:
ØThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system is only designed to reduce damage in
the event of a collision. Over reliance on the system leading to the accelerator
pedal or brake pedal being mistakenly operated could result in an accident.
ØThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) is a system which operates in response to a
vehicle ahead. The system may not be able to detect or react to 2-wheeled vehicles
or pedestrians.
ØThe laser sensor for the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system is installed near
the rearview mirror. To assure the correct operation of the Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS), heed the following cautions.
ØDo not apply stickers to the surface of the windshield near the laser sensor
(including transparent stickers). Otherwise, the laser sensor may not be able to
detect vehicles or obstructions ahead which could result in an accident.
ØDo not disassemble the laser sensor.
ØIf cracks or damage caused by flying gravel or debris is visible near the laser
sensor, stop using the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system immediately
and have your vehicle inspected by an Authorized Mazda Dealer. If the vehicle
continues to be driven with cracks or scratch marks left on the windshield near
the laser sensor, the system may operate unnecessarily and cause an
unexpected accident.
Refer to Stopping The Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) System Operation on
page 4-81.
ØWhen replacing the windshield wipers or windshield, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
Do not modify the suspension:
If the vehicle height or inclination is changed, the system will not be able to correctly
detect vehicles or obstructions ahead. This will result in the Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS) system not operating normally or mistakenly operating, which could cause a
serious accident.
Turn off the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) when the vehicle is running on a chassis
roller or being towed:
Turn off the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system to prevent mistaken operation
when the vehicle is running on a chassis roller or being towed. See the next page on
how to turn off the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS).
Refer to Stopping The Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) System Operation on page
4-81.
When Driving
Brake
4-77
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page205
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (206,1)
CAUTION
ØWhen driving off-road in areas where there is grass or forage, it is recommended
that the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system be turned off.
ØAlways use tires for all wheels that are of the specified size, and the same
manufacture, brand, and tread pattern. In addition, do not use tires with
significantly different wear patterns on the same vehicle. Do not use tires with
significantly different wear patterns on the same vehicle as the Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS) system may not operate normally.
ØThe laser sensor includes a function for detecting a soiled windshield and
informing the driver, however, depending on the conditions, it may not detect
plastic shopping bags, ice or snow on the windshield. In such cases, the system
cannot accurately determine a vehicle or obstruction ahead and may not be able
to operate normally. Always drive carefully and pay attention to the road ahead.
NOTE
lThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system will operate under the following conditions.
lThe engine is running.
lThe display in the instrument cluster does not indicate that the system requires inspection or it
cannot be used.
lThe vehicle speed is between about 4 to 30 km/h (2 to 18 mph).
lThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system is not turned off.
lThe TCS operation is not turned off using the TCS OFF switch.
lThe DSC is not malfunctioning.
lThe driver is not deliberately performing driving operations (accelerator pedal, steering
wheel, and braking operations).
lThe Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) detects a vehicle ahead by emitting a near-infrared laser
beam and receiving the beam reflected off the reflector of the vehicle ahead, and then using it for
the measurement. Consequently, the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) may not operate under the
following conditions:
lReflection of the laser is poor due to the shape of the vehicle ahead.
lThe vehicle ahead is significantly dirty.
lUnder bad weather condition, such as rain, fog and snow.
lThe window washer is being used or the windshield wipers are not used when it's raining.
lThe windshield is dirty.
lThe steering wheel is turned completely left or right, or the vehicle is accelerated rapidly and
comes close to the vehicle ahead.
lTrucks with low loading platforms, vehicles traveling at extremely low speeds, and vehicles
with a high profile.
lVehicles with certain shapes such as a vehicle carrier.
4-78
When Driving
Brake
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page206
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (207,1)
lUnder the following conditions, the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system may not operate
normally.
lHeavy luggage is loaded in the luggage compartment or on the rear seat.
lWhen there is the possibility of partial contact with a vehicle or obstruction ahead.
lWhen driving on continuously curving roads, entering and exiting curves, and unstable driving
due to a vehicle accident or breakdown in a driving lane.
lElongated luggage or cargo is loaded onto installed roof rails and covers the laser sensor.
lExhaust gas from the vehicle in front, sand, snow, and water vapor rising from manholes and
grating, and water splashed into the air.
lWhen towing a malfunctioning vehicle.
lIn the following cases, the laser sensor may inadvertently determine that there is a vehicle ahead
and the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system may operate.
lObjects on the road at the entrance to a curve.
lVehicles passing in the opposite lane while making a curve.
lMetal objects, bumps, or protruding objects on the road.
lWhen passing through a toll gate.
lWhen passing under a vinyl curtain or flag.
lPlastic objects such as pylons.
lTwo-wheeled vehicles, pedestrians, animals or standing trees.
lIf the vehicle is driven with some of the tires having significant wear, the system may not operate
correctly. If the tires are returned to a normal state and the master warning light still illuminates,
have your vehicle inspected by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qLaser Sensor Handling
The Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) laser sensor is installed at the top of the windshield
near the rearview mirror.
Always keep the surface of the windshield around the laser sensor clean to assure proper
operation of the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) system.
When Driving
Brake
4-79
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page207
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (208,1)
WARNING
As there is the possibility of eye damage occurring from the laser, always heed the
following precautions:
ØNever remove the sensor.
ØA removed sensor will not meet the conditions for a class 1M laser under the IEC
60825-1 specification and therefore eye safety cannot be assured.
ØDo not peer into the sensor using optical instruments with a magnification
function such as magnifying glasses, and microscopic and objective lenses within
a distance of 100 mm (3.94 in) from the sensor.
Laser sensor radiation data
Maximum average power: 45 mW
Pulse duration: 33 ns
Wavelength: 905 nm
Divergence angle (horizontal×vertical): 28 degrees×12 degrees
4-80
When Driving
Brake
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page208
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (209,1)
q
Stopping The Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS) System Operation
The Smart City Brake Support (SCBS)
system can be deactivated. Refer to
Personalization Features on page 9-10.
When the engine is restarted, the system
becomes operational.
With Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS) OFF Indicator Light
When the Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS) system is turned off, the Smart
City Brake Support (SCBS) OFF indicator
light turns on.
NOTE
When the TCS OFF switch is pressed to stop
the TCS operation, the Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS) system operation also stops
and the Smart City Brake Support (SCBS)
OFF indicator light turns on.
When Driving
Brake
4-81
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page209
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (210,1)
Antilock Brake System (ABS)
The ABS control unit continuously
monitors the speed of each wheel. If one
wheel is about to lock up, the ABS
responds by automatically releasing and
reapplying that wheel's brake.
The driver will feel a slight vibration in
the brake pedal and may hear a chattering
noise from the brake system. This is
normal ABS system operation. Continue
to depress the brake pedal without
pumping the brakes.
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
WARNING
Do not rely on ABS as a substitute for
safe driving:
The ABS cannot compensate for
unsafe and reckless driving, excessive
speed, tailgating (following another
vehicle too closely), driving on ice and
snow, and hydroplaning (reduced tire
friction and road contact because of
water on the road surface). You can
still have an accident.
NOTE
lBraking distances may be longer on loose
surfaces (snow or gravel, for example)
which usually have a hard foundation. A
vehicle with a normal braking system may
require less distance to stop under these
conditions because the tires will build up a
wedge of surface layer when the wheels
skid.
lThe sound of the ABS operating may be
heard when starting the engine or
immediately after starting the vehicle,
however, it does not indicate a malfunction.
4-82
When Driving
ABS/TCS/DSC
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page210
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (211,1)
Traction Control System
(TCS)
The Traction Control System (TCS)
enhances traction and safety by
controlling engine torque and braking.
When the TCS detects driving wheel
slippage, it lowers engine torque and
operates the brakes to prevent loss of
traction.
This means that on a slick surface, the
engine adjusts automatically to provide
optimum power to the drive wheels,
limiting wheel spin and loss of traction.
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
WARNING
Do not rely on the Traction Control
System (TCS) as a substitute for safe
driving:
The Traction Control System (TCS)
cannot compensate for unsafe and
reckless driving, excessive speed,
tailgating (following another vehicle
too closely), and hydroplaning
(reduced tire friction and road
contact because of water on the road
surface). You can still have an
accident.
Use snow tires or tire chains and drive
at reduced speeds when roads are
covered with ice and/or snow:
Driving without proper traction
devices on snow and/or ice-covered
roads is dangerous. The Traction
Control System (TCS) alone cannot
provide adequate traction and you
could still have an accident.
NOTE
To turn off the TCS, press the TCS OFF switch
(page 4-84).
When Driving
ABS/TCS/DSC
4-83
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page211
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (212,1)
qTCS OFF Switch
Press the TCS OFF switch to turn off the
TCS. The TCS OFF indicator light in the
instrument cluster will illuminate.
Press the switch again to turn the TCS
back on. The TCS OFF indicator light
will turn off.
NOTE
lWhen TCS is on and you attempt to free the
vehicle when it is stuck, or drive it out of
freshly fallen snow, the TCS will activate.
Depressing the accelerator will not
increase engine power and freeing the
vehicle may be difficult. When this happens,
turn off the TCS.
lIf the TCS is off when the engine is turned
off, it automatically activates when the
ignition is switched ON.
lLeaving the TCS on will provide the best
traction.
lIf the TCS OFF switch is pressed and held
for 10 seconds or more, the TCS OFF
switch malfunction detection function
operates and the TCS system activates
automatically. The TCS OFF indicator light
turns off while the TCS system is operative.
Dynamic Stability Control
(DSC)
The Dynamic Stability Control (DSC)
automatically controls braking and engine
torque in conjunction with systems such
as ABS and TCS to help control side slip
when driving on slippery surfaces, or
during sudden or evasive maneuvering,
enhancing vehicle safety.
Refer to ABS (page 4-82) and TCS (page
4-83).
DSC operation is possible at speeds
greater than 20 km/h (12 mph).
A system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
WARNING
Do not rely on the Dynamic Stability
Control as a substitute for safe driving:
The Dynamic Stability Control (DSC)
cannot compensate for unsafe and
reckless driving, excessive speed,
tailgating (following another vehicle
too closely), and hydroplaning
(reduced tire friction and road
contact because of water on the road
surface). You can still have an
accident.
4-84
When Driving
ABS/TCS/DSC
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page212
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (213,1)
CAUTION
ØThe DSC may not operate correctly
unless the following are observed:
ØUse tires of the correct size
specified for your Mazda on all
four wheels.
ØUse tires of the same
manufacturer, brand and tread
pattern on all four wheels.
ØDo not mix worn tires.
ØThe DSC may not operate correctly
when tire chains are used or a
temporary spare tire is installed
because the tire diameter changes.
When Driving
ABS/TCS/DSC
4-85
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page213
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (214,1)
All-Wheel Drive (AWD)
Operation
lAWD provides excellent drivability on
snow-covered and ice-packed roads,
sand and mud, as well as on steep
slopes and other slippery surfaces.
lA system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
WARNING
Never spin a wheel that is off the
ground:
Spinning a wheel that is off the
ground as a result of the vehicle
being stuck or in a ditch is
dangerous. The drive assembly could
be seriously damaged which could
lead to an accident or could even
lead to overheating, oil leakage, and
a fire.
qAWD Driving
WARNING
Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed and
abrupt maneuvers when driving this
vehicle:
Sharp turns, excessive speed and
abrupt maneuvering of this vehicle is
dangerous as it could result in the
increased risk of loss of vehicle
control, vehicle roll-over, personal
injury or death.
This vehicle has a higher center of
gravity. Vehicles with a higher center
of gravity such as utility and AWD
vehicles handle differently than
vehicles with a lower center of
gravity.
Utility and AWD vehicles are not
designed for cornering at high speeds
any more than low profile sports cars
are designed to perform satisfactorily
under off-road conditions. In
addition, utility vehicles have a
significantly higher rollover rate than
other types of vehicles.
Drive carefully when the vehicle is
loaded by lowering vehicle speed and
applying the brakes earlier:
Abrupt maneuvering and sudden
braking when driving a loaded
vehicle is dangerous as the driving
behavior of a vehicle with a high
center of gravity is different when it is
loaded compared to when it is not,
and could result in the loss of vehicle
control and an accident.
4-86
When Driving
AWD
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page214
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (215,1)
qTires and Tire Chains
The condition of the tires plays a large
role in the performance of the vehicle.
Moreover, to prevent adverse effects to
the drive assembly, please note the
following:
Tires
lWhen replacing tires, always replace
all front and rear tires at the same time.
lAll tires must be of the same size,
manufacture, brand and tread pattern.
Pay particular attention when
equipping snow or other types of
winter tires.
lDo not mix tread-worn tires with
normal tires.
lInspect tire inflation pressures at the
specified periods adjust to the specified
pressures, and initialize the tire
pressure monitoring system.
NOTE
Check the tire inflation pressure label attached
to driver's door frame for the correct tire
inflation pressure.
lMake sure to equip the vehicle with
genuine wheels of the specified size,
on all wheels. With AWD, the system
is calibrated for all four wheels being
of the same dimensions.
Tire chains
lInstall tire chains to the front tires.
lDo not use tire chains on the rear
wheels.
lDo not drive the vehicle faster than 30
km/h (19 mph) with the tire chains
installed.
lDo not drive the vehicle with tire
chains on road conditions other than
snow or ice.
qTowing
If the vehicle requires towing, have it
towed with all four wheels completely off
the ground(page 7-20).
When Driving
AWD
4-87
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page215
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (216,1)
Power Steering
lPower steering is only operable when
the engine is running. If the engine is
off or if the power steering system is
inoperable, you can still steer, but it
requires more physical effort.
If the steering feels stiffer than usual
during normal driving or the steering
vibrates, consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
lFor vehicles with the type A instrument
cluster, check the vehicle condition or
have the vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer according to
the indication.
lA system malfunction or operation
conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on
page 4-22.
CAUTION
Never hold the steering wheel to the
extreme left or right for more than 5
seconds with the engine running.
This could damage the power
steering system.
4-88
When Driving
Power Steering
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page216
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (217,1)
Cruise Control
With cruise control, you can set and automatically maintain any speed of more than about
25 km/h (16 mph).
WARNING
Do not use the cruise control under the following conditions:
Using the cruise control under the following conditions is dangerous and could result
in loss of vehicle control.
ØHilly terrain
ØSteep inclines
ØHeavy or unsteady traffic
ØSlippery or winding roads
ØSimilar restrictions that require inconsistent speed
qCruise Control Switch
CANCEL switch
OFF switch
ON switch
RES switch
Cruise control
SET+/SET- switch
When Driving
Cruise Control
4-89
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page217
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (218,1)
qActivation/Deactivation
To activate the system, press the ON
switch.
The cruise main indicator light (Amber)
illuminates.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page
4-22.
To deactivate the system, press the OFF
switch.
The cruise main indicator light (Amber)
turns off.
WARNING
Always turn off the cruise control
system when it is not in use:
Leaving the cruise control system in
an activation-ready state while the
cruise control is not in use is
dangerous as the cruise control could
unexpectedly activate if the
activation button is accidentally
pressed, and result in loss of vehicle
control and an accident.
qTo Set Speed
1. Activate the cruise control system by
pressing the ON switch.
The cruise main indicator light
(Amber) illuminates. Refer to Warning/
Indicator Lights on page 4-22.
2. Accelerate to the desired speed, which
must be more than 25 km/h (16 mph).
3. Set the cruise control by pressing the
SET or SET - switch at the desired
speed. The cruise control is set at the
moment the SET or SET - switch is
pressed. Release the accelerator pedal
simultaneously. The cruise set indicator
light (Green) illuminates.
NOTE
lRelease the SET or SET - switch at the
desired speed, otherwise the speed will
continue increasing while the SET
switch is pressed and held, and continue
decreasing while the SET - switch is pressed
and held (except when the accelerator
pedal is depressed).
lOn a steep grade, the vehicle may
momentarily slow down while ascending,
or speed up while descending.
lCruise control will cancel if the vehicle
speed decreases below 21 km/h (13 mph)
when cruise is activated, such as when
climbing a steep grade.
lCruise control may cancel at about 15 km/h
(9 mph) below the preset speed (such as
may happen when climbing a long, steep
grade).
For the Type A instrument cluster, the
vehicle speed preset using the cruise
control is displayed in the instrument
cluster.
4-90
When Driving
Cruise Control
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page218
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:48 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (219,1)
qTo Increase Cruising Speed
Follow either of these procedures.
To increase speed using cruise control
switch
Press the SET switch and hold it. Your
vehicle will accelerate.
Release the switch at the speed you want.
Press the SET and release it
immediately to adjust the preset speed.
Multiple operations will increase the
preset speed according to the number of
times it is operated.
Increasing speed with a single SET
operation
Meter display for vehicle speed indicated
in km/h: 1 km/h (0.6 mph)
Meter display for vehicle speed indicated
in mph: 1 mph (1.6 km/h)
To increase speed using accelerator
pedal
Depress the accelerator pedal to accelerate
to the desired speed. Press the SET or
SET - switch and release it immediately.
NOTE
Accelerate if you want to speed up temporarily
when the cruise control is on. Greater speed
will not interfere with or change the set speed.
Take your foot off the accelerator to return to
the set speed.
qTo Decrease Cruising Speed
Press the SET - switch and hold it. The
vehicle will gradually slow.
Release the switch at the speed you want.
Press the SET- switch and release it
immediately to adjust the preset speed.
Multiple operations will decrease the
preset speed according to the number of
times it is operated.
Decreasing speed with a single SET-
operation
Meter display for vehicle speed indicated
in km/h: 1 km/h (0.6 mph)
Meter display for vehicle speed indicated
in mph: 1 mph (1.6 km/h)
qTo Resume Cruising Speed at
More Than 25 km/h (16 mph)
If some other method besides the OFF
switch was used to cancel cruising speed
(such as applying the brake pedal) and the
system is still activated, the most recent
set speed will automatically resume when
the RES switch is pressed.
If vehicle speed is below 25 km/h (16
mph), increase the vehicle speed up to 25
km/h (16 mph) or more and press the RES
switch.
qTo Temporarily Cancel
To temporarily cancel the system, use one
of these methods:
lSlightly depress the brake pedal.
lDepress the clutch pedal (Manual
transaxle only).
lPress the CANCEL switch.
If the RESUME switch is pressed when
the vehicle speed is 25 km/h (16 mph) or
higher, the system reverts to the
previously set speed.
When Driving
Cruise Control
4-91
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page219
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (220,1)
qTo Deactivate
To deactivate the system, press the OFF
switch.
4-92
When Driving
Cruise Control
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page220
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (221,1)
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
lThe Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) monitors the air pressure of all four tires.
If the air pressure of one or more tires is too low, the system warns the driver by
indicating the tire pressure monitoring system warning light in the instrument cluster
(the warning is also indicated in the display on the type A
*1
instrument cluster) and
operating a beep sound. The system monitors the tire pressures indirectly using the data
sent from the ABS wheel speed sensors.
To allow the system to operate correctly, the system needs to be initialized with the
specified tire pressure (value on the tire pressure label). Follow the procedure and
perform the initialization.
*1 Refer to Type A on page 4-22.
lFor vehicles with the type A
*1
instrument cluster, check the vehicle condition or have
the vehicle inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer according to the indication.
*1 Refer to Type A on page 4-22.
lA system malfunction or operation conditions are indicated by a warning.
Refer to Warning/Indicator Lights on page 4-22.
Refer to Tire Inflation Pressure Warning Beep on page 7-34.
ABS wheel speed sensor
When Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
4-93
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page221
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (222,1)
CAUTION
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold
and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on
the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires of a
different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure
monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or
more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire
pressure telltale illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-
inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation
also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling
and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is
the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure
telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one
minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the
malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal
low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons,
including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle
that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS
malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
To avoid false readings, the system samples for a little while before indicating a
problem. As a result it will not instantaneously register a rapid tire deflation or blow
out.
4-94
When Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page222
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (223,1)
NOTE
Because this system detects slight changes in tire conditions, the timing of the warning may be faster
or slower in the following cases:
lThe size, manufacturer, or the type of tires is different from the specification.
lThe size, manufacturer, or the type of a tire is different from the others, or the level of tire wear is
excessively different between them.
lA run-flat tire, studless tire, snow tire, or tire chains are used.
lAn emergency tire is used (The tire pressure monitoring system warning light may flash and then
continue illuminating).
lA tire is repaired using the emergency flat tire repair kit.
lThe tire pressure is excessively higher than the specified pressure, or the tire pressure is suddenly
lowered for some reason such as a tire burst during driving.
lThe vehicle speed is lower than about 15 km/h (9.3 mph) (including when the vehicle is stopped),
or the drive period is shorter than 5 minutes.
lThe vehicle is driven on an extremely rough road or a slippery, icy road.
lHard steering and rapid acceleration/deceleration are repeated such as during aggressive driving
on a winding road.
lLoad on the vehicle is applied to a tire such as by loading heavy luggage to one side of the
vehicle.
lSystem initialization has not been implemented with the specified tire pressure.
qTire Pressure Monitoring System
Initialization
In the following cases, system
initialization must be performed so that
the system operates normally.
lA tire pressure is adjusted.
lTire rotation is performed.
lA tire or wheel is replaced.
lThe battery is replaced or completely
drained.
lThe tire pressure monitoring system
warning light is illuminated.
Initialization method
1. Park the car in a safe place and firmly
apply the parking brake.
2. Let the tires cool, then adjust the tire
pressure of all four (4) tires to the
specified pressure indicated on the tire
pressure label located on the door jamb
of the driver's door (door open). Refer
to Tires on page 9-8.
3. Switch the ignition ON.
When Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
4-95
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page223
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (224,1)
4. While the vehicle is parked, press and
hold the tire pressure monitoring
system set switch and verify that the
tire pressure monitoring system
warning light in the instrument cluster
flashes twice and a beep sound is heard
once.
CAUTION
If the system initialization is
performed without adjusting the tire
pressure, the system cannot detect
the normal tire pressure and it may
not illuminate the tire pressure
monitoring system warning light
even if a tire pressure is low, or it
may illuminate the light even if the
pressures are normal.
The system initialization will not be
performed if the switch is pressed
while the vehicle is being driven.
4-96
When Driving
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page224
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (225,1)
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
í
The Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) system is designed to assist the driver by monitoring
blind spots on both sides of the vehicle to the rear in certain situations such as when
changing lanes on roads and freeways.
The BSM system monitors the detection areas on both sides of the vehicle to the rear when
the vehicle speed is about 32 km/h (20 mph) or more, and notifies the driver of vehicles in
the detection area by illuminating the BSM warning light.
If the turn signal lever is operated in the direction the BSM warning light is illuminated, the
system warns the driver of the vehicle in the detection area with a beep sound.
A system malfunction or operation conditions are indicated by a warning. Refer to
Warning/Indicator Lights on page 4-22.Refer to Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
Warning Beep on page 7-35.
Detection areas
Your vehicle
WARNING
Do not rely completely on the BSM system. Always look over your shoulder before
changing lanes:
The BSM system can assist the driver in confirming the safety of the surroundings
but is not a complete substitute. The driver is responsible for assuring lane changes
and other maneuvers. Always pay attention to the direction in which the vehicle is
traveling and the vehicle's surroundings.
NOTE
lThe BSM system does not operate when the vehicle speed is lower than about 32 km/h (20 mph).
lThe radar sensors are equipped inside the rear bumper. (page 4-100)
lThe system may not operate normally when towing a trailer. Turn off the system by operating the
BSM OFF switch when towing a trailer.
When Driving
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
4-97
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page225
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (226,1)
lThe radar sensors do not detect human, animal, or static objects such as fences. In addition, the
system pauses when the selector lever is shifted to the R position. (The system resumes
automatically when the selector lever is shifted from the R position.)
lThe detectability of the radar sensors has its limitations. The BSM system may not operate
properly under the following conditions:
lIce, snow, or soil adheres to the rear bumper surface around the radar sensors.
lDuring adverse weather conditions such as rain or snow, or under conditions where water is
sprayed.
lThe rear bumper area around the radar sensors is blocked by foreign material (such as
stickers or a bicycle carrier).
lThe radar sensors may not detect all types of vehicles around your vehicle, especially the
following types of vehicles:
lMotorcycles
lVehicles with body shapes that radar may not reflect such as a flatbed trailer with no cargo.
lVehicles with lower body height such as sports cars.
lHave the radar sensors inspected at an Authorized Mazda Dealer if any shock is applied to the
rear bumper, even in a minor accident. If the vehicle is driven with a damaged radar sensor, the
system may not operate properly resulting in an accident.
lFor repairs or paintwork around the radar sensors, or replacement of the bumper, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lThe radar sensors of the BSM system may be regulated under the radio wave related laws of the
country where the vehicle is driven. The sensors in this system are approved for use in the U.S.A.
(including territories), Canada, and Mexico. If a vehicle with a BSM system is driven in a country
other than the U.S.A., Canada, or Mexico, the system has to be turned off using the BSM OFF
switch.
lThe detection area of the system has been determined based on the lane width of general
freeways. Therefore on a road with a narrower lane width, the system may detect vehicles on a
lane next to the adjacent lane and operate the warning light/beep. On a road with wider lane
width, the system may not detect vehicles on the adjacent lane and may not operate the warning
light/beep.
lOperation of the warning light/beep may be delayed or the system may not operate the warning
light/beep under the following conditions:
lThe vehicle accelerates from a standing-start with a vehicle alongside.
lA vehicle moves from a lane two lanes over to the adjacent lane.
lThe difference in vehicle speed between your vehicle and another vehicle is larger when
passing or being passed, and the vehicle passes the detection area within a short period of
time.
lOn a steep incline, or when there is a difference in height between lanes.
lImmediately after the system has been activated by pressing the BSM OFF switch again after it
has been turned off (BSM OFF indicator light in instrument panel illuminates) by pressing the
switch.
lAlthough the system may detect objects on the road side such as parked vehicles or guardrails and
operate the warning light/beep, it does not indicate a malfunction.
4-98
When Driving
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page226
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (227,1)
lIf the vehicle is driven on a road with less traffic and few vehicles that the radar sensors can
detect, the system may pause (The BSM OFF indicator light in the instrument panel flashes).
However, it does not indicate a malfunction.
lThe following conditions may affect the visibility of the BSM warning lights on the outside mirror,
making it difficult to confirm the illumination of the lights:
lIce or snow adheres to the surface of the outside mirrors.
lThe door window glass is tinted.
qBSM Warning Light
The blind spot monitoring system alerts the driver to the presence of another vehicle in an
adjacent lane using the BSM warning lights and the warning beep while the system is
operational.
BSM warning light
Equipped on the left and right door mirrors.
This warning light illuminates for a few seconds when the ignition is switched ON.
If the BSM system detects a vehicle in the detection area while the vehicle is driven at a
speed of about 32 km/h (20 mph) or more, the BSM warning light illuminates on the side
of the vehicle where the rear on-coming vehicle is detected.
NOTE
lIf ice or snow adhere to the outer mirror surface, the BSM warning light may not be visible.
lIf the door window glass is tinted, it may affect the visibility of the BSM warning light, making it
difficult to confirm the illumination of the light.
When Driving
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
4-99
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page227
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (228,1)
qBSM OFF Switch
When the BSM OFF switch is pressed,
the BSM system turns off and the BSM
OFF indicator light illuminates.
Press the BSM OFF switch again to turn
on the BSM system. The BSM OFF
indicator light turns off.
NOTE
lThe system may not operate normally when
towing a trailer. Turn off the system by
operating the BSM OFF switch when
towing a trailer.
lIf the ignition is switched off with the BSM
system turned off, the system becomes
operable automatically when the ignition is
switched ON.
qCare of Radar Sensors
The radar sensors are equipped inside the
rear bumper.
Radar sensors
Always keep the bumper surface near the
radar sensor area clean so that the BSM
system operates normally. Refer to
Exterior Care on page 6-56.
NOTE
lThe BSM OFF indicator light flashes if the
radar sensors cannot operate normally. If
the light remains flashing after cleaning the
bumper surface near the radar sensor area,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lFor repairs or paintwork around the radar
sensors, or replacement of the bumper,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
4-100
When Driving
Blind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page228
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (229,1)
Rear View Monitor
í
The rear view monitor provides visual images of the rear of the vehicle when reversing.
WARNING
Always drive carefully confirming the safety of the rear and the surrounding
conditions by looking directly with your eyes:
Reversing the vehicle by only looking at the screen is dangerous as it may cause an
accident or a collision with an object. The rear view monitor is only a visual assist
device when reversing the vehicle. The images on the screen may be different from
the actual conditions.
CAUTION
ØDo not use the rear view monitor under the following conditions: Using the rear
view monitor under the following conditions is dangerous and could result in
injury or vehicle damage or both.
ØIcy or snow-covered roads.
ØTire chains or a temporary spare tire is installed.
ØThe liftgate is not fully closed.
ØThe vehicle is on a road incline.
ØWhen the display is cold, images may course across the monitor or the screen and
may be dimmer than usual, which could cause difficulty in confirming the
surrounding conditions of the vehicle. Always drive carefully confirming the safety
of the rear and the surrounding conditions by looking directly with your eyes.
ØDo not apply excessive force to the camera. The camera position and angle may
deviate.
ØDo not disassemble, modify, or remove it as it may no longer be waterproof.
ØThe camera cover is made of plastic. Do not apply degreasing agents, organic
solvents, wax, or glass coating agents to the camera cover. If any are spilled on
the cover, wipe off with a soft cloth immediately.
ØDo not rub the cover excessively, or polish it using an abrasive compound or a
hard brush. The cover may be damaged affecting the image.
NOTE
lIf water, snow, or mud is stuck on the camera lens, wipe it off using a soft cloth. If it cannot be
wiped off, use a mild detergent.
lIf the camera temperature changes rapidly (Hot to cold, cold to hot), the rear view monitor may
not operate correctly.
lWhen replacing the tires, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer. Replacing the tires could result in
deviation of the guide lines which appear on the display.
lIf the vehicle's front, side, or rear has been involved in a collision, the alignment of the rear view
parking camera (location, installation angle) may have deviated. Always consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer to have the vehicle inspected.
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-101
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page229
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (230,1)
qRear View Parking Camera Location
Rear View Parking Camera
qSwitching to the Rear View Monitor Display
Shift the shift lever to R with the ignition switched ON to switch the display to the rear
view monitor display.
NOTE
When the shift lever is shifted from R to another shift lever position, the screen returns to the previous
display.
4-102
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page230
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (231,1)
qDisplayable Range on the Screen
The images on the screen may be different from the actual conditions.
(Screen display)
(Actual view)
Object
Garnish
Bumper
NOTE
lThe displayable range varies depending on the vehicle and road conditions.
lThe displayable range is limited. Objects under the bumper or around the bumper ends cannot be
displayed.
lThe distance appearing in the displayed image is different from the actual distance because the
rear view parking camera is equipped with a specific lens.
lSome optionally installed vehicle accessories may be picked up by the camera. Do not install any
optional parts that can interfere with the camera view, such as illuminating parts or parts made of
reflective material.
lIt may be difficult to see the display under the following conditions, however, it does not indicate a
malfunction.
lIn darkened areas.
lWhen the temperature around the lens is high/low.
lWhen the camera is wet such as on a rainy day or during periods of high humidity.
lWhen foreign material such as mud is stuck around the camera.
lWhen the camera lens reflects sunlight or headlight beams.
lImage display may be delayed if the temperature around the camera is low.
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-103
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page231
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (232,1)
qViewing the Display
Guide lines which indicate the width of the vehicle (yellow) are displayed on the screen as
a reference to the approximate width of the vehicle in comparison to the width of the
parking space you are about to back into.
Use this display view for parking your vehicle in a parking space or garage.
b
a
a) Vehicle width guide lines (yellow)
Guide lines serve as a reference to the approximate width of the vehicle.
b) Distance guide lines
These guide lines indicate the approximate distance to a point measured from the
vehicle's rear (from the end of the bumper).
The red and yellow lines indicate the points about 50 cm (19 in) for the red line and 100
cm (39.3 in) for the yellow lines from the rear bumper (at the center point of each of the
lines).
CAUTION
The guide lines on the screen are fixed lines. They are not synced to the driver's
turning of the steering wheel. Always be careful and check the area to the vehicle's
rear and the surrounding area directly with your eyes while backing up.
qRear View Monitor Operation
The operation of the rear view monitor when reversing the vehicle varies depending on the
traffic, road, and vehicle conditions. The amount of steering and the timing also varies
depending on conditions, so confirm the surrounding conditions directly with your eyes
and steer the vehicle in accordance with the conditions.
Be well aware of the above cautions prior to using the rear view monitor.
NOTE
Images displayed on the monitor from the rear view parking camera are reversed images (mirror
images).
1. Shift the shift lever to R to switch the display to the rear view monitor display.
4-104
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page232
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (233,1)
2. Confirming the surrounding conditions, reverse the vehicle.
(Display condition) (Vehicle condition)
3. After your vehicle begins entering the parking space, continue backing up slowly so that
the distance between the vehicle width lines and the sides of the parking space on the
left and right are roughly equal.
4. Continue to adjust the steering wheel until the vehicle width guide lines are parallel to
the left and right sides of the parking space.
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-105
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page233
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (234,1)
5. Once they are parallel, straighten the wheels and back your vehicle slowly into the
parking space. Continue checking the vehicle's surroundings and then stop the vehicle in
the best possible position. (If the parking space has division lines, check whether the
vehicle width guide lines are parallel to them.)
(Display condition) (Vehicle condition)
6. When the shift lever is shifted from R to another shift lever position, the screen returns
to the previous display.
4-106
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page234
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (235,1)
NOTE
Because there may be a difference between the displayed image, such as indicated below, and the
actual conditions when parking, always verify the safety at the rear of the vehicle and the
surrounding area directly with your eyes.
lIn the image of the parking space (or garage) displayed below, even though the back end and
distance guide lines appear parallel in the monitor, they may not actually be parallel on the
ground.
lWhen parking in a space with a division line on only one side of the parking space, the division
line and the vehicle width guide line may appear parallel on the monitor, but they may not
actually be parallel on the ground.
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-107
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page235
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (236,1)
qVariance Between Actual Road Conditions and Displayed Image
Some variance occurs between the actual road and the displayed road. Such variance in
distance perspective could lead to an accident. Note the following conditions that may
cause a variance in distance perspective.
When the vehicle is tilted due to the weight of passengers and load
When the vehicle rear is lowered, the object displayed on the screen appears farther than
the actual distance.
Variance
Object
4-108
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page236
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (237,1)
When there is a steep grade behind the vehicle
When there is a steep upgrade (downgrade) behind the vehicle, the object displayed on the
screen appears farther (downgrade: closer) than the actual distance.
Appears
farther than
actual
distance
Appears
closer than
actual
distance
Object at actual
position
Object at actual position
Object on screen
A: Distance between the vehicle and object displayed on the screen.
B: Actual distance between the vehicle and object.
Object on screen
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-109
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page237
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (238,1)
Three-dimensional object on vehicle rear
Because the distance guide lines are displayed based on a flat surface, the distance to the
three-dimensional object displayed on the screen is different from the actual distance.
A
A
C
B
CB
(Actual distance) B>C=A
Sensed distance on screen A>B>C
(Screen display)
(Actual condition)
qPicture Quality Adjustment
WARNING
Always adjust the picture quality of the rear view monitor while the vehicle is
stopped:
Do not adjust the picture quality of the rear view monitor while driving the vehicle.
Adjusting the picture quality of the rear view monitor such as brightness, contrast,
color, and tint while driving the vehicle is dangerous as it could distract your
attention from the vehicle operation which could lead to an accident.
Picture quality adjustment can be done while the shift lever is in reverse (R).
There are four settings which can be adjusted including brightness, contrast, color, and tint.
When adjusting, pay sufficient attention to the vehicle surroundings.
1. Press the setup button ( ) to display the picture quality adjustment screen.
2. Touch the and on-screen buttons to change the set value.
Touch the on-screen button to return to the camera image display.
4-110
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page238
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (239,1)
Reset
All of the screen setting values can be reset to their initial settings.
1. Press the setup button ( ) to display the picture quality adjustment screen.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
When Driving
Rear View Monitor
4-111
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page239
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (240,1)
4-112
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page240
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (241,1)
5Interior Features
Use of various features for ride comfort, including air-conditioning and audio
system.
Climate Control System ............................................................... 5-2
Operating Tips ........................................................................... 5-2
Vent Operation .......................................................................... 5-3
Manual Type ............................................................................. 5-5
Fully Automatic Type ............................................................... 5-9
Audio System ............................................................................... 5-13
Antenna ................................................................................... 5-13
Operating Tips for Audio System ........................................... 5-13
Audio Set (Type A) ................................................................. 5-25
Audio Set (Type B) ................................................................. 5-35
Audio Control Switch Operation ............................................ 5-56
AUX/USB/iPod mode ............................................................. 5-58
Bluetooth® .................................................................................. 5-77
Bluetooth®
í
........................................................................... 5-77
Bluetooth® Hands-Free .......................................................... 5-83
Bluetooth® Audio ................................................................. 5-102
Troubleshooting .................................................................... 5-106
Interior Equipment ................................................................... 5-110
Sunvisors ............................................................................... 5-110
Interior Lights ........................................................................ 5-111
Clock ..................................................................................... 5-113
Accessory Sockets ................................................................. 5-114
Cup Holder ............................................................................ 5-116
Bottle Holder ......................................................................... 5-117
Storage Compartments .......................................................... 5-118
5-1
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page241
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (242,1)
Operating Tips
lOperate the climate control system
with the engine running.
lTo prevent the battery from being
discharged, do not leave the fan control
dial on for a long period of time with
the ignition switched ON when the
engine is not running.
lClear all obstructions such as leaves,
snow and ice from the hood and the air
inlet in the cowl grille to improve the
system efficiency.
lUse the climate control system to defog
the windows and dehumidify the air.
lThe recirculate mode should be used
when driving through tunnels or while
in a traffic jam, or when you would like
to shut off outside air for quick cooling
of the interior.
lUse the outside air mode for ventilation
or windshield defrosting.
lIf the vehicle has been parked in direct
sunlight during hot weather, open the
windows to let warm air escape, then
run the climate control system.
lRun the air conditioner about 10
minutes at least once a month to keep
internal parts lubricated.
lHave the air conditioner checked
before the weather gets hot. Lack of
refrigerant may make the air
conditioner less efficient.
The refrigerant specifications are
indicated on a label attached to the
inside of the engine compartment.
Check the label before refilling the
refrigerant. If the wrong type of
refrigerant is used, it could result in a
serious malfunction of the air
conditioner.
For details, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
Label
5-2
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page242
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (243,1)
Vent Operation
qAdjusting the Vents
Directing airflow
To adjust the direction of airflow, move
the adjustment knob.
NOTE
When using the air conditioner under humid
ambient temperature conditions, the system
may blow fog from the vents. This is not a sign
of trouble but a result of humid air being
suddenly cooled.
Side Vents
Open
Knob
Dial
Close
Center Vents
Knob
Interior Features
Climate Control System
5-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page243
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (244,1)
qSelecting the Airflow Mode
Dashboard Vents
Dashboard and Floor Vents
Floor Vents
Defroster and Floor Vents
Defroster Vents
5-4
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page244
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (245,1)
Manual Type
Temperature control dial
Air intake selector
(recirculated air
position)
Air intake selector
(outside air position)
A/C switch
Rear window defogger switch
Fan control dial Mode selector dial
qControl Switches
Temperature control dial
This dial controls temperature. Turn it
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise
for cold.
NOTE
When the mode is set to or with the fan
control dial in a position other than 0 and the
temperature control dial in the maximum cold
position, the air intake selector switches to the
recirculated air mode and the A/C turns on
automatically.
If A/C is not desired, press the A/C switch to
turn it off.
Fan control dial
This dial allows variable fan speeds.
0Fan off
1Low speed
2Medium low speed
3Medium high speed
4High speed
Mode selector dial
Turn the mode selector dial to select
airflow mode (page 5-4).
NOTE
lThe mode selector dial can be set at the
intermediate positions ( ) between each
mode. Set the dial to an intermediate
position if you want to split the airflow
between the two modes.
lFor example, when the mode selector dial is
at the position between the and
positions, airflow from the floor vent is less
than that of the position.
A/C switch
Press the A/C switch to turn the air
conditioner on. The indicator light on the
switch will illuminate when the fan
control dial is set at position 1, 2, 3, or 4.
Press the switch once again to turn the air
conditioner off.
Interior Features
Climate Control System
5-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page245
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (246,1)
NOTE
The air conditioner may not function when the
outside temperature approaches 0 °C (32 °F).
Air intake selector
This switch controls the source of air
entering the vehicle.
Press the air intake selector switch to
alternate between the outside air and
recirculated air modes.
Recirculated air mode ( )
Outside air is shut off. Air within the
vehicle is recirculated.
Outside air mode ( )
Use this mode for ventilation or
windshield defrosting.
WARNING
Do not use the recirculated air mode in
cold or rainy weather:
Using the recirculated air mode in
cold or rainy weather is dangerous as
it will cause the windows to fog up.
Your vision will be hampered, which
could lead to a serious accident.
qHeating
1. Set the mode selector dial to the
position.
2. Set the air intake selector to the outside
air mode.
3. Set the temperature control dial to the
hot position.
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired
speed.
5. If dehumidified heating is desired, turn
on the air conditioner.
NOTE
lIf the windshield fogs up easily, set the
mode selector dial to the position.
lIf cooler air is desired at face level, set the
mode selector dial at the position and
adjust the temperature control dial to
maintain maximum comfort.
lThe air to the floor is warmer than air to
the face (except when the temperature
control dial is set at the extreme hot or cold
position).
lIn the or position, the air
conditioner is automatically turned on and
the outside air mode is automatically
selected to defrost the windshield. In the
or position, the outside air mode
cannot be changed to the recirculated air
mode.
qCooling (With air conditioner)
1. Set the mode selector dial to the
position.
2. Set the temperature control dial to the
cold position.
3. Set the fan control dial to the desired
speed.
4. Turn on the air conditioner by pressing
the A/C switch.
5. After cooling begins, adjust the fan
control dial and temperature control
dial as needed to maintain maximum
comfort.
5-6
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page246
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (247,1)
CAUTION
If the air conditioner is used while
driving up long hills or in heavy
traffic, monitor the engine coolant
temperature warning light to see if it
is illuminated or flashing (page 4-22).
The air conditioner may cause engine
overheating. If the warning light is
illuminated or flashing, turn the air
conditioning off (page 7-18).
NOTE
lWhen maximum cooling is desired, set the
temperature control dial to the extreme cold
position and set the air intake selector to
the recirculated air mode, then set the fan
control dial to position 4.
lIf warmer air is desired at floor level, set
the mode selector dial at the position
and adjust the temperature control dial to
maintain maximum comfort.
lThe air to the floor is warmer than air to
the face (except when the temperature
control dial is set at the extreme hot or cold
position).
qVentilation
1. Set the mode selector dial to the
position.
2. Set the air intake selector to the outside
air mode.
3. Set the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired
speed.
q
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging
1. Set the mode selector dial to the
position.
2. Set the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
3. Set the fan control dial to the desired
speed.
WARNING
Do not defog the windshield using the
position with the temperature
control set to the cold position:
Using the position with the
temperature control set to the cold
position is dangerous as it will cause
the outside of the windshield to fog
up. Your vision will be hampered,
which could lead to a serious
accident. Set the temperature control
to the hot or warm position when
using the position.
NOTE
lFor maximum defrosting, turn on the air
conditioner, set the temperature control dial
to the extreme hot position, and the fan
control dial to position 4.
lIf warm air is desired at the floor, set the
mode selector dial to the position.
lIn the or position, the air
conditioner is automatically turned on and
the outside air mode is automatically
selected to defrost the windshield. In the
or position, the outside air mode
cannot be changed to the recirculated air
mode.
Interior Features
Climate Control System
5-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page247
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (248,1)
q
Dehumidifying (With air conditioner)
Operate the air conditioner in cool or cold
weather to help defog the windshield and
side windows.
1. Set the mode selector dial to the
desired position.
2. Set the air intake selector to the outside
air mode.
3. Set the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
4. Set the fan control dial to the desired
speed.
5. Turn on the air conditioner by pressing
the A/C switch.
NOTE
One of the functions of the air conditioner is
dehumidifying the air and, to use this function,
the temperature does not have to be set to cold.
Therefore, set the temperature control dial to
the desired position (hot or cold) and turn on
the air conditioner when you want to
dehumidify the cabin air.
5-8
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page248
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (249,1)
Fully Automatic Type
Climate control information is displayed on the display.
Airflow display
Temperature setting display (driver)
Mode selector display A/C
Temperature setting display (passenger)
Air intake selector
(recirculated air
position)
Air intake selector
(outside air position)
Driver temperature control dial
AUTO switch
Mode selector switch
Fan control dial
OFF switch
Windshield defroster switch
Rear window defogger switch
Passenger temperature control dial
DUAL switch
A/C switch
qControl Switches
AUTO switch
By pressing the AUTO switch the
following functions will be automatically
controlled in accordance with the selected
set temperature:
lAirflow temperature
lAmount of airflow
lSelection of airflow mode
lOutside/Recirculated air selection
lAir conditioner operation
NOTE
AUTO switch indicator light
lWhen on, it indicates auto operation, and
the system will function automatically.
lIf any of the following dials or switches are
operated while in auto control, the AUTO
switch indicator turns off.
lMode selector switch
lFan control dial
lWindshield defroster switch
The functions for dials and switches other
than those operated in the above continue
to operate in auto control.
OFF switch
Pressing the OFF switch shuts off the
climate control system.
Interior Features
Climate Control System
5-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page249
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (250,1)
Temperature control dial
This dial controls temperature. Turn it
clockwise for hot and counterclockwise
for cold.
lWhen the DUAL switch is off:
Turn the driver temperature control dial
to control the temperature throughout
the entire cabin.
lWhen the DUAL switch is on:
Turn the driver or front passenger
temperature control dial to
independently control the temperature
on each side of the cabin.
NOTE
lThe climate control system changes to the
individual operation mode (DUAL switch
indicator light illuminated) by turning the
front passenger temperature control dial
even when the DUAL switch is off, which
allows individual control of the set
temperature for the driver and front
passenger.
lThe temperature units for the temperature
setting display can be changed in
conjunction with the temperature units for
the outside temperature display. Refer to
Outside Temperature Display on page 4-14.
Fan control dial
The fan has seven speeds. The selected
speed will be displayed.
Mode selector switch
The desired airflow mode can be selected
(page 5-4).
NOTE
lWith the airflow mode set to the
position and the temperature control dial
set at a medium temperature, heated air is
directed to the feet and air at a comparably
lower temperature will flow through the
central, left and right vents.
lTo set the air vent to , press the
windshield defroster switch.
lIn the or position, the air
conditioner is automatically turned on and
the outside air mode is automatically
selected to defrost the windshield. In the
or position, the outside air mode
cannot be changed to the recirculated air
mode.
A/C switch
Pressing the A/C switch while the AUTO
switch is turned on will turn off the air
conditioning (cooling/dehumidifying
functions).
The air conditioning can be turned on and
off by pressing the A/C switch while the
fan control dial is on.
NOTE
lThe air conditioning operates when the A/C
switch is pressed even if the fan is off.
lThe air conditioner may not function when
the outside temperature approaches 0 °C
(32 °F).
Air intake selector
Outside or recirculated air positions can
be selected. Press the switch to select
outside/recirculated air positions.
Recirculated air position ( )
Use this position when going through
tunnels, driving in congested traffic (high
engine exhaust areas) or when quick
cooling is desired.
5-10
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page250
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (251,1)
Outside air position ( )
Use this mode for ventilation or
windshield defrosting.
WARNING
Do not use the position in cold or
rainy weather:
Using the position in cold or
rainy weather is dangerous as it will
cause the windows to fog up. Your
vision will be hampered, which could
lead to a serious accident.
DUAL switch
Use the DUAL switch to change the mode
between the individual operation (driver
and passenger) and interconnection
(simultaneous) modes.
Individual operation mode (indicator
light illuminated)
The set temperature can be controlled
individually for the driver and front
passenger.
Interconnection mode (indicator light
turned off)
The set temperature for the driver and
front passenger is controlled
simultaneously.
Windshield defroster switch
Press the switch to defrost the windshield
and front door windows.
qOperation of Automatic Air
Conditioning
1. Press the AUTO switch. Selection of
the airflow mode, air intake selector
and amount of airflow will be
automatically controlled.
2. Use the temperature control dial to
select a desired temperature.
Press the DUAL switch or turn the
front passenger temperature control
dial to control the set temperature
individually for the driver and front
passenger.
To turn off the system, press the OFF
switch.
NOTE
lSetting the temperature to maximum high
or low will not provide the desired
temperature at a faster rate.
lWhen selecting heat, the system will restrict
airflow until it has warmed to prevent cold
air from blowing out of the vents.
q
Windshield Defrosting and Defogging
Press the windshield defroster switch.
In this position, the outside air position is
automatically selected, and the air
conditioner automatically turns on. The
air conditioner will directly dehumidify
the air to the front windshield and side
windows (page 5-4). Airflow amount will
be increased.
Interior Features
Climate Control System
5-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page251
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (252,1)
WARNING
Set the temperature control to the hot
or warm position when defogging (
position):
Using the position with the
temperature control set to the cold
position is dangerous as it will cause
the outside of the windshield to fog
up. Your vision will be hampered,
which could lead to a serious
accident.
NOTE
Use the temperature control dial to increase
the air flow temperature and defog the
windshield more quickly.
qSunlight/Temperature Sensor
The fully automatic air conditioner
function measures inside and outside
temperatures, and sunlight. It then sets
temperatures inside the passenger
compartment accordingly.
CAUTION
Do not obstruct either sensor,
otherwise the automatic air
conditioner will not operate properly.
Sunlight sensor
Interior temperature sensor
5-12
Interior Features
Climate Control System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page252
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (253,1)
Antenna
qType A
í
The antenna is embedded into the window
glass.
CAUTION
When washing the inside of the
window which has an antenna, use a
soft cloth dampened in lukewarm
water, gently wiping the antenna
lines.
Use of glass cleaning products could
damage the antenna.
qType B
Operating Tips for Audio
System
WARNING
Always adjust the audio while the
vehicle is stopped:
Do not adjust the audio control
switches while driving the vehicle.
Adjusting the audio while driving the
vehicle is dangerous as it could
distract your attention from the
vehicle operation which could lead to
a serious accident.
Even if the audio control switches are
equipped on the steering wheel, learn
to use the switches without looking
down at them so that you can keep
your maximum attention on the road
while driving the vehicle.
CAUTION
For the purposes of safe driving,
adjust the audio volume to a level
that allows you to hear sounds
outside of the vehicle including car
horns and particularly emergency
vehicle sirens.
NOTE
lTo prevent the battery from being
discharged, do not leave the audio system
on for a long period of time when the
engine is not running.
lIf a cellular phone or CB radio is used in
or near the vehicle, it could cause noise to
occur from the audio system, however, this
does not indicate that the system has been
damaged.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-13
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page253
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (254,1)
Do not spill any liquid on the audio
system.
Do not insert any objects, other than CDs,
into the slot.
qRadio Reception
AM characteristics
AM signals bend around such things as
buildings or mountains and bounce off the
ionosphere.
Therefore, they can reach longer distances
than FM signals.
Because of this, two stations may
sometimes be picked up on the same
frequency at the same time.
Station 2
Station 1
Ionosphere
FM characteristics
An FM broadcast range is usually about
4050 km (2530 miles) from the
source. Because of extra coding needed to
break the sound into two channels, stereo
FM has even less range than monaural
(non-stereo) FM.
FM Station
40—50km
(25—30 miles)
Signals from an FM transmitter are similar
to beams of light because they do not
bend around corners, but they do reflect.
Unlike AM signals, FM signals cannot
travel beyond the horizon. Therefore, FM
stations cannot be received at the great
distances possible with AM reception.
AM wave
FM wave
FM wave
100—200 km (60—120 miles)
Ionosphere
Atmospheric conditions can also affect
FM reception. High humidity will cause
poor reception. However, cloudy days
may provide better reception than clear
days.
5-14
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page254
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (255,1)
Multipath noise
Since FM signals can be reflected by
obstructions, it is possible to receive both
the direct signal and the reflected signal at
the same time. This causes a slight delay
in reception and may be heard as a broken
sound or a distortion. This problem may
also be encountered when in close
proximity to the transmitter.
Reflected wave
Direct
Flutter/Skip noise
Signals from an FM transmitter move in
straight lines and become weak in valleys
between tall buildings, mountains, and
other obstacles. When a vehicle passes
through such an area, the reception
conditions may change suddenly, resulting
in annoying noise.
Weak signal noise
In suburban areas, broadcast signals
become weak because of distance from
the transmitter. Reception in such fringe
areas is characterized by sound breakup.
Strong signal noise
This occurs very close to a transmitter
tower. The broadcast signals are
extremely strong, so the result is noise and
sound breakup at the radio receiver.
Station drift noise
When a vehicle reaches the area of two
strong stations broadcasting at similar
frequencies, the original station may be
temporarily lost and the second station
picked up. At this time there will be some
noise from this disturbance.
Station 2
88.3 MHz
Station 1
88.1 MHz
Interior Features
Audio System
5-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page255
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (256,1)
qOperating Tips for CD Player
Condensation phenomenon
Immediately after turning on the heater
when the vehicle is cold, the CD or
optical components (prism and lens) in the
CD player may become clouded with
condensation. At this time, the CD will
eject immediately when placed in the unit.
A clouded CD can be corrected simply by
wiping it with a soft cloth. Clouded
optical components will clear naturally in
about an hour. Wait for normal operation
to return before attempting to use the unit.
Handling the CD player
The following precautions should be
observed.
lThe CD revolves at high speed within
the unit. Defective (cracked or badly
bent) CDs should never be used.
lDo not use non-conventional discs
such as heart-shaped, octagonal discs,
etc. The disc may not eject resulting in
a malfunction.
lIf the memory portion of the CD is
transparent or translucent, do not use
the disc.
Transparent
lA new CD may have rough edges on
its inner and outer perimeters. If a disc
with rough edges is used, proper
setting will not be possible and the CD
player will not play the CD. In
addition, the disc may not eject
resulting in a malfunction. Remove the
rough edges in advance by using a ball-
point pen or pencil as shown below. To
remove the rough edges, rub the side of
the pen or pencil against the inner and
outer perimeter of the CD.
lWhen driving over uneven surfaces,
the sound may jump.
5-16
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page256
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (257,1)
lThe CD player has been designed to
play CDs bearing the identification
logo as shown below. No other discs
can be played.
lUse discs that have been legitimately
produced. If illegally-copied discs such
as pirated discs are used, the system
may not operate properly.
lBe sure never to touch the signal
surface when handling the CDs. Pick
up a CD by grasping the outer edge or
the edge of the hole and the outer edge.
lDo not stick paper or tape on the CD.
Avoid scratching the reverse side (the
side without a label). The disc may not
eject resulting in a malfunction.
lDust, finger smudges, and dirt can
decrease the amount of light reflected
from the signal surface, thus affecting
sound quality. If the CD should
become soiled, gently wipe it with a
soft cloth from the center of the CD to
the edge.
lDo not use record sprays, antistatic
agents, or household spray cleaners.
Volatile chemicals such as benzine and
thinner can also damage the surface of
the CD and must not be used. Anything
that can damage, warp, or fog plastic
should never be used to clean CDs.
lThe CD player ejects the CD if the CD
is inserted upside down. Also dirty
and/or defective CDs may be ejected.
lDo not insert cleaning discs in the CD
player.
lDo not insert any disc with a peel-off
seal affixed to it.
lThis unit may not be able to play
certain CD-R/CD-RWs made using a
computer or music CD recorder due to
disc characteristics, scratches,
smudges, dirt, etc., or due to dust or
condensation on the lens inside the
unit.
lStoring CDs in the vehicle exposed to
direct sunlight or high temperature may
damage the CD-R/CD-RWs, and make
them unplayable.
lCD-R/CD-RW exceeding 700 MB
cannot be played.
lThis unit may not be able to play
certain discs made using a computer
due to the application (writing
software) setting used. (For details,
consult the store where the application
was purchased.)
lIt is possible that certain text data, such
as titles, recorded on a CD-R/CD-RW
may not be displayed when musical
data (CD-DA) is playing.
lThe period from when a CD-RW is
inserted to when it begins playing is
longer than a normal CD or CD-R.
lCompletely read the instruction manual
and cautions for CD-R/CD-RWs.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page257
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (258,1)
lDo not use discs with cellophane tape
adhering, partially peeled off labels, or
adhesive material exuding from the
edges of the CD label. Also, do not use
discs with a commercially-available
CD-R label affixed. The disc may not
eject resulting in a malfunction.
qOperating Tips for MP3
NOTE
Supply of this product only conveys a license
for private, non-commercial use and does not
convey a license nor imply any right to use this
product in any commercial (i.e. revenue-
generating) real time broadcasting (terrestrial,
satellite, cable and/or any other media),
broadcasting/streaming via the Internet,
intranets and/or other networks or in other
electronic content distribution systems, such as
pay-audio or audio-on-demand applications.
An independent license for such use is
required. For details, please visit
http://www.mp3licensing.com.
lThis audio system handles MP3 files
that have been recorded on CD-R/CD-
RW/CD-ROMs. Discs that have been
recorded using the following formats
can be played:
lISO 9660 level 1
lISO 9660 level 2
lJoliet extended format
lRomeo extended format
lThis unit handles MP3 files
conforming to the MP3 format
containing both header frames and data
frames.
lThis unit can play multi-session
recorded discs that have up to 50
sessions.
lThis unit can play MP3s with sampling
frequencies of 8/11.025/12/16/22.05/
24/32/44.1/48 kHz.
lThis unit can play MP3 files that have
been recorded in bit rates of 8 kbps to
320 kbps. Nonetheless, to insure
enjoyment of music with consistent
sound quality, it is recommended to use
discs that have been recorded at a bit
rate of 128 kbps or more.
lIf a disc has both music data (CD-DA)
and MP3 files, playback of the two file
types differs depending on how the
disc was recorded.
lPacket written discs cannot be played
on this unit.
lThis unit does not play CDs recorded
using MP3i (MP3 interactive), MP3
PRO and RIFF MP3 formats.
About folders and files
lThe arrangement and playing order of a
recorded disc containing MP3 files is
as follows:
05
06
01 02 03
04
1
5
4
2
3
Folder
No.
Level1Level2Level3Level4
Playback may not occur in the above
hierarchy depending on the audio unit.
: Track (File): Folder
5-18
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page258
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (259,1)
lThe folder order is automatically
assigned and this order cannot be
optionally set.
lAny folder without an MP3 file will be
ignored. (It will be skipped and the
folder number will not be displayed.)
lMP3 files not conforming to the MP3
format containing both header frames
and data frames will be skipped and
not played.
lThis unit will play MP3 files that have
up to eight levels. However, the more
levels a disc has, the longer it will take
to initially start playing. It is
recommended to record discs with two
levels or less.
lA single disc with up to 512 files can
be played and a single folder with up to
255 files can be played.
lWhen naming an MP3 file, be sure to
add an MP3 file extension (.mp3) after
the file name.
lThe number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
CAUTION
This unit can only play MP3 files that
have an MP3 file extension (.mp3)
attached. Do not attach an MP3 file
extension to any other type file as it
could cause noise to be emitted or a
malfunction in the unit.
About ID3 Tag display
lThis unit can only display ID3 Tag
album, track and artist names that have
been input using Ver.1.0/1.1/2.2/2.3/2.4
formats. Any other data that may have
been input cannot be displayed.
lThis unit cannot display some
characters. Characters which cannot be
displayed are indicated by an asterisk
().
Specialized glossary
MP3
Abbreviation for MPEG Audio Layer 3.
A technical standard for audio
compression as decided by the ISO
*1
MPEG working group. Use of MP3
allows for audio data to be compressed to
approximately a tenth of the source data
size.
*1 International Organization for
Standardization
ISO 9660
An international standard for logical
formatting of CD-ROM files and folders.
It is divided into three separate levels
based on differences in file naming
procedures, data configuration and other
characteristics.
Multi-session
A session is the complete amount of data
recorded from the beginning to the end of
a single period of CD-ROM, CD-R/CD-
RW data recording. Multi-session refers to
the existence of data from two or more
sessions on a single disc.
Sampling
Refers to the process of encoding analog
audio data at regular intervals and
converting it to digital data. The sampling
rate refers to the number of times a
sample is taken in one second and is
expressed in Hz units. Increasing the
sampling rate improves the sound quality
but also increases the data size.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page259
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (260,1)
Bit rate
Refers to the volume of data per second,
expressed in bps (bits per second).
Generally, the larger the number of the
transfer bit rate when compressing an
MP3 file, the more information regarding
musical reproduction it carries, and
therefore the better the sound quality.
Packet writing
A general term for the method, similar to
that used for floppy discs or hard drives,
of recording the required file in a single
increment on a CD-R and similar.
ID3 Tag
ID3 tag is a method for storing
information related to the music in an
MP3 file. Information such as track, artist
and album name can be stored. This
content can be freely edited using ID3
editing function software.
VBR
Abbreviation for Variable Bit Rate. While
CBR (Constant Bit Rate) is generally
used, VBR varies the bit rate for audio
compression according to compression
conditions and this allows for
compression with preference given to
sound quality.
qOperating Tips for WMA
WMA is short for Windows Media Audio
and is the audio compression format used
by Microsoft.
Audio data can be created and stored at a
higher compression ratio than MP3.
* Microsoft and Windows Media are
registered trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation U.S. in the United States
and other countries.
Playable WMA files are as follows:
Item Content
Specification
Windows Media Audio Version
7.0, 8.0, 9.0 (standard), 10.0
(standard)
Sampling rate 32/44.1/48 kHz
Bit rate 32320 kbps
CAUTION
This unit plays files with the (.wma)
file extension as a WMA file. Do not
use the WMA file extension for files
other than WMA files. Otherwise, it
could result in noise or a
malfunction.
lTrack, artist and album name
information is recorded as data termed
WMA-Tag, and this information is
displayable.
lWMA files written under specifications
other than the indicated specification
may not play normally or files or folder
names may not display correctly.
lThe file extension may not be provided
depending on the computer operating
system, version, software, or settings.
In this case, add the file extension .
wmato the end of the file name, and
then write it to the disc.
qOperating Tips for AAC
AAC stands for Advanced Audio Coding,
which is standardized voice compression
established by the ISO
*1
working group
(MPEG). Audio data can be created and
stored at a higher compression ratio than
MP3.
*1 International Organization for
Standardization
5-20
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page260
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (261,1)
Playable AAC file specifications
This unit supports playback of AAC files
recorded in CD-R and CD-RW.
Playable AAC files are as follows:
Item Content
Specification MPEG-4 AAC
Sampling rate
8/11.025/12 kHz
16/22.05/24 kHz
32/44.1/48 kHz
Bit rate 24320 kbps
CAUTION
This unit plays files with the file
extension (m4a) as an AAC file. Do
not use the AAC file extension for files
other than AAC files. Otherwise, it
could result in noise or a
malfunction.
lSong, artist, and album name
information in the AAC file is recorded
as data termed iTunes, m4a, Meta-
Data applicable, and this information
is displayable.
lAAC files written under specifications
other than the indicated specification
may not play normally or files or folder
names may not display correctly.
lThe file extension may not be provided
depending on the computer operating
system, version, software, or settings.
In this case, add the file extension .
m4ato the end of the file name, then
write it to the disc.
qOperating Tips for USB device
This unit supports playback of MP3/
WMA/AAC files recorded to USB device.
NOTE
lMusic data (MP3/WMA/AAC (.m4a)
format) stored in a USB mass-storage class
compliant device (such as USB flash
memory) can be played.
lPlayback may not be possible depending on
the type and condition of the USB flash
memory even if the audio file complies with
the standard above.
lA copyright protected WMA/AAC file
cannot be played in this unit.
lThe order of the music data stored in the
device may differ from the playback order.
lTo prevent loss or damage of stored data,
we recommend that you always back up
your data.
lIf a device exceeds the maximum electric
current value of 500 mA, it may not operate
or recharge when connected.
lDo not pull out the USB device while in the
USB mode (only pull it out while in FM/AM
radio or CD mode).
lThe device will not operate if the data is
password protected.
Playable MP3 file specifications
Playable MP3 files are as follows:
Item Content
Specification
MPEG1 AUDIO LAYER III
MPEG2 AUDIO LAYER III
MPEG2.5
Sampling rate
44.1/48/32 kHz (MPEG1)
22.05/24/16 kHz (MPEG2)
11.025/12/8 kHz (MPEG2.5)
Bit rate
32320 kbps (MPEG1)
8160 kbps (MPEG2)
8160 kbps (MPEG2.5)
Interior Features
Audio System
5-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page261
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (262,1)
CAUTION
This unit plays files with the file
extension (mp3) as an MP3 file. Do
not use the MP3 file extension for
files other than MP3 files. Otherwise,
it could result in noise or a
malfunction.
lMP3 files written under specifications
other than the indicated specification
may not play normally or files or folder
names may not display correctly.
lThe file extension may not be provided
depending on the computer operating
system, version, software, or settings.
In this case, add the file extension
.mp3to the end of the file name, and
then write it to the memory.
Playable WMA file specification
Playable WMA files are as follows:
Item Content
Specification Windows Media Audio Version
7.0, 8.0, 9.0 (standard)
Sampling rate
8/11.025/12 kHz (LOW)
16/22.05 kHz (MID)
44.1/48/32 kHz (HI)
Bit rate 32320 kbps
CAUTION
This unit plays files with the file
extension (wma) as a WMA file. Do
not use the WMA file extension for
files other than WMA files.
Otherwise, it could result in noise or
a malfunction.
lWMA files written under specifications
other than the indicated specification
may not play normally or files or folder
names may not display correctly.
lThe file extension may not be provided
depending on the computer operating
system, version, software, or settings.
In this case, add the file extension .
wmato the end of the file name, and
then write it to the memory.
Playable AAC file specification
Playable AAC files are as follows:
Item Content
Specification MPEG4 AAC-LC
Sampling rate
8/11.025/12 kHz
16/22.05/24 kHz
32/44.1/48 kHz
Bit rate 16320 kbps
CAUTION
This unit plays files with the file
extension (.aac
*1
/.m4a) as an AAC
file. Do not use the AAC file extension
for files other than AAC files.
Otherwise, it could result in noise or
a malfunction.
*1 Type B
Refer to Audio Set (Type B) on
page 5-35.
lAAC files written under specifications
other than the indicated specification
may not play normally or files or folder
names may not display correctly.
lThe file extension may not be provided
depending on the computer operating
system, version, software, or settings.
In this case, add the file extension .
aac
*1
or .m4ato the end of the file
name, and then write it to the memory.
*1 Type B
Refer to Audio Set (Type B) on
page 5-35.
5-22
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page262
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (263,1)
qOperating Tips for iPod
This unit supports playback of music files
recorded to an iPod.
liPod is a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
liPod classic is a trademark of Apple
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
liPod nano is a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
liPod touch is a trademark of Apple
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
liPhone is a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
Connectable iPods are as follows:
(Type A)
liPod: 5G
liPod classic
liPod nano: 1/2/3/4/5G
liPod touch
*1
: 1/2G
liPhone
*1
: 3G/3GS
*1 Only iPod function
(Type B)
liPod classic
liPod nano: 4/5/6G
liPod touch
*1
: 2/3/4G
liPhone
*1
: 3GS/4/4S
*1 Only iPod function
CAUTION
ØRemove the iPod when it is not in
use. Because the iPod is not
designed to withstand excessive
changes in temperature inside the
cabin, it could be damaged or the
battery may deteriorate due to the
excessive temperature or humidity
inside the cabin if it is left in the
vehicle.
ØIf data in the iPod is lost while it is
connected to the unit, Mazda
cannot guarantee recovery of any
lost data.
ØIf the iPod battery is deteriorated,
the iPod may not recharge and
playback may not be possible
when it is connected to the unit.
Replace the iPod battery
immediately.
ØBe careful not to pinch the iPod
connecting cable when opening/
closing the center console.
ØFor the details on using the iPod,
refer to the iPod instruction
manual.
ØWhen connecting the iPod to a
USB port, all commands are made
from the audio unit. iPod control is
not possible.
NOTE
The audio unit cannot display images or
videos stored in an iPod.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page263
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (264,1)
MEMO
5-24
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page264
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (265,1)
Audio Set (Type A)
Power/Volume/Sound Controls ......................................................................... page 5-26
Operating the Radio ........................................................................................... page 5-28
Operating the Compact Disc (CD) Player .......................................................... page 5-30
How to use auxiliary jack/USB port .................................................................. page 5-33
Error Indications ................................................................................................ page 5-33
Interior Features
Audio System
5-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page265
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (266,1)
qPower/Volume/Sound Controls
Audio control dialPower/Volume dial
Power ON/OFF
Switch the ignition to ACC or ON. Press
the power/volume dial to turn the audio
system on. Press the power/volume dial
again to turn the audio system off.
Volume adjustment
To adjust the volume, turn the power/
volume dial. Turn the power/volume dial
to the right to increase volume, to the left
to decrease it.
Audio sound adjustment
1. Press the audio control dial to select the
function. The selected function will be
indicated.
2. Turn the audio control dial to adjust the
selected functions as follows:
Indication Setting value
Turn Left Turn Right
(Automatic volume
adjustment)
Level
decrease
Level
increase
(Low pitch sound)
Decrease
bass
Increase
bass
(Treble sound)
Decrease
treble
Increase
treble
(Front/back volume
balance)
Shift the
sound to the
front
Shift the
sound to the
rear
(Left/right volume
balance)
Shift the
sound to the
left
Shift the
sound to the
right
(Audio operation sound)
Off On
5-26
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page266
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (267,1)
NOTE
About 5 seconds after selecting any mode, the
volume function will be automatically selected.
To reset bass, treble, fade, and balance, press
the audio control dial for 2 seconds. The unit
will beep and CLEARwill be displayed.
Automatic Level Control (ALC)
The automatic level control (ALC)
changes the audio volume automatically
according to the vehicle speed. The faster
the vehicle speed, the higher the volume
increases. ALC has ALC OFF and ALC
LEVEL 1 to 7 modes. At ALC LEVEL 7,
the amount that the volume can increase is
at the maximum. Select the mode
according to the driving conditions.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page267
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (268,1)
qOperating the Radio
Seek tuning buttons
Band selector buttons
Scan button
Auto memory button
Manual tuning/Audio control dial
Channel preset buttons
Radio ON
Press a band selector button ( )to
turn the radio on.
Band selection
Successively pressing the band selector
button ( ) switches the bands as
follows: FM1FM2AM.
The selected mode will be indicated. If
FM stereo is being received, STwill be
displayed.
NOTE
If the FM broadcast signal becomes weak,
reception automatically changes from
STEREO to MONO for reduced noise, and the
STindicator will go out.
Tuning
The radio has the following tuning
methods: Manual, Seek, Scan, Preset
channel, and Auto memory tuning. The
easiest way to tune stations is to set them
on preset channels.
NOTE
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows
or the battery is disconnected), the preset
channels will be erased.
Manual tuning
Turning the manual tuning dial will
change the frequency higher or lower.
Seek tuning
Pressing the seek tuning button ( , )
will cause the tuner to seek a higher or
lower frequency automatically.
NOTE
If you continue to press and hold the seek
tuning button ( , ), the frequency will
continue changing without stopping.
Scan tuning
Press the scan button ( )to
automatically sample strong stations.
Scanning stops at each station for about 5
seconds. To hold a station, press the scan
button ( ) again during this interval.
Preset channel tuning
The 6 preset channels can be used to store
6 AM and 12 FM stations.
1. To set a channel first select AM, FM1,
or FM2. Tune to the desired station.
5-28
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page268
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (269,1)
2. Depress a channel preset button for
about 2 seconds until a beep is heard.
The preset channel number or station
frequency will be displayed. The
station is now held in the memory.
3. Repeat this operation for the other
stations and bands you want to store.
To tune one in the memory, select AM,
FM1, or FM2 and then press its
channel preset button. The station
frequency or the channel number will
be displayed.
Auto memory tuning
This is especially useful when driving in
an area where the local stations are not
known.
Press and hold the auto memory button
() for about 2 seconds until a beep
is heard; the system will automatically
scan and temporarily store up to 6 stations
with the strongest frequencies in each
selected band in that area.
After scanning is completed, the station
with the strongest frequency will be tuned
and its frequency displayed. Press and
release the auto memory button ( )
to recall stations from the auto-stored
stations. One stored station will be
selected each time; its frequency and
channel number will be displayed.
NOTE
If no stations can be tuned after scanning
operations, Awill be displayed.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page269
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (270,1)
qOperating the Compact Disc (CD) Player
Track up/Fast-forward button
Load button
Track down/Reverse button
Folder up button
Folder down button
Text button
Scan button
CD play button
CD eject buttonRepeat button
Random button
CD slot
File dial
Type Playable data
Music/MP3/WMA/
AAC CD player
lMusic data (CD-DA)
lMP3/WMA/AAC file
NOTE
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA) and
MP3/WMA/AAC files, playback of the two or
three file types differs depending on how the
disc was recorded.
Inserting the CD
Insert the CD into the slot, label-side up.
The auto-loading mechanism will set the
CD and begin play.
NOTE
There will be a short lapse before play begins
while the player reads the digital signals on
the CD.
Ejecting the CD
Press the CD eject button ( ) to eject the
CD.
Playback
Press the CD play button ( ) to start
play when a CD is in the unit. If a CD is
not in the unit when the CD play button
() is pressed, NO DISCwill flash on
and off.
NOTE
When the load button ( ) is pressed, the
CD will load and play.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed. Press and hold the reverse button
() to reverse through a track at high
speed.
Track search
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
5-30
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page270
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (271,1)
Folder search (during MP3/WMA/AAC
CD playback)
To change to the previous folder, press the
folder down button ( ), or press the
folder up button ( ) to advance to the
next folder.
Music scan
During music CD playback
This function scans the titles on a CD and
plays 10 seconds of each song to aid you
in finding a song you want to listen to.
Press the scan button ( ) during
playback to start the scan play operation
(the track number will flash). Press the
scan button ( ) again to cancel scan
playback.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
This function scans the titles in a folder
currently being played and plays 10
seconds of each song to aid you in finding
a song you want to listen to. Press the
scan button ( ) during playback to
start the scan play operation (the track
number will flash).
Press the scan button ( ) again to
cancel scan playback.
NOTE
If the unit is left in scan, normal playback will
resume where scan was selected.
Repeat playback
During music CD playback
Press the repeat button (1) during
playback to repeat the playback of the
current song. TRACK RPTis displayed
during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) while
displaying the TRACK RPTto cancel.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
(Track repeat)
Press the repeat button (1) during
playback to repeat the playback of the
current song. TRACK RPTis displayed
during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) two times
while displaying the TRACK RPTto
cancel.
(Folder repeat)
Press the repeat button (1) two times
during playback to repeat the playback of
the current song in the folder. FOLDER
RPTis displayed during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) while
displaying FOLDER RPTto cancel.
Random playback
During music CD playback
Press the random button (2) during
playback to play the tracks in the CD
randomly. DISC RDMis displayed
during playback.
Press the random button (2) while
displaying DISC RDMto cancel.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
(Folder random)
Press the random button (2) during
playback to play the tracks in the folder
randomly. FOLDER RDMis displayed
during playback.
Press the random button (2) two times
while displaying FOLDER RDMto
cancel.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page271
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (272,1)
(CD random)
Press the random button (2) two times
during playback to play the songs on the
CD randomly. DISC RDMis displayed
during playback.
Press the random button (2) while
displaying DISC RDMto cancel.
Switching the display
For files with a file name and other
information that have been input, the
display switches between display of the
file name and other information each time
the text button ( ) is pressed during
playback.
Music CD (If CD-TEXT capable)
Track name
Album name
Artist name
Track number/Elapsed time
MP3/WMA/AAC CD
File name
Folder name
Album name
Song name
Artist name
Folder number/File number
File number/Elapsed time
NOTE
lThe information viewable in the display is
only CD information (such as artist name,
song title) which has been recorded to the
CD.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
Display scroll
Only 9 characters (File name) or 13
characters (Except file name) can be
displayed at one time. To display the rest
of the characters of a long title, press and
hold the text button ( ). The display
scrolls the next 13 characters. Press and
hold the text button ( ) again after
the last 13 characters have been displayed
to return to the beginning of the title.
5-32
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page272
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (273,1)
NOTE
The number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Message display
If CHECK CDis displayed, it means
that there is some CD malfunction. Check
the CD for damage, dirt, or smudges, and
then properly reinsert. If the message
appears again, take the unit to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.
q
How to use Auxiliary jack/USB port
Audio can be heard from the vehicle's
speakers by connecting a commercially-
available portable audio unit to the
auxiliary jack.
Use a commercially-available, non-
impedance (3.5 ) stereo mini plug cable.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer for
details.
In addition, audio can be played from the
vehicle audio device by connecting a USB
device or an iPod to the USB port.
Refer to AUX/USB/iPod mode on page
5-58.
qError Indications
If you see an error indication on the
display, find the cause in the chart. If you
cannot clear the error indication, take the
vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Indication Cause Solution
CHECK CD
CD is
inserted
upside
down
Insert the CD properly. If
the error indication
continues to display,
consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
CD is
defective
Insert another CD
properly. If the error
indication continues to
display, consult an
Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page273
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (274,1)
MEMO
5-34
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page274
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (275,1)
Audio Set (Type B)
CAUTION
Do not press the screen strongly or press it with a sharp-pointed object. Otherwise,
the screen could be damaged.
Power/Volume/Display/Sound Controls ............................................................ page 5-36
Operating the Radio ........................................................................................... page 5-40
Operating the Satellite Radio ............................................................................. page 5-44
Operating the Compact Disc (CD) Player .......................................................... page 5-52
How to use Auxiliary jack/USB port ................................................................. page 5-55
Error Indications ................................................................................................ page 5-55
Setup .................................................................................................................. page 5-55
Interior Features
Audio System
5-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page275
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (276,1)
qPower/Volume/Display/Sound Controls
Setup button
Audio control dial
Audio button
Phone button
Navigation button
Power/Volume dial
Power ON/OFF
Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on. Press the power/volume
dial again to turn the audio system off.
Volume adjustment
To adjust the volume, turn the power/
volume dial.
Turn the power/volume dial to the right to
increase volume, to the left to decrease it.
Display setting
Press the setup button ( ) to display
the display setting screen.
Touch the on-screen tab to select
the item you would like to change.
Brightness adjustment
: Increase brightness
: Decrease brightness
Contrast adjustment
: Higher contrast
: Lower contrast
Tint adjustment
*1
: Green tint enhancement color
: Red tint enhancement color
*1 Adjustment can be performed only
while in the rear view camera mode.
Color adjustment
*1
: To deepen a color
: To fade a color
*1 Adjustment can be performed only
while in the rear view camera mode.
Daytime/nighttime screen setting
*1
The daytime or nighttime screen can be
selected even if the headlights are
illuminated or turned off (when bright
screen is required at night or dark screen
is required at noon).
: Daytime screen setting
: Nighttime screen setting
: Switches screen automatically
according to headlight illumination
condition
*1 The setting cannot be made while in
rear view camera mode.
Display OFF
The display can be turned off. Touch the
on-screen button to turn the
display off.
5-36
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page276
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (277,1)
The display can be turned back on as
follows:
lPress the audio button ( )to
display the audio screen.
lPress the navigation button ( )to
display the navigation screen.
lPress the phone button ( )to
display the Bluetooth
®
dial screen.
lPress the setup button ( )to
display the setup dial setting screen.
lPress the audio control dial to display
the setup sound setting screen.
lShift to the R position to change to the
rear view camera mode.
Shift to a position other than R to
return to the display off condition.
NOTE
The screen can also be turned off using voice
recognition.
Refer to Voice Recognition on page 5-81.
Display setting reset
All of the screen setting values can be
reset to their initial settings.
1. Touch the on-screen button.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
Audio sound adjustment
Press the audio control dial or touch the
on-screen button to display the
sound setting screen.
Indication Setting value
Bass
(Low pitch sound)
: Low pitch
enhancement
: Low pitch
reduction
Treble
(Treble sound)
: Treble
enhancement
: Treble reduction
Balance
(Left/right volume
balance)
: Right side
volume reduction
: Left side
volume reduction
Fader
(Front/back volume
balance)
: Front speaker
volume reduction
: Rear speaker
volume reduction
Button Beep
(Audio operation sound) : on/off
*1
Auto Level Control
*2
(Automatic volume
adjustment)
: Level up
: Level down
AudioPilot
*3
(Automatic volume
adjustment)
: on/off
Centerpoint
*3
(Automatic surround
level adjustment)
: on/off
*1 Some functions do not turn off
*2 Standard audio
*3 Bose
®
Sound System
Automatic Level Control (ALC)
The automatic level control is a feature
that automatically adjusts audio volume
and sound quality according to the vehicle
speed. The volume increases in
accordance with the increase in vehicle
speed, and decreases as vehicle speed
decreases.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-37
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page277
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (278,1)
AudioPilot
®
2
*4
AudioPilot
®
2 automatically adjusts audio
volume and sound quality in accordance
with the level of noise entering the vehicle
interior while driving. When AudioPilot
®
2 is turned on, the system automatically
calculates the conditions for optimum
hearing of sound which may be difficult
to hear depending on exterior noise.
AudioPilot
®
2 can be set on or off.
*4 AudioPilot
®
2 is a registered
trademark of Bose Corporation.
Centerpoint
®*5
Centerpoint
®
offers you the experience of
5.1-channel surround sound in your
vehicle even with your conventional 2-
channel stereo CDs. Centerpoint
®
can be
set on or off.
*5 Centerpoint
®
is a registered trademark
of Bose Corporation.
NOTE
lCenterpoint
®
operates optimally with a 2-
channel stereo CD. Audio files encoded
with high compression can be played,
however, they may result in poor sound
quality.
lCenterpoint
®
is available for 2-channel
stereo audio except for AM radio/FM radio/
AUX/Bluetooth® audio.
Sound setting reset
The settings for bass, treble, balance, and
fade can be returned to their initial
settings.
1. Touch the on-screen button.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
5-38
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page278
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (279,1)
MEMO
5-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page279
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (280,1)
qOperating the Radio
Seek tuning buttons
Manual tuning dial
Audio button
Radio ON
(Connected Satellite Radio)
Press the audio button ( ) and touch
the on-screen tab.
(Unconnected Satellite Radio)
Press the audio button ( ) and touch
the or on-screen tab.
Band selection
(Connected Satellite Radio)
Touch the on-screen tab to switch
the band as follows:
FM1FM2AM
NOTE
lis displayed when FM1 is selected,
is displayed when FM2 is
selected, and is displayed when AM
is selected.
lIf the FM broadcast signal becomes weak,
reception automatically changes from
STEREO to MONO for reduced noise, and
the STEREOindicator will no longer
display.
(Unconnected Satellite Radio)
Touch the on-screen tab to select
AM. Touch the on-screen tab to
select FM1 and FM2.
NOTE
lWhen FM1 is selected, is displayed.
When FM2 is selected, is displayed.
lIf the FM broadcast signal becomes weak,
reception automatically changes from
STEREO to MONO for reduced noise, and
the STEREOindicator will no longer
display.
Tuning
The radio has the following tuning
methods: Manual, Seek, Scan, Preset
channel, and Auto memory tuning. The
easiest way to tune stations is to set them
on preset channels.
NOTE
If the power supply is interrupted (fuse blows
or the battery is disconnected), the preset
channels will be erased.
Manual tuning
Turning the manual tuning dial will
change the frequency higher or lower.
NOTE
When an broadcast is being
received, a receivable multicast channel is also
received.
5-40
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page280
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (281,1)
Seek tuning
Pressing the seek tuning button ( , )
will cause the tuner to seek a higher or
lower frequency automatically.
NOTE
lIf you continue to press and hold the seek
tuning button ( , ) the frequency will
continue changing without stopping.
lWhen an broadcast is being
received, a receivable multicast channel is
also received.
Scan tuning
You can search for receivable radio
stations by touching the on-screen
button.
Scanning stops at each station for about
five seconds.
Touch the on-screen button one time
during reception to continue receiving a
broadcasting station.
Preset channel tuning
The six preset channels can be used to
store six AM and twelve FM stations.
1. To set a channel, first select AM, FM1,
or FM2. Tune to the desired station.
2. Press and hold any of the preset on-
screen buttons. The reception
frequency is programmed and
displayed on the preset button.
3. Repeat this operation for the other
stations and bands you want to store.
When receiving a programmed
frequency, select AM, FM1, or FM2
and touch the preset on-screen button.
NOTE
The programmed frequency is displayed on the
preset button.
Auto memory tuning
This is especially useful when driving in
an area where the local stations are
unknown. Additional AM/FM stations
can be stored without disturbing the
previously set channels.
1. Touch the on-screen button. The
auto memory preset list is displayed
and the previously tuned frequency is
received.
2. Touch the on-screen button to
display the frequencies of up to ten
radio stations on the auto memory
preset list.
3. Touch the desired frequency.
NOTE
Touch the on-screen button during
auto memory tuning to return to the AM/FM
main screen.
Radio Broadcast Data System (RBDS)
Radio text information display
A maximum of 64 characters of radio text
information sent from a broadcasting
station is displayed in the audio display.
NOTE
Radio text information is a function of FM
radio. Text information is not displayed in the
following:
lDuring reception
lNot an RBDS broadcast
lDuring HD reception
lRBDS broadcast, but radio text is not
transmitted from the radio station
Interior Features
Audio System
5-41
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page281
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (282,1)
Genre Seek
Some FM stations transmit Genre codes
(Program type like a Rock, News, and so
on). This code enables alternative stations
transmitting the same Genre code to be
found quickly. To select from the genre
list, touch the on-screen button
while in the FM mode and the desired
Genre Seek.
(To scan for Genre Seek:)
1. Touch the genre type which you want
to select.
2. Touch the , on-screen
button.
Ex.)
89.3 is currently being received. With
Rock selected as the Genre, the radio
stations broadcasting Rock are at the
following frequencies.
98.3
*1
, 98.7, 104.3
*1
, 107.1
*1 Radio stations with good reception
The frequency changes as follows each
time the Genre Seek on-screen button is
pressed.
89.398.3104.398.3
NOTE
lOnly one Genre can be selected.
lTouch the on-screen button to
return to the FM1 or FM2 main screen.
lIt may not be possible to receive any station
even if the Genre Seek function is used.
lIf a program in the selected genre is not
broadcast to a region, reception is not
possible even if the Genre Seek function is
used.
lThe Genre Seek function searches for genre
code (program type) which FM analog
broadcasts transmit. specialty
programs (HD2-HD8) cannot be searched
because they are not FM analog
broadcasts.
lIf radio stations which are selected by
scanning using the Genre Seek function are
broadcasting stations, they are
changed from analog broadcasts to
broadcasts after a few seconds
if the reception conditions are good. The
genre is displayed after the switch,
however, the genre for FM analog
broadcasts may differ.
HD Radio
What is HD RadioTechnology and
how does it work?
HD RadioTechnology is the digital
evolution of analog AM/FM radio. Your
radio product has a special receiver which
allows it to receive digital broadcasts
(where available) in addition to the analog
broadcasts it already receives. Digital
broadcasts have better sound quality than
analog broadcasts as digital broadcasts
provide free, crystal clear audio. For more
information, and a guide to available radio
stations and programming, please visit
www.hdradio.com.
5-42
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page282
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (283,1)
Benefits of HD RadioTechnology
(Information)
The song title, artist name and genre will
appear on the screen when available by
the radio station.
(Multicast)
On the FM radio frequency most digital
stations have multipleor supplemental
programs on each FM station.
Listening to HD RadioTechnology
If turns on by selecting a radio
station which is an
broadcasting station, the analog broadcast
is switched to an broadcast
automatically after a few seconds and then
received. For FM, , and for AM,
is displayed, and the illuminates
in orange.
If the HD Radio broadcast is stopped and
changed to an analog broadcast, press
down to turn off .
Multicast channel selection (FM)
Press on-screen button to
switch to the multi-cast channel for the
displayed number.
The number of multi-cast channels which
can be received differs depending on the
radio station.
NOTE
lIf an analog broadcast is received once and
is received while HD1 is
selected, the audio unit switches to the
station automatically.
lWhen the button is
illuminated, there could be a noticeable
difference in sound quality and volume
when a change from digital to analog
signals occurs. If the sound quality and
volume become noticeably diminished or
cut off, touch the HD button to turn off
( button is not
illuminated).
lOnce an analog broadcast is received when
HD1 is selected from the preset channels, it
is switched to automatically. If
the radio reception conditions are poor, or
is off, switching to
broadcasts is not possible.
lWhen an HD specialty channel (HD2 to
HD8) is selected from the preset channels,
No HD signalis displayed and no audio
is output until is received. If
the radio reception conditions are poor,
No HD signalcontinues to be displayed.
lIf the is not illuminated or does not
illuminate in orange, information such as
song titles of the station are
received, however, the audio output is
analog. If information can no longer be
received and the non-reception condition
continues, and on-
screen buttons disappear.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-43
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page283
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (284,1)
qOperating the Satellite Radio
í
Seek tuning buttons
Manual tuning dial
Audio button
What is satellite radio?
With over 130 channels, SIRIUS Satellite
Radio brings you more of what you love.
Get channels and channels of commercial-
free music, plus sports, news, talk,
entertainment and more.
Commercial-free music from nearly
every genre rock to pop, hip-hop to
country, jazz, classical and more. Plus live
performances and artist-dedicated
channels.
Live sports Play-by-Play & Expert Talk
every NFL game, every NASCAR
®
race, 24/7 sports talk, college sports and
more.
Exclusive entertainment, comedy and
talk The biggest names, compelling
talk, hilarious comedy.
World-class news plus local traffic and
weather.
Sign up for SIRIUS Satellite Radio today!
NOTE
Exclusive to Sirius. If your vehicle is equipped
with Sirius, your new Mazda includes a free
introductory subscription with a limited term
trial offer. Call 888-539-7474 to activate. For
more information, visit www.siriusxm.com.
Satellite radio is only available in regions
providing satellite radio service (some areas of
the United States and Canada). Contact
Authorized Mazda Dealer for details.
How to Activate Satellite Radio
You must call SIRIUS to activate your
service. Activation is free and takes only a
few minutes.
SIRIUS service uses an ID code to
identify your radio. This code is needed to
activate SIRIUS service, and report any
problems.
Please have the following information
ready:
lSIRIUS ID (12-digit electronic serial
no, or ESN
*1
)
lValid credit card information (may not
be required at initial sign-up)
*1 ESN: Electronic Serial Number
5-44
Interior Features
í
Some models.
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page284
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (285,1)
Be sure you are parked outside with a
clear view of open sky, you will be
instructed to turn on your radio (in
SIRIUS mode and tuned to channel 184).
Activation typically takes only 25
minutes.
Displaying the SIRIUS ID (ESN)
Turn the manual tuning dial and select
channel 0 to display the twelve-digit
Electronic Serial Number (ESN) for the
SIRIUS tuner.
SIRIUS operation
All operations of the satellite radio are
conducted by means of the audio unit.
SIRIUS radio mode selection
Touch the on-screen tab on the
audio screen to receive the previously
received SIRIUS channel.
Every time the on-screen tab is
touched, the bank changes in the order
shown below.
SIRIUS1 SIRIUS2 SIRIUS3
NOTE
lSIRIUS1, SIRIUS2 and SIRIUS3: six
stations can be stored in each bank for
convenient access to your favorite stations.
lis displayed when SIRIUS1 is
selected, is displayed when
SIRIUS2 is selected, and is
displayed when SIRIUS3 is selected.
Operation in the initial state
It may take some time to start up the
equipment when it is in the initial state,
when there is a change in the user's
subscription condition, when the firmware
is updated or when the SIRIUS channel
map is changed.
Updating Channels XXX %is
displayed when the SIRIUS channel map
is changed.
If the user contract content is changed,
Subscription Updatedis displayed.
When the firmware is updated, the
Updating Receiveris displayed.
Updating could take as long as a few
minutes depending on the geographical
area. When the unit is in an initialized
state, channel 184 is displayed after the
display indicates Updating Receiver.
NOTE
Do not perform the following operation while
Updating Channels XXX %,Updating
Receiveris displayed. Otherwise, the
updating procedure will be canceled.
lTurning off the audio power
lSwitching to other modes
lSwitching the ignition off
When the SIRIUS mode is switched to
another mode, or when the power is
turned off, the present channel which is
being received is stored as the last
channel.
Channel up
Turn the manual tuning dial to the right or
press the seek up button ( ).
Channel down
Turn the manual tuning dial to the left or
press the seek down button ( ).
Interior Features
Audio System
5-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page285
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (286,1)
NOTE
The channel is continuously switched to the
next or previous channel while the seek tuning
button ( , ) is continuously pressed.
Unsubscribed channel
When a channel which has been preset
becomes unsubscribed or the current
channel being listened to becomes
unsubscribed, the following is displayed:
Call 888-539-SIRIUS
to subscribe
NOTE
When the subscription contract is canceled, all
of the channels including channel 184 appear
as unsubscribed.
Preset channel programming
1. Select the desired channel to be
programmed.
2. Long-press any of the preset on-screen
buttons.
NOTE
Six stations can be stored in each bank,
SIRIUS1, SIRIUS2 and SIRIUS3 for
convenient access to your favorite stations.
Preset channel call-up
Touch the preset on-screen button for the
channel which you want to select.
NOTE
In the initial setting, all channels are preset to
184.
Selection from channel list
Receivable channels can be displayed on
the channel list screen. You can easily
select the channel you want to listen from
the list. Each category can be also
displayed.
1. Touch the on-screen button.
2. Touch the channel you want to listen
from the list.
NOTE
Currently available channels (including
parental locked channels) are all displayed in
the list.
(Select from category list)
1. Touch the on-screen
button on the channel list screen.
2. Touch the category name which you
want to select from the list.
NOTE
A category can be set only when a channel
which belongs to a category is being received.
Scan tuning
Touch the on-screen button to
automatically sample stations. Scanning
stops at each station for about five
seconds.
To hold a station, touch the on-
screen button again during this interval.
NOTE
Unsubscribed channels, invalid channels,
parental lock channels and channel 0 are not
subject to the scan, therefore these channels
will skip automatically.
Channel number, channel name,
category name, artist name, song titles
and information display
The information regarding the channel
which is currently being received is
displayed.
NOTE
If channels have not been subscribed to or
parental locked, the channel name, category
name, artist name, song title and information
is not displayed.
5-46
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page286
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (287,1)
Display scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of the title. When the last
character is displayed, touch the on-
screen button to display the first character
of the title.
NOTE
The on-screen button is displayed only if a
whole title cannot be displayed at one time.
Instant replay
This function allows you to rewind and
replay the program that you were
previously or are currently listening to.
When the on-screen button is
touched, playback starts from the
beginning of the current program.
When the on-screen button is
touched twice, playback starts from the
beginning of the previous program.
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to reverse the program while the
button is being pressed.
When the on-screen button is
touched, playback starts from the
beginning of the next program.
When the on-screen button is
touched while the last program is being
played, the instant replay mode is
canceled.
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to fast-forward the program while
the button is being pressed.
When touching and holding the button
until the end of the program, the instant
replay mode is canceled.
Instant replay (PAUSE)
If the on-screen button is touched,
instant replay mode is turned on in a
paused condition (PAUSE).
Touch the on-screen button again
to resume playback from the point at
which it was paused.
Parental lock
Parental lock, parental unlock, parental
lock code change, and parental lock code
reset can be set.
NOTE
lTouch the on-screen button during
all the settings to return to the previous
display.
lTouch the on-screen button during the
code and master code input to delete an
input number.
lIf only a four-digit code or master code is
input, Donecan be selected.
lIf the registered code has been forgotten,
reset the code in Initialize Parental Code
to [0000].
Parental lock
If a channel is locked, the channel is
muted.
1. Turn the manual tuning dial to select
the desired channel.
2. Touch the on-screen button to
display the settings screen.
3. Touch the on-screen
button to display the parental lock
settings screen.
4. Input Parental Codeis displayed, and
input of the registered code is possible.
To enter a number, use the numerical
keypad.
5. After inputting the four digits, touch
the on-screen button to confirm
the four digits.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-47
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page287
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (288,1)
6. If the four digits match the registered
code, Channel XXX lockedappears
and mute is turned on. If they do not
match the registered code, Wrong
codeappears and then the display
returns to Input Parental Code.
Parental unlock
Channels locked using the parental lock
function can be unlocked.
1. Select a channel to be unlocked by
turning the manual tuning dial.
2. Touch the on-screen button to
display the settings screen.
3. Touch the on-screen
button to display the parental unlock
settings screen.
4. Input Parental Codeis displayed, and
input of the registered code is possible.
To enter a number, use the numerical
keypad.
5. After inputting the four digits, touch
the on-screen button to confirm
the four digits.
6. If the four digits match the registered
code, Channel XXX unlocked
appears and mute is canceled. If they
do not match the registered code,
Wrong codeappears and then the
display returns to Input Parental
Code.
Parental-lock code change
When changing the code, the new code is
input after the previous one is input first.
1. Touch the on-screen button to
display the settings screen.
2. Touch the on-
screen button to display the code
change screen.
3. Enter Current Codeis displayed, and
input of the registered code is possible.
To enter a number, use the numerical
keypad.
4. After inputting the four digits, touch
the on-screen button to confirm
the four digits.
5. If the four digits match the registered
code, Enter New Codeis displayed.
If they do not match the registered
code, Wrong codeappears and then
the display returns to Enter Current
Code. To enter a number, use the
numerical keypad.
6. After inputting the four digits, touch
the on-screen button to confirm
the four digits.
7. Code changedappears to indicate
that the new code input has been
completed.
8. The display returns to its normal
display.
NOTE
Channels locked before changing the code
remain after changing the code. To unlock a
channel, input the changed code.
Parental-lock code reset
If the registered code has been forgotten,
reset the code to the default [0000] code.
1. Touch the on-screen button to
display the settings screen.
2. Touch the on-
screen button to display the code initial
screen.
3. Enter Master Codeis displayed, and
input of the registered code is possible.
To enter a number, use the numerical
keypad.
5-48
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page288
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (289,1)
NOTE
Master code:
The Master Code is used to initialize or re-
initialize the code in the event that the code is
not set to [0000] and/or the personalized code
is not known. The initialization process resets
the code to [0000]. The master code can
potentially defeat the intent of the security of
the parental lock if it is located by persons not
authorized by the owner to access certain
channels.
SIRIUS Satellite Radio Master Code: [0913]
4. After inputting the four digits, touch
the on-screen button to confirm
the four digits.
5. If the four digits match the master
code, Code initializedappears. If
they do not match the master code,
Wrong codeappears and the display
returns to Enter Master Code.
6. The code returns to the default [0000]
code.
Seek alert
The song title and artist name for the song
currently being listened to, and team
names at the sports game currently being
listened to can be recorded as favorites.
The user is notified when a program
begins which has favorites-related
information recorded.
Selection from seek alert program list
Select the station you want to listen to
from the list to receive the program.
Touch the on-screen button to
return to the receiving screen.
Storing songs, artists, and sports team
names
NOTE
lA maximum of 10 songs, artists, and sports
team names each can be stored.
lIf the song title, artist name, sports team
name cannot be displayed, No available
items for this programis displayed.
lEven if the song title, and artist name are
displayed in the main screen, it may not be
possible to record information for old
songs.
lIf a song name is stored, the song seek
function is turned on.
lIf an artist name is stored, the artist seek
function is turned on.
lIf a sports team name is stored, the game
alert function is turned on.
1. Touch the on-screen button to
display the current song and artist
names currently being received. The
sports team name is displayed while
the sports program is being received.
2. Select the item you want to store from
song title, artist name and sports team
name.
3. XXXXX (song, artist, sports team
name) storedis displayed.
NOTE
If there is not enough available storage space,
Song Memory Fullor Artist Memory Full
or Team Memory Fulland Delete one to
store new oneare displayed. Delete from the
list.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page289
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (290,1)
Seek alert setting
On or off switching to song seek, artist
seek, or game alert function, and deletion
of stored information can be performed.
Touch the on-screen button and the
on-screen button. Touch the button
you want to change from ,,or
.
(On or off switching)
Touch the , , and
on-screen button.
(Deletion)
1. Select song title, artist name, or sports
team name that you want to delete from
the list.
2. Touch the on-screen button to
display XXXXX (song, artist, sports
team name) deleted.
5-50
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page290
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (291,1)
MEMO
5-51
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page291
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (292,1)
qOperating the Compact Disc (CD) Player
CD slot
Audio button
CD eject button
Track up/Fast-forward
button
Track down/Reverse
button
File dial
Type Playable data
Music/MP3/WMA/
AAC CD player
lMusic data (CD-DA)
lMP3/WMA/AAC file
NOTE
If a disc has both music data (CD-DA) and
MP3/WMA/AAC files, playback of the two or
three file types differs depending on how the
disc was recorded.
Inserting the CD
Insert the CD into the slot, label-side up.
The auto-loading mechanism will set the
CD and begin play.
NOTE
There will be a short lapse before play begins
while the player reads the digital signals on
the CD.
Ejecting the CD
Press the CD eject button ( ) to eject the
CD.
Playback
Press the audio button ( )or
on-screen tab with a CD inserted.
Pause
To pause playback, touch the on-
screen button.
Touch the on-screen button during
a pause to cancel it.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Operations using audio panel
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed.
Press and hold the reverse button ( )to
reverse through a track at high speed.
Operations on screen
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to advance through a track at high
speed.
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to reverse through a track at high
speed.
5-52
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page292
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (293,1)
Track search
Operations using audio panel
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Operations on screen
Touch the on-screen button once to
skip forward to the beginning of the next
track.
Touch the on-screen button within
a few seconds after playback begins to
track down to the beginning of the
previous track.
Touch the on-screen button after a
few seconds have elapsed to start
playback from the beginning of the
current track.
Displaying file list
The desired file list in the CD can be
viewed.
During music CD playback
Touch the on-screen button to display
the track list in the CD.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
(Viewing file list in desired folder)
1. Touch the on-screen button to
display the folder list in the CD.
2. Touch the folder which you want to
select.
(Viewing file list of current folder)
Touch the on-screen button.
Selecting file/track
Select the file/track you want to play.
During music CD playback
1. Touch the on-screen button to
display the track list in the CD.
2. Touch the track you want to play.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
NOTE
Press the on-screen button on the file list
screen to display the list of folders.
(Selection from all folders in CD)
1. When the on-screen button is
touched, the folder list in the CD is
displayed.
2. Select the folder name from the
displayed list.
3. The files in the selected folder are
displayed.
4. Select the file you want to play.
(Selection from inside folder in which a
song is currently being played)
1. Press the on-screen button to
select the song list.
2. Touch the song you want to listen to.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-53
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page293
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (294,1)
Music scan
During music CD playback
This function scans the titles on a CD and
plays 10 seconds of each song to aid you
in finding a song you want to listen to.
1. Touch the on-screen button
during playback to play 10 seconds of
each subsequent track starting from the
next song.
2. Touch the on-screen button
during playback of the song you want
to listen to and continue the playback
from that point.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
This function scans the titles in a folder
currently being played and plays 10
seconds of each song to aid you in finding
a song you want to listen to.
1. Touch the on-screen button
during playback to play 10 seconds of
each subsequent track starting from the
next song.
2. Touch the on-screen button
during playback of the song you want
to listen to and continue the playback
from that point.
NOTE
lIf the unit is left in scan, normal playback
will resume where scan was selected.
lIf all the tracks are scanned, the unit will
resume normal playback.
Repeat playback
During music CD playback
Touch the on-screen button during
playback to play the song currently being
played repeatedly.is displayed
during playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
(Track repeat)
Touch the on-screen button to play
the song during playback repeatedly.
is displayed during playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
(Folder repeat)
Touch the on-screen button two
times to play the songs in the folder
repeatedly. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
Shuffle playback
During music CD playback
Touch the on-screen button during
playback to play the songs in the CD
shuffle. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
During MP3/WMA/AAC CD playback
(Folder shuffle)
Touch the on-screen button during
playback to play the songs in the folder
shuffle. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
(CD shuffle)
Touch the on-screen button two
times during playback to play the songs in
the CD shuffle. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
5-54
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page294
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (295,1)
Display scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of the title. When the last
character is displayed, touch the on-
screen button to display the first character
of the title.
NOTE
lThe on-screen button is displayed only
if a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time.
lThe information viewable in the display is
only CD information (such as artist name,
song title) which has been recorded to the
CD.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
lThe number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Message Display
If CD Erroris displayed, it means that
there is some CD malfunction. Check the
CD for damage, dirt, or smudges, and
then properly reinsert. If the message
appears again, take the unit to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer for service.
q
How to use Auxiliary jack/USB port
Audio can be heard from the vehicle's
speakers by connecting a commercially-
available portable audio unit to the
auxiliary jack.
Use a commercially-available, non-
impedance (3.5 ) stereo mini plug cable.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer for
details.
In addition, audio can be played from the
vehicle audio device by connecting a USB
device or an iPod to the USB port.
Refer to AUX/USB/iPod mode on page
5-58.
qError Indications
If you see an error indication on the
display, find the cause in the chart. If you
cannot clear the error indication, take the
vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Indication
Cause Solution
CD
Error
CD is inserted
upside down
Insert the CD
properly. If the error
indication continues
to display, consult an
Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
CD is defective
Insert another CD
properly. If the error
indication continues
to display, consult an
Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
qSetup
You can customize settings in the setup
display as follows:
Display
Refer to Power/Volume/Display/Sound
Controls on page 5-36.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-55
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page295
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (296,1)
Sound
Refer to Power/Volume/Display/Sound
Controls on page 5-36.
Vehicle
lDoor Locks
lLight Control
lWipers Control
1. Press the setup button ( ).
2. Touch the on-screen tab to
display the vehicle setting screen.
3. Touch the desired setting item.
4. Select the desired setup item from the
list by touching it.
5. Touch the on-screen button.
Language
1. Press the setup button ( ).
2. Touch the on-screen tab to
display the language setting screen.
3. Touch the desired language from the
list.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
Only the available languages are displayed.
Default (Vehicle settings only)
1. Press the setup button ( ).
2. Touch the on-screen tab.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
5. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
The settings for display, sound, and language
cannot be initialized.
Audio Control Switch
Operation
When the audio unit is turned on,
operation of the audio unit from the
steering wheel is possible.
NOTE
lBecause the audio unit will be turned off
under the following conditions, the switches
will be inoperable.
lWhen the ignition is switched off.
lWhen the power button on the audio unit
is pressed and the audio unit is turned
off.
lMazda has installed this system to prevent
distraction while driving the vehicle and
using audio controls on the dashboard.
Always make safe driving your first priority.
Without Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free
5-56
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page296
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (297,1)
With Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free
qAdjusting the Volume
To increase the volume, press up the
volume switch ( ).
To decrease the volume, press down the
volume switch ( ).
qSeek Switch
When listening to the radio
Press the seek switch ( , ). The radio
switches to the next/previous stored
station in the order that it was stored
(16).
Press and hold the seek switch ( ,)to
seek all usable stations at a higher or
lower frequency whether programmed or
not.
Radio stations which have been
previously stored in the auto memory
tuning can be called up by pressing the
seek switch ( , ) while any radio
station stored in the auto memory tuning
is being received. Radio stations can be
called up in the order they were stored
with each press of the switch ( , ).
When playing a CD, USB, iPod or
Bluetooth
®
audio
*1
Press the seek switch ( ) to skip forward
to the beginning of the next track.
Press the seek switch ( ) within a few
seconds after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the seek switch ( ) after a few
seconds have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Press and hold the seek switch ( ,)to
continuously switch the tracks up or
down.
*1 Type B
qMute Switch
í
Press the mute switch ( ) once to mute
audio, press it again to resume audio
output.
NOTE
If the ignition is switched off with the audio
muted, the mute will be canceled. Therefore,
when the engine is restarted, the audio is not
muted. To mute the audio again, press the mute
switch ( ).
Interior Features
Audio System
5-57
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page297
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (298,1)
AUX/USB/iPod mode
Audio can be heard from the vehicle's
speakers by connecting a commercially-
available portable audio unit to the
auxiliary jack.
A commercially-available, non-impedance
(3.5 ) stereo mini plug cable is required.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer for
details.
In addition, audio can be played from the
vehicle audio device by connecting USB
device or an iPod to the USB port.
Auxiliary jack/USB port
How to use AUX mode ....... page 5-60
How to use USB mode (Type
A) ......................................... page 5-62
How to use USB mode (Type
B) ......................................... page 5-66
How to use iPod mode (Type
A) ......................................... page 5-70
How to use iPod mode (Type
B) ......................................... page 5-74
5-58
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page298
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (299,1)
WARNING
Do not adjust the portable audio unit
or a similar product while driving the
vehicle:
Adjusting the portable audio unit or
a similar product while driving the
vehicle is dangerous as it could
distract your attention from the
vehicle operation which could lead to
a serious accident. Always adjust the
portable audio unit or a similar
product while the vehicle is stopped.
CAUTION
ØAlways close the auxiliary jack/
USB port lid when it is not in use.
If foreign matter or liquid
penetrates the auxiliary jack/USB
port, it may cause a malfunction.
ØDepending on the portable audio
device, noise may occur when the
device is connected to the vehicle
accessory socket. (If noise occurs,
do not use the accessory socket.)
NOTE
lThis mode may not be usable depending on
the portable audio device to be connected.
lBefore using the auxiliary jack/USB port,
refer to the instruction manual for the
portable audio device.
lUse a commercially-available, non-
impedance (3.5 ) stereo mini plug for
connecting the portable audio unit to the
auxiliary jack. Before using the auxiliary
jack, read the manufacturer's instructions
for connecting a portable audio unit to the
auxiliary jack.
lTo prevent discharging of the battery, do
not use the auxiliary input for long periods
with the engine off or idling.
lWhen connecting a device to the auxiliary
jack or USB port, noise may occur
depending on the connected device. If the
device is connected to the vehicle's
accessory socket, the noise can be reduced
by unplugging it from the accessory socket.
qHow to connect USB port/
Auxiliary jack
USB port Auxiliary jack
Connecting a device
1. Open the console lid.
2. Open the auxiliary jack/USB port lid.
3. Connect the connector on the device to
the USB port.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-59
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page299
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (300,1)
Connecting with a connector cable
1. Open the console lid.
2. Open the auxiliary jack/USB port lid.
3. Pass the connection plug cord through
the cutout of the console and connect
the device plug/connector cable to the
auxiliary jack/USB port.
WARNING
Do not allow the connection plug cord
to get tangled with the parking brake
or the shift lever:
Allowing the plug cord to become
tangled with the parking brake or
the shift lever is dangerous as it
could interfere with driving, resulting
in an accident.
CAUTION
Do not place objects or apply force to
the auxiliary jack/USB port with the
plug connected.
NOTE
lInsert the plug to the auxiliary jack/USB
port securely.
lInsert or pull out the plug with the plug
perpendicular to the auxiliary jack/USB
port hole.
lInsert or remove the plug by holding its
base.
qHow to use AUX mode
Type A Type B
(Type A)
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the USB/AUX button ( ) of the
audio unit to change to the AUX mode.
(Type B)
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the audio button ( )to
display the audio screen.
4. Press the on-screen tab to switch
to the AUX mode.
5-60
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page300
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (301,1)
NOTE
lWhen the device is not connected to the
auxiliary jack, the mode does not switch to
the AUX mode.
lSet the volume of the portable audio unit to
the maximum within the range that the
sound does not become distorted, then
adjust the volume using the power/volume
dial of the audio unit or the up/down switch
of the audio control switch.
lAudio adjustments other than audio volume
can only be done using the portable audio
device.
lIf the connection plug is pulled out from the
auxiliary jack while in AUX mode, noise
may occur.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-61
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page301
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (302,1)
qHow to use USB mode (Type A)
Track up/Fast-forward button
Track down/Reverse button
Repeat button
Random button
Folder down button
Folder up button
Text button
Scan button
USB/AUX button
File dial
Type Playable data
USB mode MP3/WMA/AAC file
Playback
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the USB/AUX button ( )to
switch to the USB mode and start
playback.
NOTE
lSome devices such as smart phones may
require a setting change to allow USB
operation.
lWhen the USB device is not connected, the
mode does not switch to USB mode.
lWhen there is no playable data in the USB
device, NO CONTENTSis flashed.
lPlayback of the USB device is in the order
of the folder numbers. Folders which have
no MP3/WMA/AAC files are skipped.
lDo not remove the USB device while in the
USB mode. The data may be damaged.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed.
Press and hold the reverse button ( )to
reverse through a track at high speed.
Track search
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Folder search
To change to the previous folder, press the
folder down button ( ), or press the
folder up button ( ) to advance to the
next folder.
Music Scan
This function scans the titles in a folder
currently being played and plays ten
seconds of each song to aid you in finding
a song you want to listen to.
5-62
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page302
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (303,1)
Press the scan button ( ) during
playback to start the scan play operation
(the track number will flash). Press the
scan button ( ) again to cancel scan
playback.
NOTE
If the unit is left in scan, normal playback will
resume where scan was selected.
Repeat playback
(Track repeat)
Press the repeat button (1) during
playback to play the current track
repeatedly. TRACK RPTis displayed
during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) two times
while TRACK RPTis displayed to
cancel.
(Folder repeat)
Press the repeat button (1) two times
during playback to repeat the playback of
the songs in the current folder. FOLDER
RPTis displayed during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) while
FOLDER RPTis displayed to cancel.
Random playback
(Folder random)
Press the random button (2) during
playback to play the tracks in the folder
randomly. FOLDER RDMis displayed
during playback.
Press the random button (2) two times
while FOLDER RDMis displayed to
cancel.
(Media random)
Press the random button (2) two times
during playback to play the songs in the
USB device randomly. MEDIA RDMis
displayed during playback.
Press the random button (2) while
MEDIA RDMis displayed to cancel.
Switching the display
For files with a file name and other
information that have been input, the
display switches between display of the
file name and other information each time
the text button ( ) is pressed during
playback.
File number/Elapsed time display
Folder name
File name
Album name
Song name
Artist name
Folder number/File number
NOTE
lThe information (artist name, music name)
is displayed only when the USB device
information in the USB device has
information which can be displayed on the
screen.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
Display scroll
Only 9 characters (File name) or 13
characters (Except file name) can be
displayed at one time. To display the rest
of the characters of a long title, press and
hold the text button ( ). The display
scrolls the next 13 characters. Press and
hold the text button ( ) again after
the last 13 characters have been displayed
to return to the beginning of the title.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-63
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page303
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (304,1)
NOTE
The number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Error Messages
When the message CHECK USBis
displayed, it indicates that there is some
error in the USB device. Verify that the
content recorded in the USB device has
MP3/WMA/AAC files and re-connect
correctly. If the message reappears, have
the unit checked by an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
5-64
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page304
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (305,1)
MEMO
5-65
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page305
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (306,1)
qHow to use USB mode (Type B)
Audio button
Power/Volume dial
Track up/Fast-forward
button
Track down/Reverse
button
File dial
Type Playable data
USB mode MP3/WMA/AAC file
Playback
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the audio button ( )to
display the audio screen.
4. Touch the on-screen tab to
switch to USB mode and start
playback.
NOTE
lSome devices such as smart phones may
require a setting change to allow USB
operation.
lWhen a USB device is not connected to the
USB port, the mode does not switch to the
USB mode even if the on-screen tab
is touched.
lDo not remove the USB device while in the
USB mode. Otherwise, the data could be
damaged.
Pause
Touch the on-screen button to
pause playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
playback is paused to cancel the pause.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Operations using audio panel
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed.
Press and hold the reverse button ( )to
reverse through a track at high speed.
Operations on screen
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to advance through a track at high
speed.
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to reverse through a track at high
speed.
Track search
Operations using audio panel
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
5-66
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page306
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (307,1)
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Operations on screen
Touch the on-screen button once to
skip forward to the beginning of the next
track.
Touch the on-screen button within
a few seconds after playback begins to
track down to the beginning of the
previous track.
Touch the on-screen button after a
few seconds have elapsed to start
playback from the beginning of the
current track.
Displaying song list
The song list in the USB device can be
viewed.
NOTE
The song list may not display depending on the
conditions.
(Displaying optional list)
1. Touch the on-screen button during
playback.
2. Touch the category which you want to
select. The record list or song list is
displayed.
(Displaying a list being played)
Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
Press the on-screen button to display the
upper list.
Selecting from list
Select the desired song to play.
1. Press the on-screen button to select
the song list.
2. Touch the song you want to listen to.
NOTE
The selected song list becomes the play list.
Repeat playback
Touch the on-screen button during
playback. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
Shuffle playback
(Shuffling songs in list being played)
Touch the on-screen button during
playback. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
(Shuffling album in list being played)
Touch the on-screen button two
times during playback. is displayed
during playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
Text scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of each title. When the last
character is displayed, touch the on-
screen button to display the first character
of the title.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-67
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page307
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (308,1)
NOTE
lThe on-screen button is displayed when
the whole title is not displayed.
lThe information (artist name, music name,
album name) is displayed only when the
USB device has information which can be
displayed on the screen.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
lThe number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Error Messages
If the message USB Erroris displayed,
it indicates that there is no playable file in
the USB device or there is an error in the
USB device. Verify that the content
recorded in the USB device has MP3/
WMA/AAC files and re-connect correctly.
If the message reappears, have the unit
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
5-68
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page308
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (309,1)
MEMO
5-69
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page309
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (310,1)
qHow to use iPod mode (Type A)
Track up/Fast-forward button
Track down/Reverse button
Repeat button
Random button Category down button
Category up button
List down button
List up button
Text button
Scan button
USB/AUX button
File dial
Connectable iPod is as follows:
liPod: 5G
liPod classic
liPod nano: 1/2/3/4/5G
liPod touch
*1
: 1/2G
liPhone
*1
: 3G/3GS
*1 For only iPod functions
NOTE
The iPod functions on the iPod cannot be
operated while it is connected to the unit
because the unit controls the iPod functions.
Playback
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the USB/AUX button ( )to
switch to the iPod mode and start
playback.
NOTE
lWhen an iPod is not connected, the mode
does not switch to the iPod mode.
lWhen there is no playable data in the iPod,
NO CONTENTSis flashed.
lDo not remove the iPod while in the iPod
mode. Otherwise, the data could be
damaged.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed.
Press and hold the reverse button ( )to
reverse through a track at high speed.
Track search
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds (depends on iPod software
version) after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds (depends on iPod software
version) have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Category search
Press the category down button (5) to
select the previous category and press the
category up button (6) to select the next
category.
5-70
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page310
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (311,1)
NOTE
The types of categories include Playlist, Artist,
Album, Song, Podcast, Genre, Composer, and
Audio book.
List search
Press the list down button ( ) to select
the previous list and press the list up
button ( ) to select the next list.
NOTE
When the selected category is Song or Audio
book, there is no list.
Music Scan
This function scans the titles in a list
currently being played and plays 10
seconds of each song to aid you in finding
a song you want to listen to.
Press the scan button ( ) during
playback to start the scan play operation
(the track number will flash). Press the
scan button ( ) again to cancel scan
playback.
NOTE
If the unit is left in scan, normal playback will
resume where scan was selected.
Repeat playback
Press the repeat button (1) during
playback to repeat the playback of the
song in the current list. TRACK RPTis
displayed during playback.
Press the repeat button (1) while
displaying TRACK RPTto cancel.
Random playback
(Song random)
Press the random button (2) during
playback to play the tracks in the list
randomly. SONG RDMis displayed
during playback.
Press the random button (2) two times
while SONG RDMis displayed to
cancel.
(Album random)
Press the random button (2) two times
during playback to play the songs in the
iPod randomly. ALBUM RDMis
displayed during playback.
Press the random button (2) while
ALBUM RDMis displayed to cancel.
NOTE
The track number being played randomly is in
the order of the iPod shuffle table.
Switching the display
For files with a file name and other
information that have been input, the
display switches between display of the
file name and other information each time
the text button ( ) is pressed during
playback.
Album name
Song name
Artist name
Category (Playlist title/Genre title
/Composer title/Podcast title)
File number/Elapsed time
Interior Features
Audio System
5-71
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page311
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (312,1)
NOTE
lThe information (artist name, music name)
is displayed only when the iPod has
information which can be displayed.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
Display scroll
13 characters (Except file name) can be
displayed at one time. To display the rest
of the characters of a long title, press and
hold the text button ( ). The display
scrolls the next 13 characters. Press and
hold the text button ( ) again after
the last 13 characters have been displayed
to return to the beginning of the title.
NOTE
The number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Error Messages
If the message CHECK iPodis
displayed, it indicates that there is a
malfunction in the iPod. Verify that the
content recorded in the iPod has playable
files and connect correctly. If the message
reappears, have the unit checked by an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
5-72
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page312
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (313,1)
MEMO
5-73
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page313
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (314,1)
qHow to use iPod mode (Type B)
Audio button
Power/Volume dial
Track up/Fast-forward
button
Track down/Reverse
button
File dial
The connectable iPods are as follows:
liPod classic
liPod nano: 4/5/6G
liPod touch
*1
: 2/3/4G
liPhone
*1
: 3GS/4/4S
*1 Only iPod function
NOTE
The iPod functions on the iPod cannot be
operated while it is connected to the unit
because the unit controls the iPod functions.
Playback
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the power/volume dial to turn the
audio system on.
3. Press the audio button ( )to
display the audio screen.
4. Touch the on-screen tab to
switch to the iPod mode and start
playback.
NOTE
lWhen the iPod is connected to the USB
port, the on-screen tab changes to
the on-screen tab.
lDo not remove the iPod while in the iPod
mode. Otherwise, the data could be
damaged.
Pause
Touch the on-screen button to
pause playback. Touch the on-
screen button while playback is paused to
cancel the pause.
Fast-forward/Reverse
Operations using audio panel
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() to advance through a track at high
speed.
Press and hold the reverse button ( )to
reverse through a track at high speed.
Operations on screen
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to advance through a track at high
speed.
Touch and hold the on-screen
button to reverse through a track at high
speed.
Track search
Operations using audio panel
Press the track up button ( ) or turn the
file dial clockwise once to skip forward to
the beginning of the next track.
5-74
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page314
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (315,1)
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise within a few
seconds (depends on iPod software
version) after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Press the track down button ( ) or turn
the file dial counterclockwise after a few
seconds (depends on iPod software
version) have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Operations on screen
Touch the on-screen button once to
skip forward to the beginning of the next
track.
Touch the on-screen button within
a few seconds (depends on iPod software
version) after playback begins to track
down to the beginning of the previous
track.
Touch the on-screen button after a
few seconds (depends on iPod software
version) have elapsed to start playback
from the beginning of the current track.
Displaying song list
The song list in the iPod can be viewed.
NOTE
The song list may not display depending on the
conditions.
(Displaying optional list)
1. Touch the on-screen button during
playback.
2. Touch the category which you want to
select. The record list or song list is
displayed.
(Displaying a list being played)
Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
Press the on-screen button to display the
upper list.
Selecting from list
Select the desired song to play.
1. Press the on-screen button to select
the song list.
2. Touch the song you want to listen to.
NOTE
The selected song list becomes the play list.
Repeat playback
Touch the on-screen button during
playback. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
Shuffle playback
(Shuffling songs in list being played)
Touch the on-screen button during
playback. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
(Shuffling album in list being played)
Touch the on-screen button two
times during playback. is displayed
during playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
NOTE
The track number being shuffle played is in the
order of the iPod shuffle table.
Interior Features
Audio System
5-75
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page315
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (316,1)
Text scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of the title to display the
whole title. When the last character is
displayed, touch the on-screen button
to display the first character of the title.
NOTE
lThe on-screen button is displayed when
the whole title is not displayed.
lThe information (artist name, music name)
is displayed only when the iPod has
information which can be displayed on the
screen.
lThis unit cannot display some characters.
Characters which cannot be displayed are
indicated by an asterisk ( ).
lThe number of characters which can be
displayed is restricted.
Error Messages
If the message iPod Erroris displayed,
it indicates that there are no playable files
in the iPod or there is a malfunction.
Verify that the content recorded in the
iPod has playable files and re-connect
correctly. If the message reappears, have
the unit checked by an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
qError Indications
If you see an error indication on the
display, find the cause in the chart. If you
cannot clear the error indication, take the
vehicle to an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Indication Cause Solution
CHECK USB
USB device
malfunction
Verify that the content
recorded in the USB
device has
MP3/WMA/AAC files
and re-connect correctly.
If the error indication
continues to display,
consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
USB Error
CHECK iPod
iPod
malfunction
Verify that the content
recorded in the iPod has
playable files and
re-connect correctly.
If the error indication
continues to display,
consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
iPod Error
5-76
Interior Features
Audio System
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page316
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (317,1)
Bluetooth®
í
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free outline
When a Bluetooth
®
device (mobile phone) is connected to the vehicle's Hands-Free unit
via radio wave transmission, a call can be made or received by pressing the talk button,
pick-up button, hang-up button, or voice command on the steering wheel, or by operating
the panel. For example, even if a device (mobile phone) is in your coat pocket, a call can
be made without taking the device (mobile phone) out and operating it directly.
Bluetooth
®
audio outline
When a portable audio unit equipped with the Bluetooth
®
communication function is
programmed to the Bluetooth
®
unit, you can listen to music recorded on the programmed
portable audio device from the vehicle's speakers. It is not necessary to connect the
portable audio device to the vehicle's external input terminal. After programming, operate
the vehicle audio control panel to play/stop the audio.
Applicable Bluetooth
®
specification
Ver. 2.0 or higher
Response profile
lHFP (Hands-Free Profile) Ver. 1.5
lDUN (Dial-up Networking Profile) Ver. 1.1
lPBAP (Phone Book Access Profile) Ver. 1.0
lOPP (Object Push Profile) Ver. 1.1
lMAP (Message Access Profile) Ver. 1.0
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-77
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page317
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (318,1)
qComponent Parts
Microphone
Talk button, Pick-up button and Hang-up button
Microphone
Talk button
Hang-up button
Pick-up button
Audio unit
Audio unit (Type B)
The audio unit (Type B) is used for volume adjustment and touch panel operation.
Bluetooth
®
information is displayed in the display. The screen is switched by touching the
tab for each function to be used.
Do not press the panel strongly or press it with a sharp-pointed object.
Microphone (Hands-Free)
The microphone is used for speaking voice commands or exchanging conversation.
Talk button, Pick-Up button and Hang-Up button (Hands-Free)
The basic functions of Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free can be used for such things as making calls
or hanging up using the talk button, pick-up button and hang-up button on the steering
wheel.
NOTE
The talk button, pick-up button, and hang-up button are operable with the audio unit turned off.
Volume adjustment
The power/volume dial of the audio unit is used to adjust the volume. Turn the dial to the
right to increase volume, to the left to decrease it.
The volume can also be adjusted using the volume button on the steering wheel.
5-78
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page318
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (319,1)
Conversation volume and the volume of the voice guidance and ringtone can each be set in
advance.
1. Touch the on-screen tab to display the Bluetooth
®
setting screen.
2. Touch the on-screen button to display the volume adjustment screen.
3. (Volume up) Touch the on-screen button.
(Volume down) Touch the on-screen button.
4. Prompt: Phone call will be at this volume.or Voice guidance will be at this
volume.
NOTE
The volume of the audio unit cannot be adjusted while Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free is being used.
qBluetooth® Preparation
Device programming (Pairing)
To use Bluetooth
®
audio and Hands-Free,
the device equipped with Bluetooth
®
has
to be programmed to the unit using the
following procedure. A maximum of
seven devices including Bluetooth
®
audio
devices and Hands-Free mobile phones
can be programmed.
NOTE
lFor your safety, a device can be
programmed only when the vehicle is
parked. If the vehicle starts to move, the
pairing procedure will end. Park the car in
a safe place before programming.
lThe communication range of a Bluetooth
®
equipped device is about 10 meters (32 ft)
or less.
CAUTION
Some Bluetooth
®
mobile devices are
not compatible with the vehicle.
Consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer,
Mazda's call center or Web support
center for information regarding
Bluetooth
®
mobile device
compatibility:
ØU.S.A.
Phone: 800-430-0153
Web: www.MazdaUSA.com/
bluetooth
ØCanada
Phone: 800-430-0153
Web: www.mazdahandsfree.ca
ØMexico
Center of Attention to Client (CAC)
Phone: 01-800-01-MAZDA
Web: www.mazdamexico.com.mx
Pairing Procedure
1. Press the phone button ( ) on the
audio unit or commander switch.
2. Touch the on-screen tab.
3. Touch the on-screen
button. The list of pairing devices is
displayed.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-79
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page319
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (320,1)
4. Touch the on-screen button to
display the message and switch to the
device operation.
5. Using your device, perform a search
for the Bluetooth
®
device (Peripheral
device).
6. Select Mazdafrom the device list
searched by the device.
7. (Device with Bluetooth
®
version 2.0)
Input the displayed 4-digit pairing code
into the device.
(Device with Bluetooth
®
version 2.1
or higher)
lJust Works is detected
The pairing is performed
automatically.
lNumeric Comparison is detected
Make sure the displayed 6-digit
code on the audio is also displayed
on the device, and touch the
on-screen button. A connection
license agreement may be required
depending on the device.
After a device is registered, the system
automatically identifies the device. By
activating Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free again,
or by activating Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free
first after switching the ignition from OFF
to ACC, the device connection condition
is indicated in the display.
Device selection
If several devices have been programmed,
the Bluetooth
®
unit links the device last
programmed. If you would like to link a
different programmed device, it is
necessary to change the link. The order of
device priority after the link has been
changed is maintained even when the
ignition is switched off.
NOTE
If the device name cannot be displayed, ...is
added at the end of the title which is displayed.
Connecting other devices
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the device name which you
want to connect to display the device
information screen.
4. Touch the on-screen button to
connect as a Hands-Free device. Touch
the on-screen button to connect
as a Bluetooth
®
audio device.
5. Touch the on-screen button.
If the connection is completed, the device
name is displayed. Touch the on-
screen button to display the device list
screen and display the or icon in the
new device name which is connected.
Disconnecting a device
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the device name which is
currently connected to display the
device information screen.
4. Touch the on-screen button to
disconnect the Hands-Free device.
Touch the on-screen button to
disconnect the audio device.
5. Touch the on-screen button.
Deleting a device
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
5-80
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page320
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (321,1)
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the device name which you
want to delete.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
5. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
If you want to delete all of the pairing devices,
restore the default settings.
Changing PIN code
PIN code (4 digits) can be changed.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Delete the PIN code which is currently
set.
5. Input the new PIN code to be set.
6. Touch the on-screen button.
Restoring default settings
All the pairing device information and
phonebook data can be deleted.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
qAvailable Language
The Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free System
applies to the following languages:
lEnglish
lSpanish
lFrench
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
qVoice Recognition
The Mazda Bluetooth
®
Hands-free system
can be used to make calls or operate the
audio unit using voice recognition which
includes numerous convenient commands.
In this section, the basic operation of the
voice recognition is explained.
Activating Voice Recognition
To Activate the Main Menu: Press the talk
button.
To Activate the Phone Menu: After
activating the main menu, say Phone.
To Activate the Navi Menu: After
activating the main menu, say
Navigation.
NOTE
lWhen activating the Phone Menu from the
Main Menu, the user is informed of the
available options (Call, Dial, Redial, Call
back ,Setup or Emergency) via voice
navigation.
lFor voice recognition details with the
navigation system, refer to the separate
NAVIGATION SYSTEM Owner's
Manual.
Ending Voice Recognition
Use one of the following methods:
lPress and hold the talk button.
lPress the hang-up button.
Skipping Voice Guidance (for faster
operation)
Press and release the talk button.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-81
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page321
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (322,1)
NOTE
lThe Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free system is
operable several seconds after the ignition
is switched to ACC or ON (requires less
than 15 seconds).
lWhen operating the audio unit or the A/C
while using Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free, the
beep sounds or voice guidance (audio unit)/
cannot be heard.
Tutorial
The tutorial explains how to use
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free.
The available tutorial items are General,
Phone, and Audio.
To activate the tutorial, do the following:
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Tutorial
4. Prompt: Tutorial
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Tutorial
item)
6. Follow the prompts to receive the
appropriate voice guidance
instructions.
Commands useable anytime during
voice recognition
Help,Go Back,Cancel,Display
OFF/Display ONare commands which
can be used at anytime during voice
recognition.
Help function use
The help function informs the user of all
the available voice commands under the
current conditions.
1. Say: [Beep] Help
2. Follow the prompts to receive the
appropriate voice guidance
instructions.
Returning to previous operation
This command is for returning to the
previous operation while in the voice
recognition mode.
Say: [Beep] Go Back
Cancel
The Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free system
transitions to standby status if the
following operation is performed while
the system is activated.
Say: [Beep] Cancel
Display OFF/Display ON
The audio unit display can be switched
off/on by voice recognition operation.
Say: [Beep] Display OFF(or Display
ON)
To prevent a deterioration in the voice
recognition rate and voice quality, the
following points should be observed:
lThe Hands-free system cannot perform
voice recognition while voice guidance
or a beep sound is operating. Wait until
the voice guidance or the beep sound is
finished before saying your commands.
lDialects or different wording other than
Hands-Free prompts cannot be
recognized by voice recognition. Speak
in the wording specified by the voice
commands.
lIt is not necessary to face the
microphone or approach it. Speak the
voice commands while maintaining a
safe driving position.
lDo not speak too slow or too loud.
lSpeak clearly, without pausing between
words or numbers.
5-82
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page322
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (323,1)
lClose the windows and/or the
moonroof to reduce loud noises from
outside the vehicle. Turn down the
airflow of the air-conditioning system
while Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free is being
used.
lMake sure the vents are not directing
air up towards the microphone.
NOTE
If the voice recognition performance is not
satisfactory.
Refer to Troubleshooting on page 5-106.
Bluetooth® Hands-Free
qMaking a Call
Phonebook Usage
Telephone calls can be made by saying
the contact name in the downloaded
phonebook or the name of a person whose
phone number has been registered in the
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free. Refer to Import
contact (Download Phonebook).
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready.
3. Say: [Beep] Phone call
4. Prompt: Name, please.
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. John)
(Say a name registered in the
phonebook.)
The name spoken will be searched for
in the phonebook.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 7.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 6.
6. Prompt: Would you like to call
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Person you would like to call)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 7.
(Person you do not want to call)
Say: [Beep] NoThen go to Step 6
(Maximum 3 times)
7. Prompt: Would you like to call
XXXXX... (Ex. John) at home, at
work, or mobile, or other... or press the
hang-up button to exit Hands-Free
mode.
8. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. at
home)
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-83
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page323
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (324,1)
9. Prompt: XXXXX... (Ex. John)
XXXX (Ex. at home). Press the pick-
up button to call, or say Go Back to
enter a different name.
10. (Dialing) Press the pick-up button or
say Call. Then go to Step 11.
(Name correction) Say, Go Back.
Then go back to Step 4.
11. The call is made.
NOTE
The name in the phonebook and location can
be combined.
Ex. In Step 5, say, John home, then, Steps 6
to 8 can be skipped.
Screen operation
1. Touch the on-screen tab to
display the phonebook screen.
2. Touch the contact you would like to
call to display the details for the
contact.
3. Touch the desired phone number to
make the call.
Import contact (Download Phonebook)
Phonebook data from your device (Mobile
phone) can be sent and registered to your
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free phonebook using
Bluetooth
®
.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the or
on-screen button to switch to the
device operation.
NOTE
lIf the phonebook has been already
registered to the Hands-Free unit, the
current phonebook is overwritten during
all phonebooks download.
lA maximum of 1000 contacts can be
registered to the phonebook.
lPhonebook, incoming/outgoing call record,
and speed dialing memory are exclusive to
each mobile phone to protect privacy.
4. Download will be started from the
mobile phone.
Phonebook data deletion
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the contact information which
you want to delete.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
Call History Usage
A call can be made using the call history
(incoming/outgoing history) downloaded
from the mobile phone (Redial/Call back).
The call history is downloaded
automatically when connecting or pairing
the Hands-Free and mobile phone.
NOTE
If an anonymous call is received, the phone
number displayed in the Incoming Call History
may be random numbers. This is because a
mobile phone sends random numbers to the
vehicle. In this case, please be aware that the
Redial and Call back functions below may not
operate.
Redial Function
This voice command makes a call to the
last person you called (either from your
mobile phone or from the vehicle).
1. Press the talk button.
5-84
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page324
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (325,1)
2. Prompt: Ready.
3. Say: [Beep] Phone redial
4. A call is made to the most recent call in
the Call history (outgoing).
Call back Function
This voice command makes a call to the
last person who called you.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready.
3. Say: [Beep] Phone call back
4. A call is made to the most recent call in
the Call history (incoming).
Speed Dial Function
A maximum of eight telephone numbers
can be registered. It will take less time to
make a call after registering the telephone
number. In addition, you do not have to
look for the person you want to call in the
phonebook.
Speed Dial registration from
phonebook
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
3. Touch the contact you would like to
register to the speed dial.
4. Touch the telephone number you
would like to register.
5. Verify that the registered name and
telephone number are displayed in the
phonebook, and touch the on-
screen button.
Making calls using the Speed Dial
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the contact information you
would like to call.
Changing contact
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Touch the contact you would like to
register to the speed dial.
5. Touch the telephone number you
would like to register.
6. Verify that the registered name and
telephone number are displayed in the
phonebook, and touch the on-
screen button.
Speed Dial contact deleting
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen button for
the contact you would like to delete.
3. Touch the on-screen button to
display the confirmation screen.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
Telephone Number Input
NOTE
Practice this while parked until you are
confident you can do it while driving in a non-
taxing road situation. If you are not completely
comfortable, make all calls from a safe
parking position, and only start driving when
you can devote your full attention to driving.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready.
3. Say: [Beep] Phone dial
4. Prompt: Number, please
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-85
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page325
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (326,1)
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXXXXXXXX (Ex.
5551234) (Telephone number)
6. Prompt: XXXXXXXXXXX. (Ex
5551234) (Telephone number (first
choice))
7. Prompt: Press the pick-up button to
dial, or continue to add numbers. You
can also say Option Aor Option B
to replace the last block of digits with
the displayed alternate, or say Go
Backto delete the last block of digits.
NOTE
Option A is the second candidate, Option B is
the third, and they may not be presented
depending on the conditions.
8. (Dialing)
Press the pick-up button or say, Dial,
then go to Step 9.
(Adding/inputting telephone
number)
Say, XXXX(desired telephone
number). Then go to Step 5.
(The last recognized telephone
number is replaced by Option A or
B)
Say, Option Aor Option B. Then
go to Step 6.
(Telephone number correction)
Say, Go Back. The prompt replies,
The last entered numbers have been
removed. Then go back to Step 4 or
Step 7.
9. The call is made.
Screen operation
1. Input the telephone number using the
numerical keypad.
2. Touch the on-screen button to
make the call.
Numeral or symbol entry
Use the numerical keypad.
Long-press the on-screen button to
input .
Touch the on-screen button to delete
the currently input value.
Emergency calls
A call can be made to the emergency
phone number (911: U.S.A/Canada, 066:
Mexico) using the voice input command.
It may not function properly in some areas
in Mexico.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Phone emergency
4. Prompt: Press the Pick-Up button to
dial the Emergency number.
5. (Dialing) Press the pick-up button or
say Call.
6. Prompt: Dialing XXX (911: U.S.A/C
anada, 066: Mexico).
Automatic 911 (U.S.A./Canada only)
If the vehicle is involved in a moderate to
severe collision, a call is made
automatically to 911 from the connected
device.
1. If the vehicle is involved in a moderate
to severe collision, notification of the
call to 911 is made via audio and
screen display. To cancel the call, press
the on-screen button or hang-up
button within 10 seconds.
2. If the on-screen button or hang-
up button is not pressed within 10
seconds, the call is made to 911
automatically.
5-86
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page326
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (327,1)
NOTE
lAutomatic 911 is a secondary function of
the audio entertainment system. Therefore,
the automatic 911 function does not assure
that the call is always made to 911 after an
accident occurs.
lA Hands-free device must be paired and
connected. The 911 operator can verify the
vehicle's position information using the
Hands-free device GPS if equipped.
The 911 operator can verify the vehicles
position information.
(Switching automatic 911 on and off)
The system can be set to not call 911 if
the vehicle is involved in a moderate to
severe collision.
CAUTION
Though the system can be set to not
call 911, doing so will defeat the
purpose of the system to immediately
contact rescue personnel to assist you
after your accident. For the safety of
the driver and all passengers, Mazda
recommends that the Automatic 911
system remain activated so that a
call will be made to 911 when needed.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
3. Touch the on-screen button or
on-screen button.
4. Touch the on screen button.
qReceiving an Incoming Call
1. Prompt: Incoming call, press the
pick-up button to answer
2. To accept the call, press the pick-up
button or touch the on-screen
button.
To reject the call, press the hang-up
button or touch the on-screen
button.
NOTE
To stop receiving phone calls, turn the Don't
Disturb Me function on.
qHanging Up a Call
Press the hang-up button or touch the
on-screen button during the call.
qMute
The microphone can be muted during a
call.
Touch the on-screen button.
Touch the on-screen button during
mute to cancel the mute.
qTransferring a call from Hands-
Free to a mobile phone
Communication between the Hands-Free
unit and a device (Mobile phone) is
canceled, and the line can be switched to
the device (Mobile phone) as a standard
call.
Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
If the ignition is switched off during a Hands-
Free call, the line is transferred to the device
(Mobile phone) automatically.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-87
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page327
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (328,1)
qTransferring a call from a device
(mobile phone) to Hands-Free
Communication between devices (mobile
phone) can be switched to Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free.
Touch the on-screen button.
qCall interrupt
A call can be interrupted to receive an
incoming call from a third party.
To switch to a new incoming call.
Touch the on-screen button or press
the pick-up button on the steering wheel.
NOTE
lAfter receiving a new incoming call, the
previous call is placed on hold.
lTouch the on-screen button or press
the hang-up button on the steering wheel to
refuse a call.
Switching between calls
Touch the on-screen button or
press the pick-up button on the steering
wheel.
Three-way call function
Touch the on-screen button.
qDTMF (Dual Tone Multi-
Frequency Signal) Transmission
This function is used when transmitting
DTMF via the Numerical Keypad. The
receiver of a DTMF transmission is
generally a home telephone answering
machine or a company's automated
guidance call center.
1. Touch the on-screen button
after connecting to a home device or
service to display the tone transmission
screen.
2. Input the number using a numerical
keypad.
NOTE
If the DTMF code has two or more digits or
symbols, each one must be transmitted
individually.
qReceiving and Replying to
Messages (only MAP 1.0)
SMS (Short Message Service) messages,
MMS (Multimedia Messaging Service)
messages, and E-mail received by
connected devices can be downloaded,
displayed, and played (read by the
system).
Additionally, replies can also be made to
calls and messages in the received
messages.
Downloading messages
Up to 15 new messages can be
downloaded and displayed from a
connected device.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
lMessages that have not been read are
downloaded first.
lAttached data is not downloaded.
lMessages up to 160-bytes can be
downloaded.
lA message list is created for each device.
lIf there are unread messages, the receive
icon is displayed.
lIf the connected device does not correspond
to MAP 1.0, the AT command is used to
download. The downloaded message
indicates that it is already read.
lDownloading using the AT command may
not function depending on the connected
device.
5-88
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page328
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (329,1)
Receiving messages
When a device receives a message, a
message received notification is
displayed.
When the on-screen button
is touched, the message is downloaded.
NOTE
To not display the message received
notification, turn on the Don't Disturb Me
function.
Displaying messages
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the message you want to
display.
NOTE
lTouch the on-screen button to display
the next message, and press the
on-screen button to display the previous
message.
lWhen the on-screen button is
pressed, the message content is played
(read by the system).
Message playback
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the message you want to have
played (read) back.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
To stop the message playback, touch the
on-screen button.
Calling a person who sent a message
Calls can be made to persons sending
SMS and MMS messages.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the message to which you want
to make a call.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
Calls cannot be made to persons who have
sent e-mail.
Replying to messages
Replies to received messages can be sent
by selecting from the stored preset
messages.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the message to which you want
to reply.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Select the sentence to be sent from the
preset messages.
5. Press the on-screen button.
NOTE
The preset messages cannot be changed.
Erasing messages
Downloaded messages can be erased.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the message you want to erase.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
The messages stored in a device cannot be
erased.
qDon't Disturb Me function
A setting can be made to not notify you of
incoming phone calls and messages.
1. Touch the on-screen tab.
2. Touch the on-screen
button.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-89
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page329
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (330,1)
3. To set, touch the on-screen button
or the on-screen button.
4. Touch the on screen button.
NOTE
The following operations are possible even
when the Don't Disturb Me function is on.
lDownloading messages
lDownloading phone books
lDownloading the incoming/outgoing call
record
lSending messages
qAudio Operation Using Voice
Recognition
Audio on/off, audio mode switching, and
audio operations can be done using voice
recognition.
NOTE
(When playing a USB or iPod)
When a track is selected using voice
recognition, the track list is set to VR Playlist.
Starting the audio
The audio can be started using voice
recognition.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Turn on audio
4. Power to the audio is turned on.
Turning off the audio
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Change mode
4. Prompt: Available audio modes are:
AM, FM, FM1, FM2, Sirius, Sirius1,
Sirius2, Sirius3, USB, iPod,
Bluetooth
®
audio, Pandora
®
, CD,
AUX, Turn off audio
5. Say: [Beep] Turn off audio
6. Power to the audio is turned off.
Switching modes
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Change mode
4. Prompt: Available audio modes are:
AM, FM, FM1, FM2, Sirius, Sirius1,
Sirius2, Sirius3, USB, iPod,
Bluetooth
®
audio, Pandora
®
, CD,
AUX, Turn off audio
5. Say: [Beep] XXX (Ex. AM) (audio
source)
6. The audio source is switched.
NOTE
CD, SIRIUS digital satellite radio, USB, iPod,
BT audio, and Pandora
®
modes cannot be
selected in the following cases:
lSIRIUS digital satellite radio unit, USB
device, iPod, BT audio, or Pandora
®
unit is
not equipped on the audio system.
lCD has not been inserted.
The AUX mode is locked out unless you
connect a commercially available portable
audio unit (such as an MP3 player) to the
auxiliary jack. Connect a portable audio unit
or similar product on the market to the
auxiliary jack to listen to music or audio over
the vehicle's speakers.
5-90
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page330
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (331,1)
Playing selected track numbers
(When playing a CD)
A desired track number on a CD can be
played using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Play track
4. Prompt: What track number would
you like to play?
5. Say: [Beep] XXX (Ex. 15) (Track
number)
6. The selected track number is played.
Playing selected artist
(When playing a USB or iPod)
Tracks from a desired artist on a USB
device or iPod can be played using voice
recognition.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.Refer to How to use iPod
mode (Type B) on page 5-74.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Play
4. Prompt: Would you like to play by
Artist, Album, Playlist, or Genre?
5. Say: [Beep] Artist
6. Prompt: What artist would you like
to play?
7. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex.
Michael) (Artist name)
8. The name spoken will be searched for
in the USB device or iPod.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 10.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 9.
9. Prompt: Would you like to play
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Artist you would like to play)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 10.
(Artist you do not want to play)
Say: [Beep] No.Then go to Step 9.
(Maximum 3 times)
10. The tracks for the selected artist are
played.
Playing selected album
(When playing a USB or iPod)
The tracks from a desired album on a
USB device or iPod can be played using
voice recognition.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.Refer to How to use iPod
mode (Type B) on page 5-74.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Play
4. Prompt: Would you like to play by
Artist, Album, Playlist, or Genre?
5. Say: [Beep] Album
6. Prompt: What album would you like
to play?
7. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. Iam)
(Album name)
8. The name spoken will be searched for
in the USB device or iPod.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 10.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 9.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-91
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page331
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (332,1)
9. Prompt: Would you like to play
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Album you would like to play)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 10.
(Album you do not want to play)
Say: [Beep] No.Then go to Step 9.
(Maximum 3 times)
10. The tracks from the selected album
are played.
Playing selected playlist
(When playing a USB or iPod)
The tracks from a desired playlist on a
USB device or iPod can be played using
voice recognition.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.Refer to How to use iPod
mode (Type B) on page 5-74.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Play.
4. Prompt: Would you like to play by
Artist, Album, Playlist, or Genre?
5. Say: [Beep] Playlist
6. Prompt: What playlist would you like
to play?
7. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. My
favorite) (Playlist name)
8. The name spoken will be searched for
in the USB device or iPod.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 10.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 9.
9. Prompt: Would you like to play
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Playlist you would like to play)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 10.
(Playlist you do not want to play)
Say: [Beep] No.Then go to Step 9.
(Maximum 3 times)
10. The tracks from the selected playlist
are played.
Playing selected genre
(When playing a USB or iPod)
Tracks from a desired genre on a USB
device or iPod can be played using voice
recognition.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.Refer to How to use iPod
mode (Type B) on page 5-74.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Play
4. Prompt: Would you like to play by
Artist, Album, Playlist, or Genre?
5. Say: [Beep] Genre
6. Prompt: What genre would you like
to play?
7. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. Rock)
(Genre name)
8. The name spoken will be searched for
in the USB device or iPod.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 10.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 9.
5-92
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page332
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (333,1)
9. Prompt: Would you like to play
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Genre you would like to play)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 10.
(Genre you do not want to play)
Say: [Beep] No.Then go to Step 9.
(Maximum 3 times)
10. Tracks from the selected genre are
played.
Scan
(When playing a Radio, Sirius satellite
radio, CD, or BT audio (AVRCP1.4))
The scan function for the radio, Sirius
satellite radio, CD, or BT audio
(AVRCP1.4) can be launched using voice
recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
Refer to Operating the Satellite Radio on
page 5-44.
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Scan (or Scan Off)
4. Scan is performed or stopped.
Mute
Muting of the audio can be done using
voice recognition.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Mute (or Mute Off)
4. Mute is performed or stopped.
Track search
(When playing a CD, USB, iPod, BT
audio (AVRCP1.0/1.3/1.4))
The track up/down function can be run
using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.
Refer to How to use iPod mode (Type B)
on page 5-74.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
Track up
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Next track
4. The next track is played.
Track down
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Previous track
4. The previous track is played.
Folder search
(When playing BT audio (AVRCP1.4))
The folder up/down function can be run
using voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
Folder up
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Next folder
4. The next folder is played.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-93
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page333
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (334,1)
Folder down
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Previous folder
4. The previous folder is played.
Pause/Resume
(When playing a CD, USB, iPod, BT
audio (AVRCP1.0/1.3/1.4), Pandora
®
)
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.
Refer to How to use iPod mode (Type B)
on page 5-74.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
Pause
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Pause
4. Playback is paused.
Resume playback
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. (When playing a CD, USB, iPod, BT
audio (AVRCP1.0/1.3/1.4))
Say: [Beep] Resume
(When playing Pandora
®
)
Say: [Beep] Play
4. Playback is resumed.
Repeat
(When playing a CD, USB, iPod, BT
audio (AVRCP1.4))
The repeat function can be run using
voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.
Refer to How to use iPod mode (Type B)
on page 5-74.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
(When playing a CD)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Repeat (or Repeat Off)
4. Repeat is performed or stopped.
(When playing a USB, iPod)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Repeat
4. Prompt: Available repeat options are
Track and Off
5. Say: [Beep] Track (or Off)
6. Track repeat is performed or stopped.
(When playing BT audio)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Repeat
4. Prompt: Available repeat options are
Track , Folder, and Off
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX (Track, Folder
or Off)
5-94
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page334
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (335,1)
6. If Trackis spoken, track repeat is
performed.
If Folderis spoken, folder repeat is
performed.
If Offis spoken, repeat is stopped.
Shuffle
(When playing a CD, USB, iPod, BT
audio (AVRCP1.4))
The shuffle function can be run using
voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Compact Disc
(CD) Player on page 5-52.
Refer to How to use USB mode (Type B)
on page 5-66.
Refer to How to use iPod mode (Type B)
on page 5-74.
Refer to How to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System on page 5-102.
(When playing a CD)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Shuffle (or Shuffle Off)
4. Shuffle is performed or stopped.
(When playing a USB, iPod)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Shuffle
4. Prompt: Available shuffle options are
Album, Song, and Off
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX (Album, Song
or Off)
6. If Albumis spoken, album shuffle is
performed.
If Songis spoken, song shuffle is
performed.
If Offis spoken, shuffle is stopped.
(When playing BT audio)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Shuffle
4. Prompt: Available shuffle options are
Folder , All, and Off
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX (Folder, All or
Off)
6. If Folderis spoken, folder shuffle is
performed.
If Allis spoken, device shuffle is
performed.
If Offis spoken, shuffle is stopped.
Switching between display/non-display
of radio text information (U.S.A./
Canada only)
(When playing FM Radio)
Switching between display/non-display of
radio text information is possible using
voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Radio text (or Radio text
OFF)
4. Radio text information is displayed/not
displayed.
Selection by specifying frequency
(When playing the Radio)
Selection by specifying the frequency is
possible using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
1. Press the talk button.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-95
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page335
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (336,1)
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Frequency
4. Prompt: What frequency would you
like?
5. Say: [Beep] XXX (Ex. 610)
(Frequency)
6. The specified frequency is selected.
Seek tuning function
(When playing the Radio)
Seek tuning can be run using voice
recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
Seek up
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Seek up
4. Seek up is performed.
Seek down
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Seek down
4. Seek down is performed.
Auto memory seek function
(When playing the Radio)
The auto memory seek function can be
run using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Auto memory seek
4. Auto memory seek is performed.
Auto memory preset function
(When playing the Radio)
Auto memory preset can be selected using
voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Auto memory preset
4. Prompt: Number, please
5. Say: [Beep] X (Ex. 3) (Preset
number)
6. The specified preset is selected.
Preset switching
(When playing the Radio, Sirius
satellite radio)
Radio stations programmed to the preset
can be selected using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Radio on page
5-40.
Refer to Operating the Satellite Radio on
page 5-44.
Specify the preset number and select
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Preset
4. Prompt: Say a preset number
between 1 and 6
5. Say: [Beep] X (Ex. 3) (Preset
number)
6. The specified preset is selected.
5-96
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page336
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (337,1)
Next preset selection
(When playing the Radio)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Next preset
4. The next preset is selected.
Previous preset selection
(When playing the radio)
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Previous preset
4. The previous preset is selected.
Switching channels
(When playing a Sirius satellite radio)
Selection of the channel to be received is
possible using voice recognition.
Refer to Operating the Satellite Radio on
page 5-44.
Select by specifying the channel
number
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Channel
4. Prompt: What channel number would
you like?
5. Say: [Beep] XXX (Ex. 610) (Channel
number)
6. The specified channel is selected.
Selecting the next channel
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Next channel
4. The next channel is selected.
Selecting the previous channel
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Previous channel
4. The previous channel is selected.
Skip track function
(When playing Pandora
®
)
The skip track function can be run using
voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Skip Track
4. The next track is skipped.
Thumbs up function
(When playing Pandora
®
)
The thumbs up function can be run using
voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Thumbs Up
4. This tells Pandora
®
that you like this
track and helps to bring in more tracks
like it to your station.
Thumbs down function
(When playing Pandora
®
)
The thumbs down function can be run
using voice recognition.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-97
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page337
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (338,1)
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Thumbs Down
4. This tells Pandora
®
not to play this
track.
Pandora
®
radio station selection
(When playing Pandora
®
)
A Pandora
®
radio station can be selected
using voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Station
4. Prompt: Which Pandora
®
station you
would like?
5. Say: [Beep] XXXXX... (Ex. 90s
classic) (Station name)
6. The system searches for the announced
radio station.
If a contact is matched, go to Step 8.
If multiple contacts are matched, go to
Step 7.
7. Prompt: Would you like to play
XXXXX... (Choice 1)?
(Station you would like to play)
Say: [Beep] Yes.Then go to Step 8.
(Station you do not want to play)
Say: [Beep] No.Then go to Step 7.
(Maximum 3 times)
8. The specified radio station is selected.
Display of Pandora
®
radio station list
(When playing Pandora
®
)
The Pandora
®
radio station list can be
displayed using voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] List station
4. The radio list is displayed.
Bookmark function
(When playing Pandora
®
)
The bookmark function can be run using
voice recognition.
Refer to How to Use Pandora® on page
5-104.
1. Press the talk button.
2. Prompt: Ready
3. Say: [Beep] Bookmark
4. Prompt: Would you like to bookmark
Track, or artist?
5. Say: [Beep] Track (or Artist)
6. Track or artist is bookmarked.
5-98
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page338
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (339,1)
qGracenote Database
The Gracenote media database is used to improve voice recognition of artist and album
names with the Mazda Hands Free system. To make best use of the voice recognition,
install the most recent database.
CAUTION
For information related to the most recent Gracenote database which can be used
and how to install it, go to the Mazda Hands Free Website:
http://www.mazdahandsfree.com
Introduction
Music recognition technology and related data are provided by Gracenote
®
. Gracenote is
the industry standard in music recognition technology and related content delivery. For
more information visit www.gracenote.com.
CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright © 2000 to present Gracenote.
Gracenote Software, copyright © 2000 to present Gracenote. One or more patents owned
by Gracenote apply to this product and service. See the Gracenote website for a non-
exhaustive list of applicable Gracenote patents. Gracenote, CDDB, MusicID, MediaVOCS,
the Gracenote logo and logotype, and the Powered by Gracenotelogo are either
registered trademarks or trademarks of Gracenote in the United States and/or other
countries.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-99
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page339
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (340,1)
Gracenote
®
End User License Agreement
This application or device contains software from Gracenote, Inc. of Emeryville, California
(Gracenote). The software from Gracenote (the Gracenote Software) enables this
application to perform disc and/or file identification and obtain music-related information,
including name, artist, track, and title information (Gracenote Data) from online servers
or embedded databases (collectively, Gracenote Servers) and to perform other functions.
You may use Gracenote Data only by means of the intended End-User functions of this
application or device.
You agree that you will use Gracenote Data, the Gracenote Software, and Gracenote
Servers for your own personal non-commercial use only. You agree not to assign, copy,
transfer or transmit the Gracenote Software or any Gracenote Data to any third party. YOU
AGREE NOT TO USE OR EXPLOIT GRACENOTE DATA, THE GRACENOTE
SOFTWARE, OR GRACENOTE SERVERS, EXCEPT AS EXPRESSLY PERMITTED
HEREIN.
You agree that your non-exclusive license to use the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote
Software, and Gracenote Servers will terminate if you violate these restrictions. If your
license terminates, you agree to cease any and all use of the Gracenote Data, the Gracenote
Software, and Gracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves all rights in Gracenote Data, the
Gracenote Software, and the Gracenote Servers, including all ownership rights. Under no
circumstances will Gracenote become liable for any payment to you for any information
that you provide. You agree that Gracenote, Inc. may enforce its rights under this
Agreement against you directly in its own name.
The Gracenote service uses a unique identifier to track queries for statistical purposes. The
purpose of a randomly assigned numeric identifier is to allow the Gracenote service to
count queries without knowing anything about who you are. For more information, see the
web page for the Gracenote Privacy Policy for the Gracenote service.
The Gracenote Software and each item of Gracenote Data are licensed to you AS IS.
Gracenote makes no representations or warranties, express or implied, regarding the
accuracy of any Gracenote Data from in the Gracenote Servers. Gracenote reserves the
right to delete data from the Gracenote Servers or to change data categories for any cause
that Gracenote deems sufficient. No warranty is made that the Gracenote Software or
Gracenote Servers are error-free or that functioning of Gracenote Software or Gracenote
Servers will be uninterrupted. Gracenote is not obligated to provide you with new
enhanced or additional data types or categories that Gracenote may provide in the future
and is free to discontinue its services at any time.
GRACENOTE DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, TITLE, AND
NON-INFRINGEMENT. GRACENOTE DOES NOT WARRANT THE RESULTS THAT
WILL BE OBTAINED BY YOUR USE OF THE GRACENOTE SOFTWARE OR ANY
GRACENOTE SERVER. IN NO CASE WILL GRACENOTE BE LIABLE FOR ANY
CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES OR FOR ANY LOST PROFITS OR
LOST REVENUES.
© 2000 to present. Gracenote, Inc.
5-100
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page340
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (341,1)
Updating the database
The Gracenote media database can be updated using USB device.
1. Connect a USB device containing the software for updating Gracenote.
2. Touch the on-screen button.
3. Touch the on-screen button.
4. Touch the on-screen button to scroll the display.
When the display is scrolled to the end of the explanation, the on-screen
button is displayed.
5. Touch the on-screen button. The update is initiated.
6. Touch the on-screen button.
NOTE
Do not switch the ignition off or disconnect the USB device while updating the database. Otherwise,
data could be lost.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-101
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page341
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (342,1)
Bluetooth® Audio
Applicable Bluetooth
®
specification
Ver. 2.0 or higher
Response profile
lA2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution
Profile) Ver. 1.0/1.2
lAVRCP (Audio/Video Remote Control
Profile) Ver. 1.0/1.3/1.4
A2DP is a profile which transmits only
audio to the Bluetooth
®
unit. If your
Bluetooth
®
audio device corresponds only
to A2DP, but not AVRCP, you cannot
operate it using the control panel of the
vehicle's audio system. In this case, the
Bluetooth
®
audio device can be operated
by controlling the device itself, the same
as when a portable audio system without
the Bluetooth
®
communication function is
connected to the AUX terminal.
Function A2DP
A2DP·AVRCP
Ver.
1.0
Ver.
1.3
Ver.
1.4
Playback XXX
Pause XXX
File (Track)
up/down
XXX
Reverse ―― XX
Fast-forward ―― XX
Text display ―― XX
Folder up/down ――― X
Repeat ――― X
Shuffle ――― X
Scan ――― X
X: Available
: Not available
NOTE
lTo make sure that your Bluetooth
®
audio
device is Ver. 1.0, 1.3 or 1.4, refer to the
Owner's Manual for the Bluetooth
®
audio
device.
lThe battery consumption of Bluetooth
®
audio devices is higher while Bluetooth
®
is
connected.
lIf a general mobile phone device is USB
connected during music playback over the
Bluetooth
®
connection, the Bluetooth
®
connection is disconnected. For this reason,
you cannot have music playback over a
Bluetooth
®
connection and music playback
using a USB connection at the same time.
lThe system may not operate normally
depending on the Bluetooth
®
audio device.
qHow to Use the Bluetooth®
Audio System
Switching to Bluetooth
®
audio mode
To listen to music or voice audio recorded
to a Bluetooth
®
audio device, switch to
the Bluetooth
®
audio mode to operate the
audio device using the audio system
control panel. Any Bluetooth
®
audio
device must be programmed to the
vehicle's Bluetooth
®
unit before it can be
used.
Refer to Bluetooth® Preparation on page
5-79.
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Turn on the Bluetooth
®
audio device's
power.
Make sure that the symbol is
displayed in the audio unit's display.
NOTE
Some Bluetooth
®
audio devices need a certain
amount of time before the symbol is
displayed in the audio unit's display.
5-102
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page342
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (343,1)
3. Press the audio button ( ) and
then touch the on-screen tab to
switch to the Bluetooth
®
audio mode
and start playback.
NOTE
lIf the Bluetooth
®
audio device does not
begin playback, press the on-screen
button.
lIf the mode is switched from Bluetooth
®
audio mode to another mode (radio mode),
audio playback from the Bluetooth
®
audio
device stops.
Playback
1. To listen to a Bluetooth
®
audio device
over the vehicle's speaker system,
switch the mode to Bluetooth
®
audio
mode. (Refer to Switching to
Bluetooth
®
audio mode)
2. To stop playback, press the on-
screen button.
3. Press the button again to resume
playback.
Selecting a file (track)
Selects the next file (track)
Short-press the track up button ( )or
touch the on-screen button.
Selects the beginning of the current file
(track)
Short-press the track down button ( )or
touch the on-screen button.
Fast-forward/Reverse (AVRCP Ver. 1.3
or higher)
Fast-forward
Press and hold the fast-forward button
() or touch and hold the on-
screen button.
Reverse
Press and hold the reverse down button
() or touch and hold the on-
screen button.
Folder search (only AVRCP Ver. 1.4)
To change to the previous folder, touch
the on-screen button, or touch the
on-screen button to advance to the
next folder.
Music scan (only AVRCP Ver. 1.4)
This function scans the titles in a folder
currently being played and plays 10
seconds of each song to aid you in finding
a song you want to listen to.
1. Touch the on-screen button
during playback to play 10 seconds of
each subsequent track starting from the
next song.
2. Touch the on-screen button again
during playback of the song which you
want to listen to continue the playback
from that point.
Repeat playback (only AVRCP Ver. 1.4)
Track repeat
Touch the on-screen button to play
the song during playback repeatedly.
is displayed during playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
Folder repeat
Touch the on-screen button two
times to play the songs in the folder
repeatedly. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-103
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page343
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (344,1)
Shuffle playback (only AVRCP Ver. 1.4)
Folder shuffle
Touch the on-screen button during
playback to play the songs in the folder
shuffle. is displayed during
playback.
Touch the on-screen button two
times while is displayed to cancel.
Device shuffle
Touch the on-screen button two
times during playback to play the songs in
the device shuffle. is displayed
during playback.
Touch the on-screen button while
is displayed to cancel.
Display scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of the title. When the last
character is displayed, touch the on-
screen button to display the first character
of the title.
qBluetooth® audio device
information display
If a Bluetooth
®
audio device is connected,
the following information is displayed in
the display.
AVRCP
Ver. lower
than 1.3
AVRCP
Ver. 1.3
AVRCP
Ver. 1.4 or
higher
Device name X X X
Remaining
battery charge
of device
XX
Title XX
Artist name XX
Album name XX
File number XX
Playback time XX
Folder number ―― X
NOTE
Some information may not display depending
on the device, and if the information cannot be
displayed, No Song Nameis indicated.
qHow to Use Pandora®
What is Pandora
®
?
Pandora
®
is free personalized internet
radio. Simply enter a favorite artist, track,
genre, and Pandora
®
will create a
personalized station that plays their music
and more like it. Rate songs by giving
thumbs-up and thumbs-down feedback to
further refine your station, discover new
music and help Pandora
®
play only music
you love.
* Pandora
®
, the Pandora
®
logo, and the
Pandora
®
trade dress are trademarks or
registered trademarks of Pandora
Media, Inc., used with permission.
NOTE
To operate Pandora
®
from your Bluetooth
®
device, perform the following in advance:
lCreate Pandora
®
account on the web.
lCreate Pandora
®
station using Pandora
®
application.
lInstall Pandora
®
application on your
device.
Playback
1. To listen to Pandora
®
, touch the
on-screen tab.
2. To stop playback, press the on-
screen button.
3. Press the button again to resume
playback.
Skip song
Press the on-screen button.
5-104
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page344
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (345,1)
NOTE
lThe skip function may not be available
depending on the device.
lThe number of skips is limited by
Pandora
®
.
Selection from station list
Selection can be made from a
programmed radio station list.
1. Press the on-screen button.
2. Select the desired radio station.
NOTE
When is selected, songs randomly
selected from the radio station list are played.
Thumbs up function
Press the on-screen button to tell
Pandora
®
you like this trackand it helps
to bring in more tracks like it to your
station.
Thumbs down function
Press the on-screen button to tell
Pandora
®
not to play this track.
NOTE
If the on-screen button is touched when the
skip song function is running, the next song is
skipped.
Bookmarking
You can bookmark song or artist to check
out later on the Web.
Bookmark the song name
Press the on-screen button on the right
side of the song name.
Bookmark the artist name
Press the on-screen button on the right
side of the artist name.
Display scroll
If a whole title cannot be displayed at one
time, touch the on-screen button on
the right side of the title.
When the last character is displayed,
touch the on-screen button to display
the first character of the title.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-105
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page345
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (346,1)
Troubleshooting
Bluetooth
®
does not operate under the following conditions. Check whether the following
conditions apply to your Bluetooth
®
device:
lThe device is not being operated correctly.
lThe device is not connected to the Bluetooth
®
unit equipped on the vehicle.
lThe device's battery is weak.
lA device which interferes with radio wave reception has been placed in the vehicle.
lThe ignition switch has been turned off.
If none of the above conditions apply, refer to the following to see if any of the problem
symptoms correspond to your device.
If the problem cannot be resolved, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer or Mazda
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free Customer Service.
Mazda Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free Customer Service
If you have any problems with Bluetooth
®
, contact with our toll-free customer service
center.
lU.S.A.
Phone: 800-430-0153 (Toll-free)
Web: www.MazdaUSA.com/bluetooth
lCanada
Phone: 800-430-0153 (Toll-free)
Web: www.mazdahandsfree.ca
lMexico
Center of Attention to Client (CAC)
Phone: 01-800-01-MAZDA (Toll-free)
Web: www.mazdamexico.com.mx
5-106
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page346
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (347,1)
Device pairing, connection problems
Symptom Cause Solution method
Unable to perform pairing
First make sure the device is
compatible with the Bluetooth
®
unit,
and then check whether the
Bluetooth
®
function and the Find
Mode/Visible setting
*1
on the device
are turned on. If pairing is still not
possible after this, contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer or Mazda
Bluetooth
®
Hands-Free Customer
Service.
Unable to perform pairing The Bluetooth
®
function and the
Find Mode/Visible setting
*1
on the
device may turn off automatically
after a period of time has elapsed
depending on the device.
Check whether the Bluetooth
®
function and the Find Mode/Visible
setting
*1
on the device are turned on
and pairing or reconnect.
Does not connect automatically
when starting the engine
Automatically connects, but then
disconnects suddenly
Disconnects intermittently The device is in a location in which
radio wave interference can occur
easily, such as inside a bag in a rear
seat, in a rear pocket of a pair of
pants.
Move the device to a location in
which radio wave interference is less
likely to occur.
*1 Setting which detects the existence of a device external to the Bluetooth
®
unit
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-107
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page347
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (348,1)
Voice recognition related problems
Symptom Cause Solution method
Poor voice recognition lExcessive, slow speech.
lExcessive, forceful speech
(shouting).
lSpeaking before the beep sound
has ended.
lLoud noise
(speaking or noise from outside/
inside vehicle).
lAirflow from A/C is blowing
against the microphone.
lSpeaking in off-standard
expressions (dialect).
Regarding the causes indicated on
the left, be careful with how you
speak. In addition, when numbers are
spoken in a sequence, recognition
ability will improve if no stop is
placed between the numbers.
False recognition of numbers
Names in the phonebook are not
easily recognized
The Bluetooth
®
system is under a
condition in which recognition is
difficult.
By carrying out the following
measures, the rate of recognition will
improve.
lClear memory from the
phonebook which is not used
very often.
lAvoid shortened names, use full
names.
(Recognition improves the longer
the name is. By not using names
such as Mom,Dad, recogni-
tion will improve.)
You want to skip guidance
Guidance can be skipped by quickly
pressing and releasing the Talk
button.
When the Talk button is pressed,
voice recognition ends
The Talk button is pressed for too
long.
Operate the Talk button as follows:
lPress the button and release it
within 0.7 seconds to start voice
recognition and skip the
guidance.
lPress the button for longer than
0.7 seconds to turn off voice
recognition or end a
conversation.
Regarding problems with calls
Symptom Cause Solution method
When starting a call, vehicle noise
from the other party can be heard
For about three seconds after starting
a call, the Bluetooth
®
unit's Noise
Suppression function requires time to
adapt to the call environment.
This does not indicate a problem
with the device.
The other party cannot be heard or
the speaker's voice is quiet
The volume is set at zero or low. Increase the volume.
5-108
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page348
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (349,1)
Other problems
Symptom Cause Solution method
The indication for the remaining
battery is different between the
vehicle and the device
The indication method is different
between the vehicle and the device.
When a call is made from the
vehicle, the telephone number is
updated in the incoming/outgoing
call record but the name does not
appear
The number has not been registered
into the phonebook.
If the number has been registered
into the phonebook, the
incoming/outgoing call record is
updated by the name in the
phonebook when the engine is
restarted.
The cell phone does not synchronize
with the vehicle regarding the
incoming/outgoing call record
Some types of cell phones do not
synchronize automatically.
Operate the cell phone for
synchronization.
It takes a long time to complete the
function for changing the language
A maximum of 60 seconds is
required.
Interior Features
Bluetooth®
5-109
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page349
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (350,1)
Sunvisors
When you need a sunvisor, lower it for
use in front or swing it to the side.
Sunvisor
qSide Extension Sunvisors
í
The visor extender extends the sunvisor's
range of sun shading.
To use, pull it out.
CAUTION
When moving the sunvisor, retract
the visor extender to its original
position. Otherwise, the visor
extender could hit the rearview
mirror.
qVanity Mirrors
To use the vanity mirror, lower the
sunvisor.
If your vehicle is equipped with a vanity
mirror light, it will illuminate when you
open the cover.
To prevent the battery from being
discharged, the vanity mirror will only
illuminate in the tilt range shown below.
off
off
on
5-110
Interior Features
í
Some models.
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page350
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (351,1)
Interior Lights
Overhead Lights
Switch
Position Overhead Lights
Light off
lLight is on when any door is open
lLight is on or off when the
illuminated entry system is on
Light on
NOTE
The rear map lights also turn on and off when
the overhead light switch is operated.
Front Map Lights
When the overhead light switch is in the
door or off position, press the lens to
illuminate the front map lights, and then
press the lens again to turn them off.
NOTE
The front map lights will not turn off even if the
lens is pressed in the following cases:
lThe overhead light switch is in the ON
position.
lThe overhead light switch is in the door
position with the door open.
lThe illuminated entry system is on.
Rear Map Lights
When the overhead light switch is in the
door or off position, press the lens to
illuminate a rear map light, and then press
the lens again to turn it off.
NOTE
lOnce the rear map lights have been turned
off, they will turn on and off depending on
the position to which the overhead light is
switched.
lThe rear map lights will not turn off even if
the lens is pressed in the following cases:
lThe overhead light switch is ON.
lThe overhead light switch is in the door
position with the door open.
lThe illuminated entry system is on.
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
5-111
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page351
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (352,1)
Luggage Compartment Lights
Switch
Position Luggage Compartment Light
Light off
Light on when the liftgate is open
qIlluminated Entry System
When the illuminated entry system
operates, the overhead light (switch is in
the DOOR position) turn on for:
lAbout 30 seconds after the driver's
door is unlocked and the ignition is
switched off.
lAbout 15 seconds after all doors are
closed and the ignition is switched off.
lAbout 5 seconds after all doors are
closed and the ignition is switched off
when the key is out of the vehicle.
lIlluminates for about 15 seconds when
the ignition is returned from ACC to
OFF.
The light also turns off when:
lThe ignition is switched on and all
doors are closed.
lThe driver's door is locked.
NOTE
lBattery saver
If any door is left open with the overhead
light switch in the DOOR position, or the
liftgate is left open, the overhead light or
luggage compartment light turns off after
about 30 minutes to prevent battery
depletion.
lThe operation of the illuminated entry
system can be changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
5-112
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page352
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (353,1)
Clock
The time is displayed when the ignition is
switched to ACC or ON.
With Fully Automatic Type Climate
Control System
Clock
With Manual Type Climate Control
System
Clock
Time setting
1. Switch the ignition ACC or ON.
2. Adjust the time using the time setting
buttons ( , ).
The hours advance while the time
setting button ( ) is pressed.
The minutes advance while the time
setting button ( ) is pressed.
Time resetting
1. Switch the ignition to ACC or ON.
2. Press the :00 button.
3. When the button is pressed, the time
will be reset as follows:
(Example)
12:0112:2912:00
12:3012:591:00
NOTE
When the :00 button is pressed, the seconds
will start at 00.
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
5-113
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page353
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (354,1)
Accessory Sockets
Only use genuine Mazda accessories or
the equivalent requiring no greater than
120 W (DC 12 V, 10 A).
Front
The ignition must be switched to ACC or
ON.
Center, Rear
The accessory sockets can be used
regardless of whether the ignition is on or
off.
5-114
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page354
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (355,1)
CAUTION
ØTo prevent accessory socket
damage or electrical failure, pay
attention to the following:
ØDo not use accessories that
require more than 120 W (DC 12
V, 10 A).
ØDo not use accessories that are
not genuine Mazda accessories
or the equivalent.
ØClose the cover when the
accessory socket is not in use to
prevent foreign objects and
liquids from getting into the
accessory socket.
ØCorrectly insert the plug into
the accessory socket.
ØDo not insert the cigarette
lighter into the accessory
socket.
ØNoise may occur on the audio
playback depending on the device
connected to the accessory socket.
ØDepending on the device
connected to the accessory socket,
the vehicle's electrical system may
be affected, which could cause the
warning light to illuminate.
Disconnect the connected device
and make sure that the problem is
resolved. If the problem is
resolved, disconnect the device
from the socket and switch the
ignition off. If the problem is not
resolved, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
To prevent discharging of the battery, do not
use the socket for long periods with the engine
off or idling.
Connecting the accessory socket
1. Open the lid.
2. Pass the connection plug cord through
the cutout of the console and insert the
plug into the accessory socket.
Plug
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
5-115
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page355
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (356,1)
Cup Holder
WARNING
Never use a cup holder to hold hot
liquids while the vehicle is moving:
Using a cup holder to hold hot liquids
while the vehicle is moving is
dangerous. If the contents spill, you
could be scalded.
Do not put anything other than cups or
drink cans in cup holders:
Putting objects other than cups or
drink cans in a cup holder is
dangerous.
During sudden braking or
maneuvering, occupants could be hit
and injured, or objects could be
thrown around the vehicle, causing
interference with the driver and the
possibility of an accident. Only use a
cup holder for cups or drink cans.
qFront
NOTE
When using the cup holder to hold a small-
sized cup (height about 100 mm (4 in)), the cup
can be taken out of the cup holder easily by
using the spacer. The spacer can be set and
used in either of the front cup holders.
Spacer
5-116
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page356
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (357,1)
qRear
í
The rear cup holder is on the rear center
armrest.
Bottle Holder
Bottle holders are on the inside of the
doors.
Bottle holder
CAUTION
Do not use the bottle holders for
containers without caps. The
contents may spill when the door is
opened or closed.
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
5-117
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page357
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (358,1)
Storage Compartments
WARNING
Keep storage boxes closed when
driving:
Driving with the storage boxes open
is dangerous. To reduce the
possibility of injury in an accident or
a sudden stop, keep the storage
boxes closed when driving.
Do not put articles in storage spaces
with no lid:
Putting articles in storage spaces
with no lid is dangerous as they
could be thrown around the cabin if
the vehicle is suddenly accelerated
and cause injury depending on how
the article is stored.
CAUTION
Do not leave lighters or eyeglasses in
the storage boxes while parked under
the sun. A lighter could explode or
the plastic material in eyeglasses
could deform and crack from high
temperature.
qOverhead Console
This console box is designed to store
eyeglasses or other accessories.
Push and release to open.
qGlove Compartment
To open the glove compartment, pull the
latch toward you.
To close the glove compartment, firmly
press in the center of the glove
compartment lid.
5-118
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page358
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (359,1)
qCenter Console
To open, release the latch and pull up the
lid.
Storage tray
The storage tray can be removed.
Storage tray
qCargo Securing Loops
WARNING
Make sure luggage and cargo is
secured before driving:
Not securing cargo while driving is
dangerous as it could move or be
crushed during sudden braking or a
collision and cause injury.
Use the loops in the luggage compartment
to secure cargo with a rope or net. The
tensile strength of the loops is 196 N (20
kgf, 44 lbf). Do not apply excessive force
to the loops as it will damage them.
qRear Coat Hooks
WARNING
Never hang heavy or sharp objects on
the assist grips and coat hooks:
Hanging heavy or sharp-ended
objects such as a coat hanger from
the assist grips or coat hooks is
dangerous as they can fly off and hit
an occupant in the cabin if a curtain
air bag was to deploy, which could
result in serious injury or death.
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
5-119
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page359
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (360,1)
Always hang clothes on the coat hooks
and the assist grips without hangers.
Coat hook
qLuggage Compartment
Golf bags can be carried in the luggage
compartment.
Up to four golf bags can be carried in the
luggage compartment.
Place each of the first three golf bags into
the luggage compartment with the bottom
of each bag pointed to the right, and then
set the top of each bag so that it is pointed
to the left.
Place the fourth golf bag with its top
pointed to the left, and then set the bottom
of the bag so that it is pointed to the right.
NOTE
Some golf bags cannot fit depending on their
size.
5-120
Interior Features
Interior Equipment
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page360
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (361,1)
6Maintenance and Care
How to keep your Mazda in top condition.
Essential Information ................................................................... 6-2
Introduction ............................................................................... 6-2
Scheduled Maintenance ................................................................ 6-4
Scheduled Maintenance (U.S.A., Canada, and Puerto Rico) .... 6-4
Scheduled Maintenance (Mexico) ............................................. 6-9
Owner Maintenance ................................................................... 6-16
Owner Maintenance Precautions ............................................. 6-16
Hood ....................................................................................... 6-18
Engine Compartment Overview .............................................. 6-20
Engine Oil ............................................................................... 6-21
Engine Coolant ....................................................................... 6-23
Brake/Clutch Fluid .................................................................. 6-25
Washer Fluid ........................................................................... 6-25
Body Lubrication .................................................................... 6-26
Wiper Blades ........................................................................... 6-27
Battery ..................................................................................... 6-31
Replace Electrical Battery ....................................................... 6-33
Tires ........................................................................................ 6-35
Light Bulbs ............................................................................. 6-40
Fuses ....................................................................................... 6-49
Appearance Care ........................................................................ 6-56
Exterior Care ........................................................................... 6-56
Interior Care ............................................................................ 6-61
6-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page361
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (362,1)
Introduction
Be extremely careful and prevent injury to yourself and others or damage to your vehicle
when using this manual for inspection and maintenance.
If you are unsure about any procedure it describes, we strongly urge you to have a reliable
and qualified service shop perform the work, preferably an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Factory-trained Mazda technicians and genuine Mazda parts are best for your vehicle.
Without this expertise and the parts that have been designed and made especially for your
Mazda, inadequate, incomplete, and insufficient servicing may result in problems. This
could lead to vehicle damage or an accident and injuries.
For expert advice and quality service, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
To continue warranty eligibility and to protect your investment, it is your responsibility to
properly maintain your vehicle according to factory recommended schedules outlined in
this manual. As part of this you must keep your maintenance records, receipts, repair orders
and any other documents as evidence this maintenance was performed. You must present
these documents, should any warranty coverage disagreement occur. Failure to do so can
result in your warranty being voided either in whole or in part.
This evidence may consist of the following:
lThe Mazda Scheduled Maintenance Record, refer to the Warranty Booklet, must be
completely filled out showing mileage, repair order number, date for each service, and
signed by a qualified automotive service technician who service vehicles.
lOriginal copies of repair orders or other receipts that include the mileage and date the
vehicle was serviced. Each receipt should be signed by a qualified automotive service
technician.
lFor self maintenance, a statement that you completed the maintenance yourself,
displaying mileage and the date the work was performed. Also, receipts for the
replacement parts (fluid, filters, etc.) indicating the date and mileage must accompany
this statement.
NOTE
If you elect to perform maintenance yourself or have your vehicle serviced at a location other than an
Authorized Mazda Dealer, Mazda requires that all fluids, parts and materials must meet Mazda
standards for durability and performance as described in this manual.
Claims against the warranty resulting from lack of maintenance, as opposed to defective
materials or authorized Mazda workmanship, will not be honored.
6-2
Maintenance and Care
Essential Information
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page362
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (363,1)
Any auto repair shop using parts equivalent to your Mazda's original equipment may
perform maintenance. But we recommend that it always be done by an Authorized
Mazda Dealer using genuine Mazda parts.
Maintenance and Care
Essential Information
6-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page363
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (364,1)
Scheduled Maintenance (U.S.A., Canada, and Puerto Rico)
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions
apply.
lRepeated short-distance driving
lDriving in dusty conditions
lDriving with extended use of brakes
lDriving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are used
lDriving on rough or muddy roads
lExtended periods of idling or low-speed operation
lDriving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates
lDriving in extremely hot conditions
lDriving in mountainous conditions continually
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2 (Canada and Puerto Rico residents follow Schedule 2).
NOTE
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended
intervals.
6-4
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page364
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (365,1)
qSchedule 1
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first
Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48
×1000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96
×1000 miles 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60
ENGINE
Drive belts I
Engine oil RRRRRRRR
Engine oil filter RRRRRRRR
COOLING SYSTEM
Engine coolant
FL22 type
*1
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years; after
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years.
Others Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,
every 2 years.
FUEL SYSTEM
Air filter R
Fuel lines and hoses
*2
II
Hoses and tubes for emission
*2
I
IGNITION SYSTEM
Spark plugs Replace every 120,000 km (75,000 miles).
CHASSIS and BODY
Brake lines, hoses and connections I I
Disc brakes IIII
Tire (Rotation) Rotate every 12,000 km (7,500 miles).
Steering operation and linkages I I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel
bearing axial play II
Rear differential oil
*3*4
Transfer oil
*4
Driveshaft dust boots I I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body T T
Exhaust system and heat shields Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years.
All locks and hinges LLLLLLLL
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page365
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (366,1)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first
Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48
×1000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96
×1000 miles 7.5 15 22.5 30 37.5 45 52.5 60
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
Cabin air filter R R
Chart symbols:
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, fill up, or replace if necessary.
R: Replace
L: Lubricate
T: Tighten
Remarks:
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at
every 48,000 km (30,000 miles).
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet conditions
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.
6-6
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page366
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (367,1)
qSchedule 2
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first
Months 4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48
×1000 km 8 16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96
×1000 miles 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
ENGINE
Drive belts I
Engine oil Puerto Rico Replace every 5,000 km (3,000 miles) or 3 months.
Others RRRRRRRRRRRR
Engine oil filter RRRRRRRRRRRR
COOLING SYSTEM
Engine coolant
FL22 type
*1
Replace at first 192,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years; after
that, every 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years.
Others Replace at first 96,000 km (60,000 miles) or 4 years; after that,
every 2 years.
Engine coolant level IIIIIIIIIIII
FUEL SYSTEM
Air filter Puerto Rico R R
Others R
Fuel lines and hoses
*2
II
Hoses and tubes for emission
*2
I
IGNITION SYSTEM
Spark plugs Replace every 120,000 km (75,000 miles).
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Function of all lights IIIIIIIIIIII
CHASSIS and BODY
Brake lines, hoses and connections I I
Brake and clutch fluid level IIIIIIIIIIII
Disc brakes IIII
Tire (Rotation) Rotate every 8,000 km (5,000 miles).
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear IIIIIIIIIIII
Steering operation and linkages I I
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel
bearing axial play II
Rear differential oil
*3*4
Transfer oil
*4
Driveshaft dust boots I I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body T T
Exhaust system and heat shields Inspect every 72,000 km (45,000 miles) or 5 years.
All locks and hinges LLLLLLLLLLLL
Washer fluid level IIIIIIIIIIII
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page367
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (368,1)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers (miles), whichever comes first
Months 4 8 12 16 20 24 28 32 36 40 44 48
×1000 km 8 16 24 32 40 48 56 64 72 80 88 96
×1000 miles 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
Cabin air filter Replace every 40,000 km (25,000 miles) or 2 years.
Chart symbols:
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, fill up, or replace if necessary.
R: Replace
L: Lubricate
T: Tighten
Remarks:
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at
the recommended time or mileage/kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at
every 48,000 km (30,000 miles).
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet conditions
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km (10 miles)
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.
6-8
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page368
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (369,1)
Scheduled Maintenance (Mexico)
Follow Schedule 1 if the vehicle is operated mainly where none of the following conditions
apply.
lRepeated short-distance driving
lDriving in dusty conditions
lDriving with extended use of brakes
lDriving in areas where salt or other corrosive materials are used
lDriving on rough or muddy roads
lExtended periods of idling or low-speed operation
lDriving for long periods in cold temperatures or extremely humid climates
lDriving in extremely hot conditions
lDriving in mountainous conditions continually
If any do apply, follow Schedule 2.
NOTE
After the prescribed period, continue to follow the described maintenance at the recommended
intervals.
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page369
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (370,1)
qSchedule 1
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72
×1000 km 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120
ENGINE
Drive belts I I I
Engine oil RRRRRRRRRRRR
Engine oil filter RRRRRRRRRRRR
COOLING SYSTEM
Cooling system I I I
Engine coolant FL22 type
*1
Replace at first 200,000 km or 10 years; after that, every
100,000 km or 5 years
Others Replace every 2 years
FUEL SYSTEM
Air filter RRRRRR
Fuel lines and hoses I
*2
I
*2
I
Hoses and tubes for emission I
*2
I
*2
I
Fuel filter Replace every 60,000 km
IGNITION SYSTEM
Spark plugs Replace every 120,000 km
CHASSIS and BODY
Brake lines, hoses and connections IIIIII
Brake and clutch fluid level I I I I I I I I I
Brake fluid R R R
Disc brakes IIIIIIIIIIII
Tire (Rotation) Rotate every 10,000 km
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear IIIIIIIIIIII
Steering operation and linkages IIIIIIIIIIII
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel
bearing axial play IIIIII
Rear differential oil
*3*4
Transfer oil
*4
Driveshaft dust boots IIIIII
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body TTTTTT
Exhaust system and heat shields IIIIII
All locks and hinges LLLLLLLLLLLL
Washer fluid level IIIIIIIIIIII
6-10
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page370
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (371,1)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72
×1000 km 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
Cabin air filter R R R
Chart symbols:
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, fill up, or replace if necessary.
R: Replace
L: Lubricate
T: Tighten
Remarks:
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at
every 45,000 km.
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet conditions
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page371
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (372,1)
qSchedule 2
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36
×1000 km 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
ENGINE
Drive belts I
Engine oil RRRRRRRRRRRR
Engine oil filter RRRRRRRRRRRR
COOLING SYSTEM
Cooling system I
Engine coolant FL22 type
*1
Replace at first 200,000 km or 10 years; after that, every
100,000 km or 5 years
Others Replace every 2 years
Engine coolant level IIIIIIIIIIII
FUEL SYSTEM
Air filter CRCRCR
Fuel lines and hoses I
*2
Hoses and tubes for emission I
*2
Fuel filter Replace every 60,000 km
IGNITION SYSTEM
Spark plugs Replace every 120,000 km
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Function of all lights IIIIIIIIIIII
CHASSIS and BODY
Brake lines, hoses and connections I I I
Brake and clutch fluid level I I I I I
Brake fluid R
Disc brakes IIIIII
Tire (Rotation) Rotate every 10,000 km
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear IIIIII
Steering operation and linkages IIIIII
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel
bearing axial play III
Rear differential oil
*3*4
Transfer oil
*4
Driveshaft dust boots I I I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body T T T
Exhaust system and heat shields I I I
All locks and hinges LLLLLL
Washer fluid level IIIIII
6-12
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page372
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (373,1)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36
×1000 km 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
Cabin air filter R R R
Chart symbols:
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, fill up, or replace if necessary.
R: Replace
L: Lubricate
C: Clean
T: Tighten
Remarks:
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at
every 45,000 km.
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet conditions
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page373
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:49 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (374,1)
(Cont.)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72
×1000 km 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120
ENGINE
Drive belts I I
Engine oil RRRRRRRRRRRR
Engine oil filter RRRRRRRRRRRR
COOLING SYSTEM
Cooling system I I
Engine coolant FL22 type
*1
Replace at first 200,000 km or 10 years; after that, every
100,000 km or 5 years
Others Replace every 2 years
Engine coolant level IIIIIIIIIIII
FUEL SYSTEM
Air filter CRCRCR
Fuel lines and hoses I
*2
I
*2
Hoses and tubes for emission I
*2
I
*2
Fuel filter Replace every 60,000 km
IGNITION SYSTEM
Spark plugs Replace every 120,000 km
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Function of all lights IIIIIIIIIIII
CHASSIS and BODY
Brake lines, hoses and connections I I I
Brake and clutch fluid level I I I I
Brake fluid R R
Disc brakes IIIIII
Tire (Rotation) Rotate every 10,000 km
Tire inflation pressure and tire wear IIIIII
Steering operation and linkages IIIIII
Front and rear suspension, ball joints and wheel
bearing axial play III
Rear differential oil
*3*4
Transfer oil
*4
Driveshaft dust boots I I I
Bolts and nuts on chassis and body T T T
Exhaust system and heat shields I I I
All locks and hinges LLLLLL
Washer fluid level IIIIII
6-14
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page374
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (375,1)
Maintenance Interval
Number of months or kilometers, whichever comes first
Months 39 42 45 48 51 54 57 60 63 66 69 72
×1000 km 65 70 75 80 85 90 95 100 105 110 115 120
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
Cabin air filter R R R
Chart symbols:
I: Inspect: Inspect and clean, repair, adjust, fill up, or replace if necessary.
R: Replace
L: Lubricate
C: Clean
T: Tighten
Remarks:
*1 Use FL22 type coolant in vehicles with the inscription FL22on the radiator cap itself or the surrounding
area. Use FL22 when replacing the coolant.
*2 According to state/provincial and federal regulations, failure to perform maintenance on these items will not
void your emissions warranties. However, Mazda recommends that all maintenance services be performed at
the recommended time or kilometer period to ensure long-term reliability.
*3 If the vehicle is operated primarily under any of the following conditions, replace the rear differential oil at
every 45,000 km.
a) Towing a trailer or using a car-top carrier
b) Driving in dusty, sandy or wet conditions
c) Extended periods of idling or low speed operation
d) Repeated short trips of less than 16 km
*4 If this component has been submerged in water, the oil should be replaced.
Maintenance and Care
Scheduled Maintenance
6-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page375
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (376,1)
Owner Maintenance Precautions
The owner or a qualified service technician should make these vehicle inspections at the
indicated intervals to ensure safe and dependable operation.
Bring any problem to the attention of an Authorized Mazda Dealer or qualified service
technician as soon as possible.
When Refueling
lBrake and clutch fluid level (page 6-25)
lEngine coolant level (page 6-23)
lEngine oil level (page 6-22)
lWasher fluid level (page 6-25)
At Least Monthly
Tire inflation pressures (page 6-36)
At Least Twice a Year (For Example, Every Spring and Fall)
You can do the following scheduled maintenance items if you have some mechanical
ability and a few basic tools and if you closely follow the directions in this manual.
lEngine coolant (page 6-23)
lEngine oil (page 6-21)
Improper or incomplete service may result in problems. This section gives instructions only
for items that are easy to perform.
As explained in the Introduction (page 6-2), several procedures can be done only by a
qualified service technician with special tools.
Improper owner maintenance during the warranty period may affect warranty coverage.
Refer to Introduction (page 6-2) for owner's responsibility in protecting your investment.
For details, read the separate Mazda Warranty statement provided with the vehicle. If you
are unsure about any servicing or maintenance procedure, have it done by an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
There are strict environmental laws regarding the disposal of waste oil and fluids. Please
dispose of your waste properly and with due regard to the environment.
We recommend that you entrust the oil and fluid changes of your vehicle to an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
6-16
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page376
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (377,1)
WARNING
Do not perform maintenance work if you lack sufficient knowledge and experience or
the proper tools and equipment to do the work. Have maintenance work done by a
qualified technician:
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle is dangerous if not done properly. You
can be seriously injured while performing some maintenance procedures.
If you must run the engine while working under the hood, make certain that you
remove all jewelry (especially rings, bracelets, watches, and necklaces) and all
neckties, scarves, and similar loose clothing before getting near the engine or cooling
fan which may turn on unexpectedly:
Working under the hood with the engine running is dangerous. It becomes even
more dangerous when you wear jewelry or loose clothing.
Either can become entangled in moving parts and result in injury.
Switch the ignition to off and make sure the fan is not running before
attempting to work near the cooling fan:
Working near the cooling fan when it is running is dangerous. The fan could
continue running indefinitely even if the engine has stopped and the engine
compartment temperature is high. You could be hit by the fan and seriously injured.
Do not leave items in the engine compartment:
After you have finished checking or doing servicing in the engine compartment, do
not forget and leave items such as tools or rags in the engine compartment.
Tools or other items left in the engine compartment could cause engine damage or a
fire leading to an unexpected accident.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page377
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (378,1)
Hood
WARNING
Always check that the hood is closed
and securely locked:
A hood that is not closed and
securely locked is dangerous as it
could fly open while the vehicle is
moving and block the driver's vision
which could result in a serious
accident.
qOpening the Hood
1. With the vehicle parked, pull the
release handle to unlock the hood.
Release handle
2. Insert your hand into the hood opening,
slide the latch lever to the right, and lift
up the hood.
3. Grasp the support rod in the padded
area and secure it in the support rod
hole indicated by the arrow to hold the
hood open.
Pad
Clip
Clip
Support rod
6-18
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page378
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (379,1)
qClosing the Hood
1. Check under the hood area to make
certain all filler caps are in place and
all loose items (e.g. tools, oil
containers, etc.) have been removed.
2. Lift the hood, grasp the padded area on
the support rod, and secure the support
rod in the clip. Verify that the support
rod is secured in the clip before closing
the hood.
Clip
ClipClip
3. Lower the hood slowly to a height of
about 20 cm (7.9 in) above its closed
position and then let it drop.
CAUTION
When closing the hood, do not push
it excessively such as by applying
your weight. Otherwise, the hood
could be deformed.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page379
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (380,1)
Engine Compartment Overview
Windshield washer fluid reservoir
Engine oil-filler cap
Brake/Clutch fluid reservoir
Engine oil dipstick
Battery
Engine coolant reservoir
Fuse block
Cooling system cap
6-20
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page380
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (381,1)
Engine Oil
NOTE
Changing the engine oil should be performed
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Refer to Introduction (page 6-2) for owner's
responsibility in protecting your investment.
qRecommended Oil
U.S.A. and CANADA
Use SAE 0W-20 engine oil.
Mazda Genuine Oil is used in your Mazda
vehicle. Mazda Genuine 0W-20 Oil is
required to achieve optimum fuel
economy.
For maintenance service, Mazda
recommends Mazda Genuine Parts and
Castrol
®
(U.S.A. only).
(ILSAC)
Only use SAE 0W-20 oil
Certified For Gasoline Enginesby the
American Petroleum Institute (API).
Oil with this trademark symbol conforms
to the current engine and emission system
protection standards and fuel economy
requirements of the International
Lubricant Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S.
and Japanese automobile manufacturers.
80
60
40
20
0
–40 –20
30
120
100
5040
20
10
0
–10
–20
–30
–40
Except U.S.A. and CANADA
Use SAE 5W-30 engine oil.
Oil container labels provide important
information.
A chief contribution this type of oil makes
to fuel economy is reducing the amount of
fuel necessary to overcome engine
friction.
For maintenance service, Mazda
recommends Mazda Genuine Parts and
Castrol
®
(Mexico only).
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page381
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (382,1)
(ILSAC)
(Mexico)
Use SAE 5W-30 engine oil. If SAE 5W-
30 engine oil is not available, use SAE
5W-20 engine oil.
The quality designation SM, or ILSAC
must be on the label.
80
60
40
20
0
–40 –20
30
120
100
5040
20
10
0
–10
–20
–30
–40
qInspecting Engine Oil Level
1. Be sure the vehicle is on a level
surface.
2. Warm up the engine to normal
operating temperature.
3. Turn it off and wait at least 5 minutes
for the oil to return to the oil pan.
4. Pull out the dipstick, wipe it clean, and
reinsert it fully.
Full
OK
Low
5. Pull it out again and examine the level.
The level is normal if it is between
Low and Full.
If it is near or below Low, add enough
oil to bring the level to Full.
CAUTION
Do not add engine oil over Full. This
may cause engine damage.
6. Make sure the O-ring on the dipstick is
positioned properly before reinserting
the dipstick.
7. Reinsert the dipstick fully.
6-22
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page382
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (383,1)
Engine Coolant
qInspecting Coolant Level
WARNING
Do not use a match or live flame in the
engine compartment. DO NOT ADD
COOLANT WHEN THE ENGINE IS HOT:
A hot engine is dangerous. If the
engine has been running, parts of the
engine compartment can become
very hot. You could be burned.
Carefully inspect the engine coolant
in the coolant reservoir, but do not
open it.
Switch the ignition to off and
make sure the fan is not running before
attempting to work near the cooling
fan:
Working near the cooling fan when it
is running is dangerous. The fan
could continue running indefinitely
even if the engine has stopped and
the engine compartment temperature
is high. You could be hit by the fan
and seriously injured.
Do not remove either cooling
system cap when the engine and
radiator are hot:
When the engine and radiator are
hot, scalding coolant and steam may
shoot out under pressure and cause
serious injury.
NOTE
Changing the coolant should be done by an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Inspect the antifreeze protection and
coolant level in the coolant reservoir at
least once a yearat the beginning of the
winter seasonand before traveling
where temperatures may drop below
freezing.
Inspect the condition and connections of
all cooling system and heater hoses.
Replace any that are swollen or
deteriorated.
The coolant should be at full in the
radiator and between the F and L marks
on the coolant reservoir when the engine
is cool.
If it is at or near L, add enough coolant to
the coolant reservoir to provide freezing
and corrosion protection and to bring the
level to F.
Securely tighten the coolant reservoir tank
cap after adding coolant.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page383
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (384,1)
CAUTION
ØRadiator coolant will damage
paint.
Rinse it off quickly if spilled.
ØUse only soft (demineralized)
water in the coolant mixture.
Water that contains minerals will
cut down on the coolant's
effectiveness.
ØDo not add only water. Always
add a proper coolant mixture.
ØThe engine has aluminum parts
and must be protected by an
ethylene-glycol-based coolant to
prevent corrosion and freezing.
ØDO NOT USE coolants Containing
Alcohol, methanol, Borate or
Silicate.
These coolants could damage the
cooling system.
ØDO NOT MIX alcohol or methanol
with the coolant. This could
damage the cooling system.
ØDo not use a solution that
contains more than 60%
antifreeze.
This would reduce effectiveness.
NOTE
If the FL22mark is shown on or near the
cooling system cap, it is recommended to use
Mazda Genuine FL22 engine coolant (page
6-4).
If the coolant reservoir is empty or new
coolant is required frequently, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
6-24
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page384
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (385,1)
Brake/Clutch Fluid
q
Inspecting Brake/Clutch Fluid Level
WARNING
If the brake/clutch fluid level is low,
have the brakes inspected:
A low brake/clutch fluid level is
dangerous.
A low level could indicate brake
lining wear or a brake system leak
which could cause the brakes to fail
and lead to an accident.
The brakes and clutch draw fluid from the
same reservoir.
Inspect the fluid level in the reservoir
regularly. It should be kept between the
MAX and MIN lines.
The level normally drops with
accumulated distance, a condition
associated with wear of brake and clutch
linings. If it is excessively low, have the
brake/clutch system inspected by an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Washer Fluid
qInspecting Washer Fluid Level
WARNING
Use only windshield washer fluid or
plain water in the reservoir:
Using radiator antifreeze as washer
fluid is dangerous. If sprayed on the
windshield, it will dirty the
windshield, affect your visibility, and
could result in an accident.
Using Washer Fluid Without Anti-freeze
Protection in Cold Weather:
Operating your vehicle in
temperatures below 4 degrees C (40
degrees F) using washer fluid without
anti-freeze protection is dangerous
as it could cause impaired windshield
vision and result in an accident. In
cold weather, always use washer
fluid with anti-freeze protection.
NOTE
State or local regulations may restrict the use
of volatile organic compounds (VOCs), which
are commonly used as anti-freeze agents in
washer fluid. A washer fluid with limited VOC
content should be used only if it provides
adequate freeze resistance for all regions and
climates in which the vehicle will be operated.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page385
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (386,1)
Inspect fluid level in the washer fluid
reservoir; add fluid if necessary.
L
F
OK
The top of the float should be between F
and L.
Use plain water if washer fluid is
unavailable.
But use only washer fluid in cold weather
to prevent it from freezing.
NOTE
Front and rear washer fluid is supplied from
the same reservoir.
Body Lubrication
All moving points of the body, such as
door and hood hinges and locks, should
be lubricated each time the engine oil is
changed. Use a nonfreezing lubricant on
locks during cold weather.
Make sure the hood's secondary latch
keeps the hood from opening when the
primary latch is released.
6-26
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page386
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (387,1)
Wiper Blades
CAUTION
ØHot waxes applied by automatic
car washers have been known to
affect the wiper's ability to clean
windows.
ØTo prevent damage to the wiper
blades, do not use gasoline,
kerosene, paint thinner, or other
solvents on or near them.
ØWhen the wiper lever is in the
AUTO position and the ignition is
switched ON, the wipers may
move automatically in the
following cases:
ØIf the windshield above the rain
sensor is touched.
ØIf the windshield above the rain
sensor is wiped with a cloth.
ØIf the windshield is struck with
a hand or other object.
ØIf the rain sensor is struck with
a hand or other object from
inside the vehicle.
Be careful not to pinch hands or
fingers as it may cause injury, or
damage the wipers. When
washing or servicing your Mazda,
make sure the wiper lever is in the
OFF position.
Contamination of either the windshield or
the blades with foreign matter can reduce
wiper effectiveness. Common sources are
insects, tree sap, and hot wax treatments
used by some commercial car washes.
If the blades are not wiping properly,
clean the window and blades with a good
cleaner or mild detergent; then rinse
thoroughly with clean water. Repeat if
necessary.
q
Replacing Windshield Wiper Blades
When the wipers no longer clean well, the
blades are probably worn or cracked.
Replace them.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the wiper arms
and other components, do not try to
sweep the wiper arm by hand.
NOTE
To prevent damage to the wiper arm blades
when raising both the driver and passenger
side wiper arms, raise the driver side wiper
arm first. Conversely, when setting down the
wiper arms, set the passenger side wiper arm
down first.
1. Raise the wiper arm.
2. Open the clip and slide the blade
assembly in the direction of the arrow.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the windshield
let the wiper arm down easily, do not
let it slap down on the windshield.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page387
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (388,1)
3. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it
out of blade holder.
4. Remove the metal stiffeners from each
blade rubber and install them in the
new blade.
CAUTION
ØDo not bend or discard the
stiffeners. You need to use them
again.
ØIf the metal stiffeners are
switched, the blade's wiping
efficiency could be reduced.
So do not use the driver's side
metal stiffeners on the passenger's
side, or vice versa.
ØBe sure to reinstall the metal
stiffeners in the new blade rubber
so that the curve is the same as it
was in the old blade rubber.
5. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.
Then install the blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
qReplacing Rear Window Wiper
Blade
When the wiper no longer cleans well, the
blade is probably worn or cracked.
Replace it.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the wiper arm
and other components, do not move
the wiper by hand.
6-28
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page388
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (389,1)
1. Remove the cover and raise the wiper
arm.
2. Firmly rotate the wiper blade to the
right until it unlocks, then remove the
blade.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the rear
window, do not let the wiper arm fall
on it.
3. Pull down the blade rubber and slide it
out of the blade holder.
4. Remove the metal stiffeners from the
blade rubber and install them in the
new blade.
CAUTION
Do not bend or discard the stiffeners.
You need to use them again.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page389
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (390,1)
5. Carefully insert the new blade rubber.
Then install the blade assembly in the
reverse order of removal.
6-30
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page390
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (391,1)
Battery
WARNING
Wash hands after handling the battery and related accessories:
Battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds,
chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and reproductive harm.
Read the following precautions carefully before using the battery or inspecting
to ensure safe and correct handling:
Always wear eye protection when working near the battery:
Working without eye protection is dangerous. Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID
which could cause blindness if splashed into your eyes. Also, hydrogen gas produced
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode.
Wear eye protection and protective gloves to prevent contact with battery
fluid:
Spilled battery fluid is dangerous.
Battery fluid contains SULFURIC ACID which could cause serious injuries if it gets in
eyes, or on the skin or clothing. If this happens, immediately flush your eyes with
water for 15 minutes or wash your skin thoroughly and get medical attention.
Always keep batteries out of the reach of children:
Allowing children to play near batteries is dangerous. Battery fluid could cause
serious injuries if it gets in the eyes or on the skin.
Keep flames and sparks away from open battery cells and do not allow metal
tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative ( ) terminal of the battery when
working near a battery. Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact the vehicle
body:
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. Keep all flames including
cigarettes and sparks away from open battery cells.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page391
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (392,1)
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery cells:
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.
NOTE
Before performing battery maintenance, remove the battery cover by pulling the tab.
Tab
qBattery Maintenance
To get the best service from a battery:
lKeep it securely mounted.
lKeep the top clean and dry.
lKeep terminals and connections clean,
tight, and coated with petroleum jelly
or terminal grease.
lRinse off spilled electrolyte
immediately with a solution of water
and baking soda.
lIf the vehicle will not be used for an
extended time, disconnect the battery
cables and charge the battery every six
weeks.
When replacing the battery, refer to the
specification charts (page 9-4).
6-32
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page392
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (393,1)
Replace Electrical Battery
If the buttons on the transmitter are
inoperable and the operation indicator
light does not flash, the battery may be
dead.
Replace with a new battery before the
transmitter becomes unusable.
CAUTION
ØMake sure the battery is installed
correctly. Battery leakage could
occur if it is not installed correctly.
ØWhen replacing the battery, be
careful not to touch any of the
internal circuitry and electrical
terminals, bend the electrical
terminals, or get dirt in the
transmitter as the transmitter
could be damaged.
ØThere is the danger of explosion if
the battery is not correctly
replaced.
ØDispose of used batteries
according to the following
instructions.
ØInsulate the plus and minus
terminals of the battery using
cellophane or equivalent tape.
ØNever disassemble.
ØNever throw the battery into
fire or water.
ØNever deform or crush.
ØReplace only with the same type
battery (CR2025 or equivalent).
The following conditions indicate that the
battery power is low:
lThe KEY indicator light (green) flashes
in the instrument cluster for about 30
seconds after the engine is turned off
(for vehicles with a type A meter,
messages are displayed in the
instrument cluster).
lThe system does not operate and the
operation indicator light on the
transmitter does not flash when the
buttons are pressed.
lThe system's operational range is
reduced.
Replacing the battery at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer is recommended to prevent
damage to the key. If replacing the battery
by yourself, follow the instruction below.
Replacing the key battery
1. Pull out the auxiliary key.
2. Insert a small, flathead screwdriver into
the groove shown in the figure and
rotate the screwdriver to open the cover
slightly.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page393
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (394,1)
3. Insert the small, flathead screwdriver
into the gap between the cover and the
transmitter, and then rotate the
screwdriver to detach the cover.
4. Remove the battery cap, then remove
the battery.
5. Insert a new battery with the positive
pole facing up, and then cover the
battery with the battery cap.
6. Close the cover.
7. Reinsert the auxiliary key.
6-34
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page394
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (395,1)
CAUTION
ØBe careful not to allow the rubber
ring shown in the figure to be
scratched or damaged.
ØIf the rubber ring detaches,
reattach it before inserting a new
battery.
Rubber ring
Tires
For reasons of proper performance, safety,
and better fuel economy, always maintain
recommended tire inflation pressures and
stay within the recommended load limits
and weight distribution.
WARNING
Using Different Tire Types:
Driving your vehicle with different
types of tires is dangerous. It could
cause poor handling and poor
braking; leading to loss of control.
Except for the limited use of the
temporary spare tire, use only the
same type tires (radial, bias-belted,
bias-type) on all four wheels.
Using Wrong-Sized Tires:
Using any other tire size than what is
specified for your Mazda (page 9-8)
is dangerous. It could seriously affect
ride, handling, ground clearance, tire
clearance, and speedometer
calibration. This could cause you to
have an accident. Use only tires that
are the correct size specified for your
Mazda.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page395
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (396,1)
qTire Inflation Pressure
WARNING
Always inflate the tires to the correct
pressure:
Overinflation or underinflation of
tires is dangerous. Adverse handling
or unexpected tire failure could result
in a serious accident.
Refer to Tires on page 9-8.
Use only a Mazda-genuine tire valve
cap:
Use of a non-genuine part is
dangerous as the correct tire air
pressure cannot be maintained if the
tire valve becomes damaged. If the
vehicle is driven under this condition,
the tire air pressure will decrease
which could result in a serious
accident. Do not use any part for the
tire valve cap that is not a Mazda-
genuine part.
Inspect all tire pressures monthly
(including the spare) when the tires are
cold. Maintain recommended pressures
for the best ride, handling, and minimum
tire wear.
Refer to the specification charts (page
9-8).
After adjusting the tire pressure,
initialization of the tire pressure
monitoring system is necessary to make
the system operates normally.
Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Initialization on page 4-95.
NOTE
lAlways check tire pressure when tires are
cold.
lWarm tires normally exceed recommended
pressures. Do not release air from warm
tires to adjust the pressure.
lUnderinflation can cause reduced fuel
economy, uneven and accelerated tire wear,
and poor sealing of the tire bead, which
will deform the wheel and cause separation
of tire from rim.
lOverinflation can produce a harsh ride,
uneven and accelerated tire wear, and a
greater possibility of damage from road
hazards.
Keep your tire pressure at the correct
levels. If one frequently needs inflating,
have it inspected.
qTire Rotation
WARNING
Rotate tires periodically:
Irregular tire wear is dangerous. To
equalize tread wear for maintaining
good performance in handling and
braking, rotate the tires according to
the scheduled maintenance charts.
Refer to Scheduled Maintenance on
page 6-4.
6-36
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page396
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (397,1)
During rotation, inspect them for correct
balance.
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)
spare tire in rotation.
Forward
Also, inspect them for uneven wear and
damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused
by one or a combination of the following:
lIncorrect tire pressure
lImproper wheel alignment
lOut-of-balance wheel
lSevere braking
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to
specification (page 9-8) and inspect the
lug nuts for tightness.
After adjusting the tire pressure,
initialization of the tire pressure
monitoring system is necessary to make
the system operates normally.
Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Initialization on page 4-95.
CAUTION
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial
tires that have an asymmetrical tread
pattern or studs only from front to
rear, not from side to side. Tire
performance will be reduced if
rotated from side to side.
qReplacing a Tire
WARNING
Always use tires that are in good
condition:
Driving with worn tires is dangerous.
Reduced braking, steering, and
traction could result in an accident.
Replace all four tires at the same time:
Replacing just one tire is dangerous.
It could cause poor handling and
poor braking resulting in loss of
vehicle control. Mazda strongly
recommends that you replace all four
tires at the same time.
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator
will appear as a solid band across the
tread.
Replace the tire when this happens.
New tread
Tread wear indicator
Worn tread
You should replace the tire before the
band crosses the entire tread.
After adjusting the tire pressure,
initialization of the tire pressure
monitoring system is necessary to make
the system operates normally.
Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System
Initialization on page 4-95.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-37
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page397
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (398,1)
NOTE
Tires degrade over time, even when they are
not being used on the road. It is recommended
that tires generally be replaced when they are
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates
or frequent high loading conditions can
accelerate the aging process. You should
replace the spare tire when you replace the
other road tires due to the aging of the spare
tire. The period in which the tire was
manufactured (both week and year) is
indicated by a 4-digit number.
Refer to Tire Labeling on page 8-24.
qTemporary Spare Tire
Inspect the temporary spare tire at least
monthly to make sure it is properly
inflated and stored.
NOTE
The temporary spare tire condition gradually
deteriorates even if it has not been used.
The temporary spare tire is easier to
handle because of its construction which
is lighter and smaller than a conventional
tire. This tire should be used only for an
emergency and only for a short distance.
Use the temporary spare tire only until the
conventional tire is repaired, which should
be as soon as possible.
Refer to Tires on page 9-8.
CAUTION
ØDo not use your temporary spare
tire rim with a snow tire or a
conventional tire. Neither will
properly fit and could damage
both tire and rim.
ØThe temporary spare tire has a
tread life of less than 5,000 km
(3,000 miles). The tread life may
be shorter depending on driving
conditions.
ØThe temporary spare tire is for
limited use, however, if the tread
wear solid-band indicator
appears, replace the tire with the
same type of temporary spare
(page 6-38).
NOTE
Tires degrade over time, even when they are
not being used on the road. It is recommended
that tires generally be replaced when they are
6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates
or frequent high loading conditions can
accelerate the aging process. You should
replace the spare tire when you replace the
other road tires due to the aging of the spare
tire. The period in which the tire was
manufactured (both week and year) is
indicated by a 4-digit number.
Refer to Tire Labeling on page 8-24.
qReplacing a Wheel
WARNING
Always use wheels of the correct size
on your vehicle:
Using a wrong-sized wheel is
dangerous. Braking and handling
could be affected, leading to loss of
control and an accident.
6-38
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page398
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (399,1)
CAUTION
A wrong-sized wheel may adversely
affect:
ØTire fit
ØWheel and bearing life
ØGround clearance
ØSnow-chain clearance
ØSpeedometer calibration
ØHeadlight aim
ØBumper height
ØTire Pressure Monitoring System
When replacing a wheel, make sure the
new one is the same as the original factory
wheel in diameter, rim width, and offset
(inset/outset).
Proper tire balancing provides the best
riding comfort and helps reduce tread
wear. Out-of-balance tires can cause
vibration and uneven wear, such as
cupping and flat spots.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page399
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (400,1)
Light Bulbs
With xenon fusion headlights With halogen headlights
Rear map lights
Overhead light (Front)/
Map lights
Luggage compartment light
Daytime running lights
Rear side-marker lights
Rear turn signal lights
Brake lights/TaillightsTaillights (Liftgate side)
Reverse lights
License plate lights
Headlights (Low/High beam)
High-mount brake light
Side turn signal lights
Front turn signal lights/Parking lights
(Front side-marker lights)
Fog lights
Headlights (High beam)/
Day time running lights
Headlights (Low beam)
Front turn signal lights/
Parking lights (Front side-
marker lights)
Fog lights
Vanity mirror lights
Rear map lights
Overhead light (Front)/
Map lights
Luggage compartment light
Vanity mirror lights
Some models.
6-40
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page400
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (401,1)
WARNING
Do not replace the xenon fusion bulbs
yourself:
Replacing the xenon fusion bulbs
yourself is dangerous. Because the
xenon fusion bulbs require high
voltage, you could receive an electric
shock if the bulbs are handled
incorrectly. Consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer when the replacement
is necessary.
Never touch the glass portion of a
halogen bulb with your bare hands and
always wear eye protection when
handling or working around the bulbs:
When a halogen bulb breaks, it is
dangerous. These bulbs contain
pressurized gas. If one is broken, it
will explode and serious injuries
could be caused by the flying glass.
If the glass portion is touched with
bare hands, body oil could cause the
bulb to overheat and explode when
lit.
Always keep halogen bulbs out of the
reach of children:
Playing with a halogen bulb is
dangerous. Serious injuries could be
caused by dropping a halogen bulb
or breaking it some other way.
NOTE
lTo replace the bulb, contact an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
lIf the halogen bulb is accidentally touched,
it should be cleaned with rubbing alcohol
before being used.
lUse the protective cover and carton for the
replacement bulb to dispose of the old bulb
promptly and out of the reach of children.
qReplacing Exterior Light Bulbs
Headlights (With xenon fusion
headlights)
Low/High beam bulbs
You cannot replace the low/high beam
bulbs by yourself. The bulbs must be
replaced at an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Daytime running lights
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
2. Lift the hood.
3. Disconnect the connector from the unit
by pressing the tab on the connector
with your finger and pulling the
connector backward.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-41
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page401
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (402,1)
4. Turn the socket and bulb assembly to
remove it. Carefully remove the bulb
from its socket in the reflector by
gently pulling it straight back out of the
socket.
5. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Headlights (With halogen headlights)
Low-beam bulbs, High-beam bulbs/
Daytime running lights
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
2. Lift the hood.
3. (Right side)
Remove the windshield washer fluid
reservoir from the guide.
Windshield washer
fluid reservoir
Guide
4. Disconnect the connector from the unit
by pressing the tab on the connector
with your finger and pulling the
connector downward.
Low-beam bulbs
High-beam bulbs/Daytime running
lights
5. Turn the socket and bulb assembly to
remove it. Carefully remove the bulb
from its socket in the reflector by
gently pulling it straight backward out
of the socket.
6-42
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page402
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (403,1)
Low-beam bulbs
High-beam bulbs/Daytime running
lights
6. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Front turn signal lights/Parking lights
(Front side-marker lights)
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
2. If you are changing the right bulb, start
the engine, turn the steering wheel all
the way to the right, and turn off
engine. If you are changing the left
bulb, turn the steering wheel to the left.
3. Pull the center of each plastic retainer
and remove the retainers.
Installation
Removal
4. Turn the screw counterclockwise and
remove it, and then partially peel back
the mudguard.
5. Turn the socket and bulb assembly
counterclockwise and remove it.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-43
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page403
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (404,1)
6. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.
7. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Fog lights
í
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
2. If you are changing the right bulb, start
the engine, turn the steering wheel all
the way to the right, and turn off
engine. If you are changing the left
bulb, turn the steering wheel to the left.
3. Pull the center of each plastic retainer
and remove the retainers.
Installation
Removal
4. Turn the screw counterclockwise and
remove it, and then partially peel back
the mudguard.
5. Disconnect the connector from the unit
by pressing the tab on the connector
with your finger and pulling the
connector downward.
6-44
Maintenance and Care
í
Some models.
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page404
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (405,1)
6. Turn the socket and bulb assembly to
remove it. Carefully remove the bulb
from its socket in the reflector by
gently pulling it straight back out of the
socket.
7. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Side-turn signal lights
Due to the complexity and difficulty of
the procedure, the LED bulbs must be
replaced by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
LED bulb replacement is not possible because
it is built into the unit. Replace the unit.
Brake lights/Taillights, Rear turn signal
lights, Rear side-marker lights,
Taillights (Liftgate side), Reverse lights
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
2. Remove the cover with a cloth-
wrapped flathead screwdriver to the
cover.
Brake lights/Taillights, Rear turn signal
lights, Rear side-marker lights
Taillights (Liftgate side), Reverse lights
3. Turn the socket and bulb assembly
counterclockwise and remove it.
4. Disconnect the bulb from the socket.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page405
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (406,1)
Brake lights/Taillights
Rear turn signal lights
Rear side-marker lights
Taillights (Liftgate side)
Reverse lights
5. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
High-mount brake light
Due to the complexity and difficulty of
the procedure, the LED bulbs must be
replaced by an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
LED bulb replacement is not possible because
it is built into the unit. Replace the unit.
License plate lights
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and the headlight switch is off.
6-46
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page406
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (407,1)
2. Wrap a flathead screwdriver with a soft
cloth to prevent damage to the lens,
and then remove the lens by carefully
prying on the edge of the lens with a
flathead screwdriver.
3. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.
4. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
qReplacing Interior Light Bulbs
Overhead light (Front)/Map lights,
Rear map lights, Vanity mirror lights
í
1. Wrap a small flathead screwdriver with
a soft cloth to prevent damage to the
lens, and then remove the lens by
carefully prying on the edge of the lens
with the flathead screwdriver.
2. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.
Overhead light (Front)/Map lights
Rear map lights
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-47
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page407
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (408,1)
Vanity mirror lights
3. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Luggage compartment light
1. Wrap a small flathead screwdriver with
a soft cloth to prevent damage to the
lens and remove the lens unit by
carefully prying on the edge of the lens
unit with the flathead screwdriver.
2. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the bulb by pressing the tab on
the connector with your finger and
pulling the connector.
CAUTION
When replacing the bulb always
disconnect the connector first.
Otherwise, electric and electronic
devices could be shorted.
6-48
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page408
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (409,1)
3. Disconnect the bulb by pulling it out.
4. Install the new bulb in the reverse order
of the removal procedure.
Fuses
Your vehicle's electrical system is
protected by fuses.
If any lights, accessories, or controls do
not work, inspect the appropriate circuit
protector. If a fuse has blown, the inside
element will be melted.
If the same fuse blows again, avoid using
that system and consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
qFuse Replacement
Replacing the fuses on the vehicle's left
side
If the electrical system does not work,
first inspect the fuses on the vehicle's left
side.
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and other switches are off.
2. Open the fuse panel cover.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page409
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (410,1)
3. Pull the fuse straight out with the fuse
puller provided on the fuse block
located in the engine compartment.
4. Inspect the fuse and replace it if it is
blown.
Normal Blown
5. Insert a new fuse of the same amperage
rating, and make sure it fits tightly. If it
does not fit tightly, have an expert
install it. We recommend an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
If you have no spare fuses, borrow one
of the same rating from a circuit not
essential to vehicle operation, such as
the AUDIO or OUTLET circuit.
CAUTION
Always replace a fuse with a genuine
Mazda fuse or equivalent of the same
rating. Otherwise you may damage
the electric system.
6. Reinstall the cover and make sure that
it is securely installed.
Replacing the fuses under the hood
If the headlights or other electrical
components do not work and the fuses in
the cabin are normal, inspect the fuse
block under the hood. If a fuse is blown, it
must be replaced. Follow these steps:
1. Make sure the ignition is switched off,
and other switches are off.
2. Remove the fuse block cover.
6-50
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page410
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (411,1)
3. If any fuse but the MAIN fuse is
blown, replace it with a new one of the
same amperage rating.
Normal Blown
WARNING
Do not replace the main fuse by
yourself. Have an Authorized Mazda
Dealer perform the replacement:
Replacing the fuse by yourself is
dangerous because the MAIN fuse is
a high current fuse. Incorrect
replacement could cause an electrical
shock or a short circuit resulting in a
fire.
4. Reinstall the cover and make sure that
it is securely installed.
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-51
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page411
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (412,1)
qFuse Panel Description
Fuse block (Engine compartment)
DESCRIPTION FUSE
RATING PROTECTED COMPONENT
1 ADD FAN GE 30 A Cooling fan
2 IG2 30 A For protection of various circuits
3 INJECTOR 30 A Engine control system
4 FAN DE 40 A
5 P.WINDOW1 30 A Power windows
6―― ―
7 ADD FAN DE 40 A
8 EVVT 20 A Engine control system
9 DEFOG 40 A Rear window defogger
10 DCDC DE 40 A
11 FAN GE 30 A Cooling fan
12 ―― ―
13 ―― ―
14 ―― ―
15 ENG.MAIN 40 A Engine control system
16 ABS/DSC M 50 A ABS, Dynamic stability control system
17 50 A For protection of various circuits
6-52
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page412
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (413,1)
DESCRIPTION FUSE
RATING PROTECTED COMPONENT
18 WIPER 20 A Front window wiper and washer
19 HEATER 40 A Air conditioner
20 DCDC REG 30 A
21 ENGINE.IG1 7.5 A Engine control system
22 C/U IG1 15 A For protection of various circuits
23 H/L LOW L
HID L 15 A Headlight (LH)
*1
, Headlight low beam (LH)
*2
24 H/L LOW R 15 A Headlight low beam (RH)
*2
25 ENGINE3 15 A Engine control system
26 ENGINE2 15 A Engine control system
27 ENGINE1 15 A Engine control system
28 AT 15 A Transaxle control system
í
, Ignition switch
29 H/CLEAN 20 A
30 A/C 7.5 A Air conditioner
31 AT PUMP 15 A
32 STOP 10 A Brake lights
33 R.WIPER 15 A Rear window wiper
34 H/L HI 20 A Headlight high beam
*2
35 HID R 15 A Headlight (RH)
*1
36 FOG 15 A Fog lights
í
37 7.5 A Engine control system
38 AUDIO2 7.5 A Audio system
39 GLOW SIG 5 A
40 METER2 7.5 A
41 METER1 10 A Instrument cluster
42 SRS1 7.5 A Air bag
43 BOSE 25 A Bose
®
Sound System-equipped model
í
44 AUDIO1 15 A Audio system
45 ABS/DSC S 30 A ABS, Dynamic stability control system
46 FUEL PUMP 15 A Fuel system
47 FUEL WARM 25 A
48 TAIL 15 A Taillights, License plate lights
49 FUEL PUMP2 25 A
50 HAZARD 25 A Hazard warning flashers, Turn signal lights, Parking lights
(Front side-marker lights)
51 DRL 15 A Daytime running lights
í
52 R.OUTLET2 15 A Accessory sockets
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-53
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page413
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (414,1)
DESCRIPTION FUSE
RATING PROTECTED COMPONENT
53 HORN 15 A Horn
54 ROOM 15 A Overhead light
*1 With xenon fusion headlights
*2 With halogen headlights
Fuse block (Left side)
DESCRIPTION FUSE
RATING PROTECTED COMPONENT
1 P.SEAT D 30 A Power seat
í
2 P.WINDOW3 30 A
3 R.OUTLET3 15 A Accessory sockets
4 P.WINDOW2 25 A Power windows
5 SRS2/ESCL 15 A Seat weight sensor
í
6 D.LOCK 25 A Power door locks
7 SEAT WARM 20 A Seat warmer
í
8 SUNROOF 10 A Moonroof
í
9 F.OUTLET 15 A Accessory sockets
10 MIRROR 7.5 A Power control mirror
11 R.OUTLET1 15 A
12 ―― ―
6-54
Maintenance and Care
í
Some models.
Owner Maintenance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page414
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (415,1)
DESCRIPTION FUSE
RATING PROTECTED COMPONENT
13 ―― ―
14 ―― ―
15 ―― ―
16 ―― ―
17 M.DEF 7.5 A Mirror defogger
í
18 ―― ―
19 ―― ―
20 AT IND 7.5 A AT shift indicator
í
21 P.SEAT P 30 A
Maintenance and Care
Owner Maintenance
6-55
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page415
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (416,1)
Exterior Care
The paintwork on your Mazda represents
the latest technical developments in
composition and methods of application.
Environmental hazards, however, can
harm the paint's protective properties, if
proper care is not taken.
Here are some examples of possible
damage, with tips on how to prevent
them.
Etching Caused by Acid Rain or
Industrial Fallout
Occurrence
Industrial pollutants and vehicle emissions
drift into the air and mix with rain or dew
to form acids. These acids can settle on a
vehicle's finish. As the water evaporates,
the acid becomes concentrated and can
damage the finish.
And the longer the acid remains on the
surface, the greater the chance is for
damage.
Prevention
It is necessary to wash and wax your
vehicle to preserve its finish according to
the instructions in this section. These
steps should be taken immediately after
you suspect that acid rain has settled on
your vehicle's finish.
Damage Caused by Bird Dropping,
Insects, or Tree Sap
Occurrence
Bird droppings contain acids. If these are
not removed they can eat away the clear
and color base coat of the vehicle's
paintwork.
When insects stick to the paint surface
and decompose, corrosive compounds
form. These can erode the clear and color
base coat of the vehicle's paintwork if
they are not removed.
Tree sap will harden and adhere
permanently to the paint finish. If you
scratch the sap off while it is hard, some
vehicle paint could come off with it.
Prevention
It is necessary to have your Mazda
washed and waxed to preserve its finish
according to the instructions in this
section. This should be done as soon as
possible.
Bird droppings can be removed with a
soft sponge and water. If you are traveling
and these are not available, a moistened
tissue may also take care of the problem.
The cleaned area should be waxed
according to the instructions in this
section.
Insects and tree sap are best removed with
a soft sponge and water or a commercially
available chemical cleaner.
Another method is to cover the affected
area with dampened newspaper for one to
two hours. After removing the newspaper,
rinse off the loosened debris with water.
Water Marks
Occurrence
Rain, fog, dew, and even tap water can
contain harmful minerals such as salt and
lime. If moisture containing these
minerals settles on the vehicle and
evaporates, the minerals will concentrate
and harden to form white rings. The rings
can damage your vehicle's finish.
6-56
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page416
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (417,1)
Prevention
It is necessary to wash and wax your
vehicle to preserve its finish according to
the instructions in this section. These
steps should be taken immediately after
you find water marks on your vehicle's
finish.
Paint Chipping
Occurrence
Paint chipping occurs when gravel thrown
in the air by another vehicle's tires hits
your vehicle.
How to avoid paint chipping
Keeping a safe distance between you and
the vehicle ahead reduces the chances of
having your paint chipped by flying
gravel.
NOTE
lThe paint chipping zone varies with the
speed of the vehicle. For example, when
traveling at 90 km/h (56 mph), the paint
chipping zone is 50 m (164 ft).
lIn low temperatures a vehicle's finish
hardens. This increases the chance of paint
chipping.
lChipped paint can lead to rust forming on
your Mazda. Before this happens, repair the
damage by using Mazda touch-up paint
according to the instructions in this section.
Failure to repair the affected area could
lead to serious rusting and expensive
repairs.
Follow all label and container directions
when using a chemical cleaner or polish.
Read all warnings and cautions.
qMaintaining the Finish
Washing
CAUTION
ØWhen the wiper lever is in the
AUTO position and the ignition is
switched ON, the wipers may
move automatically in the
following cases:
ØIf the windshield above the rain
sensor is touched or wiped with
a cloth.
ØIf the windshield is struck with
a hand or other object from
either outside or inside the
vehicle.
Keep hands and scrapers clear of
the windshield when the wiper
lever is in the AUTO position and
the ignition is switched ON as
fingers could be pinched or the
wipers and wiper blades damaged
when the wipers activate
automatically.
If you are going to clean the
windshield, be sure the wipers are
turned off completelythis is
particularly important when
clearing ice and snowwhen it is
most likely that the engine is left
running.
ØDo not spray water in the engine
compartment. Otherwise, it could
result in engine-starting problems
or damage to electrical parts.
ØWhen washing and waxing the
vehicle, be careful not to apply
excessive force to any single area
of the vehicle roof or the antenna.
Otherwise, you could dent the
vehicle or damage the antenna.
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
6-57
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page417
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (418,1)
To help protect the finish from rust and
deterioration, wash your Mazda
thoroughly and frequently, at least once a
month, with lukewarm or cold water.
If the vehicle is washed improperly, the
paint surface could be scratched. Here are
some examples of how scratching could
occur.
Scratches occur on the paint surface
when:
lThe vehicle is washed without first
rinsing off dirt and other foreign
matter.
lThe vehicle is washed with a rough,
dry, or dirty cloth.
lThe vehicle is washed at a car wash
that uses brushes that are dirty or too
stiff.
lCleansers or wax containing abrasives
are used.
NOTE
lMazda is not responsible for scratches
caused by automatic car washes or
improper washing.
lScratches are more noticeable on vehicles
with darker paint finishes.
To minimize scratches on the vehicle's
paint finish:
lRinse off any dirt or other foreign
matter using lukewarm or cold water
before washing.
lUse plenty of lukewarm or cold water
and a soft cloth when washing the
vehicle. Do not use a nylon cloth.
lRub gently when washing or drying the
vehicle.
lTake your vehicle only to a car wash
that keeps its brushes well maintained.
lDo not use abrasive cleansers or wax
that contain abrasives.
CAUTION
Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or caustic
agents on chrome-plated or anodized
aluminum parts. This may damage
the protective coating; also, cleaners
and detergents may discolor or
deteriorate the paint.
Pay special attention to removing salt,
dirt, mud, and other foreign material from
the underside of the fenders, and make
sure the drain holes in the lower edges of
the doors and rocker panels are clean.
Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,
industrial fallout, and similar deposits can
damage the finish if not removed
immediately. When prompt washing with
plain water is ineffective, use a mild soap
made for use on vehicles.
Thoroughly rinse off all soap with
lukewarm or cold water. Do not allow
soap to dry on the finish.
After washing the vehicle, dry it with a
clean chamois to prevent water spots from
forming.
6-58
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page418
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (419,1)
WARNING
Dry off brakes that have become wet
by driving slowly, releasing the
accelerator pedal and lightly applying
the brakes several times until the brake
performance returns to normal:
Driving with wet brakes is
dangerous. Increased stopping
distance or the vehicle pulling to one
side when braking could result in a
serious accident. Light braking will
indicate whether the brakes have
been affected.
When using a high water pressure car
wash
High water temperature and high water
pressure car washers are available
depending on the type of car wash
machine. If the car washer nozzle is put
too close to the vehicle, the force of the
spray could damage or deform the
molding, affect the sealability of parts,
and allow water to penetrate the interior.
Keep a sufficient space (30 cm (12 in) or
more) between the nozzle and the vehicle.
In addition, do not spend too much time
spraying the same area of the vehicle, and
be very careful when spraying between
gaps in doors and around windows.
Waxing
Your vehicle needs to be waxed when
water no longer beads on the finish.
Always wash and dry the vehicle before
waxing it. In addition to the vehicle body,
wax the metal trim to maintain its luster.
1. Use wax which contains no abrasives.
Waxes containing abrasive will remove
paint and could damage bright metal
parts.
2. Use a good grade of natural wax for
metallic, mica, and solid colors.
3. When waxing, coat evenly with the
sponge supplied or a soft cloth.
4. Wipe off the wax with a soft cloth.
NOTE
A spot remover to remove oil, tar, and similar
materials will usually also take off the wax.
Rewax these areas even if the rest of the
vehicle does not need it.
qRepairing Damage to the Finish
Deep scratches or chips on the finish
should be repaired promptly. Exposed
metal quickly rusts and can lead to major
repairs.
CAUTION
If your Mazda is damaged and needs
metal parts repaired or replaced,
make sure the body shop applies
anti-corrosion materials to all parts,
both repaired and new. This will
prevent them from rusting.
qBright-Metal Maintenance
lUse tar remover to remove road tar and
insects. Never do this with a knife or
similar tool.
lTo prevent corrosion on bright-metal
surfaces, apply wax or chrome
preservative and rub it to a high luster.
lDuring cold weather or in coastal areas,
cover bright-metal parts with a coating
of wax or preservative heavier than
usual. It would also help to coat them
with noncorrosive petroleum jelly or
some other protective compound.
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
6-59
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page419
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (420,1)
CAUTION
Do not use steel wool, abrasive
cleaners, or strong detergents
containing highly alkaline or caustic
agents on chrome-plated or anodized
aluminum parts. This may result in
damage to the protective coating and
cause discoloration or paint
deterioration.
qUnderbody Maintenance
Road chemicals and salt used for ice and
snow removal and solvents used for dust
control may collect on the underbody. If
not removed, they will speed up rusting
and deterioration of such underbody parts
as fuel lines, frame, floor pan, and exhaust
system, even though these parts may be
coated with anti-corrosive material.
Thoroughly flush the underbody and
wheel housings with lukewarm or cold
water at the end of each winter. Try also
to do this every month.
Pay special attention to these areas
because they easily hide mud and dirt. It
will do more harm than good to wet
down the road grime without removing
it.
The lower edges of doors, rocker panels,
and frame members have drain holes that
should not be clogged. Water trapped
there will cause rusting.
WARNING
Dry off brakes that have become wet
by driving slowly, releasing the
accelerator pedal and lightly applying
the brakes several times until the brake
performance returns to normal:
Driving with wet brakes is
dangerous. Increased stopping
distance or the vehicle pulling to one
side when braking could result in a
serious accident. Light braking will
indicate whether the brakes have
been affected.
qAluminum Wheel Maintenance
í
A protective coating is provided over the
aluminum wheels. Special care is needed
to protect this coating.
CAUTION
Do not use any detergent other than
mild detergent. Before using any
detergent, verify the ingredients.
Otherwise, the product could discolor
or stain the aluminum wheels.
NOTE
lDo not use a wire brush or any abrasive
cleaner, polishing compound, or solvent on
aluminum wheels. They may damage the
coating.
lAlways use a sponge or soft cloth to clean
the wheels.
Rinse the wheels thoroughly with lukewarm
or cold water. Also, be sure to clean the
wheels after driving on dusty or salted
roads to help prevent corrosion.
lAvoid washing your vehicle in an automatic
car wash that uses high-speed or hard
brushes.
lIf your aluminum wheels lose luster, wax
the wheels.
6-60
Maintenance and Care
í
Some models.
Appearance Care
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page420
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (421,1)
qPlastic Part Maintenance
lWhen cleaning the plastic lenses of the
lights, do not use gasoline, kerosene,
rectified spirit, paint, thinner, highly
acidic detergents, or strongly alkaline
detergents. Otherwise, these chemical
agents can discolor or damage the
surfaces resulting in a significant loss
in functionality. If plastic parts become
inadvertently exposed to any of these
chemical agents, flush with water
immediately.
lIf plastic parts such as the bumpers
become inadvertently exposed to
chemical agents or fluids such as
gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery
fluid, it could cause discoloration,
staining, or paint peeling. Wipe off any
such chemical agents or fluids using a
soft cloth immediately.
lHigh water temperature and high water
pressure car washers are available
depending on the type of high pressure
car washer device. If the car washer
nozzle is put too close to the vehicle or
aimed at one area for an extended
period of time, it could deform plastic
parts or damage the paint.
lDo not use wax containing compounds
(polish). Otherwise, it could result in
paint damage.
lIn addition, do not use an electrical or
air tool to apply wax. Otherwise, the
frictional heat generated could result in
deformation of plastic parts or paint
damage.
Interior Care
WARNING
Do not spray water in the cabin:
Splashing water on electrical parts
such as the audio unit and switches
is dangerous as it could cause a
malfunction or a fire.
qDashboard Precautions
Prevent caustic solutions such as perfume
and cosmetic oils from contacting the
dashboard. They will damage and discolor
the dashboard. If these solutions get on
the dashboard, wipe them off
immediately.
CAUTION
Do not use glazing agents.
Glazing agents contain ingredients
which may cause discoloration,
wrinkling, cracks and peeling.
Instrument panel top (soft pad)
lExtremely soft material is used for the
soft pad surface. When cleaning, it is
recommended that you use a clean
towel dampened in a mild detergent to
remove soiling.
lIf the soft pad surface is rubbed
harshly, it could result in the surface
being damaged leaving white scratch
marks.
qCleaning the Upholstery and
Interior Trim
Vinyl
Remove dust and loose dirt from vinyl
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.
Clean vinyl with a leather-and-vinyl
cleaner.
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
6-61
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page421
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (422,1)
Leather
í
Remove dust and sand first using a
vacuum cleaner or other means, then wipe
dirt off using a soft cloth with a leather
cleaner or a soft cloth soaked in mild
soap.
Wipe off the remaining cleaner or soap
using a cloth soaked in clean water and
wrung out well.
Remove moisture with a dry, soft cloth
and allow the leather to further dry in a
well-ventilated, shaded area. If the leather
gets wet such as from rain, also remove
moisture and dry it as soon as possible.
NOTE
lBecause genuine leather is a natural
material, its surface is not uniform and it
may have natural scars, scratches, and
wrinkles.
lTo maintain the quality for as long as
possible, periodical maintenance, about
twice a year, is recommended.
lSand and dust on the seat surface may
damage the overcoat of the genuine leather
surfaces and accelerate wear.
lGreasy soiling on genuine leather may
cause molding and stains.
lRubbing hard with a stiff brush or cloth
may cause damage.
lDo not wipe the leather using alcohol,
chlorine bleach, or organic solvents such as
thinner, benzene, or gasoline. Otherwise, it
may cause discoloration or stains.
lIf the seats get wet, promptly remove
moisture with a dry cloth. Remaining
moisture on the surface may cause
deterioration such as hardening and
shrinkage.
lExposure to direct sunlight for long periods
may cause deterioration and shrinkage.
When parking the car under direct sunlight
for long periods, shade the interior using
sunshades.
lDo not leave vinyl products on the seats for
long periods as they may affect the leather
quality and coloring. If the cabin
temperature becomes hot, the vinyl may
deteriorate and adhere to the genuine
leather.
Fabric
Remove dust and loose dirt from fabric
with a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.
Clean it with a mild soap solution good
for upholstery and carpets. Remove fresh
spots immediately with a fabric spot
cleaner.
6-62
Maintenance and Care
í
Some models.
Appearance Care
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page422
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (423,1)
To keep the fabric looking clean and
fresh, take care of it. Otherwise its color
will be affected, it can be stained easily,
and its fire-resistance may be reduced.
CAUTION
Use only recommended cleaners and
procedures. Others may affect
appearance and fire-resistance.
Panel
When the panel needs to be cleaned, use a
soft cloth to wipe off dirt from the surface.
NOTE
Scratches or nicks on the panels resulting from
the use of a hard brush or cloth may not be
repairable.
Be particularly careful when cleaning the
following areas which are installed with
specially coated panels.
· Piano black panel
í
qCleaning the Lap/Shoulder Belt
Webbing
Clean the webbing with a mild soap
solution recommended for upholstery or
carpets. Follow instructions. Do not
bleach or dye the webbing; this may
weaken it.
After cleaning the belts, thoroughly dry
the belt webbing and make sure there is
no remaining moisture before retracting
them.
WARNING
Have an Authorized Mazda Dealer
replace damaged seat belts
immediately:
Using damaged seat belts is
dangerous. In a collision, damaged
belts cannot provide adequate
protection.
qCleaning the Window Interiors
If the windows become covered with an
oily, greasy, or waxy film, clean them
with glass cleaner. Follow the directions
on the container.
CAUTION
ØDo not scrape or scratch the inside
of the window glass. It could
damage the thermal filaments
and the antenna lines.
ØWhen washing the inside of the
window glass, use a soft cloth
dampened in lukewarm water,
gently wiping the thermal
filaments and the antenna lines.
Use of glass cleaning products
could damage the thermal
filaments and the antenna lines.
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
6-63
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page423
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (424,1)
qCleaning the Floor Mats
Rubber floor mats should be cleaned with
mild soap and water only.
WARNING
Do not use rubber cleaners, such as tire
cleaner or tire shine, when cleaning
rubber floor mats:
Cleaning the rubber floor mats with
rubber cleaning products makes the
floor mats slippery.
This may cause an accident when
depressing the accelerator, brake, or
clutch (Manual transaxle) pedal or
when getting in or out of the vehicle.
After removing the floor mats for
cleaning, always reinstall them
securely.Refer to Floor Mat on page 3-40.
6-64
Maintenance and Care
Appearance Care
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page424
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (425,1)
7If Trouble Arises
Helpful information on what to do if a problem arises with the vehicle.
Parking in an Emergency ............................................................. 7-2
Parking in an Emergency .......................................................... 7-2
Flat Tire ......................................................................................... 7-3
Spare Tire and Tool Storage ...................................................... 7-3
Changing a Flat Tire ................................................................. 7-7
Battery Runs Out ........................................................................ 7-14
Jump-Starting .......................................................................... 7-14
Emergency Starting .................................................................... 7-17
Starting a Flooded Engine ....................................................... 7-17
Push-Starting ........................................................................... 7-17
Overheating ................................................................................. 7-18
Overheating ............................................................................. 7-18
Emergency Towing ..................................................................... 7-20
Towing Description ................................................................. 7-20
Tiedown Hooks ....................................................................... 7-21
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds ..................... 7-23
When Warning/Indicator Lights Illuminate/Flash ................... 7-23
Warning Sound is Activated ................................................... 7-32
When Liftgate Cannot be Opened ............................................. 7-36
When Liftgate Cannot be Opened ........................................... 7-36
7-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page425
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (426,1)
Parking in an Emergency
The hazard warning lights should always
be used when you stop on or near a
roadway in an emergency.
The hazard warning lights warn other
drivers that your vehicle is a traffic hazard
and that they must take extreme caution
when near it.
Depress the hazard warning flasher and all
the turn signals will flash. The hazard
warning indicator lights in the instrument
cluster flash simultaneously.
NOTE
lThe turn signals do not work when the
hazard warning lights are on.
lCheck local regulations about the use of
hazard warning lights while the vehicle is
being towed to verify that it is not in
violation of the law.
7-2
If Trouble Arises
Parking in an Emergency
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page426
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (427,1)
Spare Tire and Tool Storage
Spare tire and tools are stored in the locations illustrated in the diagram.
Except Mexico
Spare tire
Spare tire hold-down bolt
Tire hold-down bolt
Jack
Lug wrench
Jack lever
Tiedown eyelet (Short type)
Tiedown eyelet (Long type)
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page427
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (428,1)
Mexico
Spare tire
Spare tire hold-down bolt
Jack
Lug wrench
Jack lever
Tiedown eyelet (Short type) Tiedown eyelet (Long type)
7-4
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page428
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (429,1)
qJack
To remove the jack
1. Open the trunk board.
2. Secure the trunk board by attaching the
hook to the head restraint.
Without luggage compartment cover
With luggage compartment cover
3. Remove the jack.
To secure the jack
Perform the removal procedure in reverse.
Maintenance
lAlways keep the jack clean.
lMake sure the moving parts are kept
free from dirt or rust.
lMake sure the screw thread is
adequately lubricated.
qSpare Tire
Your Mazda has a temporary spare tire.
The temporary spare tire is lighter and
smaller than a conventional tire, and is
designed only for emergency use and
should be used only for VERY short
periods. Temporary spare tires should
NEVER be used for long drives or
extended periods.
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page429
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (430,1)
WARNING
Do not install the temporary spare tire
on the front wheels (driving wheels):
Driving with the temporary spare tire
on one of the front driving wheels is
dangerous. Handling will be affected.
You could lose control of the vehicle,
especially on ice or snow bound
roads, and have an accident. Move a
regular tire to the front wheel and
install the temporary spare tire to the
rear.
CAUTION
ØWhen using the temporary spare
tire, driving stability may decrease
compared to when using only the
conventional tire. Drive carefully.
ØTo avoid damage to the temporary
spare tire or to the vehicle, observe
the following precautions:
ØDo not exceed 80 km/h (50
mph).
ØAvoid driving over obstacles.
Also, do not drive through an
automatic car wash. This tire's
diameter is smaller than a
conventional tire, so the ground
clearance is reduced about
10 mm (0.4 in).
ØDo not use a tire chain on this
tire because it will not fit
properly.
ØDo not use your temporary
spare tire on any other vehicle,
it has been designed only for
your Mazda.
ØUse only one temporary spare
tire on your vehicle at the same
time.
To remove the spare tire
1. Open the trunk board.
2. Secure the trunk board by attaching the
hook to the head restraint.
Without luggage compartment cover
With luggage compartment cover
7-6
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page430
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (431,1)
3. Turn the spare tire hold-down bolt
counterclockwise.
Spare tire hold-down bolt
To secure the spare tire
Store the spare tire in the reverse order of
removal. After storing, verify that the
spare tire is stored securely.
Changing a Flat Tire
NOTE
If the following occurs while driving, it could
indicate a flat tire.
lSteering becomes difficult.
lThe vehicle begins to vibrate excessively.
lThe vehicle pulls in one direction.
If you have a flat tire, drive slowly to a
level spot that is well off the road and out
of the way of traffic to change the tire.
Stopping in traffic or on the shoulder of a
busy road is dangerous.
WARNING
Be sure to follow the directions for
changing a tire:
Changing a tire is dangerous if not
done properly. The vehicle can slip off
the jack and seriously injure
someone.
No person should place any portion
of their body under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
Never allow anyone inside a vehicle
supported by a jack:
Allowing someone to remain in a
vehicle supported by a jack is
dangerous. The occupant could cause
the vehicle to fall resulting in serious
injury.
NOTE
Make sure the jack is well lubricated before
using it.
1. Park on a level surface off the right-of-
way and firmly set the parking brake.
2. Put a vehicle with an automatic
transaxle in Park (P), a manual
transaxle in Reverse (R) or 1, and turn
off the engine.
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page431
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (432,1)
3. Turn on the hazard warning flasher.
4. Have everyone get out of the vehicle
and away from the vehicle and traffic.
5. Remove the jack, tool, and spare tire
(page 7-3).
6. Block the wheel diagonally opposite
the flat tire. When blocking a wheel,
place a tire block both in front and
behind the tire.
NOTE
When blocking a tire, use rocks or wood blocks
of sufficient size if possible to hold the tire in
place.
qRemoving a Flat Tire
1. If your vehicle is equipped with steel
wheels, pry off the center cap with the
beveled end of the jack lever.
CAUTION
Use the jack lever when removing the
center cap. Using your hands to
remove it may cause an injury. In
addition, using a tool other than the
jack lever may cause damage to the
wheel or the center cap.
2. Loosen the lug nuts by turning them
counterclockwise one turn each, but do
not remove any lug nuts until the tire
has been raised off the ground.
3. Place the jack on the ground.
7-8
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page432
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (433,1)
4. Turn the jack screw in the direction
shown in the figure and adjust the jack
head so that it is close to the jack-up
position.
Jack head
5. Place the jack under the jack-up
position closest to the tire being
changed with the jack head squarely
under the jack-up point.
Jacking position
6. Continue raising the jack head
gradually by rotating the screw with
your hand until the jack head is
inserted into the jack-up position.
Tire blocks
Jacking position
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page433
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (434,1)
WARNING
Use only the front and rear jacking
positions recommended in this manual:
Attempting to jack the vehicle in
positions other than those
recommended in this manual is
dangerous. The vehicle could slip off
the jack and seriously injure or even
kill someone. Use only the front and
rear jacking positions recommended
in this manual.
Do not jack up the vehicle in a position
other than the designated jack-up
position or place any objects on or
under the jack:
Jacking up the vehicle in a position
other than the designated jack-up
position or placing objects on or
under the jack is dangerous as it
could deform the vehicle body or the
vehicle could fall off the jack
resulting in an accident.
Use only the jack provided with your
Mazda:
Using a jack that is not designed for
your Mazda is dangerous. The vehicle
could slip off the jack and seriously
injure someone.
Never place objects under the jack:
Jacking the vehicle with an object
under the jack is dangerous. The jack
could slip and someone could be
seriously injured by the jack or the
falling vehicle.
7. Insert the jack lever and attach the lug
wrench to tire jack.
8. Turn the jack handle clockwise and
raise the vehicle high enough so that
the spare tire can be installed. Before
removing the lug nuts, make sure your
Mazda is firmly in position and that it
cannot slip or move.
7-10
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page434
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (435,1)
WARNING
Do not jack up the vehicle higher than
is necessary:
Jacking up the vehicle higher than is
necessary is dangerous as it could
destabilize the vehicle resulting in an
accident.
Do not start the engine or shake the
vehicle while it is jacked up:
Starting the engine or shaking the
vehicle while it is jacked up is
dangerous as it could cause the
vehicle to fall off the jack resulting in
an accident.
Never go under the vehicle while it is
jacked up:
Going under the vehicle while it is
jacked up is dangerous as it could
result in death or serious injury if the
vehicle were to fall off the jack.
9. Remove the lug nuts by turning them
counterclockwise; then remove the
wheel and center cap.
qLocking Lug Nuts
If your vehicle has Mazda optional
antitheft wheel lug nuts, one on each
wheel will lock the tires and you must use
a special key to unlock them. This key
will attach to the lug wrench and can be
stored with the spare tire. Register them
with the lock manufacturer by filling out
the card provided in the glove
compartment and mailing it in the
accompanying envelope. If you lose this
key, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer
or use the lock manufacturer's order form,
which is with the registration card.
Special keyAntitheft lug nut
To remove an antitheft lug nut
1. Obtain the special key for the antitheft
lug nut.
2. Place the special key on top of the
antitheft lug nut, and be sure to hold
the key square to it. If you hold the key
at an angle, you may damage both key
and nut. Do not use a power impact
wrench.
3. Place the lug wrench on top of the key
and apply pressure. Turn the wrench
counterclockwise.
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page435
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (436,1)
To install the antitheft lug nut
1. Place the special key on top of the nut,
and be sure to hold the key square to it.
If you hold the key at an angle, you
may damage both key and nut. Do not
use a power impact wrench.
2. Place the lug wrench on top of the
special key, apply pressure, and turn it
clockwise.
Nut tightening torque
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf) 108147
(1214, 80108)
qMounting the Spare Tire
1. Remove dirt and grime from the
mounting surfaces of the wheel and
hub, including the hub bolts, with a
cloth.
WARNING
Make sure the mounting surfaces of
the wheel, hub and lug nuts are clean
before changing or replacing tires:
When changing or replacing a tire,
not removing dirt and grime from the
mounting surfaces of the wheel, hub
and hub bolts is dangerous. The lug
nuts could loosen while driving and
cause the tire to come off, resulting in
an accident.
2. Mount the spare tire.
3. Install the lug nuts with the beveled
edge inward; tighten them by hand.
WARNING
Do not apply oil or grease to lug nuts
and bolts and do not tighten the lug
nuts beyond the recommended
tightening torque:
Applying oil or grease to lug nuts and
bolts is dangerous. The lug nuts
could loosen while driving and cause
the tire to come off, resulting in an
accident. In addition, lug nuts and
bolts could be damaged if tightened
more than necessary.
7-12
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page436
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (437,1)
4. Turn the lug wrench counterclockwise
and lower the vehicle. Use the lug
wrench to tighten the nuts in the order
shown.
If you are unsure of how tight the nuts
should be, have them inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Nut tightening torque
N·m (kgf·m, ft·lbf) 108147
(1214, 80108)
WARNING
Always securely and correctly tighten
the lug nuts:
Improperly or loosely tightened lug
nuts are dangerous. The wheel could
wobble or come off. This could result
in loss of vehicle control and cause a
serious accident.
Be sure to reinstall the same nuts you
removed or replace them with metric
nuts of the same configuration:
Because the wheel studs and lug nuts
on your Mazda have metric threads,
using a non-metric nut is dangerous.
On a metric stud, it would not secure
the wheel and would damage the
stud, which could cause the wheel to
slip off and cause an accident.
5. (Aluminum wheel equipped vehicle)
Remove the center cap by tapping it
with the lug wrench.
6. Store the damaged tire, using the tire
hold-down bolt to hold it in place.
Tire hold-down bolt
7. Remove the tire blocks and store the
tools and jack.
8. Check the inflation pressure. Refer to
Tires on page 9-8.
9. Have the flat tire repaired or replaced
as soon as possible.
WARNING
Do not drive with any tires that have
incorrect air pressure:
Driving on tires with incorrect air
pressure is dangerous. Tires with
incorrect pressure could affect
handling and result in an accident.
When you check the regular tires' air
pressure, check the spare tire, too.
NOTE
To prevent the jack and tool from rattling, store
them properly.
If Trouble Arises
Flat Tire
7-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page437
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (438,1)
Jump-Starting
Jump-starting is dangerous if done incorrectly. So follow the procedure carefully. If you
feel unsure about jump-starting, we strongly recommend that you have a competent service
technician do the work.
WARNING
Follow These Precautions Carefully:
To ensure safe and correct handling of the battery, read the following precautions
carefully before using the battery or inspecting it.
Do not allow the positive ( ) terminal to contact any other metal object that
could cause sparks:
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries. When working near a
battery, do not allow metal tools to contact the positive ( ) or negative ( )
terminal of the battery.
Keep all flames, including cigarettes, and sparks away from open battery
cells:
Flames and sparks near open battery cells are dangerous. Hydrogen gas, produced
during normal battery operation, could ignite and cause the battery to explode. An
exploding battery can cause serious burns and injuries.
Do not jump-start a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level:
Jump-starting a frozen battery or one with a low fluid level is dangerous. It may
rupture or explode, causing serious injury.
Connect the negative cable to a good ground point away from the battery:
Connecting the end of the second jumper cable to the negative ( ) terminal of the
discharged battery is dangerous.
A spark could cause the gas around the battery to explode and injure someone.
Route the jumper cables away from parts that will be moving:
Connecting a jumper cable near or to moving parts (cooling fans, belts) is dangerous.
The cable could get caught when the engine starts and cause serious injury.
7-14
If Trouble Arises
Battery Runs Out
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page438
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (439,1)
CAUTION
Use only a 12 V booster system. You can damage a 12 V starter, ignition system, and
other electrical parts beyond repair with a 24 V power supply (two 12 V batteries in
series or a 24 V motor generator set).
Connect cables in numerical order and disconnect in reverse order.
Jumper cables
Booster battery
Discharged battery
1. Remove the battery cover.
2. Make sure the booster battery is 12 V
and that its negative terminal is
grounded.
3. If the booster battery is in another
vehicle, do not allow both vehicles to
touch. Turn off the engine of the
vehicle with the booster battery and all
unnecessary electrical loads in both
vehicles.
4. Connect the jumper cables in the exact
sequence as in the illustration.
lConnect one end of a cable to the
positive terminal on the discharged
battery (1).
lAttach the other end to the positive
terminal on the booster battery (2).
lConnect one end of the other cable
to the negative terminal of the
booster battery (3).
lConnect the other end to the ground
point indicated in the illustration
away from the discharged battery
(4).
If Trouble Arises
Battery Runs Out
7-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page439
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (440,1)
5. Start the engine of the booster vehicle
and run it a few minutes. Then start the
engine of the other vehicle.
6. When finished, carefully disconnect the
cables in the reverse order described in
the illustration.
7. If the battery cover has been removed,
install it in the reverse order of
removal.
NOTE
Verify that the covers are securely installed.
7-16
If Trouble Arises
Battery Runs Out
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page440
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (441,1)
Starting a Flooded Engine
If the engine fails to start, it may be
flooded (excessive fuel in the engine).
Follow this procedure:
1. If the engine does not start within five
seconds on the first try, wait ten
seconds and try again.
2. Make sure the parking brake is on.
3. Depress the accelerator all the way and
hold it there.
4. Depress the clutch pedal (Manual
transaxle) or the brake pedal
(Automatic transaxle), then press the
push button start. If the engine starts,
release the accelerator immediately
because the engine will suddenly rev
up.
5. If the engine fails to start, crank it
without depressing the accelerator.
If the engine still does not start using the
above procedure, have your vehicle
inspected by an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
Push-Starting
Do not push-start your Mazda.
WARNING
Never tow a vehicle to start it:
Towing a vehicle to start it is
dangerous. The vehicle being towed
could surge forward when its engine
starts, causing the two vehicles to
collide. The occupants could be
injured.
CAUTION
Do not push-start a vehicle that has
a manual transaxle. It can damage
the emission control system.
NOTE
You cannot start a vehicle with an automatic
transaxle by pushing it.
If Trouble Arises
Emergency Starting
7-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page441
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (442,1)
Overheating
If the High engine coolant temperature
warning light illuminates, the vehicle
loses power, or you hear a loud knocking
or pinging noise, the engine is probably
too hot.
WARNING
Switch the ignition to off and
make sure the fan is not running before
attempting to work near the cooling
fan:
Working near the cooling fan when it
is running is dangerous. The fan
could continue running indefinitely
even if the engine has stopped and
the engine compartment temperature
is high. You could be hit by the fan
and seriously injured.
Do not remove either
cooling system cap when the engine
and radiator are hot:
When the engine and radiator are
hot, scalding coolant and steam may
shoot out under pressure and cause
serious injury.
Open the hood ONLY after steam is no
longer escaping from the engine:
Steam from an overheated engine is
dangerous. The escaping steam could
seriously burn you.
If the High engine coolant temperature
warning light illuminates:
1. Drive safely to the side of the road and
park off the right-of-way.
2. Put a vehicle with an automatic
transaxle in park (P), a manual
transaxle in neutral.
3. Apply the parking brake.
4. Turn off the air conditioner.
5. Check whether coolant or steam is
escaping from the engine compartment.
If steam is coming from the engine
compartment:
Do not go near the front of the vehicle.
Stop the engine.
Wait until the steam dissipates, then
open the hood and start the engine.
If neither coolant nor steam is
escaping:
Open the hood and idle the engine until
it cools.
CAUTION
If the cooling fan does not operate
while the engine is running, the
engine temperature will increase.
Stop the engine and call an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
6. Make sure the cooling fan is operating,
then turn off the engine after the
temperature has decreased.
7. When cool, check the coolant level.
If it is low, look for coolant leaks from
the radiator and hoses.
7-18
If Trouble Arises
Overheating
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page442
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (443,1)
If you find a leak or other damage, or if
coolant is still leaking:
Stop the engine and call an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
Cooling system cap
Coolant reservoir
Cooling fan
If you find no problems, the engine is
cool, and no leaks are obvious:
Carefully add coolant as required (page
6-23).
CAUTION
If the engine continues to overheat or
frequently overheats, have the
cooling system inspected. The engine
could be seriously damaged unless
repairs are made. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
If Trouble Arises
Overheating
7-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page443
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (444,1)
Towing Description
We recommend that towing be done only
by an Authorized Mazda Dealer or a
commercial tow-truck service.
Proper lifting and towing are necessary to
prevent damage to the vehicle.
Particularly when towing a AWD vehicle,
where all the wheels are connected to the
drive train, proper transporting of the
vehicle is absolutely essential to avoid
damaging the drive system. Government
and local laws must be followed.
Wheel dollies
A towed 2WD vehicle should have its
drive wheels (front wheels) off the
ground. If excessive damage or other
conditions prevent this, use wheel dollies.
When towing a 2WD vehicle with the rear
wheels on the ground, release the parking
brake.
A towed AWD vehicle must have all its
wheels off the ground.
WARNING
Always tow a AWD vehicle with all four
wheels off the ground:
Towing a AWD vehicle with either the
front or rear wheels on the ground is
dangerous as the drive train could be
damaged, or the vehicle could trail
away from the tow truck and cause
an accident. If the drive train has
been damaged, transport the vehicle
on a flat bed truck.
7-20
If Trouble Arises
Emergency Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page444
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (445,1)
CAUTION
ØDo not tow the vehicle pointed
backward with driving wheels on
the ground. This may cause
internal damage to the transaxle.
ØDo not tow with sling-type
equipment. This could damage
your vehicle. Use wheel-lift or
flatbed equipment.
Tiedown Hooks
CAUTION
Do not use the front and rear
tiedown eyelets for towing the
vehicle.
They have been designed only for
securing the vehicle to a transport
vessel during shipping.
Using the eyelets for any other
purpose could result in the vehicle
being damaged.
qTiedown Hooks
1. Remove the tiedown eyelet and the lug
wrench from the luggage compartment
(page 7-3).
2. Wrap a flathead screwdriver or similar
tool with a soft cloth to prevent
damage to a painted bumper, and open
the cap located on the front or rear
bumper.
Front
If Trouble Arises
Emergency Towing
7-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page445
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (446,1)
Rear
CAUTION
Do not use excessive force as it may
damage the cap or scratch the
painted bumper surface.
NOTE
Remove the cap completely and store it so as
not to lose it.
3. Securely install the tiedown eyelet
using the lug wrench.
Front
Tiedown eyelet
(Long type)
Lug wrench
Rear
Tiedown eyelet
(Short type)
Lug wrench
4. Hook the tying rope to the tiedown
eyelet.
CAUTION
If the tiedown eyelet is not securely
tightened, it may loosen or disengage
from the bumper when tying the
vehicle. Make sure that the tiedown
eyelet is securely tightened to the
bumper.
7-22
If Trouble Arises
Emergency Towing
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page446
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (447,1)
When Warning/Indicator
Lights Illuminate/Flash
qIf the master warning light
illuminates
Type A
Displays when notification of the system
malfunctions is required.
Check the message indicated in the
display and consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
(Display example)
Displays as follows:
Master
warning
light
Indication in display and master
warning light in instrument cluster are
illuminated at same time
This indicates a malfunction with the
vehicle system. Check the message
indicated in the display and consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer. For details,
refer to the explanations for the warning/
indicator lights, in the warning/indicator
lights section, which match the symbol in
the upper part of the display. If a message
is not indicated in the display, operate the
INFO switch to display the Warning
screen.
Type B
The light illuminates continuously if any
one of the following occurs. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
lThere is a malfunction in the battery
management system.
lThere is a malfunction in the brake
switch.
qIf the brake system warning light
illuminates
If the brake warning light remains
illuminated even though the parking brake
is released, the brake fluid may be low or
there could be a problem with the brake
system. Park the vehicle in a safe place
immediately and contact an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page447
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (448,1)
WARNING
Do not drive with the brake system
warning light illuminated. Contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer to have the
brakes inspected as soon as possible:
Driving with the brake system
warning light illuminated is
dangerous. It indicates that your
brakes may not work at all or that
they could completely fail at any
time. If this light remains
illuminated, after checking that the
parking brake is fully released, have
the brakes inspected immediately.
CAUTION
In addition, the effectiveness of the
braking may diminish so you may
need to depress the brake pedal more
strongly than normal to stop the
vehicle.
qIf the antilock brake system
(ABS) warning light illuminates
If the ABS warning light stays on while
you're driving, the ABS control unit has
detected a system malfunction. If this
occurs, your brakes will function normally
as if the vehicle had no ABS.
Should this happen, consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
NOTE
When the engine is jump-started to charge the
battery, uneven rpm occurs and the ABS
warning light may illuminate. If this occurs, it
is the result of the weak battery and does not
indicate an ABS malfunction.
Recharge the battery.
qIf the brake system warning light
and the ABS warning light
illuminate simultaneously
If the electronic brake force distribution
control unit determines that some
components are operating incorrectly, the
control unit may illuminate the brake
system warning light and the ABS
warning light simultaneously. The
problem is likely to be the electronic
brake force distribution system.
WARNING
Do not drive with both the ABS warning
light and brake warning light
illuminated. Have the vehicle towed to
an Authorized Mazda Dealer to have
the brakes inspected as soon as
possible:
Driving when the brake system
warning light and ABS warning light
are illuminated simultaneously is
dangerous.
When both lights are illuminated, the
rear wheels could lock more quickly
in an emergency stop than under
normal circumstances.
7-24
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page448
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (449,1)
q
If the charging system warning
indication/warning light is indicated
Type A/Type B
If the warning light/indication illuminates
while driving, it indicates a malfunction
of the alternator or of the charging system.
Drive to the side of the road and park off
the right-of-way. Consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
CAUTION
Do not continue driving when the
charging system warning light is
illuminated because the engine could
stop unexpectedly.
q
If the engine oil warning indication/
warning light is indicated
Type A/Type B
This warning light/warning indication
indicates low engine oil pressure.
CAUTION
Do not run the engine if the oil
pressure is low. Otherwise, it could
result in extensive engine damage.
If the light illuminates or the warning
indication is displayed while driving:
1. Drive to the side of the road and park
off the right-of-way on level ground.
2. Turn off the engine and wait 5 minutes
for the oil to drain back into the oil
pan.
3. Inspect the engine oil level (page 6-22).
If it's low, add the appropriate amount
of engine oil while being careful not to
overfill.
CAUTION
Do not run the engine if the oil level
is low. Otherwise, it could result in
extensive engine damage.
4. Start the engine and check the warning
light/warning indication.
If the light/indication remains illuminated
even though the oil level is normal or after
adding oil, stop the engine immediately
and have your vehicle towed to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qIf the check engine light
illuminates or flashes
If this light illuminates while driving, the
vehicle may have a problem. It is
important to note the driving conditions
when the light illuminated and consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page449
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (450,1)
The check engine light may illuminate in
the following cases:
lThe fuel tank level being very low or
approaching empty.
lThe engine's electrical system has a
problem.
lThe emission control system has a
problem.
l(U.S.A. and Canada)
The fuel-filler cap is missing or not
tightened securely.
If the check engine light remains on, or it
flashes continuously, do not drive at high
speeds and consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer as soon as possible.
qIf the high engine coolant
temperature warning light (red)
illuminates or flashes
The light flashes when the engine coolant
temperature is extremely high, and
illuminates when the engine coolant
temperature increases further.
Handling Procedure
Flashing light
Drive slowly to reduce engine load until
you can find a safe place to stop the
vehicle and wait for the engine to cool
down.
Illuminated light
This indicates the possibility of
overheating. Park the vehicle in a safe
place immediately and stop the engine.
Refer to Overheating (page 7-18).
CAUTION
Do not drive the vehicle with the high
engine coolant temperature warning
light illuminated. Otherwise, it could
result in damage to the engine.
qIf the AWD warning indication/
warning light is indicated
Type A
The warning indication will display under
the following conditions;
lThere is an abnormality with the AWD
system.
lThere is too much difference in tire
radius between the front and rear
wheels.
lThe differential oil temperature is
abnormally high.
lThere is a continuous large difference
between front and rear wheel rotation,
such as when trying to pull away from
an icy surface or when trying to
remove the vehicle from mud, sand or
similar conditions.
When 4WD system inspection
requiredis indicated
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
7-26
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page450
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (451,1)
When Stop vehicle at safe areais
indicated
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a
few moments, if the indication disappears,
you can resume driving. If the indication
does not disappear, contact an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
Type B
The warning light will illuminate or flash
under the following conditions:
lIlluminates when there is an
abnormality with the AWD system.
lIlluminates if there is too much
difference in tire radius between the
front and rear wheels.
lFlashes when the differential oil
temperature is abnormally high.
lFlashes when there is a continuous
large difference between front and rear
wheel rotation, such as when trying to
pull away from an icy surface or when
trying to remove the vehicle from mud,
sand or similar conditions.
When illuminated
If the AWD warning light illuminates,
contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
When flashing
Park the vehicle in a safe place. After a
few moments, if the warning light stops
flashing, you can resume driving. If the
light does not stop flashing, contact an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
q
If the automatic transaxle warning
indication/warning light is indicated
Type A/Type B
The light/indication illuminates when the
transaxle has a problem.
CAUTION
If the automatic transaxle warning
light/warning indication illuminates,
the transaxle has an electrical
problem. Continuing to drive your
Mazda in this condition could cause
damage to your transaxle. Consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon
as possible.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page451
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (452,1)
qIf the power steering malfunction
warning indication/indicator light
is indicated
Type A/Type B
The power steering malfunction indicator
light/warning indication illuminates or
flashes if there is a malfunction with the
power steering while the engine is
running.
If the indicator light/warning indication
illuminates or flashes, park the vehicle in
a safe place immediately and stop the
engine.
If the indicator light/warning indication
does not turn off even if the engine is
restarted afterwards, consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lIf the indicator light/warning indication
illuminates or flashes, the power steering
will not operate normally. If this happens,
the steering wheel can still be operated,
however, the operation may feel heavy
compared to normal, and the steering
wheel could vibrate when turning.
lRepeatedly jerking the steering wheel left
and right while the vehicle is stopped or
moving extremely slowly will cause the
power steering system to go into protective
mode which will make the steering feel
heavy, but this does not indicate a problem.
If this occurs, park the vehicle safely and
wait several minutes for the system to
return to normal.
qIf the air bag/front seat belt
pretensioner system warning light
illuminates or flashes
A system malfunction is indicated if the
warning light constantly flashes,
constantly illuminates or does not
illuminate at all when the ignition is
switched ON. If any of these occur,
consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer as
soon as possible. The system may not
operate in an accident.
WARNING
Never tamper with the air bag/
pretensioner systems and always have
an Authorized Mazda Dealer perform
all servicing and repairs:
Self-servicing or tampering with the
systems is dangerous. An air bag/
pretensioner could accidentally
activate or become disabled causing
serious injury or death.
7-28
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page452
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (453,1)
qIf the tire pressure monitoring
system warning light flashes
If the tire pressure monitoring system has
a malfunction, the tire pressure warning
light flashes for about 1 minute when the
ignition is switched ON and then
continues illuminating. Have your vehicle
checked by an Authorized Mazda Dealer
as soon as possible.
qIf the KEY warning light (red)
illuminates
Type A
Keyless System Inspection Required
is displayed
This message is displayed if the advanced
keyless entry & push button start system
has a problem.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
CAUTION
If the above message is indicated, or
the push button start indicator light
(amber) flashes, the engine may not
start. If the engine cannot be started,
try starting it using the emergency
operation for starting the engine, and
have the vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
Refer to Emergency Operation for
Starting the Engine on page 4-8.
Set Power to OFFis displayed
This message is displayed when the
driver's door is opened without switching
the ignition off.
Key not foundis displayed
This message is displayed when any of
the following operations is performed
with the key out of the operational range
or placed in areas inside the cabin where it
is difficult for the key to be detected.
lThe push button start is pressed with
the ignition switched off
lThe ignition is switched on
lAll doors are closed without switching
the ignition off
Type B
If any malfunction occurs in the keyless
entry system, it illuminates continuously.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page453
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (454,1)
CAUTION
If the key warning indicator light
illuminates or the push button start
indicator light (amber) flashes, the
engine may not start. If the engine
cannot be started, try starting it
using the emergency operation for
starting the engine, and have the
vehicle inspected at an Authorized
Mazda Dealer as soon as possible.
Refer to Emergency Operation for
Starting the Engine on page 4-8.
qIf the traction control system
(TCS)/dynamic stability control
(DSC) indicator light illuminates
If the light stays on, the TCS, DSC or the
brake assist system may have a
malfunction and they may not operate
correctly. Take your vehicle to an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lIn addition to the indicator light flashing, a
slight lugging sound will come from the
engine. This indicates that the TCS/DSC is
operating properly.
lOn slippery surfaces, such as fresh snow, it
will be impossible to achieve high rpm
when the TCS is on.
q
If the traction control system (TCS)
OFF indicator light illuminates
If the light remains illuminated and the
TCS is not switched off, take your vehicle
to an Authorized Mazda Dealer. The DSC
may have a malfunction.
q
If the adaptive front lighting system
(AFS) OFF indicator light flashes
í
The indicator light flashes continuously if
the system is malfunctioning. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
lEven if the AFS is not operating due to
some malfunction, the normal headlight
function is still operable.
lIf there is a malfunction with the headlight
auto-leveling function, the indicator light
flashes.
7-30
If Trouble Arises
í
Some models.
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page454
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (455,1)
qIf the low engine coolant
temperature indicator light (blue)
does not turn off
If the low engine coolant temperature
indicator light remains illuminated after
the engine has been sufficiently warmed
up, the temperature sensor could have a
malfunction. Consult an Authorized
Mazda Dealer.
q
If the turn signal/hazard warning
indicator light illuminates or flashes
at an abnormally high speed
If an indicator light remains illuminated
(does not flash) or if it flashes abnormally,
one of the turn signal bulbs may be
burned out. Consult an Authorized Mazda
Dealer.
qIf the security indicator light
illuminates or flashes
If the engine does not start with the
correct key, and the security indicator
light keeps illuminating or flashing, the
system may have a malfunction. Consult
an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
q
If the blind spot monitoring (BSM)
system OFF indicator light flashes
í
The indicator light flashes if the BSM
system has a malfunction. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
NOTE
If the vehicle is driven on a road with less
traffic and few vehicles that the radar sensors
can detect, the system may pause (The BSM
OFF indicator light in the instrument panel
flashes). However, it does not indicate a
malfunction.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-31
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page455
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (456,1)
q
If the lights-on indicator light flashes
The light continues to flash if the lighting
system has a malfunction. Consult an
Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Warning Sound is Activated
qLights-On Reminder
í
The lights-on reminder is operable when
the time setting
*1
of the auto headlight off
function is 0 seconds.
If lights are on and the ignition is
switched to ACC or the ignition is
switched off, a continuous beep sound
will be heard when the driver's door is
opened.
*1 If the light switch is left on, the auto
headlight off function automatically
turns off the lights about 30 seconds
after switching the ignition off. The
time setting can be changed.
Refer to Personalization Features on
page 9-10.
NOTE
lWhen the ignition is switched to ACC, the
Ignition Not Switched Off (STOP)
Warning Beep(page 7-33) overrides the
lights-on reminder.
lA personalized function is available to
change the sound volume for the lights-on
reminder.
Refer to Personalization Features on page
9-10.
7-32
If Trouble Arises
í
Some models.
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page456
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (457,1)
q
Air Bag/Front Seat Belt
Pretensioner System Warning Beep
If a malfunction is detected in the air bag/
front seat belt pretensioner systems and
the warning light, a warning beep sound
will be heard for about 5 seconds every
minute.
The air bag and seat belt pretensioner
system warning beep sound will continue
to be heard for approximately 35 minutes.
Have your vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
WARNING
Do not drive the vehicle with the air
bag/front seat belt pretensioner system
warning beep sounding:
Driving the vehicle with the air bag/
front seat belt pretensioner system
warning beep sounding is dangerous.
In a collision, the air bags and the
front seat belt pretensioner system
will not deploy and this could result
in death or serious injury.
Contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer
to have the vehicle inspected as soon
as possible.
qSeat Belt Warning Beep
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened
when the ignition is switched ON, a beep
sound will be heard for about 6 seconds.
If the driver or the front passenger's seat
belt is not fastened and the vehicle is
driven at a speed faster than about 20
km/h (12 mph), a beep sound will be
heard again for a specified period of time.
NOTE
lSome models do not have the seat belt
warning function for the front passenger's
seat.
lPlacing heavy items on the front passenger
seat may cause the front passenger seat belt
warning function to operate depending on
the weight of the item.
lTo allow the front passenger seat weight
sensor to function properly, do not place
and sit on an additional seat cushion on the
front passenger seat. The sensor may not
function properly because the additional
seat cushion could cause sensor
interference.
lWhen a small child sits on the front
passenger seat, it is possible that the
warning beep will not operate.
qIgnition Not Switched Off
(STOP) Warning Beep
If the driver's door is opened while the
ignition is switched to ACC, a continuous
beep sound will be heard to notify the
driver that the ignition has not been
switched off (STOP) (for vehicles with a
type A meter, messages are displayed in
the instrument cluster). Left in this
condition, the keyless entry system will
not operate, the car cannot be locked, and
the battery power will be depleted.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page457
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (458,1)
qKey Removed from Vehicle
Warning Beep
Under the following conditions, a beep
sound will be heard and the KEY warning
light (red) will flash continuously when
the ignition has not been switched off to
notify the driver that the key has been
removed (for vehicles with a type A
meter, messages are displayed in the
instrument cluster). The KEY warning
light (red) will stop flashing when the key
is back inside the vehicle (for vehicles
with a type A meter, messages are
displayed in the instrument cluster):
The ignition has not been switched off
and all the doors are closed after
removing the key from the vehicle. (A
beep sound will be heard 6 times.)
NOTE
Because the key utilizes low-intensity radio
waves, the Key Removed From Vehicle
Warning may activate if the key is carried
together with a metal object or it is placed in a
poor signal reception area.
qRequest Switch Inoperable
Warning Beep (With the
advanced keyless function)
If the request switch is pressed under the
following conditions while the key is
being carried, a beep will be heard for
about 2 seconds to indicate that the front
doors and the liftgate can not be locked.
lA door or the liftgate is open (door ajar
included).
lThe ignition has not been switched to
off.
q
Key Left-in-luggage Compartment
Warning Beep (With the advanced
keyless function)
If the key is left in the luggage
compartment with all doors locked and
the liftgate closed, a beep sound is heard
for about 10 seconds to remind the driver
the key has been left in the luggage
compartment. If this happens, open the
liftgate by pressing the electric liftgate
opener and remove the key. A key
removed from the luggage compartment
may not function because its functions
may have been temporarily suspended. To
restore the key function, perform the
applicable procedure (page 3-7).
q
Key Left-in-vehicle Warning Beep
(With the advanced keyless function)
When any door is opened from the
outside while the key is inside the vehicle,
the closed doors are locked. All the doors
are automatically unlocked by closing the
open door and the beep sound is heard for
about 10 seconds to notify the driver that
the key has been left in the vehicle.
If this happens, the doors and the liftgate
lock but the functions of the key left in the
vehicle cabin may be temporarily
suspended.
Perform the applicable procedure to
restore the functions of the key (page 3-7).
qTire Inflation Pressure Warning
Beep
The warning beep sound will be heard for
about 3 seconds when there is any
abnormality in tire inflation pressures
(page 4-93).
7-34
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page458
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (459,1)
qBlind Spot Monitoring (BSM)
System Warning Beep
í
The warning beep operates when the turn
signal lever is operated to the side where
the BSM warning light is illuminated.
NOTE
A personalized function is available to change
the BSM warning beep sound volume. Refer to
Personalization Features on page 9-10.
If Trouble Arises
Warning/Indicator Lights and Warning Sounds
7-35
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page459
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (460,1)
When Liftgate Cannot be
Opened
If the vehicle battery is dead or there is a
malfunction in the electrical system and
the liftgate can not be opened, perform the
following procedure as an emergency
measure to Open it:
1. Remove the cap on the interior surface
of the liftgate with a flathead
screwdriver.
Cap
2. Turn the lever to the right to unlock the
liftgate.
Lever
After performing this emergency measure,
have the vehicle inspected at an
Authorized Mazda Dealer as soon as
possible.
7-36
If Trouble Arises
When Liftgate Cannot be Opened
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page460
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (461,1)
8Customer Information and Reporting
Safety Defects
Important consumer information including warranties and add-on equipment.
Customer Assistance ............................... 8-2
Customer Assistance (U.S.A.) ............ 8-2
Customer Assistance (Canada) ........... 8-7
Customer Assistance (Puerto Rico) ... 8-10
Customer Assistance (Mexico) ......... 8-11
Mazda Importer/Distributors ............... 8-13
Importer/Distributor .......................... 8-13
Reporting Safety Defects ....................... 8-14
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S.A.) .... 8-14
Reporting Safety Defects (Canada) ... 8-15
Warranty ................................................ 8-16
Warranties for Your Mazda ............... 8-16
Outside the United States/Canada ..... 8-17
Registering Your Vehicle in A Foreign
Country (Except United States and
Canada) ............................................. 8-18
Add-On Non-Genuine Parts and
Accessories ....................................... 8-19
Cell Phones ............................................. 8-20
Cell Phones Warning ......................... 8-20
Event Data Recorder ............................. 8-21
Event Data Recorder (U.S.A. and
Canada) ............................................. 8-21
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System
(UTQGS) ................................................ 8-22
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System
(UTQGS) .......................................... 8-22
Tire Information (U.S.A.) ..................... 8-24
Tire Labeling ..................................... 8-24
Location of the Tire Label
(Placard) ............................................ 8-30
Tire Maintenance .............................. 8-33
Vehicle Loading ................................ 8-36
Steps for Determining the Correct Load
Limit ................................................. 8-42
Declaration of Conformity .................... 8-43
Declaration of Conformity ................ 8-43
Service Publications .............................. 8-48
Service Publications .......................... 8-48
8-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page461
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (462,1)
Customer Assistance (U.S.A.)
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle
in top condition.
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take
the following steps:
NOTE
If it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary restraint
system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in accordance with a
certified physician, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
qSTEP 1: Contact Your Mazda Dealer
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to
address the issue.
lIf your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of
the dealership or the OWNER.
lIf it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical conditions in
accordance with a certified physician, go to STEP 2.
qSTEP 2: Contact Mazda North American Operations
If for any reason you feel the need for further assistance after contacting your dealership
management or it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the
supplementary restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical
conditions in accordance with a certified physician, you can reach Mazda North American
Operations by one of the following ways.
Log on: at www.mazdaUSA.com
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in
the U.S., can be found here.
E-mail: click on Contact Uslocated on the Inside Mazdatab, or at the bottom of the
page at www.mazdaUSA.com
By phone at: 1 (800) 222-5500
8-2
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page462
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (463,1)
By letter at:
Attn: Customer Assistance
Mazda North American Operations
7755 Irvine Center Drive
Irvine, CA 92618-2922
P.O. Box 19734
Irvine, CA 92623-9734
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following
information:
1. Your name, address, and telephone number
2. Year and model of vehicle
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)
4. Purchase date and current mileage
5. Your dealer's name and location
6. Your question(s)
If you live outside the U.S.A., please contact your nearest Mazda Distributor.
qSTEP 3: Contact Better Business Bureau (BBB)
Mazda North American Operations realizes that mutual agreement on some issues may not
be possible. As a final step to ensure that your concerns are being fairly considered, Mazda
North American Operations has agreed to participate in a dispute settlement program
administered by the Better Business Bureau (BBB) system, at no cost to you the consumer.
BBB AUTO LINE works with consumers and the manufacturer in an attempt to reach a
mutually acceptable resolution of any warranty related concerns. If the BBB is not able to
facilitate a settlement they will provide an informal hearing before an arbitrator.
You are required to resort to BBB AUTO LINE before exercising rights or seeking
remedies under the Federal Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. § 2301 et seq. To the
extent permitted by the applicable state Lemon Law, you are also required to resort to
BBB AUTO LINE before exercising any rights or seeking remedies under the Lemon
Law. If you choose to seek remedies that are not created by the Magnuson-Moss Warranty
Act or the applicable state Lemon Law, you are not required to first use BBB AUTO
LINE.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
8-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page463
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (464,1)
The whole process normally takes 40 days or less. The arbitration decision is not binding
on you or Mazda unless you accept the decision. For more information about BBB AUTO
LINE, including current eligibility standards, please call 1-800-955-5100 or visit the BBB
website at www.lemonlaw.bbb.org.
Being truly committed to customer satisfaction is more than a phrase with Mazda. We hope
to satisfy every customer directly, but if there is ever a question about our decision, Mazda
believes in providing a fast, fair and free method such as the BBB AUTO LINE to ensure
Mazda delivers on our commitment to do the right thing for our customers!
qCalifornia Customers
1. Mazda North American Operations participates in BBB AUTO LINE, a mediation/
arbitration program administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus [4200
Wilson Boulevard, Arlington, Virginia 22203] through local Better Business Bureaus.
BBB AUTO LINE and Mazda have been certified by the Arbitration Certification
Program of the California Department of Consumer Affairs.
2. If you have a problem arising under a Mazda written warranty, we encourage you to
bring it to our attention. If we are unable to resolve it, you may file a claim with BBB
AUTO LINE. Claims must be filed with BBB AUTO LINE within six (6) months after
the expiration of the warranty.
3. To file a claim with BBB AUTO LINE, call 1-800-955-5100. There is no charge for the
call.
4. In order to file a claim with BBB AUTO LINE, you will have to provide your name and
address, the brand name and vehicle identification number (VIN) of your vehicle, and a
statement of the nature of your problem or complaint. You will also be asked to provide:
the approximate date of your acquisition of the vehicle, the vehicle's current mileage, the
approximate date and mileage at the time any problem(s) were first brought to the
attention of Mazda or one of our dealers, and a statement of the relief you are seeking.
5. BBB AUTO LINE staff may try to help resolve your dispute through mediation. If
mediation is not successful, or if you do not wish to participate in mediation, claims
within the program's jurisdiction may be presented to an arbitrator at an informal
hearing. The arbitrator's decision should ordinarily be issued within 40 days from the
time your complaint is filed; there may be a delay of 7 days if you did not first contact
Mazda about your problem, or a delay of up to 30 days if the arbitrator requests an
inspection/report by an impartial technical expert or further investigation and report by
BBB AUTO LINE.
8-4
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page464
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (465,1)
6. You are required to use BBB AUTO LINE before asserting in court any rights or
remedies conferred by California Civil Code Section 1793.22. You are also required to
use BBB AUTO LINE before exercising rights or seeking remedies created by Title I of
the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, 15 U.S.C. sec. 2301 et seq. If you choose to seek
redress by pursuing rights and remedies not created by California Civil Code Section
1793.22 or Title I of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty Act, resort to BBB AUTO LINE is
not required by those statutes.
7. California Civil Code Section 1793.2 (d) requires that, if Mazda or its representative is
unable to repair a new motor vehicle to conform to the vehicle's applicable express
warranty after a reasonable number of attempts, Mazda may be required to replace or
repurchase the vehicle. California Civil Code Section 1793.22 (b) creates a presumption
that Mazda has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its
applicable express warranties if, within 18 months from delivery to the buyer or 18,000
miles on the vehicle's odometer, whichever occurs first, one or more of the following
occurs:
lThe same nonconformity [a failure to conform to the written warranty that
substantially impairs the use, value or safety of the vehicle] results in a condition that
is likely to cause death or serious bodily injury if the vehicle is driven AND the
nonconformity has been subject to repair two or more times by Mazda or its agents
AND the buyer or lessee has directly notified Mazda of the need for the repair of the
nonconformity; OR
lThe same nonconformity has been subject to repair 4 or more times by Mazda or its
agents AND the buyer has notified Mazda of the need for the repair of the
nonconformity; OR
lThe vehicle is out of service by reason of repair of nonconformities by Mazda or its
agents for a cumulative total of more than 30 calendar days after delivery of the
vehicle to the buyer.
NOTICE TO Mazda AS REQUIRED ABOVE SHALL BE SENT TO THE
FOLLOWING ADDRESS:
Mazda North American Operations
7755 Irvine Center Drive
Irvine, CA 92618
ATTN: Customer Mediation
8. The following remedies may be sought in BBB AUTO LINE: repairs, reimbursement
for money paid to repair a vehicle or other expenses incurred as result of a vehicle
nonconformity, repurchase or replacement of your vehicle, and compensation for
damages and remedies available under Mazda's written warranty or applicable law.
9. The following remedies may not be sought in BBB AUTO LINE: punitive or multiple
damages, attorneys' fees, or consequential damages other than as provided in California
Civil Code Section 1794 (a) and (b).
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
8-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page465
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (466,1)
10. You may reject the decision issued by a BBB AUTO LINE arbitrator. If you reject the
decision, you will be free to pursue further legal action. The arbitrator's decision and
any findings will be admissible in a court action.
11. If you accept the arbitrator's decision, Mazda will be bound by the decision, and will
comply with the decision within a reasonable time not to exceed 30 days after we
receive notice of your acceptance of the decision.
12. Please call BBB AUTO LINE at 1-800-955-5100 for further details about the program.
8-6
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page466
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (467,1)
Customer Assistance (Canada)
qSatisfaction Review Process
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is of primary concern to Mazda. All Authorized
Mazda Dealers have both the knowledge and tools to keep your Mazda in top condition. In
our experience, any questions, problems, or complaints regarding the operation of your
Mazda or any other general service transactions are most effectively resolved by your
dealer. If the cause of your dissatisfaction cannot adequately be addressed by normal
dealership procedures, we recommend that you take the following steps:
qSTEP 1: Contact the Mazda Dealer
Discuss the matter with a member of dealership management. If the Service Manager has
already reviewed your concerns, contact the owner of the dealership or its General
Manager.
qSTEP 2: Contact the Mazda Regional Office
If you feel that you still require assistance, ask the dealer Service Manager to arrange for
you to meet the local Mazda Service Representative. If more expedient, contact Mazda
Canada Inc. Regional Office nearest you for such arrangements. Regional Office address
and phone numbers are shown (page 8-9).
qSTEP 3: Contact the Mazda Customer Relations Department
If still not substantially satisfied, contact the Customer Relations Department, Mazda
Canada Inc., 55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill, Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada TEL:1 (800) 263-
4680.
Provide the Department with the following information:
1. Your name, address and telephone number
2. Year and model of vehicle
3. Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). Refer to the Vehicle Identification Labelspage
of section 9 of this manual for the location of the VIN.
4. Purchase date
5. Present odometer reading
6. Your dealer's name and location
7. The nature of your problem and/or cause of dissatisfaction
The Department, in cooperation with the local Mazda Service Representative, will review
the case to determine if everything possible has been done to ensure your satisfaction.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
8-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page467
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (468,1)
Please recognize that the resolution of service problems in most cases requires the use of
your Mazda dealer's service facilities, personnel and equipment. We urge you to follow the
above three steps in sequence for most effective results.
qMediation/Arbitration Program
Occasionally a customer concern cannot be resolved through Mazda's Customer
Satisfaction Program. If after exhausting the procedures in this manual your concern is still
not resolved, you have another option.
Mazda Canada Inc. participates in an arbitration program administered by the
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP). CAMVAP will advise you about
how your concern may be reviewed and resolved by an independent third party through
binding arbitration.
Your complete satisfaction is the goal of Mazda Canada Inc. and our dealers.
Mazda's participation in CAMVAP makes a valuable contribution to our achieving that
goal. There is no charge for using CAMVAP. CAMVAP results are fast, fair and final as the
award is binding on both you and Mazda Canada Inc.
qCanadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP)
If a specific item of concern arises, where a solution cannot be reached between an owner,
Mazda, and/or one of its dealers (that all parties cannot agree upon), the owner may wish to
use the services offered by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).
CAMVAP uses the services of Provincial Administrators to assist consumers in scheduling
and preparing for their arbitration hearings. However, before you can proceed with
CAMVAP you must follow your Mazda dispute resolution process as outlined previously.
8-8
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page468
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (469,1)
CAMVAP is fully implemented in all provinces and territories.
Consumers wishing to obtain further information about the Program should contact the
Provincial Administrator at 1 (800) 207-0685, or by contacting the
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan Office at:
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan
235 Yorkland Boulevard, suite 300
North York, Ontario
M2J 4Y8
http://camvap.ca
Provincial Administrators may be reached locally as listed below:
Province/Territory CAMVAP Number
British Columbia & Yukon Territories 1 (800) 207-0685
Alberta & Northwest Territories 1 (800) 207-0685
Saskatchewan 1 (800) 207-0685
Manitoba 1 (800) 207-0685
Ontario 1 (800) 207-0685
Atlantic Canada 1 (800) 207-0685
Quebec 1 (800) 207-0685
qRegional Offices
REGIONAL OFFICES COVERING AREAS
MAZDA CANADA INC.
WESTERN REGION
5011 275 STREET
LANGLEY, BRITISH COLUMBIA
V4W 0A8
(778) 369-2100
1 (800) 663-0908
ALBERTA,
BRITISH COLUMBIA,
MANITOBA,
SASKATCHEWAN,
YUKON
MAZDA CANADA INC.
CENTRAL REGION
55 VOGELL ROAD,
RICHMOND HILL,
ONTARIO, L4B 3K5
1 (800) 263-4680
ONTARIO,
NEW BRUNSWICK,
NOVA SCOTIA,
PRINCE EDWARD ISLAND,
NEWFOUNDLAND
MAZDA CANADA INC.
QUEBEC REGION
6111 ROUTE TRANSCANADIENNE
POINTE CLAIRE, QUEBEC
H9R 5A5
(514) 694-6390
QUEBEC
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
8-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page469
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (470,1)
Customer Assistance (Puerto Rico)
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. That is why all Authorized
Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle in top
condition.
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take
the following steps:
qSTEP 1
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to
address the issue. If your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS,
SALES, SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL
MANAGER of the dealership or the OWNER.
qSTEP 2
If, after following STEP 1, you feel the need for further assistance, please contact your
area's Mazda representative (Indicated on the next page).
Please help us by providing the following information:
1. Your name, address, and telephone number
2. Year and model of vehicle
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)
4. Purchase date and current mileage
5. Your dealer's name and location
6. Your question(s)
8-10
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page470
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (471,1)
Customer Assistance (Mexico)
Your complete and permanent satisfaction is our business. We are here to serve you. All
Authorized Mazda Dealers have the knowledge and the tools to keep your Mazda vehicle
in top condition.
If you have any questions or recommendations for improvement regarding the service of
your Mazda vehicle or servicing by Mazda Dealer personnel, we recommend that you take
the following steps:
qContact Your Mazda Dealer
Discuss the matter with an Authorized Mazda Dealer. This is the quickest and best way to
address the issue.
lIf your concern has not been resolved by the CUSTOMER RELATIONS, SALES,
SERVICE, or PARTS MANAGER, then please contact the GENERAL MANAGER of
the dealership or the OWNER.
lIf it becomes necessary to have the components or wiring system for the supplementary
restraint system modified to accommodate a person with certain medical condition in
accordance with a certified physician you must contact your dealership in order to avoid
the potential loss of the warranty of your vehicle which may occur if some third party is
hired by the customer to make any modifications to this system.
Log on: at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx
Answers to many questions, including how to locate or contact a local Mazda dealership in
Mexico, can be found here.
E-mail: click on Contactanosat the top of the page at www.MazdaMexico.com.mx
By phone at: 01 800 01 MAZDA (62932)
By letter at:
Attn: Customer Assistance
Mazda Motor de Mexico
Mario Pani #150, PB Col. Lomas de Santa Fe
Mexico, D.F. C.P. 05300
Del. Cuajimalpa de Morelos
Tel: Customer Assistance
01 800 01 MAZDA (62932).
In order to serve you efficiently and effectively, please help us by providing the following
information:
1. Your name, address, and telephone number
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
8-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page471
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (472,1)
2. Year and model of vehicle
3. Vehicle Identification Number (17 digits, noted on your registration or title or located on
the upper driver's side corner of the dash)
4. Purchase date and current mileage
5. Your dealer's name and location
6. Your question(s)
8-12
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Customer Assistance
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page472
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (473,1)
Importer/Distributor
qU.S.A.
Mazda North American Operations
7755 Irvine Center Drive
Irvine, CA 92618-2922 U.S.A.
P.O. Box 19734
Irvine, CA 92623-9734 U.S.A.
TEL:1 (800) 222-5500 (in U.S.A.)
(949) 727-1990 (outside U.S.A.)
qCANADA
Mazda Canada Inc.
55 Vogell Road, Richmond Hill,
Ontario, L4B 3K5 Canada
TEL: 1 (800) 263-4680 (in Canada)
(905) 787-7000 (outside Canada)
q
PUERTO RICO/U.S. Virgin Island
International Automotive Distributor
Group, LLC. (Mazda de Puerto Rico)
P.O. Box 191850, San Juan, Puerto Rico
00919-1850
TEL: (787) 641-1777
qMEXICO
Mazda Motor de Mexico
Mario Pani # 150, PB Col. Lomas de
Santa Fe Mexico, D.F. C.P. 05300 Del.
Cuajimalpa
TEL: Center of Attention to Clients:
01 (800) 016 2932. in Mexico
qGUAM
Triple J Motors
157 South Marine Drive, Tamuning,
GUAM 96911 USA
P.O. Box 6066 Tamuning, Guam 96931
TEL: (671) 649-6555
qSAIPAN
Pacific International Marianas, Inc.
(d.b.a. Midway Motors)
P.O. Box 887 Saipan, MP 96950
TEL: (670) 234-7524
Triple J Saipan, Inc.
(d.b.a. Triple J Motors)
P.O. Box 500487 Saipan, MP 96950-0487
TEL: (670) 234-7133/3051
qAMERICAN SAMOA
Polynesia Motors, Inc.
P.O. Box 1120, Pago Pago, American
Samoa 96799
TEL: (684) 699-9347
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Mazda Importer/Distributors
8-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page473
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (474,1)
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S.A.)
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could
cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mazda Motor
Corporation (Your Mazda Importer/Distributor).
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and
remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual
problems between you, your dealer, or Mazda Motor Corporation (Your Mazda
Importer/Distributor).
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-
327-4236 (TTY:1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., Washington, DC,
20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
NOTE
If you live in the U.S.A., all correspondence to Mazda Motor Corporation should be forwarded to:
Mazda North American Operations
7755 Irvine Center Drive
Irvine, California 92618-2922
or
P.O. Box 19734
Irvine, CA 92623-9734
Customer Experience Center or toll free at 1 (800) 222-5500
If you live outside of the U.S.A., please contact the nearest Mazda Distributor shown (page 8-13) in
this booklet.
8-14
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Reporting Safety Defects
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page474
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (475,1)
Reporting Safety Defects (Canada)
Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect
Investigations and Recalls, may telephone the toll free hotline 1-800-333-0510, or contact
Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville Tower C, 330
Sparks Street, Ottawa ON K1A 0N5.
For additional road safety information, please visit the Road Safety website at:
http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/menu.htm
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Reporting Safety Defects
8-15
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page475
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (476,1)
Warranties for Your Mazda
lNew Vehicle Limited Warranty
lPowertrain Limited Warranty
lSafety Restraint System Limited Warranty
lAnti-perforation Limited Warranty
lFederal Emission Control Warranty/California Emission Control Warranty
lEmission Defect Warranty
lEmission Performance Warranty
lEmission Control Warranty
lReplacement Parts and Accessories Limited Warranty
lTire Warranty
NOTE
Warranty information varies depending on the country. Refer to the Warranty Booklet for detailed
warranty information.
8-16
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Warranty
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page476
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (477,1)
Outside the United States/Canada
Government regulations in the United States/Canada require that automobiles meet specific
emission regulations and safety standards. Therefore, vehicles built for use in the United
States/Canada may differ from those sold in other countries.
The differences may make it difficult or even impossible for your vehicle to receive
satisfactory servicing in other countries. We strongly recommend that you NOT take your
Mazda outside the United States/Canada.
United States
However, in the event that you are moving to Canada permanently, Mazda vehicles built
for use in the United States could be eligible for exportation to Canada with specific
vehicle modifications to comply with the Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
(CMVSS).
Canada
However, in the event that you are moving to the United States permanently, Mazda
vehicles built for use in Canada could be eligible for exportation to the United States with
specific vehicle modifications to comply with the United States Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standards (FMVSS).
NOTE
The above is applicable for a permanent import/export situation and not related to travelers on
vacation.
You may have the following problems if you do take your vehicle outside of the United
States/Canada:
lRecommended fuel may be unavailable. Any kind of leaded fuel or low-octane fuel will
affect vehicle performance and damage the emission controls and engine.
lProper repair facilities, tools, testing equipment, and replacement parts may not be
available.
Please refer to your Manufacturer's Warranty Booklet for more information.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Warranty
8-17
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page477
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (478,1)
Registering Your Vehicle in A Foreign Country (Except
United States and Canada)
Registering your vehicle in a foreign country may be problematic depending on whether it
meets the specific emission and safety standards of the country in which the vehicle will be
driven. Consequently, your vehicle may require modifications at personal expense in order
to meet the regulations.
In addition, you should be aware of the following issues:
Satisfactory vehicle servicing may be difficult or impossible in another country.
The fuel specified for your vehicle may be unavailable.
Parts, servicing techniques, and tools necessary to maintain and repair your vehicle may be
unavailable.
There might not be an Authorized Mazda Dealer in the country you plan to take your
vehicle.
The Mazda warranty is valid only in certain countries.
8-18
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Warranty
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page478
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (479,1)
Add-On Non-Genuine Parts and Accessories
Non-genuine parts and accessories for Mazda vehicles can be found in stores.
These may fit your vehicle, but they are not approved by Mazda for use with Mazda
vehicles. When you install non-genuine parts or accessories, they could affect your
vehicle's performance or safety systems; the Mazda warranty doesn't cover this. Before you
install any non-genuine parts or accessories, consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
WARNING
Always consult an Authorized Mazda Dealer before you install non-genuine parts or
accessories:
Installation of non-genuine parts or accessories is dangerous. Improperly designed
parts or accessories could seriously affect your vehicle's performance or safety
systems. This could cause you to have an accident or increase your chances of
injuries in an accident.
Be very careful in choosing and installing add-on electrical equipment, such as
mobile telephones, two-way radios, stereo systems, and car alarm systems:
Incorrectly choosing or installing improper add-on equipment or choosing an
improper installer is dangerous. Essential systems could be damaged, causing engine
stalling, air-bag (SRS) activation, ABS/TCS/DSC inactivation, or a fire in the vehicle.
Mazda assumes no responsibility for death, injury, or expenses that may result from the
installation of add-on non-genuine parts or accessories.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Warranty
8-19
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page479
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (480,1)
Cell Phones Warning
WARNING
Please comply with the legal regulations concerning the use of communication
equipment in vehicles in your country:
Use of any electrical devices such as cell phones, computers, portable radios, vehicle
navigation or other devices by the driver while the vehicle is moving is dangerous.
Dialing a number on a cell phone while driving also ties-up the driver's hands. Use of
these devices will cause the driver to be distracted and could lead to a serious
accident. If a passenger is unable to use the device, pull off the right-of-way to a safe
area before use. If use of a cell phone is necessary despite this warning, use a hands-
free system to at least leave the hands free to drive the vehicle. Never use a cell
phone or other electrical devices while the vehicle is moving and, instead,
concentrate on the full-time job of driving.
8-20
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Cell Phones
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page480
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (481,1)
Event Data Recorder (U.S.A. and Canada)
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR
is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or
hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicles systems
performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety
systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
· How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
· Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened;
· How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
· How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes
and injuries occur.
NOTE:
EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash or near crash-like
situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no
personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded. However, other
parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally
identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle
or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law
enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access
to the vehicle or the EDR.
Mazda will not disclose any of the data recorded in an EDR to a third party unless:
lA written agreement from the vehicle owner or the lessee is obtained
lOfficially requested by the police or other law enforcement authorities
lUsed as a defense for Mazda in a law suit, claim, or arbitration
lOrdered by a judge or court
However, if necessary Mazda will:
lUse the data for research on Mazda vehicle performance, including safety.
lDisclose the data or the summarized data to a third party for research purposes without
disclosing vehicle or owner identification information.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Event Data Recorder
8-21
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page481
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (482,1)
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)
This information relates to the tire grading system developed by the U.S. National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration for grading tires by tread wear, traction, and
temperature performance.
qTread Wear
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one-and-a-half times as well on the government
course as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm because of variations in driving habits, service
practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.
qTraction-AA, A, B, C
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. These grades represent
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor
traction performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on braking (straight ahead) traction
tests and does not include acceleration cornering (turning), hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
qTemperature-A, B, C
The temperature grades A (the highest), B, and C, represent the tire's resistance to the
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire
life, and excessive temperatures can lead to sudden tire failure.
Grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger vehicle tires must meet
under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent
higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by
law.
8-22
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page482
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (483,1)
WARNING
Keep your vehicle's tires properly inflated and not overloaded:
Driving with improperly inflated or overloaded tires is dangerous. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure. The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
These grades will be added to the sidewalls of passenger vehicle tires over the next several
years according to a schedule established by the NHTSA and the tire manufacturers.
The grade of tires available as standard or optional equipment on Mazda vehicles may vary
with respect to grade.
ALL PASSENGER VEHICLE TIRES MUST CONFORM TO THESE GRADES AND
TO ALL OTHER FEDERAL TIRE-SAFETY REQUIREMENTS.
qUNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder
and maximum section width.
For example:
TREADWEAR 200 TRACTION AA TEMPERATURE A
UTQGS MARK (example)
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Uniform Tire Quality Grading System (UTQGS)
8-23
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page483
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (484,1)
Tire Labeling
Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of
all tires. This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire
and also provides a tire identification number for safety standard certification and in case of
a recall.
qInformation on Passenger Vehicle Tires
Please refer to the sample below.
1. TIN: U.S. DOT tire identification number
2. Passenger car tire
3. Nominal width of tire in millimeters
4. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)
5. Radial
6. Run-flat tire
7. Rim diameter code
8. Load index & speed symbol
9. Severe snow conditions
10. Tire ply composition and materials used
8-24
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page484
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (485,1)
11. Max. load rating
12. Tread wear, traction and temperature grades
13. Max. permissible inflation pressure
14. SAFETY WARNING
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and
load index rating may be different from the example.
P
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).
NOTE
If your tire size does not begin with a letter this may mean it is designated by either ETRTO
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire Manufacturing Association).
215
215is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger
the number, the wider the tire.
65
65is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.
R
Ris the tire construction symbol. R indicates Radial ply construction.
15
15is the wheel rim diameter in inches.
95
95is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each
tire can support.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-25
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page485
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (486,1)
H
His the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of
the tire is rated.
Letter Rating Speed Rating
Q 99 mph
R 106 mph
S 112 mph
T 118 mph
U 124 mph
H 130 mph
V 149 mph
W 168
*
mph
Y 186
*
mph
*
For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph, tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For
tires with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph, tire manufacturers always use the letters ZR.
M S or M/S: Mud and Snow
AT: All Terrain.
AS: All Season. The MSor M/Sindicates that the tire has some functional use in
mud and snow.
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)
This begins with the letters DOTwhich indicates the tire meets all federal standards. The
next two numbers or letters are the plant code where it was manufactured, and the last four
numbers represent the week and year the tire was manufactured. For example, the numbers
457 means the 45st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example,
the number 2102 means the 21th week of 2002. The other numbers are marketing codes
used at the manufacturer's discretion. This information is used to contact consumers if a tire
defect requires a recall.
Tire Ply Composition and Materials Used
The number of plies indicates the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire. In
general, the greater the number of plies, the more weight a tire can support. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate the tire materials, which include steel, nylon, polyester,
and other.
Maximum Load Rating
This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds that can be carried by
the tire.
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure
This number is the greatest amount of air pressure that should ever be put in the tire under
normal driving conditions.
8-26
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page486
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (487,1)
Tread Wear, Traction and Temperature Grades
Tread wear: The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course. For
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100.
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The grades
represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have
poor traction performance.
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the tire's
resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
Snow Tires
In some heavy snow areas, local governments may require true snow tires, those with very
deeply cut tread. These tires should only be used in pairs or placed on all four wheels.
Make sure you purchase snow tires that are the same size and construction type as the other
tires on your vehicle.
SAFETY WARNING
The following safety warning appears on the tire's sidewall.
SERIOUS INJURY MAY RESULT FROM:
lEXPLOSION OF TIRE/RIM ASSEMBLY DUE TO IMPROPER MOUNTING-
MATCH TIRE DIAMETER TO RIM DIAMETER; NEVER EXCEED 40 psi (275 kPa)
TO SEAT BEADS-ONLY SPECIALLY TRAINED PERSONS SHOULD MOUNT
TIRES.
lTIRE FAILURE DUE TO UNDER-INFLATION/OVERLOADING/DAMAGE-
FOLLOW OWNER'S MANUAL AND PLACARD IN VEHICLE-FREQUENTLY
CHECK INFLATION PRESSURE AND INSPECT FOR DAMAGE.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-27
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page487
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (488,1)
qInformation on Temporary Tires
Please refer to the sample below.
1. Temporary tires
2. Nominal width of tire in millimeters
3. Ratio of height to width (aspect ratio)
4. Diagonal
5. Rim diameter code
6. Load index & speed symbol
T115/70D16 90M is an example of a tire size and load index rating. Here is an explanation
of the various components of that tire size and load index rating. Note that the tire size and
load index rating may be different from the example.
T
Indicates a tire that may be installed on cars, SUVs, minivans and light trucks as designated
by the Tire and Rim Association (T&RA).
115
115is the nominal width of the tire in millimeters. This three-digit number gives the
width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger
the number, the wider the tire.
8-28
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page488
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (489,1)
70
70is the aspect ratio. This two-digit number indicates the tire's ratio of height to width.
D
Dis the tire construction symbol. D indicates diagonal ply construction.
16
16is the wheel rim diameter in inches.
90
90is the Load Index. This two-or three-digit number indicates how much weight each
tire can support.
M
Mis the speed rating. The speed rating denotes the maximum speed for which the use of
the tire is rated.
Letter Rating Speed Rating
M 81 mph
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-29
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page489
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (490,1)
Location of the Tire Label (Placard)
You will find the tire label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size and other important
information on the driver's side B-pillar or on the edge of the driver's door frame.
SAMPLE
qRecommended Tire Inflation Pressure
On the tire label you will find the recommended tire inflation pressure in both kPa and psi
for the tires installed as original equipment on the vehicle. It is very important that the
inflation pressure of the tires on your vehicle is maintained at the recommended pressure.
You should check the tire pressure regularly to insure that the proper inflation pressure is
maintained.
Refer to Tires on page 9-8.
NOTE
Tire pressures listed on the vehicle placard or tire information label indicate the recommended cold
tire inflation pressure, measured when the tires are cold, after the vehicle has been parked for at least
3 hours. As you drive, the temperature in the tire warms up, increasing the tire pressure.
8-30
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page490
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (491,1)
WARNING
Always check the tire inflation pressures on a regular basis according to the
recommended tire inflation pressure on the tire label and in conjunction with the
information in this owner's manual:
Driving your vehicle with under-inflated tires is dangerous.
Under-inflation is the most common cause of failures in any kind of tire and may
result in severe cracking, tread separation or blowout, with unexpected loss of
vehicle control and increased risk of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing
and rolling resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It
results in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of control and accidents. A tire
can lose up to half of its air pressure and not appear to be flat!
It is impossible to determine whether or not tires are properly inflated just by looking
at them.
qChecking Tire Pressure
1. When you check the air pressure, make sure the tires are cold meaning they are not
hot from driving even a mile.
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire.
3. Firmly press a tire gauge onto the valve.
4. Add air to achieve recommended air pressure.
5. If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in the center of the
valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.
6. Replace the valve cap.
7. Repeat with each tire, including the spare.
NOTE
Some spare tires require higher inflation pressure.
8. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other objects embedded that
could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air leak.
9. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts, bulges, cracks or other
irregularities.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-31
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page491
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (492,1)
qGlossary of Terms
Tire Placard: A label indicating the OE tire sizes, recommended inflation pressure, and
the maximum weight the vehicle can carry.
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of each tire providing
information about the tire brand and manufacturing plant, tire size, and date of
manufacture.
Inflation Pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.
kPa: Kilopascal, the metric unit for air pressure.
psi: Pounds per square inch, the English unit for air pressure.
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the front door.
Original Equipment (OE): Describes components originally equipped on the vehicle.
Vehicle Load Limit: The maximum value of the combination weight of occupants and
cargo.
Bead Area of the Tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.
Sidewall Area of the Tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.
Tread Area of the Tire: Area on the perimeter of the tire that contacts the road when it's
mounted on the vehicle.
Seating capacity means the total allowable number of vehicle occupants. Seating capacity
is described on the tire label.
Production options weight is the combination weight of installed regular production
options weighing over 2.3 kilograms in excess of the standard items which they replace,
and not previously considered in the curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy
duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim.
Rim is the metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire
beads are seated.
8-32
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page492
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (493,1)
Tire Maintenance
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear abnormally. Here are
some important maintenance points:
qTire Inflation Pressure
Inspect all tire pressure monthly (including the spare) when the tires are cold. Maintain
recommended pressures for the best ride, top handling, and minimum tire wear. Use the
pressures specified on the vehicle tire information placard or tire label for optimum service.
qTire Rotation
To equalize tread wear, rotate the tires every 12,000 km (7,500 miles) or sooner if irregular
wear develops. During rotation, inspect them for correct balance.
Do not include (TEMPORARY USE ONLY)
spare tire in rotation.
Forward
Inspect the tires for uneven wear and damage. Abnormal wear is usually caused by one or a
combination of the following:
lIncorrect tire pressure
lImproper wheel alignment
lOut-of-balance wheel
lSevere braking
After rotation, inflate all tire pressures to specification (page 9-8) and inspect the lug nuts
for tightness.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-33
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page493
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (494,1)
CAUTION
Rotate unidirectional tires and radial tires that have an asymmetrical tread pattern
or studs only from front to rear, not from side to side. Tire performance will be
weakened if rotated from side to side.
(With limited-slip differential)
Don't use the following:
ØTires not of the designated size
ØTires of different sizes or types at the same time
ØTires not sufficiently inflated
If these instructions aren't followed, the rotation of the left and right wheels will be
different and will thus apply a constant load on the limited-slip differential.
This will cause a malfunction.
qReplacing a Tire
WARNING
Always use tires that are in good condition:
Driving with worn tires is dangerous. Reduced braking, steering, and traction could
result in an accident.
If a tire wears evenly, a wear indicator will appear as a solid band across the tread.
Replace the tire when this happens.
New tread
Tread wear indicator
Worn tread
You should replace the tire before the band crosses the entire tread.
8-34
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page494
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (495,1)
NOTE
Tires degrade over time, even when they are not being used on the road. It is recommended that tires
generally be replaced when they are 6 years or older. Heat caused by hot climates or frequent high
loading conditions can accelerate the aging process. You should replace the spare tire when you
replace the other road tires due to the aging of the spare tire. The period in which the tire was
manufactured (both week and year) is indicated by a 4-digit number.
Refer to Tire Labeling on page 8-24.
qSafety Practices
The way you drive has a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety. So cultivate
good driving habits for your own benefit.
lObserve posted speed limits and drive at speeds that are safe for the existing weather
conditions
lAvoid fast starts, stops and turns
lAvoid potholes and objects on the road
lDo not run over curbs or hit the tire against the curb when parking
CAUTION
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving or you suspect your
tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your speed. Drive with caution
until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and inspect the tire for damage. If the tire
is under-inflated or damaged, deflate it, remove the tire and rim and replace it with
your spare tire. If you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest
vehicle or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-35
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page495
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (496,1)
Vehicle Loading
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or trailer, to keep
your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating capability, with or without a trailer.
Properly loading your vehicle will provide maximum return of vehicle design performance.
Before loading your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining
your vehicle's weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle's Safety
Certification Label and Tire and Load Information Label:
WARNING
Overloaded Vehicle:
Overloading a vehicle is dangerous. The results of overloading can have serious
consequences in terms of passenger safety. Too much weight on a vehicle's
suspension system can cause spring or shock absorber failure, brake failure,
handling or steering problems, irregular tire wear, tire failure or other damage.
Overloading makes a vehicle harder to drive and control. It also increases the
distance required for stopping. In cases of serious overloading, brakes can fail
completely, particularly on steep grades. The load a tire will carry safely is a
combination of the size of the tire, its load range, and corresponding inflation
pressure.
Never overload the vehicle and always observe the vehicle's weight ratings from the
vehicle's Safety Certification and Tire and Load Information labels.
Base Curb Weight is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of fuel and all
standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or optional equipment.
Vehicle Curb Weight is the weight of your new vehicle when you picked it up from your
dealer plus any aftermarket equipment.
PAYLOAD
8-36
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page496
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (497,1)
Payload is the combination weight of cargo and passengers that the vehicle is designed to
carry. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found on the Tire and Load
Information label on the driver's door frame or door pillar. Look for THE
COMBINATION WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND CARGO SHOULD NEVER
EXCEED XXX kg or XXX lbsfor your maximum payload. The payload listed on the tire
label is the maximum payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any
aftermarket or dealer installed equipment has been installed on the vehicle, the weight of
the equipment must be subtracted from the payload listed on the tire label in order to be
accurate.
SAMPLE
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-37
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page497
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (498,1)
CARGO
Cargo Weight includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight, including cargo and
optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load or king pin weight is also part of
cargo weight.
The cargo weight limit decreases depending on the number of vehicle occupants. The cargo
weight limit can be calculated by subtracting the total weight of the vehicle occupants from
the combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceedvalue on the tire
label.
Examples: Based on a single occupant weight of 68 kg (150 lbs), and a value of 385 kg
(849 lbs) for the combination weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed:
The cargo weight limit with one occupant is 385 kg (849 lbs) _68 kg (150 lbs) = 317 kg
(699 lbs)
The cargo weight limit with two occupants is 385 kg (849 lbs) _(68 × 2) kg ( (150 × 2)
lbs) = 249 kg (549 lbs)
If the weight of the occupant increases, the cargo weight limit decreases by that much.
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) is the total weight placed on each axle (front and rear) -
including vehicle curb weight and all payload.
8-38
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page498
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (499,1)
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight that can be carried
by a single axle (front or rear). These numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance
Certification Label located on the driver's door frame or door pillar. The total load on
each axle must never exceed its GAWR.
GVW
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) is the Vehicle Curb Weight cargo passengers.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the fully
loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment, passengers and cargo). The GVWR is
shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label located on the driver's door
frame or door pillar. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-39
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page499
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (500,1)
SAMPLE
WARNING
Exceeding Axle Weight Rating Limits:
Exceeding the Safety Certification Label axle weight rating limits is dangerous and
could result in death or serious injury as a result of substandard vehicle handling,
performance, engine, transmission and/or structural damage, serious damage to the
vehicle, or loss of control.
Always keep the vehicle within the axle weight rating limits.
GCW
8-40
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page500
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (501,1)
GCW (Gross Combination Weight) is the weight of the loaded vehicle (GVW) plus the
weight of the fully loaded trailer.
GCWR (Gross Combination Weight Rating) is the maximum allowable weight of the
vehicle and the loaded trailer - including all cargo and passengers - that the vehicle can
handle without risking damage. (Important: The towing vehicle's braking system is rated
for operation at GVWR, not at GCWR. Separate functional brakes should be used for safe
control of towed vehicles and for trailers weighing more than 1,500 lbs). The GCW must
never exceed the GCWR.
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight is the highest possible weight of a fully loaded trailer
the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only mandatory options, no cargo (internal or
external), a tongue load of 10_15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15_25%
(fifth-wheel trailer), and driver only (150 lbs). Consult your dealership (or the RV and
Trailer Towing Guide provided by your dealership) for more detailed information.
Tongue Load or Fifth-Wheel King Pin Weight refers to the amount of the weight that a
trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.
Examples: For a 5000 lb conventional trailer, multiply 5000 by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a
proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lbs. For an 11,500 lb fifth-wheel trailer, multiply by
0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to 2,875 lbs.
WARNING
Exceeding GVWR or GAWR Specifications:
Exceeding the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label is dangerous.
Exceeding any vehicle rating limitation could result in a serious accident, injury, or
damage to the vehicle.
Do not use replacement tires with lower load carrying capacities than the originals
because they may lower the vehicle's GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement
tires with a higher limit than the originals do not increase the GVWR and GAWR
limitations.
Never exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the certification label.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
8-41
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page501
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (502,1)
Steps for Determining the Correct Load Limit
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit-
(1) Locate the statement The combined weight of occupants and cargo should
never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.on your vehicle's placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be
riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg
or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load
capacity. For example, if the XXXamount equals 1400 lbs. and there
will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available
cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 _750 (5 × 150) = 650
lbs.)
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the
vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage
load capacity calculated in Step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.
8-42
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Tire Information (U.S.A.)
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page502
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (503,1)
Declaration of Conformity
qKeyless Entry System/Immobilizer System
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Declaration of Conformity
8-43
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page503
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (504,1)
qBlind Spot Monitoring (BSM) System
Radiation Hazard
This BSM (blind spot monitoring) device emits intentional electromagnetic radiation in the
24 GHz to 25 GHz frequency range. The total radiated average power over the entire
bandwidth is below _14 dBm (40 µW). The active emitting antenna surface is 72 cm
2
;
therefore the radiated power density in front of the BSM device is 0.55 µW/cm
2
. This
value is far below the legal human exposure protection limit of 1 mW/cm
2
(MPE) in
Europe and US.
Declaration of compliance for 24 GHz blind spot radar
(U.S.A)
FCC ID: OAYBSDTX
This vehicle is equipped with a 24 GHz blind spot monitoring (BSM) radar system, which
complies with part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
3. This device may only work when the vehicle is in operation pursuant to § 15. 252 (a)
(4).
(CANADA)
IC:4135A-BSDTX
This device complies with the radio standards specification RSS-220 of Industry Canada.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference.
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
(MEXICO)
RLVCOBS10-0567
NOTE
During printing time of this user manual the approvals listed above are granted. Further countries
may become available or actual certification identifiers may be subject to change or update.
WARNING
Changes or modifications not expressively approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
8-44
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Declaration of Conformity
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page504
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (505,1)
qHomeLink Wireless Control System
CAUTION
HomeLink has been tested and complies with FCC and Industry Canada rules.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user's authority to operate the device.
NOTE
FCC ID: NZLMOBHL4
CANADA:4112A-MOBHL4
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1- This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2- This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired
operation.
qSatellite Radio
NOTE
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can
radiate radio frequency energy and if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may
cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that
interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful
interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following
measures:
- Increase the separation between the equipment and tuner.
- Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the tuner is connected.
- Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Declaration of Conformity
8-45
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page505
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (506,1)
qAudio System
This CD player is made and tested to meet exacting safety standards. It meets FCC
requirements and complies with safety performance standards of the U.S. Department of
Health and Human Services.
CAUTION
ØThis CD player should not be adjusted or repaired by anyone except qualified
service personnel.
If servicing is required, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
ØUse of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than those
specified herein may result in hazardous laser exposure. Never operate the CD
player with the top case of the unit removed.
ØChanges or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user's authority to operate this equipment.
NOTE
For CD player section:
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,
pursuant to part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that
interference will not occur in a particular installation.
qBluetooth® Hands-Free
FCC
FCC: CB2MAZGEN6HFT
NOTE
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
WARNING
Changes or modifications made to this equipment not expressly approved by the
manufacturer may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment.
8-46
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Declaration of Conformity
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page506
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (507,1)
NOTE
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection
against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can
radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions,
may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that
interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful
interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off
and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following
measures:
lReorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
lIncrease the separation between the equipment and receiver.
lConnect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
lConsult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
IC
IC:279B-MAZGEN6HFT
Licence exempt
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is
subject to the following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause interference, and
(2) This device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause
undesired operation of the device.
The term IC: before the radio certification number only signifies that Industry Canada
technical specifications were met. The antenna used for this transmitter must not be co-
located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter. End-users and
installers must be provided with installation instructions and transmitter operating
conditions for satisfying RF exposure compliance.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Declaration of Conformity
8-47
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page507
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (508,1)
Service Publications
Factory-authorized Mazda service publications are available for owners who wish to do
some of their own maintenance and repair.
When requesting any of our publications through an Authorized Mazda Dealer, refer to the
chart below.
If they do not have what you need in stock, they can order it for you.
PUBLICATION ORDER NUMBER PUBLICATION DESCRIPTION
9999-95-033B-15 2015 WORKSHOP MANUAL (English)
9999-MX-033B-15 2015 WORKSHOP MANUAL (Spanish)
9999-95-076G-15 2015 WIRING DIAGRAM (English)
9999-MX-076G-15 2015 WIRING DIAGRAM (Spanish)
9999-95-050C-15 2015 OWNER'S MANUAL (English)
9999-EC-050C-15 2015 OWNER'S MANUAL (English and French)
9999-PR-050C-15 2015 OWNER'S MANUAL (Spanish)
9999-95-105F-15 2015 SERVICE HIGHLIGHTS
9999-95-NAV1-13 2015 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL
(English)
9999-EC-NAV1-13 2015 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL
(English and French)
9999-PR-NAV1-13 2015 NAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL
(Spanish)
qWORKSHOP MANUAL:
Covers recommended maintenance and repair procedures of the drive train, body and
chassis.
qWIRING DIAGRAM:
Provides electrical schematics as well as component location for the entire electrical
system.
qOWNER'S MANUAL:
This booklet contains information regarding the proper care and operation of your vehicle.
This is not a technician's manual.
8-48
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Service Publications
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page508
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (509,1)
qSERVICE HIGHLIGHTS:
Provides description and operation of the many systems of your Mazda.
qNAVIGATION SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL:
This booklet contains information regarding the proper operation and use of the navigation
system. This is not a technician's manual.
Customer Information and Reporting Safety Defects
Service Publications
8-49
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page509
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (510,1)
8-50
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page510
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (511,1)
9Specifications
Technical information about your Mazda.
Identification Numbers ................................................................. 9-2
Vehicle Information Labels ....................................................... 9-2
Specifications ................................................................................. 9-4
Specifications ............................................................................ 9-4
Personalization Features ............................................................ 9-10
Personalization Features .......................................................... 9-10
9-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page511
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (512,1)
Vehicle Information Labels
qVehicle Identification Number
The vehicle identification number legally
identifies your vehicle. The number is on
a plate attached to the cowl panel located
on the left corner of the dashboard. This
plate can easily be seen through the
windshield.
qMotor Vehicle Safety Standard
Label (U.S.A. and Canada)
qChassis Number
Open the cover shown in the figure to
check the chassis number.
qVehicle Emission Control
Information Label (U.S.A. and
Canada)
9-2
Identification Numbers
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page512
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (513,1)
qTire Pressure Label
qEngine Number
SKYACTIV-G 2.0, SKYACTIV-G 2.5
Forward
Identification Numbers
9-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page513
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (514,1)
Specifications
qEngine
Item Specification
SKYACTIV-G 2.0 SKYACTIV-G 2.5
Type DOHC-16V in-line, 4-cylinder
Bore × Stroke 83.5 × 91.2 mm (3.29 × 3.59 in) 89.0 × 100 mm (3.50 × 3.94 in)
Displacement 1,997.6 ml (1,997.6 cc) 2,488.5 ml (2,488.5 cc)
Compression ratio 13.0 13.0
qElectrical System
Item Classification
Battery 12V-60Ah/20HR or 12V-65Ah/20HR
Spark-plug number Mazda Genuine spark plug
*1
PE5R-18-110 or PE5S-18-110
*1 This spark plug provides the SKYACTIV-G engine with optimum performance. Contact an Authorized Mazda
Dealer for details.
CAUTION
When cleaning the iridium plugs, do not use a wire brush. The fine particulate
coating on the iridium alloy and platinum tips could be damaged.
qLubricant Quality
Lubricant Classification
Engine oil Refer to Recommended Oil on page 6-21.
Manual transaxle oil API Service GL-4
SAE 75W-80
Automatic transaxle fluid Mazda Genuine ATF FZ
Transfer case oil API Service GL-5
SAE 80W-90
Rear differential oil API Service GL-5
SAE 80W-90
Brake/Clutch fluid SAE J1703 or FMVSS116 DOT-3
NOTE
Refer to Introduction on (page 6-2) for owner's responsibility in protecting your investment.
9-4
Specifications
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page514
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (515,1)
qCapacities
(Approximate Quantities)
Item Capacity
Engine oil
SKYACTIV-G 2.0
With oil filter replacement 4.2 L (4.4 US qt, 3.7 Imp qt)
Without oil filter replacement 4.0 L (4.2 US qt, 3.5 Imp qt)
SKYACTIV-G 2.5
With oil filter replacement 4.5 L (4.8 US qt, 4.0 Imp qt)
Without oil filter replacement 4.3 L (4.5 US qt, 3.8 Imp qt)
Coolant
U.S.A. and
Canada
SKYACTIV-G 2.0
Manual transaxle 7.3 L (7.7 US qt, 6.4 Imp qt)
Automatic
transaxle 7.5 L (7.9 US qt, 6.6 Imp qt)
SKYACTIV-G 2.5 7.7 L (8.1 US qt, 6.8 Imp qt)
Mexico SKYACTIV-G 2.0 7.7 L (8.1 US qt, 6.8 Imp qt)
SKYACTIV-G 2.5 7.9 L (8.3 US qt, 7.0 Imp qt)
Manual transaxle oil 1.65 L (1.74 US qt, 1.45 Imp qt)
Automatic transaxle fluid 7.8 L (8.2 US qt, 6.9 Imp qt)
Transfer case oil 0.45 L (0.48 US qt, 0.40 Imp qt)
Rear differential oil 0.45 L (0.48 US qt, 0.40 Imp qt)
Fuel tank 2WD 56.0 L (14.8 US gal, 12.3 Imp gal)
AWD 58.0 L (15.3 US gal, 12.8 Imp gal)
Check oil and fluid levels with dipsticks or reservoir gauges.
qDimensions
Item Vehicle specification
Overall length 4,540 mm (178.7 in)
Overall width 1,840 mm (72.4 in)
Overall height 1,710 mm (67.3 in)
Front tread 1,585 mm (62.4 in)
Rear tread 1,590 mm (62.6 in)
Wheelbase 2,700 mm (106.3 in)
qWeights
U.S.A. and Canada
SKYACTIV-G 2.0
(2WD)
Item Weight
Manual transaxle Automatic transaxle
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) 1,940 kg (4,277 lb) 1,975 kg (4,354 lb)
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) Front 972 kg (2,143 lb) 1,009 kg (2,224 lb)
Rear 971 kg (2,141 lb) 969 kg (2,136 lb)
Specifications
9-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page515
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (516,1)
(AWD)
Item Weight
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) 2,043 kg (4,504 lb)
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) Front 1,026 kg (2,262 lb)
Rear 1,020 kg (2,249 lb)
SKYACTIV-G 2.5
(2WD)
Item Weight
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) 2,000 kg (4,409 lb)
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) Front 1,035 kg (2,282 lb)
Rear 968 kg (2,134 lb)
(AWD)
Item Weight
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) 2,071 kg (4,566 lb)
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) Front 1,056 kg (2,328 lb)
Rear 1,018 kg (2,244 lb)
Mexico
SKYACTIV-G 2.0
Item Weight
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
Total 1,978 kg (4,361 lb)
Front 991 kg (2,185 lb)
Rear 987 kg (2,176 lb)
GAW (Permissible axle load) Front 1,011 kg (2,229 lb)
Rear 1,065 kg (2,348 lb)
SKYACTIV-G 2.5
(2WD)
Item Weight
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
Total 2,000 kg (4,409 lb)
Front 1,017 kg (2,242 lb)
Rear 983 kg (2,167 lb)
GAW (Permissible axle load) Front 1,037 kg (2,286 lb)
Rear 1,062 kg (2,341 lb)
(AWD)
Item Weight
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
Total 2,066 kg (4,555 lb)
Front 1,037 kg (2,286 lb)
Rear 1,029 kg (2,269 lb)
GAW (Permissible axle load) Front 1,058 kg (2,332 lb)
Rear 1,108 kg (2,443 lb)
9-6
Specifications
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page516
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (517,1)
qAir Conditioner
The type of refrigerant used is indicated on a label attached to the inside of the engine compartment. Check the
label before recharging the refrigerant. Refer to Climate Control System on page 5-2.
Item Classification
Refrigerant Type HFC134a (R-134a)
qLight Bulbs
Exterior light
Light bulb Category
Wattage ECE R (SAE)
With halogen bulb headlights
Headlights Low beam 55 H11 (H11)
High beam 65 HB3 (9005)
Daytime running lights
With xenon fusion bulb headlights
Headlights High/Low beam 35 D4S (D4S)
Daytime running lights 13 P13W ()
Front turn signal lights/
Parking lights (Front side-marker lights) 27/8 (1157NA)
Fog lights
í
55 H11 (H11)
Side turn signal lights LED
*1
()
High-mount brake light LED
*1
()
Rear turn signal lights 21 WY21W (7443NA)
Brake lights/Taillights 21/5 W21/5W (7443)
Rear side-marker lights 5 W5W ()
Taillights (Liftgate side) 5 W5W ()
Reverse lights 18 W16W (921)
License plate lights 5 W5W ()
*1 LED is the abbreviation for Light Emitting Diode.
Interior light
Light bulb Category
Wattage ECE R
Overhead lights (Front)/Map lights 8
Rear map lights 8
Luggage compartment light 5
Vanity mirror lights
í
2
Specifications
9-7
í
Some models.
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page517
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (518,1)
qTires
NOTE
The tires have been optimally matched with the chassis of your vehicle.
When replacing tires, Mazda recommends that you replace tires of the same type originally fitted to
your vehicle. For details, contact an Authorized Mazda Dealer.
Check the tire pressure label for tire size and inflation pressure.
Refer to Tire Inflation Pressure on page 6-36.
After adjusting the tire pressure, initialization of the tire pressure monitoring system is
necessary to make the system operates normally.
Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System Initialization on page 4-95.
Standard tire
(U.S.A. and Canada)
Tire size Inflation pressure
Front Rear
P225/65R17 100H 230 kPa (34 psi) 230 kPa (34 psi)
P225/55R19 99V 250 kPa (36 psi) 250 kPa (36 psi)
(Mexico)
Tire size Inflation pressure
Up to 3 persons Full load
225/65R17 102V Front 230 kPa (2.3 bar, 33 psi) 260 kPa (2.6 bar, 38 psi)
Rear 230 kPa (2.3 bar, 33 psi) 280 kPa (2.8 bar, 41 psi)
225/55R19 99V Front 250 kPa (2.5 bar, 36 psi) 260 kPa (2.6 bar, 38 psi)
Rear 250 kPa (2.5 bar, 36 psi) 290 kPa (2.9 bar, 42 psi)
1 person's weight: About 75 kg
Temporary spare tire
(U.S.A. and Canada)
Tire size Inflation pressure
T145/90D16 106M 420 kPa (60 psi)
(Mexico)
Tire size Inflation pressure
185/80R17 95M 250 kPa (2.5 bar, 36 psi)
Lug nut tightening torque
When installing a tire, tighten the lug nut to the following torque.
108147 N·m (1214 kgf·m, 80108 ft·lbf)
9-8
Specifications
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page518
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (519,1)
qFuses
Refer to Fuses on page 6-49.
Specifications
9-9
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page519
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (520,1)
Personalization Features
The following personalization feature is available. This setting can only be changed by an Authorized Mazda.
Items in which the feature setting can be changed differ depending on the market and specification.
Item Feature Factory Setting Available Settings
Daytime running
lights
The function of the daytime running lights can
be changed. On On/Off
9-10
Personalization Features
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page520
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (521,1)
The following personalization features can be changed by the vehicle owner.
Items in which the feature setting can be changed differ depending on the market and specification.
Item Feature Factory Setting Available Settings
Power door lock
Changes the auto lock/unlock function setting for all
the doors according to the vehicle speed, the vehicle
power supply condition, and the selector lever
position.
Refer to Auto Lock/Unlock Function on page 3-14.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Lock: Driving,
Unlock: IGN
Off
Off/Lock When
Driving/Lock: Shift
From P, Unlock: In
P/Lock When
Shifting Out Of P
Keyless entry
system
The method for unlocking the doors using the
transmitter can be changed.
Refer to Transmitter on page 3-4.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Once: Driver's,
Twice: All
Doors
Touch Once: All
Doors
The time required for the doors to relock
automatically after unlocking with the transmitter can
be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
60 seconds 30 seconds/90
seconds
Advanced keyless
entry system
The volume of the answer-back beep during advanced
keyless entry system operation can be changed.
Refer to Locking, Unlocking with Request Switch
(With the advanced keyless function) on page 3-11.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Medium Off/Low/High
The function to automatically lock the doors when
leaving the vehicle while carrying the key can be
changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Off On
The method for unlocking the doors using the request
switch can be changed.
Refer to Locking, Unlocking with Request Switch
(With the advanced keyless function) on page 3-11.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Once: Driver's,
Twice: All
Doors
Touch Once: All
Doors
The time required for the doors to relock
automatically after unlocking with the transmitter can
be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
60 seconds 30 seconds/90
seconds
Illumination entry
The time required for the interior lamp to turn off
automatically can be changed
(prevents battery depletion when a door is open/ajar).
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
30 minutes 60 minutes/10
minutes
The time required for the interior lamp to turn off
automatically after all doors are closed can be
changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
15 seconds 7.5 seconds/30
seconds/60 seconds
Three-flash turn
signal
The three-flash turn function can be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55. On Off
Auto-wiper control The auto-wiper control function can be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
On
(Rain Sensing) Off (Intermittent)
Personalization Features
9-11
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page521
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (522,1)
Item Feature Factory Setting Available Settings
Auto headlight
off
*1
The time required for headlights to turn off after
ignition is switched off can be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
30 seconds
0 seconds
*2
/
60 seconds/
90 seconds/
120 seconds
Auto-light control
The headlight illumination on/off timing based on
surrounding lightness/darkness can be changed.
Refer to Setup on page 5-55.
Medium
Light/Medium
Light/Medium
Dark/Dark
Turn indicator
The turn indicator beep volume level can be changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
High Low
Lights-on
reminder
*3
The volume of the lights-on reminder warning alarm
can be changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
Off High/Low
Blind Spot
Monitoring (BSM)
system
The volume of the BSM warning beep can be
changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
High Low/OFF
Multi-information
display operation
sound
The operation sound volume for the following
operations can be changed.
lTrip computer data clearing
The INFO switch is pressed for 1.5 seconds or
longer while the average fuel economy or average
vehicle speed is displayed.
lNumerical value scroll
The Up/Down switch is pressed for 1.5 seconds or
longer, such as while the maintenance monitor
period setting screen is displayed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
High Low/OFF
9-12
Personalization Features
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page522
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (523,1)
Item Feature Factory Setting Available Settings
Meter display
The distance unit can be changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
miles or km km or miles
The display language can be changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
English, French,
or Spanish
English/French/Spanish
The temperature unit can be changed.
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
°F or °C °C or °F
Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS)
The system can be changed so that Smart City Brake
Support (SCBS) does not operate.
*4
Refer to Trip Computer and INFO Switch on page
4-18.
ON OFF
*1 If the setting is changed to 0 seconds, the following operation is performed according to the headlight switch
position:
lAt position: Headlights turn off immediately after the ignition is switched off.
lAt any position other than : Headlights do not turn off after the ignition is switched off.
*2 When set to 0 seconds, the lights-on reminder is operable.
*3 The setting of the lights-on reminder can be changed with the time setting of auto headlight off function set to
0 seconds.
Refer to Lights-On Reminder on page 7-32.
*4 Though these systems can be turned OFF, doing so will defeat the purpose of the system and Mazda
recommends that these systems remain ON.
Personalization Features
9-13
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page523
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (524,1)
9-14
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page524
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (525,1)
10 Index
10-1
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page525
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (526,1)
A
Accessory Socket ............................ 5-114
Adaptive Front Lighting System
(AFS) ................................................ 4-59
Add-On Non-Genuine Parts and
Accessories ....................................... 8-19
Advanced Key
Operational range ......................... 3-9
Advanced Keyless Entry System ........ 3-8
Air Bag Systems ............................... 2-40
All-Wheel Drive
(AWD) Operation ............................. 4-86
Antilock Brake System (ABS) .......... 4-82
Audio Control Switch
Adjusting the Volume ................ 5-57
Mute Switch ............................... 5-57
Seek Switch ................................ 5-57
Audio System
Antenna ...................................... 5-13
Audio Control Switch ................ 5-56
Audio Set (Type A) .................... 5-25
Audio Set (Type B) .................... 5-35
AUX/USB/iPod mode ................ 5-58
Operating Tips for Audio
System ........................................ 5-13
Satellite Radio ............................ 5-44
Automatic Transaxle
Driving tips ................................ 4-53
Manual shift mode ..................... 4-49
Shift-lock override ..................... 4-48
Shift-lock system ....................... 4-48
Transaxle ranges ........................ 4-47
B
Battery ............................................... 6-31
Maintenance ............................... 6-32
Specifications ............................... 9-4
B
Battery runs out ................................. 7-14
Jump-Starting ............................. 7-14
Beep Sounds
Air bag/front seat belt pretensioner
system warning .......................... 7-33
Blind spot monitoring
(BSM) system warning .............. 7-35
Ignition not switched off
(STOP) warning ......................... 7-33
Key left-in-luggage compartment
warning ...................................... 7-34
Key left-in-vehicle warning ....... 7-34
Key removed from vehicle
warning ...................................... 7-34
Lights-on reminder ..................... 7-32
Request switch inoperable
warning ...................................... 7-34
Seat belt warning ........................ 7-33
Tire inflation pressure warning ... 7-34
Blind Spot Monitoring
(BSM) System .................................. 4-97
BSM OFF switch ..................... 4-100
BSM warning light ..................... 4-99
Care of radar sensors ................ 4-100
Bluetooth® ....................................... 5-77
Bluetooth® Audio .................... 5-102
Bluetooth® Hands-Free ............. 5-83
Troubleshooting ....................... 5-106
Body Lubrication .............................. 6-26
Bottle Holder ................................... 5-117
Brakes
Brakes assist ............................... 4-73
Foot brake .................................. 4-71
Pad wear indicator ...................... 4-73
Parking brake ............................. 4-72
Break-In Period ................................. 3-39
10-2
Index
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page526
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (527,1)
C
Capacities ............................................ 9-5
Carbon Monoxide ............................. 3-23
Cargo Securing Loops ..................... 5-119
Cell Phones ....................................... 8-20
Center Console ................................ 5-119
Child Restraint
Child-restraint system
installation .................................. 2-28
Installing child-restraint
systems ....................................... 2-29
LATCH child-restraint
systems ....................................... 2-36
Child Safety Locks for Rear Doors ... 3-18
Climate Control System ...................... 5-2
Fully Automatic Type .................. 5-9
Gas specifications ........................ 9-7
Manual Type ................................ 5-5
Operating Tips .............................. 5-2
Vent Operation ............................. 5-3
Clock ............................................... 5-113
Cruise Control ................................... 4-89
Cruise Control Set Vehicle Speed ..... 4-15
Cup Holder ...................................... 5-116
Customer Assistance ........................... 8-2
D
Dashboard Illumination .................... 4-13
Daytime Running Lights ................... 4-59
Defogger
Mirror ......................................... 4-66
Rear window .............................. 4-66
Dimensions ......................................... 9-5
Door Locks ....................................... 3-10
Driving In Flooded Area ................... 3-43
Driving on Uneven Road .................. 3-44
D
Driving Tips ...................................... 3-39
Automatic transaxle ................... 4-53
Break-in period .......................... 3-39
Driving in flooded area .............. 3-43
Driving on uneven road ............. 3-44
Floor mat .................................... 3-40
Hazardous driving ...................... 3-40
Money-saving suggestions ......... 3-39
Overloading ............................... 3-43
Rocking the vehicle .................... 3-41
Winter driving ............................ 3-41
Dynamic Stability Control (DSC) ..... 4-84
E
Emergency Starting
Push-Starting .............................. 7-17
Starting a Flooded Engine .......... 7-17
Emergency Towing
Tiedown Hooks .......................... 7-21
Towing Description .................... 7-20
Emission Control System .................. 3-22
Engine
Coolant ....................................... 6-23
Engine Compartment
Overview .................................... 6-20
Exhaust gas ................................ 3-23
Hood release .............................. 6-18
Oil .............................................. 6-21
Starting ......................................... 4-3
Essential information .......................... 6-2
Event Data Recorder ......................... 8-21
Exhaust Gas ...................................... 3-23
Index
10-3
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page527
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (528,1)
E
Exterior Care ..................................... 6-56
Aluminum Wheel
Maintenance ............................... 6-60
Bright-Metal Maintenance ......... 6-59
Maintaining the Finish ............... 6-57
Plastic Part Maintenance ............ 6-61
F
Flasher
Hazard warning .......................... 4-67
Headlights .................................. 4-55
Flat Tire ............................................... 7-3
Mounting the Spare Tire ............ 7-12
Floor Mat .......................................... 3-40
Fluid
Brake/Clutch .............................. 6-25
Washer ........................................ 6-25
Fluids
Classification ................................ 9-4
Fog Lights ......................................... 4-60
Foot Brake ........................................ 4-71
Front Seat ............................................ 2-5
Fuel
Filler lid and cap ........................ 3-24
Gauge ......................................... 4-13
Requirements ............................. 3-21
Tank capacity ............................... 9-5
G
Gauges .............................................. 4-10
Glove Compartment ........................ 5-118
H
Hazard Warning Flasher .................... 4-67
Hazardous Driving ............................ 3-40
H
Head Restraint .................................. 2-12
Headlights
Control ....................................... 4-55
Flashing ...................................... 4-58
High-low beam .......................... 4-58
Leveling ..................................... 4-59
Hill Launch Assist (HLA) ................. 4-74
HomeLink Wireless Control
System .............................................. 4-68
Hood Release .................................... 6-18
Horn .................................................. 4-67
I
Ignition
Switch .......................................... 4-2
Illuminated Entry System ................ 5-112
Immobilizer System .......................... 3-35
Indicator Lights
AFS OFF .................................... 4-40
BSM OFF ................................... 4-43
Cruise ......................................... 4-42
Hazard warning .......................... 4-42
Headlight high-beam .................. 4-42
KEY ............................................ 4-38
Lights-on .................................... 4-43
Low engine coolant
temperature ................................ 4-41
Power steering malfunction ........ 4-33
Security ...................................... 4-42
Shift position .............................. 4-41
Smart City Brake Support
(SCBS) OFF ............................... 4-41
TCS OFF .................................... 4-40
TCS/DSC ................................... 4-40
Turn signal ................................. 4-42
Wrench ....................................... 4-40
10-4
Index
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page528
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (529,1)
I
Inspecting Brake/Clutch Fluid
Level ................................................. 6-25
Inspecting Coolant Level .................. 6-23
Inspecting Engine Oil Level ............. 6-22
Inspecting Washer Fluid Level ......... 6-25
Instrument Cluster ............................. 4-10
Interior Care ...................................... 6-61
Cleaning the Lap/Shoulder Belt
Webbing ..................................... 6-63
Cleaning the Upholstery and Interior
Trim ............................................ 6-61
Cleaning the Window Interiors... 6-63
Dashboard Precautions ............... 6-61
Interior Lights ................................. 5-111
Luggage Compartment Light.... 5-111
Map Lights ............................... 5-111
Overhead Lights ....................... 5-111
J
Jack ..................................................... 7-5
Jump-Starting .................................... 7-14
K
Key Suspend Function ........................ 3-7
Keyless Entry System ......................... 3-3
Keys .................................................... 3-2
Key suspend function ................... 3-7
Transmitter ................................... 3-4
L
Label Information ............................... 9-2
Lane-Change Signals ........................ 4-60
Liftgate .............................................. 3-18
L
Light Bulbs
Replacement ............................... 6-40
Specifications ............................... 9-7
Lighting Control ............................... 4-55
Lubricant Quality ................................ 9-4
Luggage Compartment ................... 5-120
Luggage Compartment Light .......... 5-111
M
Maintenance and Care ........................ 6-2
Maintenance Monitor ........................ 4-15
Manual Transaxle Operation ............. 4-44
Recommendations for shifting.... 4-45
Map Lights ...................................... 5-111
Meters and Gauges ........................... 4-10
Mirror Defogger ................................ 4-66
Mirrors
Outside mirrors .......................... 3-27
Rearview mirror ......................... 3-28
Money-Saving Suggestions .............. 3-39
O
Odometer and Trip Meter .................. 4-11
Outside Mirrors ................................. 3-27
Outside Temperature Display ............ 4-14
Overhead Console ........................... 5-118
Overhead Lights .............................. 5-111
Overheating ....................................... 7-18
Overloading ...................................... 3-43
Index
10-5
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page529
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (530,1)
O
Owner Maintenance
Closing the Hood ....................... 6-19
Engine Compartment
Overview .................................... 6-20
Opening the Hood ...................... 6-18
Owner Maintenance
Precautions ................................. 6-16
Replace Electrical Battery .......... 6-33
P
Parking Brake ................................... 4-72
Personalization Features ................... 9-10
Power Steering .................................. 4-88
Power Windows ................................ 3-30
R
Rear Coat Hooks ............................. 5-119
Rear Door Child Safety Locks .......... 3-18
Rear Seat ............................................. 2-8
Rear View Monitor ......................... 4-101
Rear Window Defogger .................... 4-66
Rear Window Washer ....................... 4-65
Rear Window Wiper .......................... 4-65
Rearview Mirror ................................ 3-28
Recommended Oil ............................ 6-21
Recreational Towing ......................... 3-53
Registering Your Vehicle in A Foreign
Country ............................................. 8-18
Replacement
Electrical battery ......................... 6-33
Fuse ............................................ 6-49
Light Bulbs ................................ 6-40
Tires ........................................... 6-37
Wheel ......................................... 6-38
Wiper .......................................... 6-27
Rocking the Vehicle .......................... 3-41
S
Safety Defects, Reporting ................. 8-14
Satellite Radio ................................... 5-44
Scheduled Maintenance ...................... 6-4
Seat Belt System
3-point type ................................ 2-17
Automatic locking ...................... 2-16
Emergency locking .................... 2-16
Extender ..................................... 2-21
Pregnant women ........................ 2-16
Seats
Front seat ...................................... 2-5
Head restraint ............................. 2-12
Rear seat ....................................... 2-8
Seat warmer .................................. 2-7
Security System
Immobilizer system .................... 3-35
Theft-deterrent system ............... 3-37
Service Publications .......................... 8-48
Smart City Brake Support (SCBS) .... 4-76
Laser Sensor Handling ............... 4-79
Stopping The Smart City Brake
Support
(SCBS) System Operation ......... 4-81
Spare Tire ............................................ 7-5
Specifications ...................................... 9-4
Speedometer ...................................... 4-11
SRS Air Bags
Front passenger occupant
classification system .................. 2-56
How the SRS air bags work ....... 2-49
Limitations to SRS air bag ......... 2-54
Monitoring ................................. 2-62
SRS air bag deployment
criteria ........................................ 2-53
Supplemental restraint system
components ................................ 2-47
Starting the Engine .............................. 4-3
10-6
Index
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page530
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (531,1)
S
Steering Wheel .................................. 3-26
Horn ........................................... 4-67
Storage Compartments .................... 5-118
Cargo securing loops ................ 5-119
Center console .......................... 5-119
Glove compartment .................. 5-118
Luggage Compartment ............. 5-120
Overhead console ..................... 5-118
Rear coat hooks ........................ 5-119
Sunshade ........................................... 3-34
Sunvisors ......................................... 5-110
T
Tachometer ........................................ 4-12
Theft-Deterrent System ..................... 3-37
Tiedown
Hook .......................................... 7-21
Tire Information ................................ 8-24
Tire Pressure Monitoring System ...... 4-93
Tires .................................................. 6-35
Flat Tire ........................................ 7-3
Replacing a Tire ......................... 6-37
Replacing a Wheel ..................... 6-38
Snow tires .................................. 3-42
Specifications ............................... 9-8
Temporary Spare Tire ................. 6-38
Tire chains .................................. 3-42
Tire Inflation Pressure ................ 6-36
Tire Rotation .............................. 6-36
Uniform tire quality grading system
(UTQGS) ................................... 8-22
Towing
Recreational towing ................... 3-53
Trailer Towing
(U.S.A. and Canada) .................. 3-45
Towing Description ........................... 7-20
T
Traction Control System (TCS) ........ 4-83
TCS OFF switch ........................ 4-84
Transmitter .......................................... 3-4
Trip Computer ................................... 4-18
Trip Meter ......................................... 4-11
Trouble
Battery runs out .......................... 7-14
Emergency Starting .................... 7-17
Emergency Towing .................... 7-20
Flat Tire ........................................ 7-3
Overheating ................................ 7-18
Parking in an Emergency ............. 7-2
Warning/indicator lights and warning
sounds ........................................ 7-23
When liftgate cannot be
opened ........................................ 7-36
Turn and Lane-Change Signals ......... 4-60
V
Vanity Mirrors ................................. 5-110
Vehicle Information Labels ................. 9-2
Index
10-7
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page531
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A
Black plate (532,1)
W
Warning Lights
ABS ............................................ 4-29
Air bag system ........................... 4-33
Automatic transaxle ................... 4-32
AWD .......................................... 4-32
Brake system .............................. 4-28
Charging system ......................... 4-30
Check engine .............................. 4-31
Check fuel cap ........................... 4-34
Door-ajar .................................... 4-35
Engine oil ................................... 4-30
Front seat belt pretensioner
system ........................................ 4-33
High engine coolant
temperature ................................ 4-31
KEY ............................................ 4-38
Low fuel ..................................... 4-34
Low washer fluid level ............... 4-36
Seat belt ...................................... 4-34
Tire pressure monitoring
system ........................................ 4-36
Warning/Buzzer ................................ 7-23
Warranty ............................................ 8-16
Weights ............................................... 9-5
Windows
Power windows .......................... 3-30
Windshield Washer ........................... 4-65
Windshield Wipers ............................ 4-62
Winter Driving .................................. 3-41
Wiper
Replacing Rear Window Wiper
Blade .......................................... 6-28
Replacing Windshield Wiper
Blades ........................................ 6-27
10-8
Index
CX-5_8DR2-EA-14A_Edition1 Page532
Thursday, November 21 2013 8:50 AM
Form No.8DR2-EA-14A

Navigation menu